|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 2 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | assess multiple developmental domains, including literacy, |
2 | | language, mathematics, and social and emotional development. |
3 | | The assessment must be valid, reliable, and developmentally |
4 | | appropriate to formatively assess a child's development and |
5 | | readiness for kindergarten. |
6 | | (c) Results from the assessment may be used by the school |
7 | | to understand the child's development and readiness for |
8 | | kindergarten, to tailor instruction, and to measure the child's |
9 | | progress over time. Assessment results may also be used to |
10 | | identify a need for the professional development of teachers |
11 | | and early childhood educators and to inform State-level and |
12 | | district-level policies and resource allocation. |
13 | | The school shall make the assessment results available to |
14 | | the child's parent or guardian. |
15 | | The assessment results may not be used (i) to prevent a |
16 | | child from enrolling in kindergarten or (ii) as the sole |
17 | | measure used in determining the grade promotion or retention of |
18 | | a student. |
19 | | (d) On an annual basis, the State Board shall report |
20 | | publicly, at a minimum, data from the assessment for the State |
21 | | overall and for each school district. The State Board's report |
22 | | must disaggregate data by race and ethnicity, household income, |
23 | | students who are English learners, and students who have an |
24 | | individualized education program. |
25 | | (e) The State Superintendent of Education shall appoint a |
26 | | committee of no more than 21 members, consisting of parents, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 3 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | teachers, school administrators, assessment experts, regional |
2 | | superintendents of schools, and citizens, to review, on an |
3 | | ongoing basis, the content and design of the assessment, the |
4 | | collective results of the assessment as measured against |
5 | | kindergarten-readiness standards, and other issues involving |
6 | | the assessment as identified by the committee. |
7 | | The committee shall make periodic recommendations to the |
8 | | State Superintendent of Education and the General Assembly |
9 | | concerning the assessments. |
10 | | (f) The State Board may adopt rules to implement and |
11 | | administer this Section.
|
12 | | (105 ILCS 5/27A-5)
|
13 | | Sec. 27A-5. Charter school; legal entity; requirements.
|
14 | | (a) A charter school shall be a public, nonsectarian, |
15 | | nonreligious, non-home
based, and non-profit school. A charter |
16 | | school shall be organized and operated
as a nonprofit |
17 | | corporation or other discrete, legal, nonprofit entity
|
18 | | authorized under the laws of the State of Illinois.
|
19 | | (b) A charter school may be established under this Article |
20 | | by creating a new
school or by converting an existing public |
21 | | school or attendance center to
charter
school status.
Beginning |
22 | | on April 16, 2003 (the effective date of Public Act 93-3), in |
23 | | all new
applications to establish
a charter
school in a city |
24 | | having a population exceeding 500,000, operation of the
charter
|
25 | | school shall be limited to one campus. The changes made to this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 4 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Section by Public Act 93-3 do not apply to charter schools |
2 | | existing or approved on or before April 16, 2003 (the
effective |
3 | | date of Public Act 93-3). |
4 | | (b-5) In this subsection (b-5), "virtual-schooling" means |
5 | | a cyber school where students engage in online curriculum and |
6 | | instruction via the Internet and electronic communication with |
7 | | their teachers at remote locations and with students |
8 | | participating at different times. |
9 | | From April 1, 2013 through December 31, 2016, there is a |
10 | | moratorium on the establishment of charter schools with |
11 | | virtual-schooling components in school districts other than a |
12 | | school district organized under Article 34 of this Code. This |
13 | | moratorium does not apply to a charter school with |
14 | | virtual-schooling components existing or approved prior to |
15 | | April 1, 2013 or to the renewal of the charter of a charter |
16 | | school with virtual-schooling components already approved |
17 | | prior to April 1, 2013.
|
18 | | (c) A charter school shall be administered and governed by |
19 | | its board of
directors or other governing body
in the manner |
20 | | provided in its charter. The governing body of a charter school
|
21 | | shall be subject to the Freedom of Information Act and the Open |
22 | | Meetings Act. No later than January 1, 2021 ( one year after the |
23 | | effective date of Public Act 101-291) this amendatory Act of |
24 | | the 101st General Assembly , a charter school's board of |
25 | | directors or other governing body must include at least one |
26 | | parent or guardian of a pupil currently enrolled in the charter |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 5 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | school who may be selected through the charter school or a |
2 | | charter network election, appointment by the charter school's |
3 | | board of directors or other governing body, or by the charter |
4 | | school's Parent Teacher Organization or its equivalent. |
5 | | (c-5) No later than January 1, 2021 ( one year after the |
6 | | effective date of Public Act 101-291) this amendatory Act of |
7 | | the 101st General Assembly or within the first year of his or |
8 | | her first term, every voting member of a charter school's board |
9 | | of directors or other governing body shall complete a minimum |
10 | | of 4 hours of professional development leadership training to |
11 | | ensure that each member has sufficient familiarity with the |
12 | | board's or governing body's role and responsibilities, |
13 | | including financial oversight and accountability of the |
14 | | school, evaluating the principal's and school's performance, |
15 | | adherence to the Freedom of Information Act and the Open |
16 | | Meetings Act Acts , and compliance with education and labor law. |
17 | | In each subsequent year of his or her term, a voting member of |
18 | | a charter school's board of directors or other governing body |
19 | | shall complete a minimum of 2 hours of professional development |
20 | | training in these same areas. The training under this |
21 | | subsection may be provided or certified by a statewide charter |
22 | | school membership association or may be provided or certified |
23 | | by other qualified providers approved by the State Board of |
24 | | Education.
|
25 | | (d) For purposes of this subsection (d), "non-curricular |
26 | | health and safety requirement" means any health and safety |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 6 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | requirement created by statute or rule to provide, maintain, |
2 | | preserve, or safeguard safe or healthful conditions for |
3 | | students and school personnel or to eliminate, reduce, or |
4 | | prevent threats to the health and safety of students and school |
5 | | personnel. "Non-curricular health and safety requirement" does |
6 | | not include any course of study or specialized instructional |
7 | | requirement for which the State Board has established goals and |
8 | | learning standards or which is designed primarily to impart |
9 | | knowledge and skills for students to master and apply as an |
10 | | outcome of their education. |
11 | | A charter school shall comply with all non-curricular |
12 | | health and safety
requirements applicable to public schools |
13 | | under the laws of the State of
Illinois. On or before September |
14 | | 1, 2015, the State Board shall promulgate and post on its |
15 | | Internet website a list of non-curricular health and safety |
16 | | requirements that a charter school must meet. The list shall be |
17 | | updated annually no later than September 1. Any charter |
18 | | contract between a charter school and its authorizer must |
19 | | contain a provision that requires the charter school to follow |
20 | | the list of all non-curricular health and safety requirements |
21 | | promulgated by the State Board and any non-curricular health |
22 | | and safety requirements added by the State Board to such list |
23 | | during the term of the charter. Nothing in this subsection (d) |
24 | | precludes an authorizer from including non-curricular health |
25 | | and safety requirements in a charter school contract that are |
26 | | not contained in the list promulgated by the State Board, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 7 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | including non-curricular health and safety requirements of the |
2 | | authorizing local school board.
|
3 | | (e) Except as otherwise provided in the School Code, a |
4 | | charter school shall
not charge tuition; provided that a |
5 | | charter school may charge reasonable fees
for textbooks, |
6 | | instructional materials, and student activities.
|
7 | | (f) A charter school shall be responsible for the |
8 | | management and operation
of its fiscal affairs including,
but |
9 | | not limited to, the preparation of its budget. An audit of each |
10 | | charter
school's finances shall be conducted annually by an |
11 | | outside, independent
contractor retained by the charter |
12 | | school. To ensure financial accountability for the use of |
13 | | public funds, on or before December 1 of every year of |
14 | | operation, each charter school shall submit to its authorizer |
15 | | and the State Board a copy of its audit and a copy of the Form |
16 | | 990 the charter school filed that year with the federal |
17 | | Internal Revenue Service. In addition, if deemed necessary for |
18 | | proper financial oversight of the charter school, an authorizer |
19 | | may require quarterly financial statements from each charter |
20 | | school.
|
21 | | (g) A charter school shall comply with all provisions of |
22 | | this Article, the Illinois Educational Labor Relations Act, all |
23 | | federal and State laws and rules applicable to public schools |
24 | | that pertain to special education and the instruction of |
25 | | English learners, and
its charter. A charter
school is exempt |
26 | | from all other State laws and regulations in this Code
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 8 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | governing public
schools and local school board policies; |
2 | | however, a charter school is not exempt from the following:
|
3 | | (1) Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5 of this Code regarding |
4 | | criminal
history records checks and checks of the Statewide |
5 | | Sex Offender Database and Statewide Murderer and Violent |
6 | | Offender Against Youth Database of applicants for |
7 | | employment;
|
8 | | (2) Sections 10-20.14, 10-22.6, 24-24, 34-19, and |
9 | | 34-84a of this Code regarding discipline of
students;
|
10 | | (3) the Local Governmental and Governmental Employees |
11 | | Tort Immunity Act;
|
12 | | (4) Section 108.75 of the General Not For Profit |
13 | | Corporation Act of 1986
regarding indemnification of |
14 | | officers, directors, employees, and agents;
|
15 | | (5) the Abused and Neglected Child Reporting Act;
|
16 | | (5.5) subsection (b) of Section 10-23.12 and |
17 | | subsection (b) of Section 34-18.6 of this Code; |
18 | | (6) the Illinois School Student Records Act;
|
19 | | (7) Section 10-17a of this Code regarding school report |
20 | | cards;
|
21 | | (8) the P-20 Longitudinal Education Data System Act; |
22 | | (9) Section 27-23.7 of this Code regarding bullying |
23 | | prevention; |
24 | | (10) Section 2-3.162 of this Code regarding student |
25 | | discipline reporting; |
26 | | (11) Sections 22-80 and 27-8.1 of this Code; |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 9 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (12) Sections 10-20.60 and 34-18.53 of this Code; |
2 | | (13) Sections 10-20.63 and 34-18.56 of this Code; |
3 | | (14) Section 26-18 of this Code; |
4 | | (15) Section 22-30 of this Code; and |
5 | | (16) Sections 24-12 and 34-85 of this Code ; . |
6 | | (17) the (16) The Seizure Smart School Act ; and . |
7 | | (18) Section 2-3.64a-10 of this Code. |
8 | | The change made by Public Act 96-104 to this subsection (g) |
9 | | is declaratory of existing law. |
10 | | (h) A charter school may negotiate and contract with a |
11 | | school district, the
governing body of a State college or |
12 | | university or public community college, or
any other public or |
13 | | for-profit or nonprofit private entity for: (i) the use
of a |
14 | | school building and grounds or any other real property or |
15 | | facilities that
the charter school desires to use or convert |
16 | | for use as a charter school site,
(ii) the operation and |
17 | | maintenance thereof, and
(iii) the provision of any service, |
18 | | activity, or undertaking that the charter
school is required to |
19 | | perform in order to carry out the terms of its charter.
|
20 | | However, a charter school
that is established on
or
after April |
21 | | 16, 2003 (the effective date of Public Act 93-3) and that |
22 | | operates
in a city having a population exceeding
500,000 may |
23 | | not contract with a for-profit entity to
manage or operate the |
24 | | school during the period that commences on April 16, 2003 (the
|
25 | | effective date of Public Act 93-3) and
concludes at the end of |
26 | | the 2004-2005 school year.
Except as provided in subsection (i) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 10 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of this Section, a school district may
charge a charter school |
2 | | reasonable rent for the use of the district's
buildings, |
3 | | grounds, and facilities. Any services for which a charter |
4 | | school
contracts
with a school district shall be provided by |
5 | | the district at cost. Any services
for which a charter school |
6 | | contracts with a local school board or with the
governing body |
7 | | of a State college or university or public community college
|
8 | | shall be provided by the public entity at cost.
|
9 | | (i) In no event shall a charter school that is established |
10 | | by converting an
existing school or attendance center to |
11 | | charter school status be required to
pay rent for space
that is |
12 | | deemed available, as negotiated and provided in the charter |
13 | | agreement,
in school district
facilities. However, all other |
14 | | costs for the operation and maintenance of
school district |
15 | | facilities that are used by the charter school shall be subject
|
16 | | to negotiation between
the charter school and the local school |
17 | | board and shall be set forth in the
charter.
|
18 | | (j) A charter school may limit student enrollment by age or |
19 | | grade level.
|
20 | | (k) If the charter school is approved by the State Board or |
21 | | Commission, then the charter school is its own local education |
22 | | agency. |
23 | | (Source: P.A. 100-29, eff. 1-1-18; 100-156, eff. 1-1-18; |
24 | | 100-163, eff. 1-1-18; 100-413, eff. 1-1-18; 100-468, eff. |
25 | | 6-1-18; 100-726, eff. 1-1-19; 100-863, eff. 8-14-18; 101-50, |
26 | | eff. 7-1-20; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; 101-291, eff. 1-1-20; |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 11 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 101-531, eff. 8-23-19; 101-543, eff. 8-23-19; revised 8-4-20.) |
2 | | Article 10. |
3 | | Section 10-5. The Early Intervention Services System Act is |
4 | | amended by changing Section 11 as follows:
|
5 | | (325 ILCS 20/11) (from Ch. 23, par. 4161)
|
6 | | Sec. 11. Individualized Family Service Plans.
|
7 | | (a) Each eligible infant or toddler and that infant's or |
8 | | toddler's family
shall receive:
|
9 | | (1) timely, comprehensive, multidisciplinary |
10 | | assessment of the unique
strengths and needs of each |
11 | | eligible infant and toddler, and assessment of the concerns
|
12 | | and priorities of the families to appropriately assist them |
13 | | in meeting
their needs and identify supports and services |
14 | | to meet those needs; and
|
15 | | (2) a written Individualized Family Service Plan |
16 | | developed by a
multidisciplinary team which includes the |
17 | | parent or guardian. The
individualized family service plan |
18 | | shall be based on the
multidisciplinary team's assessment |
19 | | of the resources, priorities,
and concerns of the family |
20 | | and its identification of the supports
and services |
21 | | necessary to enhance the family's capacity to meet the
|
22 | | developmental needs of the infant or toddler, and shall |
23 | | include the
identification of services appropriate to meet |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 12 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | those needs, including the
frequency, intensity, and |
2 | | method of delivering services. During and as part of
the |
3 | | initial development of the individualized family services |
4 | | plan, and any
periodic reviews of the plan, the |
5 | | multidisciplinary team may seek consultation from the lead
|
6 | | agency's designated experts, if any, to help
determine |
7 | | appropriate services and the frequency and intensity of |
8 | | those
services. All services in the individualized family |
9 | | services plan must be
justified by the multidisciplinary |
10 | | assessment of the unique strengths and
needs of the infant |
11 | | or toddler and must be appropriate to meet those needs.
At |
12 | | the periodic reviews, the team shall determine whether |
13 | | modification or
revision of the outcomes or services is |
14 | | necessary.
|
15 | | (b) The Individualized Family Service Plan shall be |
16 | | evaluated once a year
and the family shall be provided a review |
17 | | of the Plan at 6 month intervals or
more often where |
18 | | appropriate based on infant or toddler and family needs.
The |
19 | | lead agency shall create a quality review process regarding |
20 | | Individualized
Family Service Plan development and changes |
21 | | thereto, to monitor
and help assure that resources are being |
22 | | used to provide appropriate early
intervention services.
|
23 | | (c) The initial evaluation and initial assessment and |
24 | | initial
Plan meeting must be held within 45 days after the |
25 | | initial
contact with the early intervention services system. |
26 | | The 45-day timeline does not apply for any period when the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 13 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | child or parent is unavailable to complete the initial |
2 | | evaluation, the initial assessments of the child and family, or |
3 | | the initial Plan meeting, due to exceptional family |
4 | | circumstances that are documented in the child's early |
5 | | intervention records, or when the parent has not provided |
6 | | consent for the initial evaluation or the initial assessment of |
7 | | the child despite documented, repeated attempts to obtain |
8 | | parental consent. As soon as exceptional family circumstances |
9 | | no longer exist or parental consent has been obtained, the |
10 | | initial evaluation, the initial assessment, and the initial |
11 | | Plan meeting must be completed as soon as possible. With |
12 | | parental consent,
early intervention services may commence |
13 | | before the completion of the
comprehensive assessment and |
14 | | development of the Plan.
|
15 | | (d) Parents must be informed that early
intervention
|
16 | | services shall be provided to each eligible infant and toddler, |
17 | | to the maximum extent appropriate, in the natural
environment, |
18 | | which may include the home or other community settings. Parents
|
19 | | shall make
the final decision to accept or decline
early |
20 | | intervention services. A decision to decline such services |
21 | | shall
not be a basis for administrative determination of |
22 | | parental fitness, or
other findings or sanctions against the |
23 | | parents. Parameters of the Plan
shall be set forth in rules.
|
24 | | (e) The regional intake offices shall explain to each |
25 | | family, orally and
in
writing, all of the following:
|
26 | | (1) That the early intervention program will pay for |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 14 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | all early
intervention services set forth in the |
2 | | individualized family service plan that
are not
covered or |
3 | | paid under the family's public or private insurance plan or |
4 | | policy
and not
eligible for payment through any other third |
5 | | party payor.
|
6 | | (2) That services will not be delayed due to any rules |
7 | | or restrictions
under the family's insurance plan or |
8 | | policy.
|
9 | | (3) That the family may request, with appropriate |
10 | | documentation
supporting the request, a
determination of |
11 | | an exemption from private insurance use under
Section |
12 | | 13.25.
|
13 | | (4) That responsibility for co-payments or
|
14 | | co-insurance under a family's private insurance
plan or |
15 | | policy will be transferred to the lead
agency's central |
16 | | billing office.
|
17 | | (5) That families will be responsible
for payments of |
18 | | family fees,
which will be based on a sliding scale
|
19 | | according to the State's definition of ability to pay which |
20 | | is comparing household size and income to the sliding scale |
21 | | and considering out-of-pocket medical or disaster |
22 | | expenses, and that these fees
are payable to the central |
23 | | billing office. Families who fail to provide income |
24 | | information shall be charged the maximum amount on the |
25 | | sliding scale.
|
26 | | (f) The individualized family service plan must state |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 15 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | whether the family
has private insurance coverage and, if the |
2 | | family has such coverage, must
have attached to it a copy of |
3 | | the family's insurance identification card or
otherwise
|
4 | | include all of the following information:
|
5 | | (1) The name, address, and telephone number of the |
6 | | insurance
carrier.
|
7 | | (2) The contract number and policy number of the |
8 | | insurance plan.
|
9 | | (3) The name, address, and social security number of |
10 | | the primary
insured.
|
11 | | (4) The beginning date of the insurance benefit year.
|
12 | | (g) A copy of the individualized family service plan must |
13 | | be provided to
each enrolled provider who is providing early |
14 | | intervention services to the
child
who is the subject of that |
15 | | plan.
|
16 | | (h) Children receiving services under this Act shall |
17 | | receive a smooth and effective transition by their third |
18 | | birthday consistent with federal regulations adopted pursuant |
19 | | to Sections 1431 through 1444 of Title 20 of the United States |
20 | | Code. Children who receive early intervention services prior to |
21 | | their third birthday and are found eligible for an |
22 | | individualized education program under the Individuals with |
23 | | Disabilities Education Act, 20 U.S.C. 1414(d)(1)(A), and under |
24 | | Section 14-8.02 of the School Code may continue to receive |
25 | | early intervention services until the beginning of the school |
26 | | year following their third birthday in order to minimize gaps |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 16 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | in services, ensure better continuity of care, and align |
2 | | practices for the enrollment of preschool children with special |
3 | | needs to the enrollment practices of typically developing |
4 | | preschool children. |
5 | | (Source: P.A. 97-902, eff. 8-6-12; 98-41, eff. 6-28-13.)
|
6 | | Article 15. |
7 | | Section 15-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the |
8 | | Equitable Early Childhood Education and Care Act. References in |
9 | | this Article to "this Act" mean this Article. |
10 | | Section 15-5. Findings; policies. |
11 | | (a) The General Assembly finds the following:
|
12 | | (1) Long-standing research shows that high-quality |
13 | | early childhood experiences have an impact on children's |
14 | | short-term and long-term outcomes, such as educational |
15 | | attainment, health, and lifetime income, particularly for |
16 | | children from low-income families. |
17 | | (2) Early childhood education and care programs |
18 | | provide child care so parents can maintain stable |
19 | | employment, provide for themselves and their families, and |
20 | | advance their career or educational goals. |
21 | | (3) Illinois has a vigorous early childhood education |
22 | | and care industry composed of programs that serve children |
23 | | under the age of 6, including preschool and child care in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 17 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | schools, centers, and homes; these programs also include |
2 | | home visiting and services for young children with special |
3 | | needs. |
4 | | (4) A significant portion of the early childhood |
5 | | workforce and of family child care providers are Black and |
6 | | Latinx women. |
7 | | (5) Illinois was among the first states in the nation |
8 | | to enact the Pre-K At-Risk program and services for infants |
9 | | and toddlers in the 1980s and reaffirmed this commitment to |
10 | | early childhood education in 2006 by creating Preschool for |
11 | | All to offer State-funded, high-quality preschool to |
12 | | 3-year-olds and 4-year-olds. |
13 | | (6) Illinois was one of the first states in the nation |
14 | | to commit education funding to very young children and to |
15 | | have a statutory commitment to grow funding for |
16 | | infant-toddler services as it grows preschool services, |
17 | | including prenatal supports like home visitors and doulas. |
18 | | (7) Countless children and families have benefitted |
19 | | from these services over these decades and have had the |
20 | | opportunity to enter school ready to learn and succeed. |
21 | | (8) Despite progress made by the State, too few |
22 | | children, particularly those from Black, Latinx, and |
23 | | low-income households and child care deserts, have access |
24 | | to high-quality early childhood education and care |
25 | | services, due to both the availability and affordability of |
26 | | quality services.
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 18 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (9) In 2019, only 29% of all children in Illinois |
2 | | entered kindergarten "ready"; only 21% of Black children, |
3 | | 17% of Latinx children, 14% of English Learners, 14% of |
4 | | children with IEPs, and 20% of children on free and reduced |
5 | | lunch demonstrated readiness, highlighting the critical |
6 | | work Illinois must do to close gaps in opportunity and |
7 | | outcomes. |
8 | | (10) The State's early childhood education and care |
9 | | programs are maintained across 3 state agencies, which |
10 | | leads to inefficiencies, lack of alignment, challenges to |
11 | | collecting comprehensive data around services and needs of |
12 | | children and families, and obstacles for both children and |
13 | | families and the early childhood education and care |
14 | | providers to navigate the fragmented system and ensure |
15 | | children receive high-quality services that meet their |
16 | | needs. |
17 | | (11) The State's current mechanisms for payment to |
18 | | early childhood education and care providers may not |
19 | | incentivize quality services and can lead to payment |
20 | | delays, lack of stability of providers, and the inability |
21 | | of providers to provide appropriate compensation to the |
22 | | workforce and support quality programming. |
23 | | (12) Illinois must advance a just system for early |
24 | | childhood education and care that ensures racially and |
25 | | economically equitable opportunities and outcomes for all |
26 | | children. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 19 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (13) In 2017, Illinois became a national leader in |
2 | | passing the K-12 Evidence-Based Funding formula for public |
3 | | schools, creating a mechanism to adequately fund and |
4 | | equitably disburse resources throughout the State and |
5 | | prioritize funding for school districts that need it most. |
6 | | (b) The General Assembly supports the following goals of |
7 | | the Illinois Commission on Equitable Early Childhood Education |
8 | | and Care Funding: |
9 | | (1) To create a more equitable, efficient, and |
10 | | effective system and thereby increase access to |
11 | | high-quality services, particularly to serve more Black |
12 | | and Latinx children and populations of children where |
13 | | children of color may be disproportionately represented, |
14 | | such as children from low-income households, with |
15 | | disabilities, experiencing homelessness, and participating |
16 | | in the child welfare system. |
17 | | (2) To ensure a more equitable system, we support the |
18 | | Commission's goal of consolidating programs and services |
19 | | into a single, adequately staffed State agency to align and |
20 | | coordinate services, to decrease barriers to access for |
21 | | families and make it easier for them to navigate the |
22 | | system, and to better collect, use, and report |
23 | | comprehensive data to ensure disparities in services are |
24 | | addressed. |
25 | | (3) To ensure equitable and adequate funding to expand |
26 | | access to high-quality services and increase compensation |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 20 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of this vital workforce, a significant proportion of which |
2 | | are Black and Latinx women. The General Assembly encourages |
3 | | the State to commit to a multi-year plan designed to move |
4 | | the State toward adequate funding over time. |
5 | | (4) To redesign the mechanisms by which the State pays |
6 | | providers of early childhood education and care services to |
7 | | ensure provider stability, capacity, and quality and to |
8 | | make sure providers and services are available to families |
9 | | throughout the State, including in areas of child care |
10 | | deserts and concentrated poverty. |
11 | | (5) To ensure comprehensive data on children and |
12 | | families' access to and participation in programs and |
13 | | resulting outcomes, including, but not limited to, |
14 | | kindergarten readiness, to understand and address the |
15 | | degree to which the State is reaching children and families |
16 | | and ensuring equitable opportunity and outcomes. |
17 | | (c) The General Assembly encourages the State to create a |
18 | | planning process and timeline, with a designated body |
19 | | accountable for implementing the Commission's recommendations, |
20 | | that includes engagement of parents, providers, communities, |
21 | | experts, and other stakeholders and to regularly evaluate the |
22 | | impact of the implementation of the Commission's |
23 | | recommendations to ensure they impact children, families, and |
24 | | communities as intended and lead to a more equitable early |
25 | | childhood education and care system for Illinois. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 21 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Article 20. |
2 | | Section 20-5. The Illinois Act on the Aging is amended by |
3 | | adding Section 4.01b as follows: |
4 | | (20 ILCS 105/4.01b new) |
5 | | Sec. 4.01b. Uniform demographic data collection. |
6 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
7 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
8 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
9 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
10 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
11 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
12 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
13 | | following: |
14 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
15 | | (2) Asian alone. |
16 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
17 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
18 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
19 | | (6) White alone. |
20 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
21 | | (8) Two or more races. |
22 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
23 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
24 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 22 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
2 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
3 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
4 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
5 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
6 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
7 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
8 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
9 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
10 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
11 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
12 | | report information about program participation for any program |
13 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
14 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
15 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
16 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
17 | | information about program participation for any program |
18 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
19 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
20 | | information collected under this Section. |
21 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
22 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
23 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
24 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
25 | | participants for each program administered by the |
26 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 23 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
2 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
3 | | racial and ethnic data, of inmates and parolees eligible |
4 | | for each of the programs detailed under paragraph (1) |
5 | | according to either eligibility guidelines or the best |
6 | | available information. |
7 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
8 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
9 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
10 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
11 | | (2). |
12 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
13 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
14 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
15 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
16 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
17 | | specified information. |
18 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department and other |
19 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
20 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
21 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
22 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
23 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
24 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
25 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
26 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 24 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the State Board of Education. |
2 | | Section 20-10. The Department of Central Management |
3 | | Services Law of the
Civil Administrative Code of Illinois is |
4 | | amended by adding Section 405-535 as follows: |
5 | | (20 ILCS 405/405-535 new) |
6 | | Sec. 405-535. Uniform demographic data collection. |
7 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
8 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
9 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
10 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
11 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
12 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
13 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
14 | | following: |
15 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
16 | | (2) Asian alone. |
17 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
18 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
19 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
20 | | (6) White alone. |
21 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
22 | | (8) Two or more races. |
23 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
24 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 25 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
2 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
3 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
4 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
5 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
6 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
7 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
8 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
9 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
10 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
11 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
12 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
13 | | report information about program participation for any program |
14 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
15 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
16 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
17 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
18 | | information about program participation for any program |
19 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
20 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
21 | | information collected under this Section. |
22 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
23 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
24 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
25 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
26 | | participants for each program administered by the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 26 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
2 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
3 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
4 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
5 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
6 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
7 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
8 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
9 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
10 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
11 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
12 | | (2). |
13 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
14 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
15 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
16 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
17 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
18 | | specified information. |
19 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department and other |
20 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
21 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
22 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
23 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
24 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
25 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
26 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 27 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
2 | | the State Board of Education. |
3 | | Section 20-15. The Children and Family Services Act is |
4 | | amended by adding Section 44 as follows: |
5 | | (20 ILCS 505/44 new) |
6 | | Sec. 44. Uniform demographic data collection. |
7 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
8 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
9 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
10 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
11 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
12 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
13 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
14 | | following: |
15 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
16 | | (2) Asian alone. |
17 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
18 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
19 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
20 | | (6) White alone. |
21 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
22 | | (8) Two or more races. |
23 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
24 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 28 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
2 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
3 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
4 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
5 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
6 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
7 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
8 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
9 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
10 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
11 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
12 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
13 | | report information about program participation for any program |
14 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
15 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
16 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
17 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
18 | | information about program participation for any program |
19 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
20 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
21 | | information collected under this Section. |
22 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
23 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
24 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
25 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
26 | | participants for each program administered by the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 29 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
2 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
3 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
4 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
5 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
6 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
7 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
8 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
9 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
10 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
11 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
12 | | (2). |
13 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
14 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
15 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
16 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
17 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
18 | | specified information. |
19 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department and other |
20 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
21 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
22 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
23 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
24 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
25 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
26 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 30 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
2 | | the State Board of Education. |
3 | | Section 20-20. The Department of Human Services Act is |
4 | | amended by changing Section 1-70 as follows: |
5 | | (20 ILCS 1305/1-70) |
6 | | Sec. 1-70. Uniform demographic data collection. |
7 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
8 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
9 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
10 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
11 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
12 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
13 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
14 | | following: |
15 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
16 | | (2) Asian alone. |
17 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
18 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
19 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
20 | | (6) White alone. |
21 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
22 | | (8) Two or more races. |
23 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
24 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 31 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
2 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
3 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
4 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
5 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
6 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
7 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
8 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
9 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
10 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
11 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
12 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
13 | | report information about program participation for any program |
14 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
15 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
16 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
17 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
18 | | information about program participation for any program |
19 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
20 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
21 | | information collected under this Section.
|
22 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
23 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
24 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
25 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
26 | | participants for each program administered by the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 32 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
2 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
3 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
4 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
5 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
6 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
7 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
8 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
9 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
10 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
11 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
12 | | (2). |
13 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
14 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
15 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
16 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
17 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
18 | | specified information. |
19 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department and other |
20 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
21 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
22 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
23 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
24 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
25 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
26 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 33 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
2 | | the State Board of Education. |
3 | | (Source: P.A. 100-275, eff. 1-1-18; 100-863, eff. 8-14-18.)
|
4 | | Section 20-25. The Department of Labor Law is amended by |
5 | | adding Section 1505-220 as follows: |
6 | | (20 ILCS 1505/1505-220 new) |
7 | | Sec. 1505-220. Uniform demographic data collection. |
8 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
9 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
10 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
11 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
12 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
13 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
14 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
15 | | following: |
16 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
17 | | (2) Asian alone. |
18 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
19 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
20 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
21 | | (6) White alone. |
22 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
23 | | (8) Two or more races. |
24 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 34 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
2 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
3 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
4 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
5 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
6 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
7 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
8 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
9 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
10 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
11 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
12 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
13 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
14 | | report information about program participation for any program |
15 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
16 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
17 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
18 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
19 | | information about program participation for any program |
20 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
21 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
22 | | information collected under this Section. |
23 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
24 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
25 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
26 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 35 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | participants for each program administered by the |
2 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
3 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
4 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
5 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
6 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
7 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
8 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
9 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
10 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
11 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
12 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
13 | | (2). |
14 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
15 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
16 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
17 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
18 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
19 | | specified information. |
20 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department and other |
21 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
22 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
23 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
24 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
25 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
26 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 36 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
2 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
3 | | the State Board of Education. |
4 | | Section 20-30. The Department of Healthcare and Family |
5 | | Services Law is amended by adding Section 2205-35 as follows: |
6 | | (20 ILCS 2205/2205-35 new) |
7 | | Sec. 2205-35. Uniform demographic data collection. |
8 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
9 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
10 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
11 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
12 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
13 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
14 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
15 | | following: |
16 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
17 | | (2) Asian alone. |
18 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
19 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
20 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
21 | | (6) White alone. |
22 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
23 | | (8) Two or more races. |
24 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 37 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
2 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
3 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
4 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
5 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
6 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
7 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
8 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
9 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
10 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
11 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
12 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
13 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
14 | | report information about program participation for any program |
15 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
16 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
17 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
18 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
19 | | information about program participation for any program |
20 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
21 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
22 | | information collected under this Section. |
23 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
24 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
25 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
26 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 38 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | participants for each program administered by the |
2 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
3 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
4 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
5 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
6 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
7 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
8 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
9 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
10 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
11 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
12 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
13 | | (2). |
14 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
15 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
16 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
17 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
18 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
19 | | specified information. |
20 | | (e) The Governor may require the Department and other |
21 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
22 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
23 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
24 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
25 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
26 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 39 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
2 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
3 | | the State Board of Education. |
4 | | Section 20-35. The Department of Public Health Powers and |
5 | | Duties Law is amended by adding Section 2310-61 as follows: |
6 | | (20 ILCS 2310/2310-61 new) |
7 | | Sec. 2310-61. Uniform demographic data collection. |
8 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
9 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
10 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
11 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
12 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
13 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
14 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
15 | | following: |
16 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
17 | | (2) Asian alone. |
18 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
19 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
20 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
21 | | (6) White alone. |
22 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
23 | | (8) Two or more races. |
24 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 40 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
2 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
3 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
4 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
5 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
6 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
7 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
8 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
9 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
10 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
11 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
12 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
13 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
14 | | report information about program participation for any program |
15 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
16 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
17 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
18 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
19 | | information about program participation for any program |
20 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
21 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
22 | | information collected under this Section. |
23 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
24 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
25 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
26 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 41 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | participants for each program administered by the |
2 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
3 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
4 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
5 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
6 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
7 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
8 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
9 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
10 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
11 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
12 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
13 | | (2). |
14 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
15 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
16 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
17 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
18 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
19 | | specified information. |
20 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department and other |
21 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
22 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
23 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
24 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
25 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
26 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 42 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
2 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
3 | | the State Board of Education. |
4 | | Section 20-40. The Department of Transportation Law of the
|
5 | | Civil Administrative Code of Illinois is amended by adding |
6 | | Section 2705-620 as follows: |
7 | | (20 ILCS 2705/2705-620 new) |
8 | | Sec. 2705-620. Uniform demographic data collection. |
9 | | (a) The Department shall collect and publicly report |
10 | | statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics of |
11 | | program participants for each program administered by the |
12 | | Department. Except as provided in subsection (b), when |
13 | | collecting the data required under this Section, the Department |
14 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
15 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
16 | | following: |
17 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
18 | | (2) Asian alone. |
19 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
20 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
21 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
22 | | (6) White alone. |
23 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
24 | | (8) Two or more races. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 43 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | The Department may further define, by rule, the racial and |
2 | | ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
3 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department is subject |
4 | | to federal reporting requirements that include the collection |
5 | | and public reporting of statistical data on the racial and |
6 | | ethnic demographics of program participants, the Department |
7 | | may maintain the same racial and ethnic classifications used |
8 | | under the federal requirements if such classifications differ |
9 | | from the classifications listed in subsection (a). |
10 | | (c) The Department shall make all demographic information |
11 | | collected under this Section available to the public which at a |
12 | | minimum shall include posting the information for each program |
13 | | in a timely manner on the Department's official website. If the |
14 | | Department already has a mechanism or process in place to |
15 | | report information about program participation for any program |
16 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
17 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
18 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department |
19 | | does not have a mechanism or process in place to report |
20 | | information about program participation for any program |
21 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
22 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
23 | | information collected under this Section. |
24 | | (d) The Department shall submit to the General Assembly on |
25 | | or before December 1 of each year preceding a new General |
26 | | Assembly a report that contains the following: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 44 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
2 | | participants for each program administered by the |
3 | | Department, as required under this Section, during the |
4 | | prior 2 fiscal years. |
5 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
6 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
7 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
8 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
9 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
10 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
11 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
12 | | program administered by the Department as indicated by the |
13 | | demographic information collected under paragraphs (1) and |
14 | | (2). |
15 | | (e) If the Department is unable to provide any item |
16 | | specified under subsection (d), the Department shall submit to |
17 | | the General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year |
18 | | preceding a new General Assembly the reason for the delay and |
19 | | the estimated date by which the Department will provide the |
20 | | specified information. |
21 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department and other |
22 | | relevant State agencies that are required to report demographic |
23 | | information as provided by this amendatory Act of the 101st |
24 | | General Assembly to consolidate into a single report each |
25 | | agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
26 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 45 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
2 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
3 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
4 | | the State Board of Education. |
5 | | Section 20-45. The School Code is amended by adding Section |
6 | | 2-3.11e as follows: |
7 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.11e new) |
8 | | Sec. 2-3.11e. Uniform demographic data collection. |
9 | | (a) The State Board of Education shall collect and publicly |
10 | | report statistical data on the racial and ethnic demographics |
11 | | of program participants for each program administered by the |
12 | | State Board of Education. Except as provided in subsection (b), |
13 | | when collecting the data required under this Section, the State |
14 | | Board of Education shall use the same racial and ethnic |
15 | | classifications for each program, which shall include, but not |
16 | | be limited to, the following: |
17 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
18 | | (2) Asian alone. |
19 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
20 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
21 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
22 | | (6) White alone. |
23 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
24 | | (8) Two or more races. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 46 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | The State Board of Education may further define, by rule, |
2 | | the racial and ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
3 | | (b) If a program administered by the State Board of |
4 | | Education is subject to federal reporting requirements that |
5 | | include the collection and public reporting of statistical data |
6 | | on the racial and ethnic demographics of program participants, |
7 | | the State Board of Education may maintain the same racial and |
8 | | ethnic classifications used under the federal requirements if |
9 | | such classifications differ from the classifications listed in |
10 | | subsection (a). |
11 | | (c) The State Board of Education shall make all demographic |
12 | | information collected under this Section available to the |
13 | | public which at a minimum shall include posting the information |
14 | | for each program in a timely manner on the State Board of |
15 | | Education's official website. If the State Board of Education |
16 | | already has a mechanism or process in place to report |
17 | | information about program participation for any program |
18 | | administered by the State Board of Education, then the State |
19 | | Board of Education shall use that mechanism or process to |
20 | | include the demographic information collected under this |
21 | | Section. If the State Board of Education does not have a |
22 | | mechanism or process in place to report information about |
23 | | program participation for any program administered by the State |
24 | | Board of Education, then the State Board of Education shall |
25 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
26 | | information collected under this Section. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 47 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (d) The State Board of Education shall submit to the |
2 | | General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year preceding |
3 | | a new General Assembly a report that contains the following: |
4 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
5 | | participants for each program administered by the State |
6 | | Board of Education, as required under this Section, during |
7 | | the prior 2 fiscal years. |
8 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
9 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in Illinois |
10 | | who are in need of or eligible for each of the programs |
11 | | detailed under paragraph (1) according to either |
12 | | eligibility guidelines or the best available information. |
13 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
14 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
15 | | program administered by the State Board of Education as |
16 | | indicated by the demographic information collected under |
17 | | paragraphs (1) and (2). |
18 | | (e) If the State Board of Education is unable to provide |
19 | | any item specified under subsection (d), the State Board of |
20 | | Education shall submit to the General Assembly on or before |
21 | | December 1 of each year preceding a new General Assembly the |
22 | | reason for the delay and the estimated date by which the |
23 | | Department will provide the specified information. |
24 | | Section 20-50. The Unified Code of Corrections is amended |
25 | | by adding Sections 3-2-2.5 and 3-2.5-62 as follows: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 48 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (730 ILCS 5/3-2-2.5 new) |
2 | | Sec. 3-2-2.5. Uniform demographic data collection. |
3 | | (a) The Department of Corrections shall collect and |
4 | | publicly report statistical data on the racial and ethnic |
5 | | demographics of program participants for each program |
6 | | administered by the Department for inmates or parolees. Except |
7 | | as provided in subsection (b), when collecting the data |
8 | | required under this Section, the Department of Corrections |
9 | | shall use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
10 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
11 | | following: |
12 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
13 | | (2) Asian alone. |
14 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
15 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
16 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
17 | | (6) White alone. |
18 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
19 | | (8) Two or more races. |
20 | | The Department of Corrections may further define, by rule, |
21 | | the racial and ethnic classifications provided in this Section. |
22 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department of |
23 | | Corrections is subject to federal reporting requirements that |
24 | | include the collection and public reporting of statistical data |
25 | | on the racial and ethnic demographics of program participants, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 49 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the Department may maintain the same racial and ethnic |
2 | | classifications used under the federal requirements if such |
3 | | classifications differ from the classifications listed in |
4 | | subsection (a). |
5 | | (c) The Department of Corrections shall make all |
6 | | demographic information collected under this Section available |
7 | | to the public which at a minimum shall include posting the |
8 | | information for each program in a timely manner on the |
9 | | Department's official website. If the Department of |
10 | | Corrections already has a mechanism or process in place to |
11 | | report information about program participation for any program |
12 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
13 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
14 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department of |
15 | | Corrections does not have a mechanism or process in place to |
16 | | report information about program participation for any program |
17 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall |
18 | | create a mechanism or process to disseminate the demographic |
19 | | information collected under this Section. |
20 | | (d) The Department of Corrections shall submit to the |
21 | | General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year preceding |
22 | | a new General Assembly a report that contains the following: |
23 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
24 | | participants for each program administered by the |
25 | | Department of Corrections, as required under this Section, |
26 | | during the prior 2 fiscal years. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 50 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
2 | | racial and ethnic data, of inmates and parolees eligible |
3 | | for each of the programs detailed under paragraph (1) |
4 | | according to either eligibility guidelines or the best |
5 | | available information. |
6 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
7 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
8 | | program administered by the Department of Corrections as |
9 | | indicated by the demographic information collected under |
10 | | paragraphs (1) and (2). |
11 | | (e) If the Department of Corrections is unable to provide |
12 | | any item specified under subsection (d), the Department of |
13 | | Corrections shall submit to the General Assembly on or before |
14 | | December 1 of each year preceding a new General Assembly the |
15 | | reason for the delay and the estimated date by which the |
16 | | Department of Corrections will provide the specified |
17 | | information. |
18 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department of Corrections |
19 | | and other relevant State agencies that are required to report |
20 | | demographic information as provided by this amendatory Act of |
21 | | the 101st General Assembly to consolidate into a single report |
22 | | each agency's recommendations provided under paragraph (3) of |
23 | | subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures each |
24 | | agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
25 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
26 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 51 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the State Board of Education. |
2 | | (730 ILCS 5/3-2.5-62 new) |
3 | | Sec. 3-2.5-62. Uniform demographic data collection. |
4 | | (a) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall collect and |
5 | | publicly report statistical data on the racial and ethnic |
6 | | demographics of program participants for each program |
7 | | administered by the Department for youths in each of the |
8 | | Department's facilities and youths on aftercare. Except as |
9 | | provided in subsection (b), when collecting the data required |
10 | | under this Section, the Department of Juvenile Justice shall |
11 | | use the same racial and ethnic classifications for each |
12 | | program, which shall include, but not be limited to, the |
13 | | following: |
14 | | (1) American Indian and Alaska Native alone. |
15 | | (2) Asian alone. |
16 | | (3) Black or African American alone. |
17 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino of any race. |
18 | | (5) Native Hawaiian and Other Pacific Islander alone. |
19 | | (6) White alone. |
20 | | (7) Some other race alone. |
21 | | (8) Two or more races. |
22 | | The Department of Juvenile Justice may further define, by |
23 | | rule, the racial and ethnic classifications provided in this |
24 | | Section. |
25 | | (b) If a program administered by the Department of Juvenile |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 52 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Justice is subject to federal reporting requirements that |
2 | | include the collection and public reporting of statistical data |
3 | | on the racial and ethnic demographics of program participants, |
4 | | the Department may maintain the same racial and ethnic |
5 | | classifications used under the federal requirements if such |
6 | | classifications differ from the classifications listed in |
7 | | subsection (a). |
8 | | (c) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall make all |
9 | | demographic information collected under this Section available |
10 | | to the public which at a minimum shall include posting the |
11 | | information for each program in a timely manner on the |
12 | | Department's official website. If the Department of Juvenile |
13 | | Justice already has a mechanism or process in place to report |
14 | | information about program participation for any program |
15 | | administered by the Department, then the Department shall use |
16 | | that mechanism or process to include the demographic |
17 | | information collected under this Section. If the Department of |
18 | | Juvenile Justice does not have a mechanism or process in place |
19 | | to report information about program participation for any |
20 | | program administered by the Department, then the Department |
21 | | shall create a mechanism or process to disseminate the |
22 | | demographic information collected under this Section. |
23 | | (d) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall submit to the |
24 | | General Assembly on or before December 1 of each year preceding |
25 | | a new General Assembly a report that contains the following: |
26 | | (1) The racial and ethnic demographics of program |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 53 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | participants for each program administered by the |
2 | | Department of Juvenile Justice, as required under this |
3 | | Section, during the prior 2 fiscal years. |
4 | | (2) The most recent demographic information, including |
5 | | racial and ethnic data, on individuals residing in |
6 | | Department facilities or who are in aftercare and who are |
7 | | in need of or eligible for each of the programs detailed |
8 | | under paragraph (1) according to either eligibility |
9 | | guidelines or the best available information. |
10 | | (3) Recommendations to eliminate any existing racial |
11 | | and ethnic disparities in program participation for each |
12 | | program administered by the Department of Juvenile Justice |
13 | | as indicated by the demographic information collected |
14 | | under paragraphs (1) and (2). |
15 | | (e) If the Department of Juvenile Justice is unable to |
16 | | provide any item specified under subsection (d), the Department |
17 | | of Juvenile Justice shall submit to the General Assembly on or |
18 | | before December 1 of each year preceding a new General Assembly |
19 | | the reason for the delay and the estimated date by which the |
20 | | Department of Juvenile Justice will provide the specified |
21 | | information. |
22 | | (f) The Governor may require the Department of Juvenile |
23 | | Justice and other relevant State agencies that are required to |
24 | | report demographic information as provided by this amendatory |
25 | | Act of the 101st General Assembly to consolidate into a single |
26 | | report each agency's recommendations provided under paragraph |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 54 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (3) of subsection (d), including a detailed account of measures |
2 | | each agency plans to implement to eliminate existing racial and |
3 | | ethnic disparities within any program administered by the |
4 | | agency. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to |
5 | | the State Board of Education. |
6 | | Article 25. |
7 | | Section 22-5. The School Code is amended by adding Section |
8 | | 22-90 as follows: |
9 | | (105 ILCS 5/22-90 new) |
10 | | Sec. 22-90. Whole Child Task Force. |
11 | | (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following |
12 | | findings: |
13 | | (1) The COVID-19 pandemic has exposed systemic |
14 | | inequities in American society. Students, educators, and |
15 | | families throughout this State have been deeply affected by |
16 | | the pandemic, and the impact of the pandemic will be felt |
17 | | for years to come. The negative consequences of the |
18 | | pandemic have impacted students and communities |
19 | | differently along the lines of race, income, language, and |
20 | | special needs. However, students in this State faced |
21 | | significant unmet physical health, mental health, and |
22 | | social and emotional needs even prior to the pandemic. |
23 | | (2) The path to recovery requires a commitment from |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 55 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | adults in this State to address our students cultural, |
2 | | physical, emotional, and mental health needs and to provide |
3 | | them with stronger and increased systemic support and |
4 | | intervention. |
5 | | (3) It is well documented that trauma and toxic stress |
6 | | diminish a child's ability to thrive. Forms of childhood |
7 | | trauma and toxic stress include adverse childhood |
8 | | experiences, systemic racism, poverty, and insecurity. The |
9 | | COVID-19 pandemic has exacerbated these issues and brought |
10 | | them into focus. |
11 | | (4) It is estimated that, overall, approximately 40% of |
12 | | children in this State have experienced at least one |
13 | | adverse childhood experience and approximately 10% have |
14 | | experienced 3 or more adverse childhood experiences. |
15 | | However, the number of adverse childhood experiences is |
16 | | higher for Black and Hispanic children who are growing up |
17 | | in poverty. The COVID-19 pandemic has amplified the number |
18 | | of students who have experienced childhood trauma. Also, |
19 | | the COVID-19 pandemic has highlighted preexisting |
20 | | inequities in school disciplinary practices that |
21 | | disproportionately impact Black and Brown students. |
22 | | (5) The cumulative effects of trauma and toxic stress |
23 | | adversely impact the physical health of students, as well |
24 | | as their ability to learn, form relationships, and |
25 | | self-regulate. If left unaddressed, these effects increase |
26 | | a student's risk for depression, alcoholism, anxiety, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 56 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | asthma, smoking, and suicide, all of which are risks that |
2 | | disproportionately affect Black youth and may lead to a |
3 | | host of medical diseases as an adult. Access to infant and |
4 | | early childhood mental health services is critical to |
5 | | ensure the social and emotional well-being of this State's |
6 | | youngest children, particularly those children who have |
7 | | experienced trauma. |
8 | | (6) Although this State enacted measures through |
9 | | Public Act -105 to address the high rate of early care and |
10 | | preschool expulsions of infants, toddlers, and |
11 | | preschoolers and the disproportionately higher rate of |
12 | | expulsion for Black and Hispanic children, a recent study |
13 | | found a wide variation in the awareness, understanding, and |
14 | | compliance with the law by providers of early childhood |
15 | | care. Further work is needed to implement the law, which |
16 | | includes providing training to early childhood care |
17 | | providers to increase their understanding of the law, |
18 | | increasing the availability and access to infant and early |
19 | | childhood mental health services, and building aligned |
20 | | data collection systems to better understand expulsion |
21 | | rates and to allow for accurate reporting as required by |
22 | | the law. |
23 | | (7) Many educators and schools in this State have |
24 | | embraced and implemented evidenced-based restorative |
25 | | justice and trauma-responsive and culturally relevant |
26 | | practices and interventions. However, the use of these |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 57 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | interventions on students is often isolated or is |
2 | | implemented occasionally and only if the school has the |
3 | | appropriate leadership, resources, and partners available |
4 | | to engage seriously in this work. It would be malpractice |
5 | | to deny our students access to these practices and |
6 | | interventions, especially in the aftermath of a |
7 | | once-in-a-century pandemic. |
8 | | (b) The Whole Child Task Force is created for the purpose |
9 | | of establishing an equitable, inclusive, safe, and supportive |
10 | | environment in all schools for every student in this State. The |
11 | | task force shall have all of the following goals, which means |
12 | | key steps have to be taken to ensure that every child in every |
13 | | school in this State has access to teachers, social workers, |
14 | | school leaders, support personnel, and others who have been |
15 | | trained in evidenced-based interventions and restorative |
16 | | practices: |
17 | | (1) To create a common definition of a |
18 | | trauma-responsive school, a trauma-responsive district, |
19 | | and a trauma-responsive community. |
20 | | (2) To outline the training and resources required to |
21 | | create and sustain a system of support for |
22 | | trauma-responsive schools, districts, and communities and |
23 | | to identify this State's role in that work, including |
24 | | recommendations concerning options for redirecting |
25 | | resources from school resource officers to classroom-based |
26 | | support. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 58 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (3) To identify or develop a process to conduct an |
2 | | analysis of the organizations that provide training in |
3 | | restorative practices, implicit bias, and |
4 | | trauma-responsive systems, mental health services, and |
5 | | social and emotional services to schools. |
6 | | (4) To provide recommendations concerning the key data |
7 | | to be collected and reported to ensure that this State has |
8 | | a full and accurate understanding of the progress toward |
9 | | ensuring that all schools employ restorative, anti-racist, |
10 | | and trauma-responsive strategies and practices. The data |
11 | | collected must include information relating to |
12 | | disciplinary practices employed on a student in person or |
13 | | through other means and to support structures in schools, |
14 | | including school resource officers and the funding of other |
15 | | similar police personnel in school programs. |
16 | | (5) To recommend an implementation timeline, including |
17 | | the key roles, responsibilities, and resources to advance |
18 | | this State toward a system in which every school, district, |
19 | | and community is progressing toward becoming |
20 | | trauma-responsive. |
21 | | (6) To seek input and feedback from stakeholders, |
22 | | including parents, students, and educators, who reflect |
23 | | the diversity of this State. |
24 | | (c) Members of the Whole Child Task Force shall be |
25 | | appointed by the State Superintendent of Education. Members of |
26 | | this task force must represent the diversity of this State and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 59 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | possess the expertise needed to perform the work required to |
2 | | meet the goals of the task force set forth under subsection |
3 | | (a). Members of the task force shall include all of the |
4 | | following: |
5 | | (1) One member of a statewide professional teachers' |
6 | | organization. |
7 | | (2) One member of another statewide professional |
8 | | teachers' organization. |
9 | | (3) One member who represents a school district serving |
10 | | a community with a population of 500,000 or more. |
11 | | (4) One member of a statewide organization |
12 | | representing social workers. |
13 | | (5) One member of an organization that has specific |
14 | | expertise in trauma-responsive school practices and |
15 | | experience in supporting schools in developing |
16 | | trauma-responsive and restorative practices. |
17 | | (6) One member of another organization that has |
18 | | specific expertise in trauma-responsive school practices |
19 | | and experience in supporting schools in developing |
20 | | trauma-responsive and restorative practices. |
21 | | (7) One member of a statewide organization that |
22 | | represents school administrators. |
23 | | (8) One member of a statewide policy organization that |
24 | | works to build a healthy public education system that |
25 | | prepares all students for a successful college, career, and |
26 | | civic life. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 60 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (9) One member of a statewide organization that brings
|
2 | | teachers together to identify and address issues
critical |
3 | | to student success. |
4 | | (10) One member of the General Assembly recommended by |
5 | | the President of the Senate. |
6 | | (11) One member of the General Assembly recommended by |
7 | | the Speaker of the House of
Representatives. |
8 | | (12) One member of the General Assembly recommended by |
9 | | the Minority Leader of the Senate. |
10 | | (13) One member of the General Assembly recommended by |
11 | | the Minority Leader of the House of Representatives. |
12 | | (14) One member of a civil rights organization that |
13 | | works actively on issues regarding student support. |
14 | | (15) One administrator from a school district that has |
15 | | actively worked to develop a system of student support that |
16 | | uses a trauma-informed lens. |
17 | | (16) One educator from a school district that has |
18 | | actively worked to develop a system of student support that |
19 | | uses a trauma-informed lens. |
20 | | (17) One member of a youth-led organization. |
21 | | (18) One member of an organization that has |
22 | | demonstrated expertise in restorative practices. |
23 | | (19) One member of a coalition of mental health and |
24 | | school practitioners who assist schools in developing and |
25 | | implementing trauma-informed and restorative strategies |
26 | | and systems. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 61 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (20) One member of an organization whose mission is to |
2 | | promote the safety, health, and economic success of |
3 | | children, youth, and families in this State. |
4 | | (21) One member who works or has worked as a |
5 | | restorative justice coach or disciplinarian. |
6 | | (22) One member who works or has worked as a social |
7 | | worker. |
8 | | (23) One member of the State Board of Education. |
9 | | (24) One member who represents a statewide principals' |
10 | | organization. |
11 | | (25) One member who represents a statewide |
12 | | organization of school boards. |
13 | | (d) The Whole Child Task Force shall meet initially at the |
14 | | call of the State Superintendent of Education, at which time |
15 | | the Governor shall select one member who holds a doctorate |
16 | | degree in whole-child research as the chairperson. The task |
17 | | force shall thereafter meet at the call of the chairperson. The |
18 | | State Board of Education shall provide administrative and other |
19 | | support to the task force. Members of the task force shall |
20 | | serve without compensation. |
21 | | (e) The Whole Child Task Force shall submit a report of its |
22 | | findings and recommendations to the General Assembly, the |
23 | | Illinois Legislative Black Caucus, the State Board of |
24 | | Education, and the Governor on or before February 1, 2022. Upon |
25 | | submitting its report, the task force is dissolved. |
26 | | (f) This Section is repealed on February 1, 2023. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 62 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Article 30. |
2 | | Section 30-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the |
3 | | Equity in Early Education Act. References in this Article to |
4 | | "this Act" mean this Article. |
5 | | Section 30-5. Findings; legislative intent. |
6 | | (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following |
7 | | findings: |
8 | | (1) The 2019 Illinois Assessment of Readiness found |
9 | | that only 37% of students in third grade met or exceeded |
10 | | learning standards in English language arts and only 41% of |
11 | | the students met or exceeded mathematics learning |
12 | | standards. |
13 | | (2) The 2017 National Assessment of Educational |
14 | | Progress similarly showed that only 35% of students in the |
15 | | fourth grade are proficient or advanced in English language |
16 | | arts while only 39% of the students are proficient or |
17 | | advanced in mathematics. |
18 | | (3) Research from the Annie E. Casey Foundation found |
19 | | that students in the third grade who are not proficient |
20 | | readers are 4 times more likely to not finish high school. |
21 | | Moreover, students in the third grade from low-income |
22 | | families who are not proficient readers are more than 6 |
23 | | times more likely to not finish high school. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 63 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) The Literacy Project Foundation estimates that 60% |
2 | | of individuals who are in prison are illiterate and 85% of |
3 | | juvenile offenders struggle with reading. |
4 | | (5) Strengthening early literacy and numeracy |
5 | | instruction and support for students in this State will pay |
6 | | dividends in the future by empowering and providing |
7 | | students with the skills they need to graduate and the |
8 | | ability to find fulfilling careers and to be productive |
9 | | members of their communities. |
10 | | (b) It is the intent of the General Assembly in enacting |
11 | | this Act that: |
12 | | (1) every public school student in this State be |
13 | | provided with the high-quality instruction, support, and |
14 | | intervention he or she needs to become proficient in |
15 | | reading and math; |
16 | | (2) the promotion of every public school student to the |
17 | | next higher grade level be based, in part, upon proficiency |
18 | | in reading and math; |
19 | | (3) school board policies facilitate evidence-based |
20 | | reading instruction, math instruction, and intervention |
21 | | services to address the reading and math needs of students; |
22 | | (4) each public school student's parent or guardian be |
23 | | informed regularly of the student's progress in reading and |
24 | | math; and |
25 | | (5) ultimately, by the third grade, every public school |
26 | | student is able to demonstrate reading and math performance |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 64 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | at or above his or her grade level. |
2 | | Section 30-10. Definitions. In this Act: |
3 | | "Level I dyslexia screening" means a process, as determined |
4 | | by a school district, for gathering additional information to |
5 | | determine if the characteristics of dyslexia are present. |
6 | | "Universal screener" means an assessment used to aid |
7 | | educators in understanding the causes for student performance, |
8 | | learning strengths, and the needs that underlie student |
9 | | performance. The assessment is conducted to identify or predict |
10 | | students who may be at risk for poor learning outcomes and is |
11 | | typically brief and conducted with all students at a particular |
12 | | grade level. |
13 | | Section 30-15. Identifying deficiencies in literacy and |
14 | | math skills. |
15 | | (a) Beginning no later than the 2022-2023 school year, a |
16 | | school district, within 45 days after the beginning of the |
17 | | school year, shall administer a valid and reliable universal |
18 | | screener to identify any deficiencies in reading or math skills |
19 | | to all students in the first and second grades. If a school |
20 | | district has been using a universal screener before the |
21 | | effective date of this Act that includes, as developmentally |
22 | | appropriate, all of the following, then the school district is |
23 | | not required to create an assessment process or administer |
24 | | different or additional universal screenings under this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 65 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Section: |
2 | | (1) Phonological and phonemic awareness. |
3 | | (2) Sound symbol recognition. |
4 | | (3) Alphabet knowledge. |
5 | | (4) Decoding skills. |
6 | | (5) Rapid naming skills. |
7 | | (6) Encoding skills. |
8 | | (7) Oral reading fluency. |
9 | | (b) If a student is determined to be at risk or at some |
10 | | risk for dyslexia after the universal screener has been |
11 | | administered, the school district must administer a Level 1 |
12 | | dyslexia screening on the student. |
13 | | (c) The State Board of Education shall create a process for |
14 | | reviewing and approving a list of reliable and valid universal |
15 | | screeners. |
16 | | Section 30-20. Reading and math intervention. A school |
17 | | district shall offer appropriate evidence-based reading or |
18 | | math intervention using a multi-tiered system of support (MTSS) |
19 | | framework to address the needs of each student in grades |
20 | | kindergarten through 3 who exhibits a deficiency in reading or |
21 | | math skills, including those students who are referred for |
22 | | additional screening. A deficiency in reading or math skills |
23 | | shall be defined as a student who scores below his or her grade |
24 | | level or a student who is determined to be at-risk for reading |
25 | | or math failure based upon a screening assessment, a diagnostic |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 66 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | assessment, a standardized summative assessment, or progress |
2 | | monitoring. The reading or math intervention shall be provided |
3 | | in addition to the core reading or math instruction that is |
4 | | provided to all students as part of the general education |
5 | | curricula. The reading or math intervention shall: |
6 | | (1) be provided to all students in grades kindergarten |
7 | | through 3 who are identified as having a deficiency in |
8 | | reading or math skills; |
9 | | (2) regularly monitor throughout the school year the |
10 | | progress of all students in grades kindergarten through 3 |
11 | | who are identified as having a deficiency in reading or |
12 | | math skills and to adjust instruction according to the |
13 | | needs of the student; |
14 | | (3) provide a student who is identified as having a |
15 | | deficiency in reading with explicit and systematic |
16 | | instruction in each of the 5 essential components of |
17 | | reading, which are phonological awareness, phonics, |
18 | | fluency, vocabulary, and comprehension, in which the |
19 | | student has a deficiency; |
20 | | (4) provide to a student who is identified as having a |
21 | | deficiency in math skills with explicit and systematic |
22 | | instruction in early numeracy skills, as applicable; |
23 | | (5) be offered primarily during regular school hours, |
24 | | although the intervention may also be offered before or |
25 | | after regular school hours; |
26 | | (6) be created in consultation with the student's |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 67 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | parent or guardian; |
2 | | (7) remain in effect until the student is proficient in |
3 | | reading or math or until the student has an individualized |
4 | | education program in place with appropriate goals in |
5 | | reading or math; and |
6 | | (8) provide, subject to appropriation, professional |
7 | | development for teachers in evidence-based practices in |
8 | | literacy and math instruction to students who lack |
9 | | proficiency in reading or math or both. |
10 | | Section 30-25. Intervention programs. A school district |
11 | | may determine the appropriate intervention program for a |
12 | | student under this Act. A program may include any of the |
13 | | following: |
14 | | (1) Summer reading and math camps that are available to |
15 | | students who have the most severe deficiencies in reading |
16 | | and math. The camps shall be staffed with highly effective |
17 | | teachers in reading and math who must provide explicit and |
18 | | systematic reading or math intervention services and |
19 | | support to correct a student's identified areas of reading |
20 | | or math deficiency. No less than 90 hours of instructional |
21 | | time in reading, math, or reading and math must be provided |
22 | | to a student. |
23 | | (2) An intensive acceleration class that may be |
24 | | established by a school district for any student who is |
25 | | retained in grade 3 and who previously was retained in any |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 68 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of grades kindergarten through 2. The intensive |
2 | | acceleration class shall have a reduced teacher-student |
3 | | ratio and shall provide to the student explicit and |
4 | | systematic reading or math instruction and intervention |
5 | | for the majority of the student's class attendance time |
6 | | each day. |
7 | | (3) An extended-time reading and math intervention |
8 | | program that is available to students in grades |
9 | | kindergarten through 3 who lack proficiency in reading or |
10 | | math. The program must provide proven and effective, |
11 | | evidence-based, substantial intervention that includes |
12 | | basic mathematics, phonemic awareness, decoding, |
13 | | vocabulary, comprehension, and fluency, as appropriate for |
14 | | each student, and that is based on a formative assessment |
15 | | designed to, at a minimum, identify weaknesses in those |
16 | | areas of learning. The program may include online or |
17 | | digital instructional materials, programs, or library |
18 | | resources. A minimum of 60 hours of supplemental |
19 | | instruction for students who have severe deficiencies in |
20 | | reading and math may be provided or a minimum of 30 hours |
21 | | of supplemental instruction for students with less severe |
22 | | deficiencies may be provided. |
23 | | Section 30-50. Rules; technical assistance. |
24 | | (a) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules |
25 | | necessary to implement, administer, and enforce this Act. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 69 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (b) The State Board of Education may provide technical |
2 | | assistance to aid school districts in implementing this Act. |
3 | | Section 30-90. The School Code is amended by adding |
4 | | Sections 2-3.51b, 2-3.161, 2-3.182, 10-20.9b, 10-20.73, |
5 | | 10-20.74, 10-20.75, 34-18.51a, 34-18.67, 34-18.68, and |
6 | | 34-18.69 and by changing Sections 10-20.9a, 21B-20, 21B-35, and |
7 | | 34-18.51 as follows: |
8 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.51b new) |
9 | | Sec. 2-3.51b. Early literacy and numeracy grants. |
10 | | (a) The State Board of Education shall implement and |
11 | | administer an early literacy and numeracy grant program to |
12 | | support school districts that serve students with deficiencies |
13 | | in reading or math skills or both to redesign school curricula, |
14 | | provide professional development for teachers, or hire |
15 | | literacy coaches. |
16 | | (b) Subject to appropriation, the State Board shall |
17 | | distribute grants under the program to school districts based |
18 | | on the number of pupils in grade 3 who have been identified as |
19 | | needing reading or math intervention under Section 10-20.9b or |
20 | | 34-18.51a. Grants shall be awarded on a non-competitive basis, |
21 | | but in order to be eligible to receive grant funds, a school |
22 | | district must submit to the State Board a high-quality plan |
23 | | that demonstrates how the school district intends to utilize |
24 | | the funding to improve literacy, numeracy instruction, or both |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 70 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to students. |
2 | | (c) The plan submitted by a school district under |
3 | | subsection (b) must include all of the following information: |
4 | | (1) A description of the methods by which the school |
5 | | district will modify its whole-class instructional |
6 | | practices. |
7 | | (2) The assessment tool or tools that will be used in |
8 | | grades kindergarten through 3. |
9 | | (3) The intervention programs that will be provided to |
10 | | students who are identified as having a reading or math |
11 | | deficiency. |
12 | | (4) The support that will be offered to teachers to |
13 | | implement these changes. |
14 | | (d) If the amount appropriated in a given fiscal year is |
15 | | insufficient to provide a grant to all eligible school |
16 | | districts that request funding under the grant program, the |
17 | | State Board may develop equity-based criteria to determine the |
18 | | priority in which school districts receive grants under the |
19 | | program. |
20 | | Each fiscal year, the State Board may withhold up to 2% of |
21 | | the amount appropriated for the grant program to administer the |
22 | | grant program. |
23 | | (e) Three years after the first grants are awarded under |
24 | | this Section, the State Board shall submit a report to the |
25 | | General Assembly. The report shall include data on the number |
26 | | of students served, the change in the rates of proficiency in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 71 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | reading and math in school districts that received a grant, and |
2 | | an assessment of the effectiveness of the grant program. |
3 | | (f) The State Board may adopt any rules necessary to |
4 | | implement this Section. |
5 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.161) |
6 | | Sec. 2-3.161. Definition of dyslexia; reading instruction |
7 | | advisory group; handbook ; screening rules . |
8 | | (a) The State Board of Education shall incorporate, in both |
9 | | general education and special education, the following |
10 | | definition of dyslexia: |
11 | | Dyslexia is a specific learning disability that is |
12 | | neurobiological in origin.
Dyslexia is characterized by |
13 | | difficulties with accurate and/or fluent word
recognition |
14 | | and by poor spelling and decoding abilities. These |
15 | | difficulties
typically result from a deficit in the |
16 | | phonological component of language
that is often |
17 | | unexpected in relation to other cognitive abilities and the
|
18 | | provision of effective classroom instruction. Secondary |
19 | | consequences may
include problems in reading comprehension |
20 | | and reduced reading experience that
can impede growth of |
21 | | vocabulary and background knowledge. |
22 | | (b) Subject to specific State appropriation or the |
23 | | availability of private donations, the State Board of Education |
24 | | shall establish an advisory group to develop a training module |
25 | | or training modules to provide education and professional |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 72 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | development to teachers, school administrators, and other |
2 | | education professionals regarding multi-sensory, systematic, |
3 | | and sequential instruction in reading. This advisory group |
4 | | shall complete its work before December 15, 2015 and is |
5 | | abolished on December 15, 2015. The State Board of Education |
6 | | shall reestablish the advisory group abolished on December 15, |
7 | | 2015 to complete the abolished group's work. The reestablished |
8 | | advisory group shall complete its work before December 31, 2016 |
9 | | and is abolished on December 31, 2016. The provisions of this |
10 | | subsection (b), other than this sentence, are inoperative after |
11 | | December 31, 2016.
|
12 | | (c) The State Board of Education shall develop and maintain |
13 | | a handbook to be made available on its Internet website that |
14 | | provides guidance for pupils, parents or guardians, and |
15 | | teachers on the subject of dyslexia. The handbook shall |
16 | | include, but is not limited to: |
17 | | (1) guidelines for teachers and parents or guardians on |
18 | | how to identify signs of dyslexia; |
19 | | (2) a description of educational strategies that have |
20 | | been shown to improve the academic performance of pupils |
21 | | with dyslexia; and |
22 | | (3) a description of resources and services available |
23 | | to pupils with dyslexia, parents or guardians of pupils |
24 | | with dyslexia, and teachers ; and . |
25 | | (4) guidelines for (i) the administration of a |
26 | | universal screener and Level I dyslexia screening, as |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 73 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | defined in Sections 10-20.73 and 34-18.67, (ii) the |
2 | | interpretation of data from the screener or screening, and |
3 | | (iii) appropriate instruction within a multi-tiered system |
4 | | of support (MTSS) framework. |
5 | | The State Board shall review the handbook once every 4 |
6 | | years to update, if necessary, the guidelines, educational |
7 | | strategies, or resources and services made available in the |
8 | | handbook. |
9 | | (d) The State Board of Education shall adopt any rules |
10 | | necessary to ensure that a student is screened as provided |
11 | | under Section 10-20.73 or 34-18.67 for the risk factors of |
12 | | dyslexia using a universal screener if: |
13 | | (1) a student is in first or second grade in a public |
14 | | school; |
15 | | (2) a student in first or second grade transfers to a |
16 | | new public school and has not been screened previously |
17 | | during the school year; and |
18 | | (3) a student from another state enrolls for the first |
19 | | time in first or second grade in a school district in this |
20 | | State, unless the student presents documentation that the |
21 | | student had the dyslexia screening or a similar screening |
22 | | during the school year or is exempt from screening. |
23 | | (e) The State Board of Education shall adopt any rules |
24 | | necessary to ensure that (i) a student is screened, as provided |
25 | | in Section 10-20.73 or 34-18.67, for the characteristics of |
26 | | dyslexia using a Level I dyslexia screening and (ii) a student |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 74 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | receives dyslexia intervention services under Section 10-20.73 |
2 | | or 34-18.67. |
3 | | (f) The State Board of Education shall provide technical |
4 | | assistance for specific learning disabilities to school |
5 | | districts, including assistance with universal screeners and |
6 | | dyslexia screenings. |
7 | | The State Board shall review the handbook once every 4 |
8 | | years to update, if necessary, the guidelines, educational |
9 | | strategies, or resources and services made available in the |
10 | | handbook. |
11 | | (Source: P.A. 99-65, eff. 7-16-15; 99-78, eff. 7-20-15; 99-602, |
12 | | eff. 7-22-16; 99-603, eff. 7-22-16; 100-201, eff. 8-18-17; |
13 | | 100-617, eff. 7-20-18.) |
14 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.182 new) |
15 | | Sec. 2-3.182. Report on reading and math intervention and |
16 | | support. |
17 | | (a) The State Board of Education shall establish a uniform |
18 | | format for school districts to report the information required |
19 | | under subsection (c) of Section 10-20.9b and subsection (c) of |
20 | | Section 34-18.51a. The format may be developed with input from |
21 | | school boards and shall be provided to each school district no |
22 | | later than 90 days prior to the annual reporting due date. |
23 | | (b) The State Board shall annually compile the information |
24 | | required under subsection (c) of Section 10-20.9b and |
25 | | subsection (c) of Section 34-18.51a, along with State-level |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 75 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | summary information, and publish the information on its |
2 | | Internet website. On or before October 31 of each year, the |
3 | | State Board shall make a report of its findings and compilation |
4 | | of information available to the public, the Governor, and the |
5 | | General Assembly, as provided under Section 3.1 of the General |
6 | | Assembly Organization Act.
|
7 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-20.9a) (from Ch. 122, par. 10-20.9a)
|
8 | | Sec. 10-20.9a. Final grade; promotion.
|
9 | | (a) Teachers shall
administer the approved
marking system |
10 | | or other approved means of evaluating pupil progress. The
|
11 | | teacher shall maintain the responsibility and right to |
12 | | determine grades and
other evaluations of students within the |
13 | | grading policies of the district
based upon his or her |
14 | | professional judgment of available criteria pertinent
to any |
15 | | given subject area or activity for which he or she is |
16 | | responsible.
District policy shall provide the procedure and |
17 | | reasons by and for which
a grade may be changed; provided that |
18 | | no grade or evaluation shall be
changed without notification to |
19 | | the teacher concerning the nature and
reasons for such change. |
20 | | If such a change is made, the person
making
the change shall |
21 | | assume such responsibility for determining the grade or
|
22 | | evaluation, and shall initial such change.
|
23 | | (b) School districts shall not promote students to the next
|
24 | | higher grade level based upon age or any other social reasons |
25 | | not related to
the academic performance of the students. School |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 76 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | On or before September 1, 1998,
school boards shall adopt and |
2 | | enforce a policy on promotion as they deem necessary to ensure |
3 | | that students
meet
local goals and objectives and can perform |
4 | | at the expected grade level prior to
promotion.
Decisions to |
5 | | promote or retain students in any classes shall be based on
|
6 | | successful completion of the curriculum, attendance, |
7 | | performance based on the assessments required under Section |
8 | | 2-3.64a-5 of this Code , the Iowa Test of Basic Skills, or
other |
9 | | testing , or any other criteria established by the school board. |
10 | | Students
determined by the local district to not qualify for |
11 | | promotion to the next
higher grade shall be provided remedial |
12 | | assistance, which may include, but
shall not be limited to, a |
13 | | summer bridge program of no less than 90 hours,
tutorial |
14 | | sessions, increased or concentrated instructional time, |
15 | | modifications
to instructional materials, and retention in |
16 | | grade. This subsection (b) is subject to Section 10-20.9b.
|
17 | | (Source: P.A. 98-972, eff. 8-15-14.)
|
18 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-20.9b new) |
19 | | Sec. 10-20.9b. Reading and math intervention and support. |
20 | | (a) A school board must notify, in writing, the parent or |
21 | | guardian of a student in any of grades kindergarten through 3 |
22 | | who exhibits a deficiency in reading or math skills at any time |
23 | | during the school year no later than 30 days after the |
24 | | identification of the deficiency in reading or math. The |
25 | | written notification provided to the parent or guardian of the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 77 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | student must include all of the following: |
2 | | (1) Notification that the student has been identified |
3 | | as having a deficiency in reading or math and that |
4 | | additional support will be provided to the student. |
5 | | (2) A description of the current services that are |
6 | | provided to the student. |
7 | | (3) A description of the proposed evidence-based |
8 | | reading or math intervention services and supplemental |
9 | | instructional services and support that will be provided to |
10 | | the student and that are designed to remedy the identified |
11 | | areas of deficiency in reading or math. |
12 | | (4) Notification that the parent or guardian will be |
13 | | informed in writing of the student's progress toward |
14 | | grade-level reading or math with each progress report or |
15 | | report card. |
16 | | (5) Strategies for the parent or guardian to use at |
17 | | home to help the student succeed in reading or math. |
18 | | (6) Notification that if the student's deficiency in |
19 | | reading or math is not corrected by the end of grade 3, the |
20 | | school will provide the student with intensive |
21 | | intervention and progress monitoring if the student is |
22 | | promoted to grade 4. |
23 | | (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, a school |
24 | | district must provide to any student retained in a grade |
25 | | intensive reading or math intervention to remedy the student's |
26 | | specific deficiency in reading or math. The reading or math |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 78 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | intervention services must include effective instructional |
2 | | strategies to accelerate student progress. The school district |
3 | | may provide any of the following services to the retained |
4 | | student: |
5 | | (1) A highly effective teacher of reading or math, as |
6 | | demonstrated by student reading or math performance data |
7 | | and teacher performance evaluations. |
8 | | (2) The use of reading or math intervention services |
9 | | and support to correct the identified areas of deficiency |
10 | | in reading or math, which include, but are not limited to: |
11 | | (A) dedicating more time than in the previous |
12 | | school year to providing to the student evidence-based |
13 | | reading or math instruction and intervention; |
14 | | (B) using reading or math strategies or programs |
15 | | that are evidence-based and have proven results for |
16 | | accelerating student reading or math achievement |
17 | | within the same school year; |
18 | | (C) daily targeted small group reading or math |
19 | | intervention based on student needs; |
20 | | (D) explicit and systematic instruction with more |
21 | | detailed explanations, more extensive opportunities |
22 | | for guided practice, and more opportunities for error |
23 | | correction and feedback; and |
24 | | (E) frequent monitoring of the reading or math |
25 | | progress of the student's reading or math skills |
26 | | throughout the school year and the adjustment of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 79 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | instruction according to the student's needs. |
2 | | (3) Before-school or after-school supplemental |
3 | | evidence-based reading or math intervention delivered by a |
4 | | teacher or tutor with specialized training in reading or |
5 | | math instruction. |
6 | | (4) An at-home plan outlined in a parental contract |
7 | | that includes participation in parent-training workshops |
8 | | or regular parent-guided reading or math activities. |
9 | | (c) On or before October 1 of each year, a school board |
10 | | must report, in writing, to the State Board of Education all of |
11 | | the following information for the prior school year, by grade |
12 | | and disaggregated by demographic group if applicable: |
13 | | (1) The school board's policies and procedures on |
14 | | student grade-level retention and promotion. |
15 | | (2) The number of students who were administered a |
16 | | universal screener, as defined in Section 10-20.73, during |
17 | | the school year. |
18 | | (3) The number of students who were administered a |
19 | | Level I dyslexia screening, as defined in Section 10-20.73. |
20 | | (4) The total number of students identified as having |
21 | | the characteristics of dyslexia during that school year. |
22 | | (5) The number of students receiving reading or math |
23 | | intervention services, including those receiving dyslexia |
24 | | intervention services, under this Section. |
25 | | (6) The number and percentage of all students in |
26 | | kindergarten through grade 3 performing below grade level |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 80 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | on local and statewide assessments. |
2 | | (7) By grade and disaggregated by demographic group, |
3 | | the number and percentage of all students retained in |
4 | | kindergarten through grade 3. |
5 | | (d) The State Board of Education shall provide technical |
6 | | assistance to aid school boards in implementing this Section. |
7 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-20.73 new) |
8 | | Sec. 10-20.73. Dyslexia screening and support. |
9 | | (a) In this Section: |
10 | | "Level I dyslexia screening" means a process, as determined |
11 | | by a school district, for gathering additional information to |
12 | | determine if the characteristics of dyslexia are present. |
13 | | "Universal screener" means an assessment used to aid |
14 | | educators in understanding the causes for student performance, |
15 | | learning strengths, and the needs that underlie student |
16 | | performance. The assessment is conducted with all students at a |
17 | | particular grade level. |
18 | | (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, a school |
19 | | district must screen students in the first and second grades |
20 | | for the risk factors of dyslexia using a universal screener |
21 | | appropriately designed for the educational context. Following |
22 | | the administration of the universal screener, if a student is |
23 | | determined to be at risk or at some risk for dyslexia, the |
24 | | school district must administer a Level I dyslexia screening of |
25 | | the student. Through the Level I dyslexia screening, the school |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 81 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | district must gather additional information to determine if the |
2 | | student has the characteristics of dyslexia. The additional |
3 | | information may include, but is not limited to, information |
4 | | from progress monitoring data, work samples, additional age and |
5 | | grade-appropriate assessments related to dyslexia, teacher |
6 | | questionnaires, parent interviews, and speech and language |
7 | | assessments and information regarding the student's family |
8 | | history related to dyslexia. |
9 | | (c) If the universal screener or the Level I dyslexia |
10 | | screening indicates that a student has some risk factors for |
11 | | dyslexia or the characteristics of dyslexia, the school must |
12 | | use a multi-tiered system of support (MTSS) framework to |
13 | | address the needs of the student. A school district is not |
14 | | required to administer a Level I dyslexia screening to a |
15 | | student if the student is receiving dyslexia intervention |
16 | | services. If a student's performance on a Level I dyslexia |
17 | | screening indicates a need for dyslexia intervention services, |
18 | | the school district must notify the student's parent or |
19 | | guardian of the results of all screenings and provide to the |
20 | | parent or guardian, in addition to the information contained in |
21 | | the handbook developed under Section 2-3.161, all of the |
22 | | following information and resource material: |
23 | | (1) The characteristics of dyslexia. |
24 | | (2) The appropriate classroom interventions and |
25 | | accommodations for students with dyslexia. |
26 | | (3) A statement that the parent or guardian may elect |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 82 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to have the student receive an educational evaluation by |
2 | | the school. |
3 | | (d) If the student's Level I dyslexia screening indicates |
4 | | that the student has the characteristics of dyslexia, the |
5 | | intervention services provided to the student pursuant to |
6 | | Section 10-20.9b must be implemented using diagnostic teaching |
7 | | guidelines described in the handbook developed under Section |
8 | | 2-3.161. |
9 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-20.74 new) |
10 | | Sec. 10-20.74. Evidence-based reading instruction. By no |
11 | | later than the beginning of the 2023-2024 school year, the |
12 | | school board of each school district that maintains grades |
13 | | kindergarten through 3 shall develop a plan to ensure that |
14 | | within 3 school years all classroom teachers, resource |
15 | | teachers, and reading interventionists who work with students |
16 | | in grades kindergarten through 3 receive professional |
17 | | development, in-service training, or coaching in |
18 | | evidence-based reading instruction that has a focus on reading |
19 | | competency in the areas of phonemic awareness. |
20 | | A teacher who provides satisfactory evidence to the school |
21 | | board that he or she has previously received explicit and |
22 | | repeated instruction in each of the 5 essential components of |
23 | | reading, which are phonemic awareness, phonics, fluency, |
24 | | comprehension, and vocabulary, through an educator preparation |
25 | | program or other accredited training program is exempt from the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 83 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | requirements of this Section. |
2 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-20.75 new) |
3 | | Sec. 10-20.75. Early reading instruction. Each school |
4 | | district that maintains grades kindergarten through 3 shall |
5 | | provide students with instructional programming and services |
6 | | necessary to ensure, to the greatest extent possible, that as a |
7 | | student progresses from kindergarten through grade 3, the |
8 | | student develops the necessary reading skills to enable him or |
9 | | her to master the academic standards and expectations |
10 | | applicable to grade 4 and higher grade levels. The |
11 | | instructional programming and services for teaching students |
12 | | to read must be evidence-based and must focus on reading |
13 | | competency in the areas of phonemic awareness, phonics, |
14 | | vocabulary development, fluency, and comprehension. |
15 | | (105 ILCS 5/21B-20) |
16 | | Sec. 21B-20. Types of licenses. The State Board of |
17 | | Education shall implement a system of educator licensure, |
18 | | whereby individuals employed in school districts who are |
19 | | required to be licensed must have one of the following |
20 | | licenses: (i) a professional educator license; (ii) an educator |
21 | | license with stipulations; (iii) a substitute teaching |
22 | | license; or (iv) until June 30, 2023, a short-term substitute |
23 | | teaching license. References in law regarding individuals |
24 | | certified or certificated or required to be certified or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 84 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | certificated under Article 21 of this Code shall also include |
2 | | individuals licensed or required to be licensed under this |
3 | | Article. The first year of all licenses ends on June 30 |
4 | | following one full year of the license being issued. |
5 | | The State Board of Education, in consultation with the |
6 | | State Educator Preparation and Licensure Board, may adopt such |
7 | | rules as may be necessary to govern the requirements for |
8 | | licenses and endorsements under this Section. |
9 | | (1) Professional Educator License. Persons who (i) |
10 | | have successfully completed an approved educator |
11 | | preparation program and are recommended for licensure by |
12 | | the Illinois institution offering the educator preparation |
13 | | program, (ii) have successfully completed the required |
14 | | testing under Section 21B-30 of this Code, (iii) have |
15 | | successfully completed coursework on the psychology of, |
16 | | the identification of, and the methods of instruction for |
17 | | the exceptional child, including without limitation |
18 | | children with learning disabilities, (iv) have |
19 | | successfully completed coursework in methods of reading |
20 | | and reading in the content area , and , beginning on July 1, |
21 | | 2024, have successfully completed and received explicit |
22 | | and repeated instruction in each of the 5 essential |
23 | | components of reading, which are phonemic awareness, |
24 | | phonics, fluency, comprehension, and vocabulary, and (v) |
25 | | have met all other criteria established by rule of the |
26 | | State Board of Education shall be issued a Professional |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 85 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Educator License. All Professional Educator Licenses are |
2 | | valid until June 30 immediately following 5 years of the |
3 | | license being issued. The Professional Educator License |
4 | | shall be endorsed with specific areas and grade levels in |
5 | | which the individual is eligible to practice. For an early |
6 | | childhood education endorsement, an individual may satisfy |
7 | | the student teaching requirement of his or her early |
8 | | childhood teacher preparation program through placement in |
9 | | a setting with children from birth through grade 2, and the |
10 | | individual may be paid and receive credit while student |
11 | | teaching. The student teaching experience must meet the |
12 | | requirements of and be approved by the individual's early |
13 | | childhood teacher preparation program. |
14 | | Individuals can receive subsequent endorsements on the |
15 | | Professional Educator License. Subsequent endorsements |
16 | | shall require a minimum of 24 semester hours of coursework |
17 | | in the endorsement area and passage of the applicable |
18 | | content area test, unless otherwise specified by rule. |
19 | | (2) Educator License with Stipulations. An Educator |
20 | | License with Stipulations shall be issued an endorsement |
21 | | that limits the license holder to one particular position |
22 | | or does not require completion of an approved educator |
23 | | program or both. |
24 | | An individual with an Educator License with |
25 | | Stipulations must not be employed by a school district or |
26 | | any other entity to replace any presently employed teacher |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 86 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | who otherwise would not be replaced for any reason. |
2 | | An Educator License with Stipulations may be issued |
3 | | with the following endorsements: |
4 | | (A) (Blank). |
5 | | (B) Alternative provisional educator. An |
6 | | alternative provisional educator endorsement on an |
7 | | Educator License with Stipulations may be issued to an |
8 | | applicant who, at the time of applying for the |
9 | | endorsement, has done all of the following: |
10 | | (i) Graduated from a regionally accredited |
11 | | college or university with a minimum of a |
12 | | bachelor's degree. |
13 | | (ii) Successfully completed the first phase of |
14 | | the Alternative Educator Licensure Program for |
15 | | Teachers, as described in Section 21B-50 of this |
16 | | Code. |
17 | | (iii) Passed a content area test, as required |
18 | | under Section 21B-30 of this Code. |
19 | | The alternative provisional educator endorsement is |
20 | | valid for 2 years of teaching and may be renewed for a |
21 | | third year by an individual meeting the requirements set |
22 | | forth in Section 21B-50 of this Code. |
23 | | (C) Alternative provisional superintendent. An |
24 | | alternative provisional superintendent endorsement on |
25 | | an Educator License with Stipulations entitles the |
26 | | holder to serve only as a superintendent or assistant |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 87 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | superintendent in a school district's central office. |
2 | | This endorsement may only be issued to an applicant |
3 | | who, at the time of applying for the endorsement, has |
4 | | done all of the following: |
5 | | (i) Graduated from a regionally accredited |
6 | | college or university with a minimum of a master's |
7 | | degree in a management field other than education. |
8 | | (ii) Been employed for a period of at least 5 |
9 | | years in a management level position in a field |
10 | | other than education. |
11 | | (iii) Successfully completed the first phase |
12 | | of an alternative route to superintendent |
13 | | endorsement program, as provided in Section 21B-55 |
14 | | of this Code. |
15 | | (iv) Passed a content area test required under |
16 | | Section 21B-30 of this Code. |
17 | | The endorsement is valid for 2 fiscal years in |
18 | | order to complete one full year of serving as a |
19 | | superintendent or assistant superintendent. |
20 | | (D) (Blank). |
21 | | (E) Career and technical educator. A career and |
22 | | technical educator endorsement on an Educator License |
23 | | with Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who has |
24 | | a minimum of 60 semester hours of coursework from a |
25 | | regionally accredited institution of higher education |
26 | | or an accredited trade and technical institution and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 88 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | has a minimum of 2,000 hours of experience outside of |
2 | | education in each area to be taught. |
3 | | The career and technical educator endorsement on |
4 | | an Educator License with Stipulations is valid until |
5 | | June 30 immediately following 5 years of the |
6 | | endorsement being issued and may be renewed. |
7 | | An individual who holds a valid career and |
8 | | technical educator endorsement on an Educator License |
9 | | with Stipulations but does not hold a bachelor's degree |
10 | | may substitute teach in career and technical education |
11 | | classrooms. |
12 | | (F) Part-time provisional career and technical |
13 | | educator or provisional career and technical educator. |
14 | | A part-time provisional career and technical educator |
15 | | endorsement or a provisional career and technical |
16 | | educator endorsement on an Educator License with |
17 | | Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who has a |
18 | | minimum of 8,000 hours of work experience in the skill |
19 | | for which the applicant is seeking the endorsement. It |
20 | | is the responsibility of each employing school board |
21 | | and regional office of education to provide |
22 | | verification, in writing, to the State Superintendent |
23 | | of Education at the time the application is submitted |
24 | | that no qualified teacher holding a Professional |
25 | | Educator License or an Educator License with |
26 | | Stipulations with a career and technical educator |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 89 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | endorsement is available and that actual circumstances |
2 | | require such issuance. |
3 | | The provisional career and technical educator |
4 | | endorsement on an Educator License with Stipulations |
5 | | is valid until June 30 immediately following 5 years of |
6 | | the endorsement being issued and may be renewed for 5 |
7 | | years. |
8 | | A part-time provisional career and technical |
9 | | educator endorsement on an Educator License with |
10 | | Stipulations may be issued for teaching no more than 2 |
11 | | courses of study for grades 6 through 12. The part-time |
12 | | provisional career and technical educator endorsement |
13 | | on an Educator License with Stipulations is valid until |
14 | | June 30 immediately following 5 years of the |
15 | | endorsement being issued and may be renewed for 5 years |
16 | | if the individual makes application for renewal. |
17 | | An individual who holds a provisional or part-time |
18 | | provisional career and technical educator endorsement |
19 | | on an Educator License with Stipulations but does not |
20 | | hold a bachelor's degree may substitute teach in career |
21 | | and technical education classrooms. |
22 | | (G) Transitional bilingual educator. A |
23 | | transitional bilingual educator endorsement on an |
24 | | Educator License with Stipulations may be issued for |
25 | | the purpose of providing instruction in accordance |
26 | | with Article 14C of this Code to an applicant who |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 90 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | provides satisfactory evidence that he or she meets all |
2 | | of the following requirements: |
3 | | (i) Possesses adequate speaking, reading, and |
4 | | writing ability in the language other than English |
5 | | in which transitional bilingual education is |
6 | | offered. |
7 | | (ii) Has the ability to successfully |
8 | | communicate in English. |
9 | | (iii) Either possessed, within 5 years |
10 | | previous to his or her applying for a transitional |
11 | | bilingual educator endorsement, a valid and |
12 | | comparable teaching certificate or comparable |
13 | | authorization issued by a foreign country or holds |
14 | | a degree from an institution of higher learning in |
15 | | a foreign country that the State Educator |
16 | | Preparation and Licensure Board determines to be |
17 | | the equivalent of a bachelor's degree from a |
18 | | regionally accredited institution of higher |
19 | | learning in the United States. |
20 | | A transitional bilingual educator endorsement |
21 | | shall be valid for prekindergarten through grade 12, is |
22 | | valid until June 30 immediately following 5 years of |
23 | | the endorsement being issued, and shall not be renewed. |
24 | | Persons holding a transitional bilingual educator |
25 | | endorsement shall not be employed to replace any |
26 | | presently employed teacher who otherwise would not be |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 91 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | replaced for any reason. |
2 | | (H) Language endorsement. In an effort to |
3 | | alleviate the shortage of teachers speaking a language |
4 | | other than English in the public schools, an individual |
5 | | who holds an Educator License with Stipulations may |
6 | | also apply for a language endorsement, provided that |
7 | | the applicant provides satisfactory evidence that he |
8 | | or she meets all of the following requirements: |
9 | | (i) Holds a transitional bilingual |
10 | | endorsement. |
11 | | (ii) Has demonstrated proficiency in the |
12 | | language for which the endorsement is to be issued |
13 | | by passing the applicable language content test |
14 | | required by the State Board of Education. |
15 | | (iii) Holds a bachelor's degree or higher from |
16 | | a regionally accredited institution of higher |
17 | | education or, for individuals educated in a |
18 | | country other than the United States, holds a |
19 | | degree from an institution of higher learning in a |
20 | | foreign country that the State Educator |
21 | | Preparation and Licensure Board determines to be |
22 | | the equivalent of a bachelor's degree from a |
23 | | regionally accredited institution of higher |
24 | | learning in the United States. |
25 | | (iv) (Blank). |
26 | | A language endorsement on an Educator License with |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 92 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Stipulations is valid for prekindergarten through |
2 | | grade 12 for the same validity period as the |
3 | | individual's transitional bilingual educator |
4 | | endorsement on the Educator License with Stipulations |
5 | | and shall not be renewed. |
6 | | (I) Visiting international educator. A visiting |
7 | | international educator endorsement on an Educator |
8 | | License with Stipulations may be issued to an |
9 | | individual who is being recruited by a particular |
10 | | school district that conducts formal recruitment |
11 | | programs outside of the United States to secure the |
12 | | services of qualified teachers and who meets all of the |
13 | | following requirements: |
14 | | (i) Holds the equivalent of a minimum of a |
15 | | bachelor's degree issued in the United States. |
16 | | (ii) Has been prepared as a teacher at the |
17 | | grade level for which he or she will be employed. |
18 | | (iii) Has adequate content knowledge in the |
19 | | subject to be taught. |
20 | | (iv) Has an adequate command of the English |
21 | | language. |
22 | | A holder of a visiting international educator |
23 | | endorsement on an Educator License with Stipulations |
24 | | shall be permitted to teach in bilingual education |
25 | | programs in the language that was the medium of |
26 | | instruction in his or her teacher preparation program, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 93 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | provided that he or she passes the English Language |
2 | | Proficiency Examination or another test of writing |
3 | | skills in English identified by the State Board of |
4 | | Education, in consultation with the State Educator |
5 | | Preparation and Licensure Board. |
6 | | A visiting international educator endorsement on |
7 | | an Educator License with Stipulations is valid for 5 |
8 | | years and shall not be renewed. |
9 | | (J) Paraprofessional educator. A paraprofessional |
10 | | educator endorsement on an Educator License with |
11 | | Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who holds a |
12 | | high school diploma or its recognized equivalent and |
13 | | either holds an associate's degree or a minimum of 60 |
14 | | semester hours of credit from a regionally accredited |
15 | | institution of higher education or has passed a |
16 | | paraprofessional competency test under subsection |
17 | | (c-5) of Section 21B-30. The paraprofessional educator |
18 | | endorsement is valid until June 30 immediately |
19 | | following 5 years of the endorsement being issued and |
20 | | may be renewed through application and payment of the |
21 | | appropriate fee, as required under Section 21B-40 of |
22 | | this Code. An individual who holds only a |
23 | | paraprofessional educator endorsement is not subject |
24 | | to additional requirements in order to renew the |
25 | | endorsement. |
26 | | (K) Chief school business official. A chief school |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 94 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | business official endorsement on an Educator License |
2 | | with Stipulations may be issued to an applicant who |
3 | | qualifies by having a master's degree or higher, 2 |
4 | | years of full-time administrative experience in school |
5 | | business management or 2 years of university-approved |
6 | | practical experience, and a minimum of 24 semester |
7 | | hours of graduate credit in a program approved by the |
8 | | State Board of Education for the preparation of school |
9 | | business administrators and by passage of the |
10 | | applicable State tests, including an applicable |
11 | | content area test. |
12 | | The chief school business official endorsement may |
13 | | also be affixed to the Educator License with |
14 | | Stipulations of any holder who qualifies by having a |
15 | | master's degree in business administration, finance, |
16 | | accounting, or public administration and who completes |
17 | | an additional 6 semester hours of internship in school |
18 | | business management from a regionally accredited |
19 | | institution of higher education and passes the |
20 | | applicable State tests, including an applicable |
21 | | content area test. This endorsement shall be required |
22 | | for any individual employed as a chief school business |
23 | | official. |
24 | | The chief school business official endorsement on |
25 | | an Educator License with Stipulations is valid until |
26 | | June 30 immediately following 5 years of the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 95 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | endorsement being issued and may be renewed if the |
2 | | license holder completes renewal requirements as |
3 | | required for individuals who hold a Professional |
4 | | Educator License endorsed for chief school business |
5 | | official under Section 21B-45 of this Code and such |
6 | | rules as may be adopted by the State Board of |
7 | | Education. |
8 | | The State Board of Education shall adopt any rules |
9 | | necessary to implement Public Act 100-288. |
10 | | (L) Provisional in-state educator. A provisional |
11 | | in-state educator endorsement on an Educator License |
12 | | with Stipulations may be issued to a candidate who has |
13 | | completed an Illinois-approved educator preparation |
14 | | program at an Illinois institution of higher education |
15 | | and who has not successfully completed an |
16 | | evidence-based assessment of teacher effectiveness but |
17 | | who meets all of the following requirements: |
18 | | (i) Holds at least a bachelor's degree. |
19 | | (ii) Has completed an approved educator |
20 | | preparation program at an Illinois institution. |
21 | | (iii) Has passed an applicable content area |
22 | | test, as required by Section 21B-30 of this Code. |
23 | | (iv) Has attempted an evidence-based |
24 | | assessment of teacher effectiveness and received a |
25 | | minimum score on that assessment, as established |
26 | | by the State Board of Education in consultation |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 96 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | with the State Educator Preparation and Licensure |
2 | | Board. |
3 | | A provisional in-state educator endorsement on an |
4 | | Educator License with Stipulations is valid for one |
5 | | full fiscal year after the date of issuance and may not |
6 | | be renewed. |
7 | | (M) (Blank). |
8 | | (N) Specialized services. A specialized services |
9 | | endorsement on an Educator License with Stipulations |
10 | | may be issued as defined and specified by rule. |
11 | | (3) Substitute Teaching License. A Substitute Teaching |
12 | | License may be issued to qualified applicants for |
13 | | substitute teaching in all grades of the public schools, |
14 | | prekindergarten through grade 12. Substitute Teaching |
15 | | Licenses are not eligible for endorsements. Applicants for |
16 | | a Substitute Teaching License must hold a bachelor's degree |
17 | | or higher from a regionally accredited institution of |
18 | | higher education. |
19 | | Substitute Teaching Licenses are valid for 5 years. |
20 | | Substitute Teaching Licenses are valid for substitute |
21 | | teaching in every county of this State. If an individual |
22 | | has had his or her Professional Educator License or |
23 | | Educator License with Stipulations suspended or revoked, |
24 | | then that individual is not eligible to obtain a Substitute |
25 | | Teaching License. |
26 | | A substitute teacher may only teach in the place of a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 97 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | licensed teacher who is under contract with the employing |
2 | | board. If, however, there is no licensed teacher under |
3 | | contract because of an emergency situation, then a district |
4 | | may employ a substitute teacher for no longer than 30 |
5 | | calendar days per each vacant position in the district if |
6 | | the district notifies the appropriate regional office of |
7 | | education within 5 business days after the employment of |
8 | | the substitute teacher in the emergency situation. An |
9 | | emergency situation is one in which an unforeseen vacancy |
10 | | has occurred and (i) a teacher is unable to fulfill his or |
11 | | her contractual duties or (ii) teacher capacity needs of |
12 | | the district exceed previous indications, and the district |
13 | | is actively engaged in advertising to hire a fully licensed |
14 | | teacher for the vacant position. |
15 | | There is no limit on the number of days that a |
16 | | substitute teacher may teach in a single school district, |
17 | | provided that no substitute teacher may teach for longer |
18 | | than 90 school days for any one licensed teacher under |
19 | | contract in the same school year. A substitute teacher who |
20 | | holds a Professional Educator License or Educator License |
21 | | with Stipulations shall not teach for more than 120 school |
22 | | days for any one licensed teacher under contract in the |
23 | | same school year. The limitations in this paragraph (3) on |
24 | | the number of days a substitute teacher may be employed do |
25 | | not apply to any school district operating under Article 34 |
26 | | of this Code. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 98 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | A school district may not require an individual who |
2 | | holds a valid Professional Educator License or Educator |
3 | | License with Stipulations to seek or hold a Substitute |
4 | | Teaching License to teach as a substitute teacher. |
5 | | (4) Short-Term Substitute Teaching License. Beginning |
6 | | on July 1, 2018 and until June 30, 2023, the State Board of |
7 | | Education may issue a Short-Term Substitute Teaching |
8 | | License. A Short-Term Substitute Teaching License may be |
9 | | issued to a qualified applicant for substitute teaching in |
10 | | all grades of the public schools, prekindergarten through |
11 | | grade 12. Short-Term Substitute Teaching Licenses are not |
12 | | eligible for endorsements. Applicants for a Short-Term |
13 | | Substitute Teaching License must hold an associate's |
14 | | degree or have completed at least 60 credit hours from a |
15 | | regionally accredited institution of higher education. |
16 | | Short-Term Substitute Teaching Licenses are valid for |
17 | | substitute teaching in every county of this State. If an |
18 | | individual has had his or her Professional Educator License |
19 | | or Educator License with Stipulations suspended or |
20 | | revoked, then that individual is not eligible to obtain a |
21 | | Short-Term Substitute Teaching License. |
22 | | The provisions of Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5 of this |
23 | | Code apply to short-term substitute teachers. |
24 | | An individual holding a Short-Term Substitute Teaching |
25 | | License may teach no more than 5 consecutive days per |
26 | | licensed teacher who is under contract. For teacher |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 99 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | absences lasting 6 or more days per licensed teacher who is |
2 | | under contract, a school district may not hire an |
3 | | individual holding a Short-Term Substitute Teaching |
4 | | License. An individual holding a Short-Term Substitute |
5 | | Teaching License must complete the training program under |
6 | | Section 10-20.67 or 34-18.60 of this Code to be eligible to |
7 | | teach at a public school. This paragraph (4) is inoperative |
8 | | on and after July 1, 2023.
|
9 | | (Source: P.A. 100-8, eff. 7-1-17; 100-13, eff. 7-1-17; 100-288, |
10 | | eff. 8-24-17; 100-596, eff. 7-1-18; 100-821, eff. 9-3-18; |
11 | | 100-863, eff. 8-14-18; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; 101-220, eff. |
12 | | 8-7-19; 101-594, eff. 12-5-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20.) |
13 | | (105 ILCS 5/21B-35) |
14 | | Sec. 21B-35. Minimum requirements for educators trained in |
15 | | other states or countries. |
16 | | (a) Any applicant who has not been entitled by an |
17 | | Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois |
18 | | institution of higher education applying for a Professional |
19 | | Educator License endorsed in a teaching field or school support |
20 | | personnel area must meet the following requirements: |
21 | | (1) the applicant must: |
22 | | (A) hold a comparable and valid educator license or |
23 | | certificate, as defined by rule, with similar grade |
24 | | level and content area credentials from another state, |
25 | | with the State Board of Education having the authority |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 100 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to determine what constitutes similar grade level and |
2 | | content area credentials from another state; |
3 | | (B) have a bachelor's degree from a regionally |
4 | | accredited institution of higher education; and |
5 | | (C) have demonstrated proficiency in the English |
6 | | language by either passing the English language |
7 | | proficiency test required by the State Board of |
8 | | Education or providing evidence of completing a |
9 | | postsecondary degree at an institution in which the |
10 | | mode of instruction was English; or |
11 | | (2) the applicant must: |
12 | | (A) have completed a state-approved program for |
13 | | the licensure area sought, including coursework |
14 | | concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional |
15 | | child, methods of reading and reading in the content |
16 | | area, and instructional strategies for English |
17 | | learners , and, beginning on July 1, 2024, have |
18 | | completed and received explicit and repeated |
19 | | instruction in each of the 5 essential components of |
20 | | reading, which are phonemic awareness, phonics, |
21 | | fluency, comprehension, and vocabulary ; |
22 | | (B) have a bachelor's degree from a regionally |
23 | | accredited institution of higher education; |
24 | | (C) have successfully met all Illinois examination |
25 | | requirements, except that: |
26 | | (i) (blank); |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 101 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (ii) an applicant who has successfully |
2 | | completed a test of content, as defined by rules, |
3 | | at the time of initial licensure in another state |
4 | | is not required to complete a test of content; and |
5 | | (iii) an applicant for a teaching endorsement |
6 | | who has successfully completed an evidence-based |
7 | | assessment of teacher effectiveness, as defined by |
8 | | rules, at the time of initial licensure in another |
9 | | state is not required to complete an |
10 | | evidence-based assessment of teacher |
11 | | effectiveness; and |
12 | | (D) for an applicant for a teaching endorsement, |
13 | | have completed student teaching or an equivalent |
14 | | experience or, for an applicant for a school service |
15 | | personnel endorsement, have completed an internship or |
16 | | an equivalent experience. |
17 | | (b) In order to receive a Professional Educator License |
18 | | endorsed in a teaching field or school support personnel area, |
19 | | applicants trained in another country must meet all of the |
20 | | following requirements: |
21 | | (1) Have completed a comparable education program in |
22 | | another country. |
23 | | (2) Have had transcripts evaluated by an evaluation |
24 | | service approved by the State Superintendent of Education. |
25 | | (3) Have a degree comparable to a degree from a |
26 | | regionally accredited institution of higher education. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 102 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) Have completed coursework aligned to standards |
2 | | concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional |
3 | | child, methods of reading and reading in the content area, |
4 | | and instructional strategies for English learners. |
5 | | (5) (Blank). |
6 | | (6) (Blank). |
7 | | (7) Have successfully met all State licensure |
8 | | examination requirements. Applicants who have successfully |
9 | | completed a test of content, as defined by rules, at the |
10 | | time of initial licensure in another country shall not be |
11 | | required to complete a test of content. Applicants for a |
12 | | teaching endorsement who have successfully completed an |
13 | | evidence-based assessment of teacher effectiveness, as |
14 | | defined by rules, at the time of initial licensure in |
15 | | another country shall not be required to complete an |
16 | | evidence-based assessment of teacher effectiveness. |
17 | | (8) Have completed student teaching or an equivalent |
18 | | experience. |
19 | | (9) Have demonstrated proficiency in the English |
20 | | language by either passing the English language |
21 | | proficiency test required by the State Board of Education |
22 | | or providing evidence of completing a postsecondary degree |
23 | | at an institution in which the mode of instruction was |
24 | | English. |
25 | | (b-5) All applicants who have not been entitled by an |
26 | | Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 103 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | institution of higher education and applicants trained in |
2 | | another country applying for a Professional Educator License |
3 | | endorsed for principal or superintendent must hold a master's |
4 | | degree from a regionally accredited institution of higher |
5 | | education, pass the English language proficiency test required |
6 | | by the State Board of Education, and hold a comparable and |
7 | | valid educator license or certificate with similar grade level |
8 | | and subject matter credentials, with the State Board of |
9 | | Education having the authority to determine what constitutes |
10 | | similar grade level and subject matter credentials from another |
11 | | state, or must meet all of the following requirements: |
12 | | (1) Have completed an educator preparation program |
13 | | approved by another state or comparable educator program in |
14 | | another country leading to the receipt of a license or |
15 | | certificate for the Illinois endorsement sought. |
16 | | (2) Have successfully met all State licensure |
17 | | examination requirements, as required by Section 21B-30 of |
18 | | this Code. Applicants who have successfully completed a |
19 | | test of content, as defined by rules, at the time of |
20 | | initial licensure in another state or country shall not be |
21 | | required to complete a test of content. |
22 | | (2.5) Have completed an internship, as defined by rule. |
23 | | (3) (Blank). |
24 | | (4) Have completed coursework aligned to standards |
25 | | concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional |
26 | | child, methods of reading and reading in the content area, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 104 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and instructional strategies for English learners and, |
2 | | beginning on July 1, 2024, have completed and received |
3 | | explicit and repeated instruction in each of the 5 |
4 | | essential components of reading, which are phonemic |
5 | | awareness, phonics, fluency, comprehension, and |
6 | | vocabulary . |
7 | | (4.5) Have demonstrated proficiency in the English |
8 | | language by either passing the English language |
9 | | proficiency test required by the State Board of Education |
10 | | or providing evidence of completing a postsecondary degree |
11 | | at an institution in which the mode of instruction was |
12 | | English. |
13 | | (5) Have completed a master's degree. |
14 | | (6) Have successfully completed teaching, school |
15 | | support, or administrative experience as defined by rule. |
16 | | (b-7) All applicants who have not been entitled by an |
17 | | Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois |
18 | | institution of higher education applying for a Professional |
19 | | Educator License endorsed for Director of Special Education |
20 | | must hold a master's degree from a regionally accredited |
21 | | institution of higher education and must hold a comparable and |
22 | | valid educator license or certificate with similar grade level |
23 | | and subject matter credentials, with the State Board of |
24 | | Education having the authority to determine what constitutes |
25 | | similar grade level and subject matter credentials from another |
26 | | state, or must meet all of the following requirements: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 105 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) Have completed a master's degree. |
2 | | (2) Have 2 years of full-time experience providing |
3 | | special education services. |
4 | | (3) Have successfully completed all examination |
5 | | requirements, as required by Section 21B-30 of this Code. |
6 | | Applicants who have successfully completed a test of |
7 | | content, as identified by rules, at the time of initial |
8 | | licensure in another state or country shall not be required |
9 | | to complete a test of content. |
10 | | (4) Have completed coursework aligned to standards |
11 | | concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional |
12 | | child, methods of reading and reading in the content area, |
13 | | and instructional strategies for English learners. |
14 | | (b-10) All applicants who have not been entitled by an |
15 | | Illinois-approved educator preparation program at an Illinois |
16 | | institution of higher education applying for a Professional |
17 | | Educator License endorsed for chief school business official |
18 | | must hold a master's degree from a regionally accredited |
19 | | institution of higher education and must hold a comparable and |
20 | | valid educator license or certificate with similar grade level |
21 | | and subject matter credentials, with the State Board of |
22 | | Education having the authority to determine what constitutes |
23 | | similar grade level and subject matter credentials from another |
24 | | state, or must meet all of the following requirements: |
25 | | (1) Have completed a master's degree in school business |
26 | | management, finance, or accounting. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 106 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) Have successfully completed an internship in |
2 | | school business management or have 2 years of experience as |
3 | | a school business administrator. |
4 | | (3) Have successfully met all State examination |
5 | | requirements, as required by Section 21B-30 of this Code. |
6 | | Applicants who have successfully completed a test of |
7 | | content, as identified by rules, at the time of initial |
8 | | licensure in another state or country shall not be required |
9 | | to complete a test of content. |
10 | | (4) Have completed modules aligned to standards |
11 | | concerning methods of instruction of the exceptional |
12 | | child, methods of reading and reading in the content area, |
13 | | and instructional strategies for English learners and, |
14 | | beginning on July 1, 2024, have completed and received |
15 | | explicit and repeated instruction in each of the 5 |
16 | | essential components of reading, which are phonemic |
17 | | awareness, phonics, fluency, comprehension, and |
18 | | vocabulary . |
19 | | (c) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the |
20 | | State Educator Preparation and Licensure Board, may adopt such |
21 | | rules as may be necessary to implement this Section.
|
22 | | (Source: P.A. 100-13, eff. 7-1-17; 100-584, eff. 4-6-18; |
23 | | 100-596, eff. 7-1-18; 101-220, eff. 8-7-19; 101-643, eff. |
24 | | 6-18-20.) |
25 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-18.51) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 107 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 34-18.51. Committee on the retention of students. |
2 | | (a) The board may create a committee on the retention of |
3 | | students. The committee shall consist of the general |
4 | | superintendent of schools or his or her designee, a district |
5 | | administrator who directs student instruction and curriculum, |
6 | | a principal from a school of the district, and a teacher from a |
7 | | school of the district. |
8 | | (b) Prior to retention in a grade, a school may submit, by |
9 | | a date as set by the committee on the retention of students, |
10 | | the names of all students determined by the school to not |
11 | | qualify for promotion to the next higher grade and the reason |
12 | | for that determination. Subject to Section 34-18.51a, the The |
13 | | committee shall review the school's decision to retain with |
14 | | respect to each student and shall make a final decision |
15 | | regarding whether or not to retain a particular student. The |
16 | | committee shall take into consideration the relevant data and |
17 | | evidence gathered during the Response to Intervention process. |
18 | | The committee may vote to overturn a retention decision if the |
19 | | committee determines that the student should be promoted after |
20 | | examining the student's access to remedial assistance, |
21 | | performance, attendance, and participation and the resources |
22 | | and facilities provided by the school district or due to the |
23 | | student having an undiagnosed learning disability.
|
24 | | (Source: P.A. 99-592, eff. 7-22-16; 100-201, eff. 8-18-17.) |
25 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-18.51a new) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 108 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 34-18.51a. Reading and math intervention and support. |
2 | | (a) The board must notify, in writing, the parent or |
3 | | guardian of a student in any of grades kindergarten through 3 |
4 | | who exhibits a deficiency in reading or math skills at any time |
5 | | during the school year no later than 30 days after the |
6 | | identification of the deficiency in reading or math. The |
7 | | written notification provided to the parent or guardian of the |
8 | | student must include all of the following: |
9 | | (1) Notification that the student has been identified |
10 | | as having a deficiency in reading or math and that |
11 | | additional support will be provided to the student. |
12 | | (2) A description of the current services that are |
13 | | provided to the student. |
14 | | (3) A description of the proposed evidence-based |
15 | | reading or math intervention services and supplemental |
16 | | instructional services and support that will be provided to |
17 | | the student and that are designed to remedy the identified |
18 | | areas of deficiency in reading or math. |
19 | | (4) Notification that the parent or guardian will be |
20 | | informed in writing of the student's progress toward |
21 | | grade-level reading or math with each progress report or |
22 | | report card. |
23 | | (5) Strategies for the parent or guardian to use at |
24 | | home to help the student succeed in reading or math. |
25 | | (6) Notification that if the student's deficiency in |
26 | | reading or math is not corrected by the end of grade 3, the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 109 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | school will provide the student with intensive |
2 | | intervention and progress monitoring if the student is |
3 | | promoted to grade 4. |
4 | | (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, the school |
5 | | district must provide to any student retained in a grade |
6 | | intensive reading or math intervention to remedy the student's |
7 | | specific deficiency in reading or math. The reading or math |
8 | | intervention services must include effective instructional |
9 | | strategies to accelerate student progress. The school district |
10 | | may provide any of the following services to the retained |
11 | | student: |
12 | | (1) A highly effective teacher of reading or math, as |
13 | | demonstrated by student reading or math performance data |
14 | | and teacher performance evaluations. |
15 | | (2) The use of reading or math intervention services |
16 | | and support to correct the identified areas of deficiency |
17 | | in reading or math, which include, but are not limited to: |
18 | | (A) dedicating more time than in the previous |
19 | | school year to providing to the student evidence-based |
20 | | reading or math instruction and intervention; |
21 | | (B) using reading or math strategies or programs |
22 | | that are evidence-based and have proven results for |
23 | | accelerating student reading or math achievement |
24 | | within the same school year; |
25 | | (C) daily targeted small group reading or math |
26 | | intervention based on student needs; |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 110 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (D) explicit and systematic instruction with more |
2 | | detailed explanations, more extensive opportunities |
3 | | for guided practice, and more opportunities for error |
4 | | correction and feedback; and |
5 | | (E) frequent monitoring of the reading or math |
6 | | progress of the student's reading or math skills |
7 | | throughout the school year and the adjustment of |
8 | | instruction according to the student's needs. |
9 | | (3) Before-school or after-school supplemental |
10 | | evidence-based reading or math intervention delivered by a |
11 | | teacher or tutor with specialized training in reading or |
12 | | math instruction. |
13 | | (4) An at-home plan outlined in a parental contract |
14 | | that includes participation in parent-training workshops |
15 | | or regular parent-guided reading or math activities. |
16 | | (c) On or before October 1 of each year, the board must |
17 | | report, in writing, to the State Board of Education all of the |
18 | | following information for the prior school year, by grade and |
19 | | disaggregated by demographic group if applicable: |
20 | | (1) The board's policies and procedures on student |
21 | | grade-level retention and promotion. |
22 | | (2) The number of students who were administered a |
23 | | universal screener, as defined in Section 34-18.67, during |
24 | | the school year. |
25 | | (3) The number of students who were administered a |
26 | | Level I dyslexia screening, as defined in Section 34-18.67. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 111 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) The total number of students identified as having |
2 | | the characteristics of dyslexia during that school year. |
3 | | (5) The number of students receiving reading or math |
4 | | intervention services, including those receiving dyslexia |
5 | | intervention services, under this Section. |
6 | | (6) The number and percentage of all students in |
7 | | kindergarten through grade 3 performing below grade level |
8 | | on local and statewide assessments. |
9 | | (7) By grade and disaggregated by demographic group, |
10 | | the number and percentage of all students retained in |
11 | | kindergarten through grade 3. |
12 | | (d) The State Board of Education shall provide technical |
13 | | assistance to aid the board in implementing this Section. |
14 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-18.67 new) |
15 | | Sec. 34-18.67. Dyslexia screening and support. |
16 | | (a) In this Section: |
17 | | "Level I dyslexia screening" means a process, as determined |
18 | | by the school district, for gathering additional information to |
19 | | determine if the characteristics of dyslexia are present. |
20 | | "Universal screener" means an assessment used to aid |
21 | | educators in understanding the causes for student performance, |
22 | | learning strengths, and the needs that underlie student |
23 | | performance. The assessment is conducted with all students at a |
24 | | particular grade level. |
25 | | (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, the school |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 112 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | district must screen students in the first and second grades |
2 | | for the risk factors of dyslexia using a universal screener |
3 | | appropriately designed for the educational context. Following |
4 | | the administration of the universal screener, if a student is |
5 | | determined to be at risk or at some risk for dyslexia, the |
6 | | school district must administer a Level I dyslexia screening of |
7 | | the student. Through the Level I dyslexia screening, the school |
8 | | district must gather additional information to determine if the |
9 | | student has the characteristics of dyslexia. The additional |
10 | | information may include, but is not limited to, information |
11 | | from progress monitoring data, work samples, additional age and |
12 | | grade-appropriate assessments related to dyslexia, teacher |
13 | | questionnaires, parent interviews, and speech and language |
14 | | assessments and information regarding the student's family |
15 | | history related to dyslexia. |
16 | | (c) If the universal screener or the Level I dyslexia |
17 | | screening indicates that a student has some risk factors for |
18 | | dyslexia or the characteristics of dyslexia, the school must |
19 | | use a multi-tiered system of support (MTSS) framework to |
20 | | address the needs of the student. The school district is not |
21 | | required to administer a Level I dyslexia screening to a |
22 | | student if the student is receiving dyslexia intervention |
23 | | services. If a student's performance on a Level I dyslexia |
24 | | screening indicates a need for dyslexia intervention services, |
25 | | the school district must notify the student's parent or |
26 | | guardian of the results of all screenings and provide to the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 113 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | parent or guardian, in addition to the information contained in |
2 | | the handbook developed under Section 2-3.161, all of the |
3 | | following information and resource material: |
4 | | (1) The characteristics of dyslexia. |
5 | | (2) The appropriate classroom interventions and |
6 | | accommodations for students with dyslexia. |
7 | | (3) A statement that the parent or guardian may elect |
8 | | to have the student receive an educational evaluation by |
9 | | the school. |
10 | | (d) If the student's Level I dyslexia screening indicates |
11 | | that the student has the characteristics of dyslexia, the |
12 | | intervention services provided to the student pursuant to |
13 | | Section 34-18.51a must be implemented using diagnostic |
14 | | teaching guidelines described in the handbook developed under |
15 | | Section 2-3.161. |
16 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-18.68 new) |
17 | | Sec. 34-18.68. Evidence-based reading instruction. By no |
18 | | later than the beginning of the 2023-2024 school year, the |
19 | | board shall develop a plan to ensure that within 3 school years |
20 | | all classroom teachers, resource teachers, and reading |
21 | | interventionists who work with students in grades kindergarten |
22 | | through 3 receive professional development, in-service |
23 | | training, or coaching in evidence-based reading instruction |
24 | | that has a focus on reading competency in the areas of phonemic |
25 | | awareness. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 114 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | A teacher who provides satisfactory evidence to the board |
2 | | that he or she has previously received explicit and repeated |
3 | | instruction in each of the 5 essential components of reading, |
4 | | which are phonemic awareness, phonics, fluency, comprehension, |
5 | | and vocabulary, through an educator preparation program or |
6 | | other accredited training program is exempt from the |
7 | | requirements of this Section. |
8 | | (105 ILCS 5/34-18.69 new) |
9 | | Sec. 34-18.69. Early reading instruction. The school |
10 | | district shall provide students with instructional programming |
11 | | and services necessary to ensure, to the greatest extent |
12 | | possible, that as a student progresses from kindergarten |
13 | | through grade 3, the student develops the necessary reading |
14 | | skills to enable him or her to master the academic standards |
15 | | and expectations applicable to grade 4 and higher grade levels. |
16 | | The instructional programming and services for teaching |
17 | | students to read must be evidence-based and must focus on |
18 | | reading competency in the areas of phonemic awareness, phonics, |
19 | | vocabulary development, fluency, and comprehension. |
20 | | Article 35. |
21 | | Section 35-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the |
22 | | Infant/Early Childhood Mental Health Consultations Act. |
23 | | References in this Article to "this Act" mean this Article. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 115 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 35-5. Findings; policies. |
2 | | (a) The General Assembly finds the following: |
3 | | (1) Social and emotional development is a core |
4 | | developmental domain in young children and is codified in |
5 | | the Illinois Early Learning Standards. |
6 | | (2) Fostering social and emotional development in |
7 | | early childhood means both providing the supportive |
8 | | settings and interactions to maximize healthy social and |
9 | | emotional development for all children, as well as |
10 | | providing communities, programs, and providers with |
11 | | systems of tiered supports with training to respond to more |
12 | | significant social and emotional challenges or where |
13 | | experiences of trauma may be more prevalent. |
14 | | (3) Early care and education programs and providers, |
15 | | across a range of settings, have an important role to play |
16 | | in supporting young children and families, especially |
17 | | those who face greater challenges, such as trauma exposure, |
18 | | social isolation, pervasive poverty, and toxic stress; if |
19 | | programs, teaching staff, caregivers, and providers are |
20 | | not provided with the support, services, and training |
21 | | needed to accomplish these goals, it can lead to children |
22 | | and families being asked to leave programs, particularly |
23 | | without connection to more appropriate services, thereby |
24 | | creating a disruption in learning and social-emotional |
25 | | development; investments in
reflective supervision, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 116 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | professional development specific to diversity, equity and |
2 | | inclusion practice, culturally responsive training, |
3 | | implicit bias training, and how trauma experienced during |
4 | | the early years can manifest in challenging behaviors will |
5 | | create systems for serving children that are informed in |
6 | | developmentally appropriate and responsive supports. |
7 | | (4) Studies have shown that the expulsion of infants, |
8 | | toddlers, and young children in early care and education |
9 | | settings is occurring at alarmingly high rates, more than 3 |
10 | | times that of students in K-12; further, expulsion occurs |
11 | | more frequently for Black children and Latinx children and |
12 | | more frequently for boys than for girls, with Black boys |
13 | | being most frequently expelled; there is evidence to show |
14 | | that the expulsion of Black girls is occurring with |
15 | | increasing frequency. |
16 | | (5) Illinois took its first steps toward addressing |
17 | | this disparity through Public Act 100-105 to prohibit |
18 | | expulsion due to child behavior in early care and education |
19 | | settings, but further work is needed to implement this law, |
20 | | including strengthening provider understanding of a |
21 | | successful transition and beginning to identify strategies |
22 | | to reduce "soft expulsions" and to ensure more young |
23 | | children and their teachers, providers, and caregivers, in |
24 | | a range of early care and education settings, can benefit |
25 | | from services, such as Infant/Early Childhood Mental |
26 | | Health Consultations (I/ECMHC) and positive behavior |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 117 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | interventions and supports such as the Pyramid Model. |
2 | | (6) I/ECMHC is a critical component needed to align |
3 | | social-emotional well-being with the public health model |
4 | | of promotion, prevention, and intervention across early |
5 | | care and education systems. |
6 | | (b) The General Assembly encourages that all of the |
7 | | following actions be taken by: |
8 | | (1) the State to increase the availability of |
9 | | Infant/Early Childhood Mental Health Consultations |
10 | | (I/ECMHC) through increased funding in early childhood |
11 | | programs and sustainable funding for coordination of |
12 | | I/ECMHC and other social and emotional support at the State |
13 | | level; |
14 | | (2) the Department of Human Services (IDHS), the |
15 | | Illinois State Board of Education (ISBE), the Governor's |
16 | | Office of Early Childhood Development (GOECD), and other |
17 | | relevant agencies to develop and promote |
18 | | provider-accessible and parent-accessible materials on the |
19 | | role and value of I/ECMHC, including targeted promotion in |
20 | | underserved communities, and promote the use of existing |
21 | | I/ECMHCs, the I/ECMHC consultant database, or other |
22 | | existing services; |
23 | | (3) the State to increase funding to promote and |
24 | | provide training and implementation support for systems of |
25 | | tiered support, such as the Pyramid Model, across early |
26 | | childhood settings and urge DHS, ISBE, GOECD, and other |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 118 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | relevant State agencies to coordinate efforts and develop |
2 | | strategies to provide outreach to and support providers in |
3 | | underserved communities and communities with fewer |
4 | | programmatic resources; and |
5 | | (4) ISBE and DCFS to provide the data required by |
6 | | Public Act 100-105, even if the data is incomplete at the |
7 | | time due to data system challenges. |
8 | | Article 40. |
9 | | Section 40-5. The Illinois Public Aid Code is amended by |
10 | | adding Section 5-39 as follows: |
11 | | (305 ILCS 5/5-39 new) |
12 | | Sec. 5-39. Behavioral health services for children; |
13 | | diagnostic assessment system. Beginning on July 1, 2022, if it |
14 | | is necessary to provide a diagnostic code for behavioral health |
15 | | services for children ages 5 and under, providers shall utilize |
16 | | a developmentally appropriate and age-appropriate diagnostic |
17 | | assessment system, such as the Diagnostic Classification of |
18 | | Mental Health and Developmental Disorders of Infancy and Early |
19 | | Childhood-Revised (DC:0-5), for diagnosis and treatment |
20 | | planning. If necessary for billing purposes, the provider, |
21 | | managed care organization, or Department shall utilize the |
22 | | existing crosswalk tool to convert the developmentally |
23 | | appropriate and age-appropriate diagnosis code to the relevant |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 119 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | code available in the State system. |
2 | | By no later than July 1, 2021, the Department shall make |
3 | | recommendations to the General Assembly on the resources needed |
4 | | to integrate developmentally appropriate and age-appropriate |
5 | | diagnostic codes into the State system. The Department shall |
6 | | have in place all necessary resources needed to integrate |
7 | | developmentally appropriate and age-appropriate diagnostic |
8 | | codes by no later than January 1, 2023. |
9 | | Article 45. |
10 | | Section 45-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the |
11 | | Early Childhood Workforce Act. References in this Article to |
12 | | "this Act" mean this Article. |
13 | | Section 45-5. Findings; policies. |
14 | | (a) The General Assembly finds the following: |
15 | | (1) Research shows that early childhood teacher |
16 | | effectiveness is a predictor for positive developmental |
17 | | and academic outcomes for children. |
18 | | (2) The work of early childhood educators is |
19 | | sophisticated and central to the healthy learning and |
20 | | development of young children and takes place in a range of |
21 | | settings, including schools, community-based centers, and |
22 | | homes. |
23 | | (3) It is critically important for children's outcomes |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 120 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to have educators that reflect the diversity of the |
2 | | families and communities they serve. |
3 | | (4) The early childhood workforce is more racially |
4 | | diverse than the K-12 workforce, and its members hold |
5 | | degrees, have earned credentials, and have years of |
6 | | experience in the field. |
7 | | (5) The early childhood workforce, particularly those |
8 | | working in community-based settings and those working with |
9 | | infants and toddlers, often are not paid wages aligned to |
10 | | the sophistication of their work and level of education. |
11 | | (6) All regions and settings have difficulty finding |
12 | | qualified teachers. |
13 | | (7) A disproportionate number of Black and Latinx women |
14 | | serve in essential, frontline positions but are |
15 | | underrepresented as lead teachers and in program |
16 | | leadership where credentials and degrees are required. |
17 | | (8) The early childhood workforce faces multiple |
18 | | barriers to additional credential and degree attainment |
19 | | that lead to career advancement and higher levels of |
20 | | compensation.
|
21 | | (b) The General Assembly encourages all of the following: |
22 | | (1) The Department of Human Services to undertake an |
23 | | analysis of teacher data in the Gateways Registry to |
24 | | determine those individuals who are close to their next |
25 | | credential or degree, including information where |
26 | | available in the Registry such as their geographic |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 121 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | location, demographics, work setting, and age groups of |
2 | | children for whom they are responsible. |
3 | | (2) The Department of Human Services to conduct |
4 | | outreach and provide targeted coaching and access to |
5 | | financial supports, including, but not limited to, |
6 | | scholarships and debt relief, in a way that prioritizes |
7 | | increasing the diversity of the teacher pipeline, regions |
8 | | of the State with the highest need, and children in age |
9 | | groups with the greatest teacher shortages. |
10 | | (3) The State Board of Education to provide additional |
11 | | financial support to candidates and provide this support to |
12 | | all candidates regardless of the setting in which they work |
13 | | and the credentials they are currently seeking, |
14 | | prioritizing those by greatest need in the early childhood |
15 | | field. |
16 | | (4) The Department of Human Services to provide annual |
17 | | reports on who receives these and other scholarships or |
18 | | other financial support administered by the Department or |
19 | | the State Board of Education by geographic location, |
20 | | demographics, work setting, age groups of children served, |
21 | | and credential/degree attainment as available. |
22 | | (5) The Board of Higher Education, in the course of |
23 | | their strategic planning process, to review the barriers |
24 | | experienced by the early childhood workforce and by |
25 | | teachers of color, in particular in accessing and |
26 | | completing the needed coursework to attain additional |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 122 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | credentials and degrees, and to recommend policy or |
2 | | practice changes to better meet the needs of this |
3 | | workforce, which is largely comprised of non-traditional |
4 | | students and women of color. |
5 | | (6) The State Board of Education and the Department of |
6 | | Human Services to prioritize reducing compensation |
7 | | disparities between the early childhood workforce and |
8 | | their K-12 counterparts and disparities within the early |
9 | | childhood workforce between setting and age groups in which |
10 | | they work, as funding becomes available. |
11 | | Article 50. |
12 | | Section 50-5. The School Code is amended by adding Section |
13 | | 2-3.183 and by changing Section 27-22 as follows: |
14 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.183 new) |
15 | | Sec. 2-3.183. Review of university admission coursework. |
16 | | (a) On or before February 1, 2021 and each February 1 |
17 | | thereafter, the State Board of Education and the Board of |
18 | | Higher Education shall jointly compile a review that |
19 | | identifies, for each public university in this State, the |
20 | | courses the university requires or recommends a high school |
21 | | student take to be admitted to the university as an |
22 | | undergraduate student. The review shall also include any |
23 | | additional coursework requirements or recommendations for |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 123 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | undergraduate admission into a specific academic major, |
2 | | college, or department of the university. The courses that are |
3 | | identified in the review as recommended must include, at a |
4 | | minimum, those courses that the university describes in its |
5 | | promotional materials as being recommended. |
6 | | (b) The State Board of Education shall make the review |
7 | | compiled under subsection (a) available to the public on its |
8 | | Internet website. |
9 | | (c) To ensure that a public high school student is not |
10 | | excluded from enrolling in a public university in this State |
11 | | because of a lack of access to required or recommended |
12 | | coursework, every public high school must provide access to |
13 | | each course identified in the review compiled under subsection |
14 | | (a) to any of its students who request to enroll in the course. |
15 | | If the high school is unable to offer the course through the |
16 | | school district, the high school must find an alternative way |
17 | | to offer the course to the student, which may include |
18 | | partnering with another school district, a community college |
19 | | district, or some other course provider, and the student's |
20 | | school district shall cover any portion of the cost of the |
21 | | course that is not covered by State or other public or private |
22 | | funding. |
23 | | (d) To ensure that every public high school student |
24 | | understands the course expectations for admission into a public |
25 | | university in this State, a school district must make available |
26 | | to students in grades 8 through 12 and their parents or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 124 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | guardians the review compiled under subsection (a) before the |
2 | | student's course schedule is finalized for the student's |
3 | | particular grade level. |
4 | | (e) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules |
5 | | necessary to implement this Section. |
6 | | (105 ILCS 5/27-22) (from Ch. 122, par. 27-22)
|
7 | | Sec. 27-22. Required high school courses.
|
8 | | (a) (Blank).
|
9 | | (b) (Blank). |
10 | | (c) (Blank). |
11 | | (d) (Blank). |
12 | | (e) Through the 2023-2024 school year, as As a prerequisite |
13 | | to receiving a high school diploma, each pupil
entering the 9th |
14 | | grade must, in addition to other course requirements, |
15 | | successfully
complete all of the following courses: |
16 | | (1) Four years of language arts. |
17 | | (2) Two years of writing intensive courses, one of |
18 | | which must be English and the other of which may be English |
19 | | or any other subject. When applicable, writing-intensive |
20 | | courses may be counted towards the fulfillment of other |
21 | | graduation requirements.
|
22 | | (3) Three years of mathematics, one of which must be |
23 | | Algebra I, one of which must include geometry content, and |
24 | | one of which may be an Advanced Placement computer science |
25 | | course. A mathematics course that includes geometry |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 125 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | content may be offered as an integrated, applied, |
2 | | interdisciplinary, or career and technical education |
3 | | course that prepares a student for a career readiness path. |
4 | | (4) Two years of science. |
5 | | (5) Two years of social studies, of which at least one |
6 | | year must be history of the United States or a combination |
7 | | of history of the United States and American government |
8 | | and, beginning with pupils entering the 9th grade in the |
9 | | 2016-2017 school year and each school year thereafter, at |
10 | | least one semester must be civics, which shall help young |
11 | | people acquire and learn to use the skills, knowledge, and |
12 | | attitudes that will prepare them to be competent and |
13 | | responsible citizens throughout their lives. Civics course |
14 | | content shall focus on government institutions, the |
15 | | discussion of current and controversial issues, service |
16 | | learning, and simulations of the democratic process. |
17 | | School districts may utilize private funding available for |
18 | | the purposes of offering civics education. |
19 | | (6) One year chosen from (A) music, (B) art, (C) |
20 | | foreign language, which shall be deemed to include American |
21 | | Sign Language, or (D) vocational education. |
22 | | (e-5) Beginning with the 2024-2025 school year, as a |
23 | | prerequisite to receiving a high school diploma, each pupil |
24 | | entering the 9th grade must, in addition to other course |
25 | | requirements, successfully complete all of the following |
26 | | courses: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 126 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) Four years of language arts. |
2 | | (2) Two years of writing intensive courses, one of |
3 | | which must be English and the other of which may be English |
4 | | or any other subject. If applicable, writing-intensive |
5 | | courses may be counted toward the fulfillment of other |
6 | | graduation requirements. |
7 | | (3) Three years of mathematics, one of which must be |
8 | | Algebra I, one of which must include geometry content, and |
9 | | one of which may be an Advanced Placement computer science |
10 | | course. A mathematics course that includes geometry |
11 | | content may be offered as an integrated, applied, |
12 | | interdisciplinary, or career and technical education |
13 | | course that prepares a student for a career readiness path. |
14 | | (4) Two years of laboratory science. |
15 | | (5) Two years of social studies, of which at least one |
16 | | year must be history of the United States or a combination |
17 | | of history of the United States and American government and |
18 | | at least one semester must be civics, which shall help |
19 | | young people acquire and learn to use the skills, |
20 | | knowledge, and attitudes that will prepare them to be |
21 | | competent and responsible citizens throughout their lives. |
22 | | Civics course content shall focus on government |
23 | | institutions, the discussion of current and controversial |
24 | | issues, service learning, and simulations of the |
25 | | democratic process. School districts may utilize private |
26 | | funding available for the purposes of offering civics |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 127 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | education. |
2 | | (6) Two years of foreign language, which shall be |
3 | | deemed to include American Sign Language. |
4 | | (7) One year chosen from (A) music, (B) art, (C) |
5 | | foreign language that is in addition to the 2 years under |
6 | | paragraph (6), which shall be deemed to include American |
7 | | Sign Language, or (D) vocational education. |
8 | | (f) The State Board of Education shall develop and inform |
9 | | school districts of standards for writing-intensive |
10 | | coursework.
|
11 | | (f-5) If a school district offers an Advanced Placement |
12 | | computer science course to high school students, then the |
13 | | school board must designate that course as equivalent to a high |
14 | | school mathematics course and must denote on the student's |
15 | | transcript that the Advanced Placement computer science course |
16 | | qualifies as a mathematics-based, quantitative course for |
17 | | students in accordance with subdivision (3) of subsection (e) |
18 | | of this Section. |
19 | | (g) This amendatory Act of 1983 does not apply to pupils |
20 | | entering the 9th grade
in 1983-1984 school year and prior |
21 | | school years or to students
with disabilities whose course of |
22 | | study is determined by an individualized
education program.
|
23 | | This amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly does not |
24 | | apply
to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2004-2005 school |
25 | | year or a prior
school year or to students with disabilities |
26 | | whose course of study is
determined by an individualized |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 128 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | education program.
|
2 | | This amendatory Act of the 101st General Assembly does not |
3 | | apply
to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2023-2024 school |
4 | | year or a prior
school year or to students with disabilities |
5 | | whose course of study is
determined by an individualized |
6 | | education program. |
7 | | (h) The provisions of this Section are subject to the |
8 | | provisions of
Section
27-22.05 of this Code and the |
9 | | Postsecondary and Workforce Readiness Act.
|
10 | | (i) The State Board of Education may adopt rules to modify |
11 | | the requirements of this Section for any students enrolled in |
12 | | grades 9 through 12 if the Governor has declared a disaster due |
13 | | to a public health emergency pursuant to Section 7 of the |
14 | | Illinois Emergency Management Agency Act. |
15 | | (Source: P.A. 100-443, eff. 8-25-17; 101-464, eff. 1-1-20; |
16 | | 101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
|
17 | | Section 50-10. The Board of Higher Education Act is amended |
18 | | by adding Section 9.40 as follows: |
19 | | (110 ILCS 205/9.40 new) |
20 | | Sec. 9.40. Review of university admission coursework. |
21 | | (a) On or before February 1, 2021 and each February 1 |
22 | | thereafter, the State Board of Education and the Board of |
23 | | Higher Education shall jointly compile a review as provided |
24 | | under Section 2-3.183 of the School Code. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 129 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (b) The Board of Higher Education may adopt any rules |
2 | | necessary to implement this Section. |
3 | | Article 55. |
4 | | Section 55-5. The School Code is amended by adding Section |
5 | | 2-3.184 and by changing Section 18-8.15 as follows: |
6 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.184 new) |
7 | | Sec. 2-3.184. Approved anti-racism initiatives; |
8 | | anti-racism investment funding. |
9 | | (a) In this Section, "approved anti-racism initiatives" |
10 | | means evidence-based or research-based practices approved by |
11 | | the State Board of Education that are shown to reduce the gaps |
12 | | and disparities experienced by African American students in |
13 | | academic achievement and educational performance and includes |
14 | | practices that have been shown to reduce disparities in |
15 | | disciplinary rates, drop-out rates, graduation rates, college |
16 | | matriculation rates, and college completion rates. |
17 | | (b) No later than January 30, 2021, the State Board shall |
18 | | create a list of approved anti-racism initiatives that may be |
19 | | implemented by school districts to enhance the educational |
20 | | performance of African American students. Approved anti-racism |
21 | | initiatives may include, but are not limited to, all of the |
22 | | following: |
23 | | (1) A reduction in class sizes in grades kindergarten |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 130 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | through 3. |
2 | | (2) The implementation of culturally appropriate |
3 | | curriculum and associated professional development. |
4 | | (3) The implementation of project-based learning and |
5 | | associated professional development. |
6 | | (4) The implementation of a Universal Design for |
7 | | Learning framework and associated professional |
8 | | development. |
9 | | (5) The implementation of research-based and on-going |
10 | | professional development for school faculty, |
11 | | administrators, and staff to identify and counter implicit |
12 | | bias. |
13 | | No later than January 30, 2021, the State Board shall make |
14 | | the list available to school districts by posting the list on |
15 | | the State Board's Internet website. No later than January 30th |
16 | | of each year thereafter, the State Board shall update the list |
17 | | and post the updated list on the State Board's Internet |
18 | | website. |
19 | | (c) Funding received by a school district pursuant to |
20 | | subparagraph (Y) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of Section |
21 | | 18-8.15 of this Code shall be utilized for the implementation |
22 | | of one or more approved anti-racism initiatives listed by the |
23 | | State Board under subsection (b) of this Section. However, a |
24 | | school district may utilize a specified amount of that funding |
25 | | for a purpose other than to implement one or more of the |
26 | | approved anti-racism initiatives if the school district, upon |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 131 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | application, obtains written consent from the State Board to |
2 | | utilize the specified amount for another purpose. The |
3 | | application for consent shall be in such form as the State |
4 | | Board prescribes. The State Board shall grant or deny consent |
5 | | within 60 days after receipt of the application. The granting |
6 | | or denial of consent shall be final, binding, and |
7 | | non-appealable. |
8 | | (d) For each school year in which a school district |
9 | | receives funding pursuant to subparagraph (Y) of paragraph (2) |
10 | | of subsection (b) of Section 18-8.15 of this Code, the school |
11 | | district shall report to the State Board on how the school |
12 | | district utilized all of the funding it received under |
13 | | subparagraph (Y) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of Section |
14 | | 18-8.15 of this Code. The report shall be in such form as the |
15 | | State Board prescribes on the State Board's website. |
16 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15) |
17 | | Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-Based Funding for student success |
18 | | for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years. |
19 | | (a) General provisions. |
20 | | (1) The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by |
21 | | June 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten |
22 | | through grade 12 public education system with the capacity |
23 | | to ensure the educational development of all persons to the |
24 | | limits of their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of |
25 | | Article X of the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 132 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | accomplish that objective, this Section creates a method of |
2 | | funding public education that is evidence-based; is |
3 | | sufficient to ensure every student receives a meaningful |
4 | | opportunity to learn irrespective of race, ethnicity, |
5 | | sexual orientation, gender, or community-income level; and |
6 | | is sustainable and predictable. When fully funded under |
7 | | this Section, every school shall have the resources, based |
8 | | on what the evidence indicates is needed, to: |
9 | | (A) provide all students with a high quality |
10 | | education that offers the academic, enrichment, social |
11 | | and emotional support, technical, and career-focused |
12 | | programs that will allow them to become competitive |
13 | | workers, responsible parents, productive citizens of |
14 | | this State, and active members of our national |
15 | | democracy; |
16 | | (B) ensure all students receive the education they |
17 | | need to graduate from high school with the skills |
18 | | required to pursue post-secondary education and |
19 | | training for a rewarding career; |
20 | | (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the |
21 | | achievement gap between at-risk and non-at-risk |
22 | | students by raising the performance of at-risk |
23 | | students and not by reducing standards; and |
24 | | (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to |
25 | | assume the primary responsibility to fund public |
26 | | education and simultaneously relieve the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 133 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | disproportionate burden placed on local property taxes |
2 | | to fund schools. |
3 | | (2) The Evidence-Based Funding formula under this |
4 | | Section shall be applied to all Organizational Units in |
5 | | this State. The Evidence-Based Funding formula outlined in |
6 | | this Act is based on the formula outlined in Senate Bill 1 |
7 | | of the 100th General Assembly, as passed by both |
8 | | legislative chambers. As further defined and described in |
9 | | this Section, there are 4 major components of the |
10 | | Evidence-Based Funding model: |
11 | | (A) First, the model calculates a unique Adequacy |
12 | | Target for each Organizational Unit in this State that |
13 | | considers the costs to implement research-based |
14 | | activities, the unit's student demographics, and |
15 | | regional wage differences. |
16 | | (B) Second, the model calculates each |
17 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity, or the amount |
18 | | each Organizational Unit is assumed to contribute |
19 | | toward its Adequacy Target from local resources. |
20 | | (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding |
21 | | the State currently contributes to the Organizational |
22 | | Unit and adds that to the unit's Local Capacity to |
23 | | determine the unit's overall current adequacy of |
24 | | funding. |
25 | | (D) Finally, the model's distribution method |
26 | | allocates new State funding to those Organizational |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 134 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Units that are least well-funded, considering both |
2 | | Local Capacity and State funding, in relation to their |
3 | | Adequacy Target. |
4 | | (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under |
5 | | this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received |
6 | | for which that Organizational Unit is authorized to make |
7 | | expenditures by law. |
8 | | (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall |
9 | | have the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4): |
10 | | "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
11 | | subsection (b) of this Section. |
12 | | "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of |
13 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
14 | | "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in |
15 | | paragraph (3) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
16 | | "Adjusted Operating Tax Rate" means a tax rate for all |
17 | | Organizational Units, for which the State Superintendent |
18 | | shall calculate and subtract for the Operating Tax Rate a |
19 | | transportation rate based on total expenses for |
20 | | transportation services under this Code, as reported on the |
21 | | most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil |
22 | | Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the |
23 | | Education and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and |
24 | | 4120 in the Transportation fund, less any corresponding |
25 | | fiscal year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding |
26 | | net adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 135 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | special education transportation reimbursement pursuant to |
2 | | Section 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this |
3 | | Code divided by the Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational |
4 | | Unit's corresponding fiscal year State of Illinois |
5 | | scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for prior |
6 | | years for regular, vocational, or special education |
7 | | transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or |
8 | | subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed the |
9 | | total transportation expenses, as defined in this |
10 | | paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from |
11 | | the Operating Tax Rate. |
12 | | "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of |
13 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
14 | | "Alternative School" means a public school that is |
15 | | created and operated by a regional superintendent of |
16 | | schools and approved by the State Board. |
17 | | "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
18 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
19 | | "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress |
20 | | monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments, |
21 | | in addition to the State accountability assessment, that |
22 | | assist teachers' needs in understanding the skills and |
23 | | meeting the needs of the students they serve. |
24 | | "Assistant principal" means a school administrator |
25 | | duly endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in |
26 | | this State. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 136 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not |
2 | | meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating |
3 | | from elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need |
4 | | for vocational support or social services beyond that |
5 | | provided by the regular school program. All students |
6 | | included in an Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as |
7 | | well as all English learner and disabled students attending |
8 | | the Organizational Unit, shall be considered at-risk |
9 | | students under this Section. |
10 | | "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" for fiscal year |
11 | | 2018 means, for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the |
12 | | average number of students (grades K through 12) reported |
13 | | to the State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit |
14 | | on October 1 in the immediately preceding school year, plus |
15 | | the pre-kindergarten students who receive special |
16 | | education services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to |
17 | | the State Board on December 1 in the immediately preceding |
18 | | school year, or the average number of students (grades K |
19 | | through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the |
20 | | Organizational Unit on October 1, plus the |
21 | | pre-kindergarten students who receive special education |
22 | | services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to the State |
23 | | Board on December 1, for each of the immediately preceding |
24 | | 3 school years. For fiscal year 2019 and each subsequent |
25 | | fiscal year, "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means, |
26 | | for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the average |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 137 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | number of students (grades K through 12) reported to the |
2 | | State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit on |
3 | | October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding school |
4 | | year, plus the pre-kindergarten students who receive |
5 | | special education services as reported to the State Board |
6 | | on October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding |
7 | | school year, or the average number of students (grades K |
8 | | through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the |
9 | | Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the |
10 | | pre-kindergarten students who receive special education |
11 | | services as reported to the State Board on October 1 and |
12 | | March 1, for each of the immediately preceding 3 school |
13 | | years. For the purposes of this definition, "enrolled in |
14 | | the Organizational Unit" means the number of students |
15 | | reported to the State Board who are enrolled in schools |
16 | | within the Organizational Unit that the student attends or |
17 | | would attend if not placed or transferred to another school |
18 | | or program to receive needed services. For the purposes of |
19 | | calculating "ASE", all students, grades K through 12, |
20 | | excluding those attending kindergarten for a half day and |
21 | | students attending an alternative education program |
22 | | operated by a regional office of education or intermediate |
23 | | service center, shall be counted as 1.0. All students |
24 | | attending kindergarten for a half day shall be counted as |
25 | | 0.5, unless in 2017 by June 15 or by March 1 in subsequent |
26 | | years, the school district reports to the State Board of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 138 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Education the intent to implement full-day kindergarten |
2 | | district-wide for all students, then all students |
3 | | attending kindergarten shall be counted as 1.0. Special |
4 | | education pre-kindergarten students shall be counted as |
5 | | 0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or has not |
6 | | collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment count by |
7 | | grade or a December 1 collection of special education |
8 | | pre-kindergarten students as of August 31, 2017 (the |
9 | | effective date of Public Act 100-465), it shall establish |
10 | | such collection for all future years. For any year in which |
11 | | a count by grade level was collected only once, that count |
12 | | shall be used as the single count available for computing a |
13 | | 3-year average ASE. Funding for programs operated by a |
14 | | regional office of education or an intermediate service |
15 | | center must be calculated using the Evidence-Based Funding |
16 | | formula under this Section for the 2019-2020 school year |
17 | | and each subsequent school year until separate adequacy |
18 | | formulas are developed and adopted for each type of |
19 | | program. ASE for a program operated by a regional office of |
20 | | education or an intermediate service center must be |
21 | | determined by the March 1 enrollment for the program. For |
22 | | the 2019-2020 school year, the ASE used in the calculation |
23 | | must be the first-year ASE and, in that year only, the |
24 | | assignment of students served by a regional office of |
25 | | education or intermediate service center shall not result |
26 | | in a reduction of the March enrollment for any school |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 139 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | district. For the 2020-2021 school year, the ASE must be |
2 | | the greater of the current-year ASE or the 2-year average |
3 | | ASE. Beginning with the 2021-2022 school year, the ASE must |
4 | | be the greater of the current-year ASE or the 3-year |
5 | | average ASE. School districts shall submit the data for the |
6 | | ASE calculation to the State Board within 45 days of the |
7 | | dates required in this Section for submission of enrollment |
8 | | data in order for it to be included in the ASE calculation. |
9 | | For fiscal year 2018 only, the ASE calculation shall |
10 | | include only enrollment taken on October 1. |
11 | | "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (10) |
12 | | of subsection (g) of this Section. |
13 | | "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of |
14 | | this Section. |
15 | | "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used |
16 | | to calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State |
17 | | aid. |
18 | | "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the |
19 | | equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk |
20 | | in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as |
21 | | calculated by the county clerk and defined in PTELL. |
22 | | "Bilingual Education Allocation" means the amount of |
23 | | an Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target |
24 | | attributable to bilingual education divided by the |
25 | | Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target, the product |
26 | | of which shall be multiplied by the amount of new funding |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 140 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | received pursuant to this Section. An Organizational |
2 | | Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable to bilingual |
3 | | education shall include all additional investments in |
4 | | English learner students' adequacy elements. |
5 | | "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary |
6 | | State aid is calculated and awarded under this Section. |
7 | | "Central office" means individual administrators and |
8 | | support service personnel charged with managing the |
9 | | instructional programs, business and operations, and |
10 | | security of the Organizational Unit. |
11 | | "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost |
12 | | differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional |
13 | | variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not |
14 | | educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the |
15 | | first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be |
16 | | the CWI initially developed by the National Center for |
17 | | Education Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A & |
18 | | M University. In the fourth and subsequent years of |
19 | | Evidence-Based Funding implementation, the State |
20 | | Superintendent shall re-determine the CWI using a similar |
21 | | methodology to that identified in the Texas A & M |
22 | | University study, with adjustments made no less frequently |
23 | | than once every 5 years. |
24 | | "Computer technology and equipment" means computers |
25 | | servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers, |
26 | | instructional software, security software, curriculum |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 141 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | management courseware, and other similar materials and |
2 | | equipment. |
3 | | "Computer technology and equipment investment |
4 | | allocation" means the final Adequacy Target amount of an |
5 | | Organizational Unit assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 in the |
6 | | prior school year attributable to the additional $285.50 |
7 | | per student computer technology and equipment investment |
8 | | grant divided by the Organizational Unit's final Adequacy |
9 | | Target, the result of which shall be multiplied by the |
10 | | amount of new funding received pursuant to this Section. An |
11 | | Organizational Unit assigned to a Tier 1 or Tier 2 final |
12 | | Adequacy Target attributable to the received computer |
13 | | technology and equipment investment grant shall include |
14 | | all additional investments in computer technology and |
15 | | equipment adequacy elements. |
16 | | "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading, |
17 | | English, writing, and language arts; history and social |
18 | | studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced |
19 | | Placement in high schools. |
20 | | "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in |
21 | | elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle |
22 | | and high schools. |
23 | | "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed |
24 | | teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to |
25 | | students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects. |
26 | | "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 142 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | tax funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the |
2 | | calendar year one year before the calendar year in which a |
3 | | school year begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the |
4 | | abolition of ad valorem personal property tax and the |
5 | | replacement of revenues lost thereby, and amending and |
6 | | repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in connection |
7 | | therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as amended (Public |
8 | | Act 81-1st S.S.-1). |
9 | | "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in |
10 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and |
11 | | calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection |
12 | | (d) of this Section. |
13 | | "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national |
14 | | employment cost index for civilian workers in educational |
15 | | services in elementary and secondary schools on a |
16 | | cumulative basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding |
17 | | the fiscal year of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation. |
18 | | "EIS Data" means the employment information system |
19 | | data maintained by the State Board on educators within |
20 | | Organizational Units. |
21 | | "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision |
22 | | insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit, |
23 | | the costs associated with the statutorily required payment |
24 | | of the normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher |
25 | | pensions, Social Security employer contributions, and |
26 | | Illinois Municipal Retirement Fund employer contributions. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 143 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the |
2 | | definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of |
3 | | this Code participating in a program of transitional |
4 | | bilingual education or a transitional program of |
5 | | instruction meeting the requirements and program |
6 | | application procedures of Article 14C of this Code. For the |
7 | | purposes of collecting the number of EL students enrolled, |
8 | | the same collection and calculation methodology as defined |
9 | | above for "ASE" shall apply to English learners, with the |
10 | | exception that EL student enrollment shall include |
11 | | students in grades pre-kindergarten through 12. |
12 | | "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources, |
13 | | and educational programs that have been identified through |
14 | | academic research as necessary to improve student success, |
15 | | improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and |
16 | | provide for other per student costs related to the delivery |
17 | | and leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the |
18 | | maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are |
19 | | specified in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this |
20 | | Section. |
21 | | "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided |
22 | | to an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section. |
23 | | "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs |
24 | | provided to students outside the regular school day before |
25 | | and after school or during non-instructional times during |
26 | | the school day. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 144 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio |
2 | | in which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and |
3 | | the denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension. |
4 | | "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4) |
5 | | of subsection (f) of this Section. |
6 | | "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of |
7 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
8 | | "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time |
9 | | equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant |
10 | | position at an Organizational Unit. |
11 | | "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection |
12 | | (g). |
13 | | "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance |
14 | | counselor who provides guidance and counseling support for |
15 | | students within an Organizational Unit. |
16 | | "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit |
17 | | district created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code. |
18 | | "Instructional assistant" means a core or special |
19 | | education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in |
20 | | the classroom and provides academic support to students. |
21 | | "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher |
22 | | or licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches |
23 | | continuous improvement in classroom instruction; provides |
24 | | instructional support to teachers in the elements of |
25 | | research-based instruction or demonstrates the alignment |
26 | | of instruction with curriculum standards and assessment |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 145 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | tools; develops or coordinates instructional programs or |
2 | | strategies; develops and implements training; chooses |
3 | | standards-based instructional materials; provides teachers |
4 | | with an understanding of current research; serves as a |
5 | | mentor, site coach, curriculum specialist, or lead |
6 | | teacher; or otherwise works with fellow teachers, in |
7 | | collaboration, to use data to improve instructional |
8 | | practice or develop model lessons. |
9 | | "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional |
10 | | materials for student instruction, including, but not |
11 | | limited to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory |
12 | | equipment, library books, and other similar materials. |
13 | | "Laboratory School" means a public school that is |
14 | | created and operated by a public university and approved by |
15 | | the State Board. |
16 | | "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a |
17 | | library information specialist or another individual whose |
18 | | primary responsibility is overseeing library resources |
19 | | within an Organizational Unit. |
20 | | "Limiting rate for Hybrid Districts" means the |
21 | | combined elementary school and high school limiting rates. |
22 | | "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
23 | | subsection (c) of this Section. |
24 | | "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph |
25 | | (A) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
26 | | "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 146 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
2 | | "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
3 | | subsection (c) of this Section. |
4 | | "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit |
5 | | in a fiscal year, the higher of the average number of |
6 | | students for the prior school year or the immediately |
7 | | preceding 3 school years who, as of July 1 of the |
8 | | immediately preceding fiscal year (as determined by the |
9 | | Department of Human Services), are eligible for at least |
10 | | one of the following low-income programs: Medicaid, the |
11 | | Children's Health Insurance Program, Temporary Assistance |
12 | | for Needy Families (TANF), or the Supplemental Nutrition |
13 | | Assistance Program, excluding pupils who are eligible for |
14 | | services provided by the Department of Children and Family |
15 | | Services. Until such time that grade level low-income |
16 | | populations become available, grade level low-income |
17 | | populations shall be determined by applying the low-income |
18 | | percentage to total student enrollments by grade level. The |
19 | | low-income percentage is determined by dividing the |
20 | | Low-Income Count by the Average Student Enrollment. The |
21 | | low-income percentage for programs operated by a regional |
22 | | office of education or an intermediate service center must |
23 | | be set to the weighted average of the low-income |
24 | | percentages of all of the school districts in the service |
25 | | region. The weighted low-income percentage is the result of |
26 | | multiplying the low-income percentage of each school |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 147 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | district served by the regional office of education or |
2 | | intermediate service center by each school district's |
3 | | Average Student Enrollment, summarizing those products and |
4 | | dividing the total by the total Average Student Enrollment |
5 | | for the service region. |
6 | | "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services, |
7 | | facility and ground maintenance, facility operations, |
8 | | facility security, routine facility repairs, and other |
9 | | similar services and functions. |
10 | | "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (9) of |
11 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
12 | | "New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds" means, for any |
13 | | given fiscal year, all State funds appropriated under |
14 | | Section 2-3.170 of this the School Code. |
15 | | "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all |
16 | | State funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in |
17 | | excess of the amount needed to fund the Base Funding |
18 | | Minimum for all Organizational Units in that school year. |
19 | | "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given |
20 | | school year, the amount of State funds that would be |
21 | | necessary to fully meet the Adequacy Target of an |
22 | | Operational Unit minus the Preliminary Resources available |
23 | | to each unit. |
24 | | "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified |
25 | | school nurse, in accordance with the rules established for |
26 | | nursing services by the State Board, who is an employee of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 148 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and is available to provide health care-related services |
2 | | for students of an Organizational Unit. |
3 | | "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the |
4 | | previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes, |
5 | | except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital |
6 | | Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes. |
7 | | For Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the |
8 | | combined elementary and high school rates utilized in the |
9 | | previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes, |
10 | | except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital |
11 | | Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes. |
12 | | "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School or any |
13 | | public school district that is recognized as such by the |
14 | | State Board and that contains elementary schools typically |
15 | | serving kindergarten through 5th grades, middle schools |
16 | | typically serving 6th through 8th grades, high schools |
17 | | typically serving 9th through 12th grades, a program |
18 | | established under Section 2-3.66 or 2-3.41, or a program |
19 | | operated by a regional office of education or an |
20 | | intermediate service center under Article 13A or 13B. The |
21 | | General Assembly acknowledges that the actual grade levels |
22 | | served by a particular Organizational Unit may vary |
23 | | slightly from what is typical. |
24 | | "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating |
25 | | the CWI in the region and original county in which an |
26 | | Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 149 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | located as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if |
2 | | the Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance |
3 | | with this paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational |
4 | | Unit CWI shall be increased to 0.9. Each county's current |
5 | | CWI value shall be adjusted based on the CWI value of that |
6 | | county's neighboring Illinois counties, to create a |
7 | | "weighted adjusted index value". This shall be calculated |
8 | | by summing the CWI values of all of a county's adjacent |
9 | | Illinois counties and dividing by the number of adjacent |
10 | | Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value of the |
11 | | original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois |
12 | | county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the |
13 | | number of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the |
14 | | original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and |
15 | | the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at |
16 | | 0.75. If the number of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the |
17 | | original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.33 and |
18 | | the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at |
19 | | 0.66. The greater of the county's current CWI value and its |
20 | | weighted adjusted index value shall be used as the |
21 | | Organizational Unit CWI. |
22 | | "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year |
23 | | immediately preceding the Base Tax Year. |
24 | | "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of |
25 | | the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county |
26 | | clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 150 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Tax Rate. |
2 | | "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in |
3 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (f) of this Section. |
4 | | "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
5 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
6 | | "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed |
7 | | to be employed as a principal in this State. |
8 | | "Professional development" means training programs for |
9 | | licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to, |
10 | | programs that assist in implementing new curriculum |
11 | | programs, provide data focused or academic assessment data |
12 | | training to help staff identify a student's weaknesses and |
13 | | strengths, target interventions, improve instruction, |
14 | | encompass instructional strategies for English learner, |
15 | | gifted, or at-risk students, address inclusivity, cultural |
16 | | sensitivity, or implicit bias, or otherwise provide |
17 | | professional support for licensed staff. |
18 | | "Prototypical" means 450 special education |
19 | | pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students |
20 | | for an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students |
21 | | for a middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students |
22 | | for a high school. |
23 | | "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation |
24 | | Law. |
25 | | "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection |
26 | | (d) of this Section. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 151 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist, |
2 | | social worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff |
3 | | member who provides support to at-risk or struggling |
4 | | students. |
5 | | "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
6 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
7 | | "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular |
8 | | Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the |
9 | | Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI. |
10 | | "School site staff" means the primary school secretary |
11 | | and any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school. |
12 | | "Special education" means special educational |
13 | | facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of |
14 | | this Code. |
15 | | "Special Education Allocation" means the amount of an |
16 | | Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable |
17 | | to special education divided by the Organizational Unit's |
18 | | final Adequacy Target, the product of which shall be |
19 | | multiplied by the amount of new funding received pursuant |
20 | | to this Section. An Organizational Unit's final Adequacy |
21 | | Target attributable to special education shall include all |
22 | | special education investment adequacy elements. |
23 | | "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides |
24 | | instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects, |
25 | | including, but not limited to, art, music, physical |
26 | | education, health, driver education, career-technical |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 152 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | education, and such other subject areas as may be mandated |
2 | | by State law or provided by an Organizational Unit. |
3 | | "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School, |
4 | | safe school, Department of Juvenile Justice school, |
5 | | special education cooperative or entity recognized by the |
6 | | State Board as a special education cooperative, |
7 | | State-approved charter school, or alternative learning |
8 | | opportunities program that received direct funding from |
9 | | the State Board during the 2016-2017 school year through |
10 | | any of the funding sources included within the calculation |
11 | | of the Base Funding Minimum or Glenwood Academy. |
12 | | "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental |
13 | | general State aid funding received by an Organizational |
14 | | Unit during the 2016-2017 school year pursuant to |
15 | | subsection (H) of Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now |
16 | | repealed). |
17 | | "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy |
18 | | Targets of all Organizational Units. |
19 | | "State Board" means the State Board of Education. |
20 | | "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent |
21 | | of Education. |
22 | | "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by |
23 | | multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for |
24 | | that Organizational Unit creating a weighted value, |
25 | | summing all Organizational Units' weighted values, and |
26 | | dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 153 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | thereby creating an average weighted index. |
2 | | "Student activities" means non-credit producing |
3 | | after-school programs, including, but not limited to, |
4 | | clubs, bands, sports, and other activities authorized by |
5 | | the school board of the Organizational Unit. |
6 | | "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or |
7 | | teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational |
8 | | Unit and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on |
9 | | a per diem or per period-assignment basis to replace |
10 | | another staff member. |
11 | | "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs |
12 | | provided to students during the summer months outside of |
13 | | the regular school year. |
14 | | "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member |
15 | | who helps in supervising students of an Organizational |
16 | | Unit, but does so outside of the classroom, in situations |
17 | | such as, but not limited to, monitoring hallways and |
18 | | playgrounds, supervising lunchrooms, or supervising |
19 | | students when being transported in buses serving the |
20 | | Organizational Unit. |
21 | | "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of |
22 | | subsection (g). |
23 | | "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined |
24 | | in paragraph (3) of subsection (g). |
25 | | "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate |
26 | | Funding", "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 154 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Funding" are defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g). |
2 | | (b) Adequacy Target calculation. |
3 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the |
4 | | sum of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing |
5 | | Essential Elements, as calculated in accordance with this |
6 | | subsection (b), with the salary amounts in the Essential |
7 | | Elements multiplied by a Regionalization Factor calculated |
8 | | pursuant to paragraph (3) of this subsection (b). |
9 | | (2) The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro |
10 | | rata basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each |
11 | | Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2), |
12 | | with investments and FTE positions pro rata funded based on |
13 | | ASE counts in excess of or less than the thresholds set |
14 | | forth in this paragraph (2). The method for calculating |
15 | | attributable pro rata costs and the defined subgroups |
16 | | thereto are as follows: |
17 | | (A) Core class size investments. Each |
18 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding required |
19 | | to support that number of FTE core teacher positions as |
20 | | is needed to keep the respective class sizes of the |
21 | | Organizational Unit to the following maximum numbers: |
22 | | (i) For grades kindergarten through 3, the |
23 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding required |
24 | | to support one FTE core teacher position for every |
25 | | 15 Low-Income Count students in those grades and |
26 | | one FTE core teacher position for every 20 |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 155 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. |
2 | | (ii) For grades 4 through 12, the |
3 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding required |
4 | | to support one FTE core teacher position for every |
5 | | 20 Low-Income Count students in those grades and |
6 | | one FTE core teacher position for every 25 |
7 | | non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. |
8 | | The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a |
9 | | grade shall be determined by subtracting the |
10 | | Low-Income students in that grade from the ASE of the |
11 | | Organizational Unit for that grade. |
12 | | (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each |
13 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
14 | | to cover that number of FTE specialist teacher |
15 | | positions that correspond to the following |
16 | | percentages: |
17 | | (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an |
18 | | elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the |
19 | | number of the Organizational Unit's core teachers, |
20 | | as determined under subparagraph (A) of this |
21 | | paragraph (2); and |
22 | | (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a |
23 | | high school, then 33.33% of the number of the |
24 | | Organizational Unit's core teachers. |
25 | | (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each |
26 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 156 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to cover one FTE instructional facilitator position |
2 | | for every 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten |
3 | | children with disabilities and all kindergarten |
4 | | through grade 12 students of the Organizational Unit. |
5 | | (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments. |
6 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding |
7 | | needed to cover one FTE teacher position for each |
8 | | prototypical elementary, middle, and high school. |
9 | | (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each |
10 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
11 | | to cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to |
12 | | 5.70% of the minimum pupil attendance days required |
13 | | under Section 10-19 of this Code for all full-time |
14 | | equivalent core, specialist, and intervention |
15 | | teachers, school nurses, special education teachers |
16 | | and instructional assistants, instructional |
17 | | facilitators, and summer school and extended day |
18 | | teacher positions, as determined under this paragraph |
19 | | (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average salary |
20 | | for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the |
21 | | average salary of each instructional assistant |
22 | | position. |
23 | | (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each |
24 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
25 | | to cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450 |
26 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 157 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5 |
2 | | students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for each 250 |
3 | | grades 6 through 8 ASE middle school students, plus one |
4 | | FTE guidance counselor for each 250 grades 9 through 12 |
5 | | ASE high school students. |
6 | | (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit |
7 | | shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse |
8 | | for each 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children |
9 | | with disabilities and all kindergarten through grade |
10 | | 12 students across all grade levels it serves. |
11 | | (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each |
12 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
13 | | to cover one FTE for each 225 combined ASE of |
14 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
15 | | kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE for |
16 | | each 225 ASE middle school students, plus one FTE for |
17 | | each 200 ASE high school students. |
18 | | (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational |
19 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE |
20 | | librarian for each prototypical elementary school, |
21 | | middle school, and high school and one FTE aide or |
22 | | media technician for every 300 combined ASE of |
23 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
24 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students. |
25 | | (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational |
26 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 158 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | principal position for each prototypical elementary |
2 | | school, plus one FTE principal position for each |
3 | | prototypical middle school, plus one FTE principal |
4 | | position for each prototypical high school. |
5 | | (K) Assistant principal investments. Each |
6 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
7 | | to cover one FTE assistant principal position for each |
8 | | prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant |
9 | | principal position for each prototypical middle |
10 | | school, plus one FTE assistant principal position for |
11 | | each prototypical high school. |
12 | | (L) School site staff investments. Each |
13 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
14 | | for one FTE position for each 225 ASE of |
15 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
16 | | kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE |
17 | | position for each 225 ASE middle school students, plus |
18 | | one FTE position for each 200 ASE high school students. |
19 | | (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit |
20 | | shall receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12 |
21 | | ASE. |
22 | | (N) Professional development investments. Each |
23 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of |
24 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
25 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
26 | | students for trainers and other professional |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 159 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | development-related expenses for supplies and |
2 | | materials. |
3 | | (O) Instructional material investments. Each |
4 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of |
5 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
6 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
7 | | students to cover instructional material costs. |
8 | | (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational |
9 | | Unit shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE |
10 | | of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
11 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover |
12 | | assessment costs. |
13 | | (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments. |
14 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per |
15 | | student of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten |
16 | | children with disabilities and all kindergarten |
17 | | through grade 12 students to cover computer technology |
18 | | and equipment costs. For the 2018-2019 school year and |
19 | | subsequent school years, Organizational Units assigned |
20 | | to Tier 1 and Tier 2 in the prior school year shall |
21 | | receive an additional $285.50 per student of the |
22 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
23 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
24 | | students to cover computer technology and equipment |
25 | | costs in the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target. |
26 | | The State Board may establish additional requirements |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 160 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | for Organizational Unit expenditures of funds received |
2 | | pursuant to this subparagraph (Q), including a |
3 | | requirement that funds received pursuant to this |
4 | | subparagraph (Q) may be used only for serving the |
5 | | technology needs of the district. It is the intent of |
6 | | Public Act 100-465 that all Tier 1 and Tier 2 districts |
7 | | receive the addition to their Adequacy Target in the |
8 | | following year, subject to compliance with the |
9 | | requirements of the State Board. |
10 | | (R) Student activities investments. Each |
11 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the following |
12 | | funding amounts to cover student activities: $100 per |
13 | | kindergarten through grade 5 ASE student in elementary |
14 | | school, plus $200 per ASE student in middle school, |
15 | | plus $675 per ASE student in high school. |
16 | | (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each |
17 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student |
18 | | of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
19 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
20 | | students for day-to-day maintenance and operations |
21 | | expenditures, including salary, supplies, and |
22 | | materials, as well as purchased services, but |
23 | | excluding employee benefits. The proportion of salary |
24 | | for the application of a Regionalization Factor and the |
25 | | calculation of benefits is equal to $352.92. |
26 | | (T) Central office investments. Each |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 161 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $742 per student of |
2 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
3 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
4 | | students to cover central office operations, including |
5 | | administrators and classified personnel charged with |
6 | | managing the instructional programs, business and |
7 | | operations of the school district, and security |
8 | | personnel. The proportion of salary for the |
9 | | application of a Regionalization Factor and the |
10 | | calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48. |
11 | | (U) Employee benefit investments. Each |
12 | | Organizational Unit shall receive 30% of the total of |
13 | | all salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target, |
14 | | excluding substitute teachers and student activities |
15 | | investments, to cover benefit costs. For central |
16 | | office and maintenance and operations investments, the |
17 | | benefit calculation shall be based upon the salary |
18 | | proportion of each investment. If at any time the |
19 | | responsibility for funding the employer normal cost of |
20 | | teacher pensions is assigned to school districts, then |
21 | | that amount certified by the Teachers' Retirement |
22 | | System of the State of Illinois to be paid by the |
23 | | Organizational Unit for the preceding school year |
24 | | shall be added to the benefit investment. For any |
25 | | fiscal year in which a school district organized under |
26 | | Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 162 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that |
2 | | amount of its employer normal cost plus the amount for |
3 | | retiree health insurance as certified by the Public |
4 | | School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of |
5 | | Chicago to be paid by the school district for the |
6 | | preceding school year that is statutorily required to |
7 | | cover employer normal costs and the amount for retiree |
8 | | health insurance shall be added to the 30% specified in |
9 | | this subparagraph (U). The Teachers' Retirement System |
10 | | of the State of Illinois and the Public School |
11 | | Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago shall |
12 | | submit such information as the State Superintendent |
13 | | may require for the calculations set forth in this |
14 | | subparagraph (U). |
15 | | (V) Additional investments in low-income students. |
16 | | In addition to and not in lieu of all other funding |
17 | | under this paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit |
18 | | shall receive funding based on the average teacher |
19 | | salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of: |
20 | | (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor) |
21 | | position for every 125 Low-Income Count students; |
22 | | (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for |
23 | | every 125 Low-Income Count students; |
24 | | (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position |
25 | | for every 120 Low-Income Count students; and |
26 | | (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 163 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | for every 120 Low-Income Count students. |
2 | | (W) Additional investments in English learner |
3 | | students. In addition to and not in lieu of all other |
4 | | funding under this paragraph (2), each Organizational |
5 | | Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher |
6 | | salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of: |
7 | | (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor) |
8 | | position for every 125 English learner students; |
9 | | (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for |
10 | | every 125 English learner students; |
11 | | (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position |
12 | | for every 120 English learner students; |
13 | | (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position |
14 | | for every 120 English learner students; and |
15 | | (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100 |
16 | | English learner students. |
17 | | (X) Special education investments. Each |
18 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding based on the |
19 | | average teacher salary for grades K through 12 to cover |
20 | | special education as follows: |
21 | | (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141 |
22 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
23 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
24 | | students; |
25 | | (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every |
26 | | 141 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 164 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
2 | | students; and |
3 | | (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every |
4 | | 1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children |
5 | | with disabilities and all kindergarten through |
6 | | grade 12 students. |
7 | | (Y) Anti-racism investment. In addition to and not |
8 | | in lieu of all other funding under this paragraph (2), |
9 | | an Organizational Unit shall receive funding in the |
10 | | amount of $250 per African American student enrolled in |
11 | | the Organizational Unit if 15% or more of the students |
12 | | enrolled in the Organizational Unit are African |
13 | | American. Funds received pursuant to this subparagraph |
14 | | (Y) shall be utilized as set forth in Section 2-3.184 |
15 | | of this Code. |
16 | | (3) For calculating the salaries included within the |
17 | | Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall |
18 | | annually calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar |
19 | | using the employment information system data maintained by |
20 | | the State Board, limited to public schools only and |
21 | | excluding special education and vocational cooperatives, |
22 | | schools operated by the Department of Juvenile Justice, and |
23 | | charter schools, for the following positions: |
24 | | (A) Teacher for grades K through 8. |
25 | | (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12. |
26 | | (C) Teacher for grades K through 12. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 165 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8. |
2 | | (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12. |
3 | | (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12. |
4 | | (G) Social worker. |
5 | | (H) Psychologist. |
6 | | (I) Librarian. |
7 | | (J) Nurse. |
8 | | (K) Principal. |
9 | | (L) Assistant principal. |
10 | | For the purposes of this paragraph (3), "teacher" |
11 | | includes core teachers, specialist and elective teachers, |
12 | | instructional facilitators, tutors, special education |
13 | | teachers, pupil support staff teachers, English learner |
14 | | teachers, extended day teachers, and summer school |
15 | | teachers. Where specific grade data is not required for the |
16 | | Essential Elements, the average salary for corresponding |
17 | | positions shall apply. For substitute teachers, the |
18 | | average teacher salary for grades K through 12 shall apply. |
19 | | For calculating the salaries included within the |
20 | | Essential Elements for positions not included within EIS |
21 | | Data, the following salaries shall be used in the first |
22 | | year of implementation of Evidence-Based Funding: |
23 | | (i) school site staff, $30,000; and |
24 | | (ii) non-instructional assistant, instructional |
25 | | assistant, library aide, library media tech, or |
26 | | supervisory aide: $25,000. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 166 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | In the second and subsequent years of implementation of |
2 | | Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii) |
3 | | of this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI. |
4 | | The salary amounts for the Essential Elements |
5 | | determined pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S) |
6 | | and (T), and (V) through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection |
7 | | (b) of this Section shall be multiplied by a |
8 | | Regionalization Factor. |
9 | | (c) Local Capacity calculation. |
10 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity |
11 | | represents an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute |
12 | | toward its Adequacy Target for purposes of the |
13 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula calculation. "Local |
14 | | Capacity" means either (i) the Organizational Unit's Local |
15 | | Capacity Target as calculated in accordance with paragraph |
16 | | (2) of this subsection (c) if its Real Receipts are equal |
17 | | to or less than its Local Capacity Target or (ii) the |
18 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity, as |
19 | | calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of this |
20 | | subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local |
21 | | Capacity Target. |
22 | | (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an |
23 | | Organizational Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by |
24 | | multiplying its Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity |
25 | | Ratio. |
26 | | (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 167 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Percentage is the conversion of the Organizational |
2 | | Unit's Local Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is |
3 | | determined in accordance with subparagraph (B) of this |
4 | | paragraph (2), into a cumulative distribution |
5 | | resulting in a percentile ranking to determine each |
6 | | Organizational Unit's relative position to all other |
7 | | Organizational Units in this State. The calculation of |
8 | | Local Capacity Percentage is described in subparagraph |
9 | | (C) of this paragraph (2). |
10 | | (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio |
11 | | in a given year is the percentage obtained by dividing |
12 | | its Adjusted EAV or PTELL EAV, whichever is less, by |
13 | | its Adequacy Target, with the resulting ratio further |
14 | | adjusted as follows: |
15 | | (i) for Organizational Units serving grades |
16 | | kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no |
17 | | further adjustments shall be made; |
18 | | (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades |
19 | | kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be |
20 | | multiplied by 9/13; |
21 | | (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades |
22 | | 9 through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be |
23 | | multiplied by 4/13; and |
24 | | (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a |
25 | | different grade configuration than those specified |
26 | | in items (i) through (iii) of this subparagraph |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 168 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (B), the State Superintendent shall determine a |
2 | | comparable adjustment based on the grades served. |
3 | | (C) The Local Capacity Percentage is equal to the |
4 | | percentile ranking of the district. Local Capacity |
5 | | Percentage converts each Organizational Unit's Local |
6 | | Capacity Ratio to a cumulative distribution resulting |
7 | | in a percentile ranking to determine each |
8 | | Organizational Unit's relative position to all other |
9 | | Organizational Units in this State. The Local Capacity |
10 | | Percentage cumulative distribution resulting in a |
11 | | percentile ranking for each Organizational Unit shall |
12 | | be calculated using the standard normal distribution |
13 | | of the score in relation to the weighted mean and |
14 | | weighted standard deviation and Local Capacity Ratios |
15 | | of all Organizational Units. If the value assigned to |
16 | | any Organizational Unit is in excess of 90%, the value |
17 | | shall be adjusted to 90%. For Laboratory Schools, the |
18 | | Local Capacity Percentage shall be set at 10% in
|
19 | | recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from |
20 | | the public university that are allocated to
the |
21 | | Laboratory School. For programs operated by a regional |
22 | | office of education or an intermediate service center, |
23 | | the Local Capacity Percentage must be set at 10% in |
24 | | recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from |
25 | | school districts that are allocated to the regional |
26 | | office of education or intermediate service center. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 169 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | The weighted mean for the Local Capacity Percentage |
2 | | shall be determined by multiplying each Organizational |
3 | | Unit's Local Capacity Ratio times the ASE for the unit |
4 | | creating a weighted value, summing the weighted values |
5 | | of all Organizational Units, and dividing by the total |
6 | | ASE of all Organizational Units. The weighted standard |
7 | | deviation shall be determined by taking the square root |
8 | | of the weighted variance of all Organizational Units' |
9 | | Local Capacity Ratio, where the variance is calculated |
10 | | by squaring the difference between each unit's Local |
11 | | Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, then multiplying |
12 | | the variance for each unit times the ASE for the unit |
13 | | to create a weighted variance for each unit, then |
14 | | summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by |
15 | | the total ASE of all units. |
16 | | (D) For any Organizational Unit, the |
17 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity Target |
18 | | shall be reduced by either (i) the school board's |
19 | | remaining contribution pursuant to paragraph (ii) of |
20 | | subsection (b-4) of Section 16-158 of the Illinois |
21 | | Pension Code in a given year or (ii) the board of |
22 | | education's remaining contribution pursuant to |
23 | | paragraph (iv) of subsection (b) of Section 17-129 of |
24 | | the Illinois Pension Code absent the employer normal |
25 | | cost portion of the required contribution and amount |
26 | | allowed pursuant to subdivision (3) of Section |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 170 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 17-142.1 of the Illinois Pension Code in a given year. |
2 | | In the preceding sentence, item (i) shall be certified |
3 | | to the State Board of Education by the Teachers' |
4 | | Retirement System of the State of Illinois and item |
5 | | (ii) shall be certified to the State Board of Education |
6 | | by the Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement |
7 | | Fund of the City of Chicago. |
8 | | (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more |
9 | | than its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity |
10 | | shall equal an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated |
11 | | in accordance with this paragraph (3). The Adjusted Local |
12 | | Capacity Target is calculated as the sum of the |
13 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target and its Real |
14 | | Receipts Adjustment. The Real Receipts Adjustment equals |
15 | | the Organizational Unit's Real Receipts less its Local |
16 | | Capacity Target, with the resulting figure multiplied by |
17 | | the Local Capacity Percentage. |
18 | | As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of |
19 | | Adequacy" means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real |
20 | | Receipts, CPPRT, and Base Funding Minimum, with the |
21 | | resulting figure divided by the Organizational Unit's |
22 | | Adequacy Target. |
23 | | (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for |
24 | | purposes of the Local Capacity calculation. |
25 | | (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the |
26 | | product of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV. An |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 171 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Adjusted |
2 | | Operating Tax Rate for property within the Organizational |
3 | | Unit. |
4 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the |
5 | | equalized assessed valuation, or EAV, of all taxable |
6 | | property of each Organizational Unit as of September 30 of |
7 | | the previous year in accordance with paragraph (3) of this |
8 | | subsection (d). The State Superintendent shall then |
9 | | determine the Adjusted EAV of each Organizational Unit in |
10 | | accordance with paragraph (4) of this subsection (d), which |
11 | | Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the purposes of |
12 | | calculating Local Capacity. |
13 | | (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department |
14 | | of Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the |
15 | | value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue |
16 | | of all taxable property of every Organizational Unit, |
17 | | together with (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending |
18 | | taxes for the funds of the Organizational Unit as of |
19 | | September 30 of the previous year and (ii) the limiting |
20 | | rate for all Organizational Units subject to property tax |
21 | | extension limitations as imposed under PTELL. |
22 | | (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the |
23 | | equalized assessed value of all taxable property of |
24 | | each Organizational Unit situated entirely or |
25 | | partially within a county that is or was subject to the |
26 | | provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 172 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Tax Code (i) an amount equal to the total amount by |
2 | | which the homestead exemption allowed under Section |
3 | | 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for real |
4 | | property situated in that Organizational Unit exceeds |
5 | | the total amount that would have been allowed in that |
6 | | Organizational Unit if the maximum reduction under |
7 | | Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500 |
8 | | in all other counties in tax year 2003 or (II) $5,000 |
9 | | in all counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and |
10 | | (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for the |
11 | | taxable year of all additional exemptions under |
12 | | Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with |
13 | | a household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk |
14 | | of any county that is or was subject to the provisions |
15 | | of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code |
16 | | shall annually calculate and certify to the Department |
17 | | of Revenue for each Organizational Unit all homestead |
18 | | exemption amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the |
19 | | Property Tax Code and all amounts of additional |
20 | | exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax |
21 | | Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or |
22 | | less. It is the intent of this subparagraph (A) that if |
23 | | the general homestead exemption for a parcel of |
24 | | property is determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177 |
25 | | of the Property Tax Code rather than Section 15-175, |
26 | | then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected by |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 173 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the difference, if any, between the amount of the |
2 | | general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of |
3 | | property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property |
4 | | Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed |
5 | | had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of |
6 | | property been determined under Section 15-175 of the |
7 | | Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this |
8 | | subparagraph (A) that if additional exemptions are |
9 | | allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code |
10 | | for owners with a household income of less than |
11 | | $30,000, then the calculation of EAV shall not be |
12 | | affected by the difference, if any, because of those |
13 | | additional exemptions. |
14 | | (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational |
15 | | Unit within a redevelopment project area in respect to |
16 | | which a municipality has adopted tax increment |
17 | | allocation financing pursuant to the Tax Increment |
18 | | Allocation Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of Article |
19 | | 11 of the Illinois Municipal Code, or the Industrial |
20 | | Jobs Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of Article 11 of the |
21 | | Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current EAV of |
22 | | real property located in any such project area that is |
23 | | attributable to an increase above the total initial EAV |
24 | | of such property shall be used as part of the EAV of |
25 | | the Organizational Unit, until such time as all |
26 | | redevelopment project costs have been paid, as |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 174 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | provided in Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment |
2 | | Allocation Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 |
3 | | of the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of |
4 | | the EAV of the Organizational Unit, the total initial |
5 | | EAV or the current EAV, whichever is lower, shall be |
6 | | used until such time as all redevelopment project costs |
7 | | have been paid. |
8 | | (B-5) The real property equalized assessed |
9 | | valuation for a school district shall be adjusted by |
10 | | subtracting from the real property value, as equalized |
11 | | or assessed by the Department of Revenue, for the |
12 | | district an amount computed by dividing the amount of |
13 | | any abatement of taxes under Section 18-170 of the |
14 | | Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a district maintaining |
15 | | grades kindergarten through 12, by 2.30% for a district |
16 | | maintaining grades kindergarten through 8, or by 1.05% |
17 | | for a district maintaining grades 9 through 12 and |
18 | | adjusted by an amount computed by dividing the amount |
19 | | of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) of |
20 | | Section 18-165 of the Property Tax Code by the same |
21 | | percentage rates for district type as specified in this |
22 | | subparagraph (B-5). |
23 | | (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid |
24 | | Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the |
25 | | lesser of the adjusted equalized assessed valuation |
26 | | for property within the partial elementary unit |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 175 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | district for elementary purposes, as defined in |
2 | | Article 11E of this Code, or the adjusted equalized |
3 | | assessed valuation for property within the partial |
4 | | elementary unit district for high school purposes, as |
5 | | defined in Article 11E of this Code. |
6 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the |
7 | | average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years |
8 | | or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in |
9 | | the immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more |
10 | | compared to the 3-year average. In the event of |
11 | | Organizational Unit reorganization, consolidation, or |
12 | | annexation, the Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the |
13 | | first 3 years after such change shall be as follows: the |
14 | | most current EAV shall be used in the first year, the |
15 | | average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV in the immediately |
16 | | preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or more compared |
17 | | to the 2-year average for the second year, and a 3-year |
18 | | average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if |
19 | | the Adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the |
20 | | 3-year average for the third year. For any school district |
21 | | whose EAV in the immediately preceding year is used in |
22 | | calculations, in the following year, the Adjusted EAV shall |
23 | | be the average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 2 |
24 | | years or the immediately preceding year if that year |
25 | | represents a decline of 10% or more compared to the 2-year |
26 | | average. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 176 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State |
2 | | Board for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as |
3 | | described in this paragraph (4) for the purposes of |
4 | | calculating an Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio. |
5 | | Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph (4), the |
6 | | PTELL EAV of an Organizational Unit shall be equal to the |
7 | | product of the equalized assessed valuation last used in |
8 | | the calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 |
9 | | of this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under |
10 | | this Section and the Organizational Unit's Extension |
11 | | Limitation Ratio. If an Organizational Unit has approved or |
12 | | does approve an increase in its limiting rate, pursuant to |
13 | | Section 18-190 of the Property Tax Code, affecting the Base |
14 | | Tax Year, the PTELL EAV shall be equal to the product of |
15 | | the equalized assessed valuation last used in the |
16 | | calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of |
17 | | this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under |
18 | | this Section multiplied by an amount equal to one plus the |
19 | | percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price Index |
20 | | for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the |
21 | | United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar |
22 | | year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the equalized |
23 | | assessed valuation of new property, annexed property, and |
24 | | recovered tax increment value and minus the equalized |
25 | | assessed valuation of disconnected property. |
26 | | As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 177 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set |
2 | | forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. |
3 | | (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation. |
4 | | (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding |
5 | | Minimum of an Organizational Unit or a Specially Funded |
6 | | Unit shall be the amount of State funds distributed to the |
7 | | Organizational Unit or Specially Funded Unit during the |
8 | | 2016-2017 school year prior to any adjustments and |
9 | | specified appropriation amounts described in this |
10 | | paragraph (1) from the following Sections, as calculated by |
11 | | the State Superintendent: Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now |
12 | | repealed); Section 5 of Article 224 of Public Act 99-524 |
13 | | (equity grants); Section 14-7.02b of this Code (funding for |
14 | | children requiring special education services); Section |
15 | | 14-13.01 of this Code (special education facilities and |
16 | | staffing), except for reimbursement of the cost of |
17 | | transportation pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section |
18 | | 14C-12 of this Code (English learners); and Section 18-4.3 |
19 | | of this Code (summer school), based on an appropriation |
20 | | level of $13,121,600. For a school district organized under |
21 | | Article 34 of this Code, the Base Funding Minimum also |
22 | | includes (i) the funds allocated to the school district |
23 | | pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to |
24 | | funding programs authorized by the Sections of this Code |
25 | | listed in the preceding sentence and (ii) the difference |
26 | | between (I) the funds allocated to the school district |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 178 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to the |
2 | | funding programs authorized by Section 14-7.02 (non-public |
3 | | special education reimbursement), subsection (b) of |
4 | | Section 14-13.01 (special education transportation), |
5 | | Section 29-5 (transportation), Section 2-3.80 |
6 | | (agricultural education), Section 2-3.66 (truants' |
7 | | alternative education), Section 2-3.62 (educational |
8 | | service centers), and Section 14-7.03 (special education - |
9 | | orphanage) of this Code and Section 15 of the Childhood |
10 | | Hunger Relief Act (free breakfast program) and (II) the |
11 | | school district's actual expenditures for its non-public |
12 | | special education, special education transportation, |
13 | | transportation programs, agricultural education, truants' |
14 | | alternative education, services that would otherwise be |
15 | | performed by a regional office of education, special |
16 | | education orphanage expenditures, and free breakfast, as |
17 | | most recently calculated and reported pursuant to |
18 | | subsection (f) of Section 1D-1 of this Code. The Base |
19 | | Funding Minimum for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. For |
20 | | programs operated by a regional office of education or an |
21 | | intermediate service center, the Base Funding Minimum must |
22 | | be the total amount of State funds allocated to those |
23 | | programs in the 2018-2019 school year and amounts provided |
24 | | pursuant to Article 34 of Public Act 100-586 and Section |
25 | | 3-16 of this Code. All programs established after June 5, |
26 | | 2019 (the effective date of Public Act 101-10) and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 179 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | administered by a regional office of education or an |
2 | | intermediate service center must have an initial Base |
3 | | Funding Minimum set to an amount equal to the first-year |
4 | | ASE multiplied by the amount of per pupil funding received |
5 | | in the previous school year by the lowest funded similar |
6 | | existing program type. If the enrollment for a program |
7 | | operated by a regional office of education or an |
8 | | intermediate service center is zero, then it may not |
9 | | receive Base Funding Minimum funds for that program in the |
10 | | next fiscal year, and those funds must be distributed to |
11 | | Organizational Units under subsection (g). |
12 | | (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the |
13 | | Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially |
14 | | Funded Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of |
15 | | Evidence-Based Funding for the prior school year, (ii) the |
16 | | Base Funding Minimum for the prior school year, and (iii) |
17 | | any amount received by a school district pursuant to |
18 | | Section 7 of Article 97 of Public Act 100-21. |
19 | | (3) Subject to approval by the General Assembly as |
20 | | provided in this paragraph (3), an Organizational Unit that |
21 | | meets all of the following criteria, as determined by the |
22 | | State Board, shall have District Intervention Money added |
23 | | to its Base Funding Minimum at the time the Base Funding |
24 | | Minimum is calculated by the State Board: |
25 | | (A) The Organizational Unit is operating under an |
26 | | Independent Authority under Section 2-3.25f-5 of this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 180 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Code for a minimum of 4 school years or is subject to |
2 | | the control of the State Board pursuant to a court |
3 | | order for a minimum of 4 school years. |
4 | | (B) The Organizational Unit was designated as a |
5 | | Tier 1 or Tier 2 Organizational Unit in the previous |
6 | | school year under paragraph (3) of subsection (g) of |
7 | | this Section. |
8 | | (C) The Organizational Unit demonstrates |
9 | | sustainability through a 5-year financial and |
10 | | strategic plan. |
11 | | (D) The Organizational Unit has made sufficient |
12 | | progress and achieved sufficient stability in the |
13 | | areas of governance, academic growth, and finances. |
14 | | As part of its determination under this paragraph (3), |
15 | | the State Board may consider the Organizational Unit's |
16 | | summative designation, any accreditations of the |
17 | | Organizational Unit, or the Organizational Unit's |
18 | | financial profile, as calculated by the State Board. |
19 | | If the State Board determines that an Organizational |
20 | | Unit has met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3), |
21 | | it must submit a report to the General Assembly, no later |
22 | | than January 2 of the fiscal year in which the State Board |
23 | | makes it determination, on the amount of District |
24 | | Intervention Money to add to the Organizational Unit's Base |
25 | | Funding Minimum. The General Assembly must review the State |
26 | | Board's report and may approve or disapprove, by joint |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 181 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | resolution, the addition of District Intervention Money. |
2 | | If the General Assembly fails to act on the report within |
3 | | 40 calendar days from the receipt of the report, the |
4 | | addition of District Intervention Money is deemed |
5 | | approved. If the General Assembly approves the amount of |
6 | | District Intervention Money to be added to the |
7 | | Organizational Unit's Base Funding Minimum, the District |
8 | | Intervention Money must be added to the Base Funding |
9 | | Minimum annually thereafter. |
10 | | For the first 4 years following the initial year that |
11 | | the State Board determines that an Organizational Unit has |
12 | | met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3) and has |
13 | | received funding under this Section, the Organizational |
14 | | Unit must annually submit to the State Board, on or before |
15 | | November 30, a progress report regarding its financial and |
16 | | strategic plan under subparagraph (C) of this paragraph |
17 | | (3). The plan shall include the financial data from the |
18 | | past 4 annual financial reports or financial audits that |
19 | | must be presented to the State Board by November 15 of each |
20 | | year and the approved budget financial data for the current |
21 | | year. The plan shall be developed according to the |
22 | | guidelines presented to the Organizational Unit by the |
23 | | State Board. The plan shall further include financial |
24 | | projections for the next 3 fiscal years and include a |
25 | | discussion and financial summary of the Organizational |
26 | | Unit's facility needs. If the Organizational Unit does not |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 182 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | demonstrate sufficient progress toward its 5-year plan or |
2 | | if it has failed to file an annual financial report, an |
3 | | annual budget, a financial plan, a deficit reduction plan, |
4 | | or other financial information as required by law, the |
5 | | State Board may establish a Financial Oversight Panel under |
6 | | Article 1H of this Code. However, if the Organizational |
7 | | Unit already has a Financial Oversight Panel, the State |
8 | | Board may extend the duration of the Panel. |
9 | | (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation. |
10 | | (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a |
11 | | Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order |
12 | | to place such units into tiers for the purposes of the |
13 | | funding distribution system described in subsection (g) of |
14 | | this Section. Initially, an Organizational Unit's |
15 | | Preliminary Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy |
16 | | are calculated pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection |
17 | | (f). Then, an Organizational Unit's Final Resources and |
18 | | Final Percent of Adequacy are calculated to account for the |
19 | | Organizational Unit's poverty concentration levels |
20 | | pursuant to paragraphs (3) and (4) of this subsection (f). |
21 | | (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are |
22 | | equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and |
23 | | Base Funding Minimum. An Organizational Unit's Preliminary |
24 | | Percent of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary |
25 | | Resources divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%. |
26 | | (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 183 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit's Final Resources are equal to the sum |
2 | | of its Local Capacity, CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding |
3 | | Minimum. The Base Funding Minimum of each Specially Funded |
4 | | Unit shall serve as its Final Resources, except that the |
5 | | Base Funding Minimum for State-approved charter schools |
6 | | shall not include any portion of general State aid |
7 | | allocated in the prior year based on the per capita tuition |
8 | | charge times the charter school enrollment. |
9 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy |
10 | | is its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. An |
11 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is |
12 | | equal to its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental |
13 | | Grant Funding, with the resulting figure added to the |
14 | | product of its Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary |
15 | | Percent of Adequacy. |
16 | | (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system. |
17 | | (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based |
18 | | Funding formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding |
19 | | equal to the sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's |
20 | | allocation of New State Funds determined pursuant to this |
21 | | subsection (g). To allocate New State Funds, the |
22 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system first |
23 | | places all Organizational Units into one of 4 tiers in |
24 | | accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), based |
25 | | on the Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy. New |
26 | | State Funds are allocated to each of the 4 tiers as |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 184 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | follows: Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 50% of all New |
2 | | State Funds, Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 49% of all New |
3 | | State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all |
4 | | New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1% |
5 | | of all New State Funds. Each Organizational Unit within |
6 | | Tier 1 or Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds |
7 | | equal to its tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following |
8 | | sentence, multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate |
9 | | determined pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection |
10 | | (g). For Tier 1, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap |
11 | | equals the tier's Target Ratio, as specified in paragraph |
12 | | (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the |
13 | | Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting |
14 | | amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final |
15 | | Resources. For Tier 2, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap |
16 | | equals the tier's Target Ratio, as described in paragraph |
17 | | (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the |
18 | | Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting |
19 | | amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final |
20 | | Resources and its Tier 1 funding allocation. To determine |
21 | | the Organizational Unit's Funding Gap, the resulting |
22 | | amount is then multiplied by a factor equal to one minus |
23 | | the Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target |
24 | | percentage. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or Tier |
25 | | 4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the |
26 | | product of its Adequacy Target and the tier's Allocation |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 185 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Rate, as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g). |
2 | | (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all |
3 | | Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit |
4 | | shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3 |
5 | | Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational |
6 | | Unit shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE. |
7 | | Any Tier 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation |
8 | | per ASE below the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall |
9 | | get a funding allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3 |
10 | | funding allocation per ASE multiplied by the |
11 | | Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 Organizational |
12 | | Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be multiplied by the |
13 | | percentage calculated by dividing the original Tier 2 |
14 | | Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 Organizational |
15 | | Units' Tier 2 funding allocation after adjusting |
16 | | districts' funding below Tier 3 levels. |
17 | | (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers |
18 | | as follows: |
19 | | (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units, |
20 | | except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of |
21 | | Adequacy less than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1 |
22 | | Target Ratio is the ratio level that allows for Tier 1 |
23 | | Aggregate Funding to be distributed, with the Tier 1 |
24 | | Allocation Rate determined pursuant to paragraph (4) |
25 | | of this subsection (g). |
26 | | (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 186 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | other Organizational Units, except for Specially |
2 | | Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of less than |
3 | | 0.90. |
4 | | (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units, |
5 | | except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of |
6 | | Adequacy of at least 0.90 and less than 1.0. |
7 | | (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units |
8 | | with a Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0. |
9 | | (4) The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 are |
10 | | determined as follows: |
11 | | (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 30%. |
12 | | (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
13 | | following equation: Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided |
14 | | by the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2 |
15 | | Organizational Units, unless the result of such |
16 | | equation is higher than 1.0. If the result of such |
17 | | equation is higher than 1.0, then the Tier 2 Allocation |
18 | | Rate is 1.0. |
19 | | (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
20 | | following equation: Tier 3
Aggregate Funding, divided |
21 | | by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3 |
22 | | Organizational
Units. |
23 | | (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
24 | | following equation: Tier 4
Aggregate Funding, divided |
25 | | by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4 |
26 | | Organizational
Units. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 187 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows: |
2 | | (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that |
3 | | allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed |
4 | | with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate. |
5 | | (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90. |
6 | | (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0. |
7 | | (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is |
8 | | greater than 90%, then than all Tier 1 funding shall be |
9 | | allocated to Tier 2 and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's |
10 | | funding may be identified. |
11 | | (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units |
12 | | receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any |
13 | | remaining New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and |
14 | | Tier 4 Organizational Units. |
15 | | (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood |
16 | | Academy, recognized by the State Board do not qualify for |
17 | | direct funding following the implementation of Public Act |
18 | | 100-465 from any of the funding sources included within the |
19 | | definition of Base Funding Minimum, the unqualified |
20 | | portion of the Base Funding Minimum shall be transferred to |
21 | | one or more appropriate Organizational Units as determined |
22 | | by the State Superintendent based on the prior year ASE of |
23 | | the Organizational Units. |
24 | | (8.5) If a school district withdraws from a special |
25 | | education cooperative, the portion of the Base Funding |
26 | | Minimum that is attributable to the school district may be |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 188 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | redistributed to the school district upon withdrawal. The |
2 | | school district and the cooperative must include the amount |
3 | | of the Base Funding Minimum that is to be reapportioned in |
4 | | their withdrawal agreement and notify the State Board of |
5 | | the change with a copy of the agreement upon withdrawal. |
6 | | (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish |
7 | | a target for State funding that will keep pace with |
8 | | inflation and continue to advance equity through the |
9 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula. The target for State |
10 | | funding of New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds is |
11 | | $50,000,000 for State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State |
12 | | fiscal years. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to |
13 | | $350,000,000 through State fiscal year 2021 . The Minimum |
14 | | Funding Level is equal to $420,000,000 for State fiscal |
15 | | year 2022 and subsequent State fiscal years. In addition to |
16 | | any New State Funds, no more than $50,000,000 New Property |
17 | | Tax Relief Pool Funds may be counted toward the Minimum |
18 | | Funding Level. If the sum of New State Funds and applicable |
19 | | New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds are less than the |
20 | | Minimum Funding Level, than funding for tiers shall be |
21 | | reduced in the following manner: |
22 | | (A) First, Tier 4 funding shall be reduced by an |
23 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
24 | | Funding Level and New State Funds until such time as |
25 | | Tier 4 funding is exhausted. |
26 | | (B) Next, Tier 3 funding shall be reduced by an |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 189 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
2 | | Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
3 | | Tier 4 funding until such time as Tier 3 funding is |
4 | | exhausted. |
5 | | (C) Next, Tier 2 funding shall be reduced by an |
6 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
7 | | Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
8 | | Tier 4 and Tier 3. |
9 | | (D) Finally, Tier 1 funding shall be reduced by an |
10 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
11 | | Funding level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
12 | | Tier 2, 3, and 4 funding. In addition, the Allocation |
13 | | Rate for Tier 1 shall be reduced to a percentage equal |
14 | | to the Tier 1 Allocation Rate set by paragraph (4) of |
15 | | this subsection (g), multiplied by the result of New |
16 | | State Funds divided by the Minimum Funding Level. |
17 | | (9.5) For State fiscal year 2019 through State fiscal |
18 | | year 2021 and subsequent State fiscal years , if New State |
19 | | Funds exceed $300,000,000, then any amount in excess of |
20 | | $300,000,000 shall be dedicated for purposes of Section |
21 | | 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of $50,000,000. For |
22 | | State fiscal year 2022 and subsequent State fiscal years, |
23 | | if New State Funds exceed $370,000,000, then any amount in |
24 | | excess of $370,000,000 shall be dedicated for purposes of |
25 | | Section 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of |
26 | | $50,000,000. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 190 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the |
2 | | appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after |
3 | | implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units |
4 | | receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under |
5 | | paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held |
6 | | harmless by establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to |
7 | | the per pupil kindergarten through grade 12 funding |
8 | | received in accordance with this Section in the prior |
9 | | fiscal year. Reductions shall be
made to the Base Funding |
10 | | Minimum of Organizational Units in Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
|
11 | | per pupil basis equivalent to the total number of the ASE |
12 | | in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded Organizational Units |
13 | | divided by the total reduction in State funding. The Base
|
14 | | Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to be applied to |
15 | | Tier 3 and Tier 4
Organizational Units and adjusted by the |
16 | | relative formula when increases in
appropriations for this |
17 | | Section resume. In no event may State funding reductions to
|
18 | | Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 exceed an amount |
19 | | that would be less than the
Base Funding Minimum |
20 | | established in the first year of implementation of this
|
21 | | Section. If additional reductions are required, all school |
22 | | districts shall receive a
reduction by a per pupil amount |
23 | | equal to the aggregate additional appropriation
reduction |
24 | | divided by the total ASE of all Organizational Units. |
25 | | (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor |
26 | | adjustments to the distribution formula set forth in this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 191 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | subsection (g) to account for the rounding of percentages |
2 | | to the nearest tenth of a percentage and dollar amounts to |
3 | | the nearest whole dollar. |
4 | | (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and |
5 | | district submission requirements. |
6 | | (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with |
7 | | appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the |
8 | | funding obligations created under this Section. |
9 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the |
10 | | Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State |
11 | | Contribution Target for each Organizational Unit under |
12 | | this Section. No Evidence-Based Funding shall be |
13 | | distributed within an Organizational Unit without the |
14 | | approval of the unit's school board. |
15 | | (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate |
16 | | and report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate |
17 | | financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the |
18 | | Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State |
19 | | Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for |
20 | | each Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds |
21 | | allocated for its students with disabilities. The State |
22 | | Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for |
23 | | each Organizational Unit the amount of funding and |
24 | | applicable FTE calculated for each Essential Element of the |
25 | | unit's Adequacy Target. |
26 | | (4) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 192 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and report to each Organizational Unit the amount the unit |
2 | | must expend on special education , and bilingual education , |
3 | | anti-racism initiatives approved under Section 2-3.184 of |
4 | | this Code, and computer technology and equipment for |
5 | | Organizational Units assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 that |
6 | | received an additional $285.50 per student computer |
7 | | technology and equipment investment grant to their |
8 | | Adequacy Target pursuant to the unit's Base Funding |
9 | | Minimum, Special Education Allocation, Bilingual Education |
10 | | Allocation, anti-racism investment allocation, and |
11 | | computer technology and equipment investment allocation. |
12 | | (5) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be |
13 | | calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal |
14 | | year basis, with payments beginning in August and extending |
15 | | through June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys |
16 | | appropriated for each fiscal year shall be distributed in |
17 | | 22 equal payments at least 2 times monthly to each |
18 | | Organizational Unit. If moneys appropriated for any fiscal |
19 | | year are distributed other than monthly, the distribution |
20 | | shall be on the same basis for each Organizational Unit. |
21 | | (6) Any school district that fails, for any given |
22 | | school year, to maintain school as required by law or to |
23 | | maintain a recognized school is not eligible to receive |
24 | | Evidence-Based Funding. In case of non-recognition of one |
25 | | or more attendance centers in a school district otherwise |
26 | | operating recognized schools, the claim of the district |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 193 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | shall be reduced in the proportion that the enrollment in |
2 | | the attendance center or centers bears to the enrollment of |
3 | | the school district. "Recognized school" means any public |
4 | | school that meets the standards for recognition by the |
5 | | State Board. A school district or attendance center not |
6 | | having recognition status at the end of a school term is |
7 | | entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal |
8 | | claim that was filed while it was recognized. |
9 | | (7) School district claims filed under this Section are |
10 | | subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as |
11 | | otherwise provided in this Section. |
12 | | (8) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall |
13 | | calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its |
14 | | Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall |
15 | | be deemed attributable to the provision of special |
16 | | educational facilities and services, as defined in Section |
17 | | 14-1.08 of this Code, in a manner that ensures compliance |
18 | | with maintenance of State financial support requirements |
19 | | under the federal Individuals with Disabilities Education |
20 | | Act. An Organizational Unit must use such funds only for |
21 | | the provision of special educational facilities and |
22 | | services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code, and |
23 | | must comply with any expenditure verification procedures |
24 | | adopted by the State Board. |
25 | | (9) All Organizational Units in this State must submit |
26 | | annual spending plans by the end of September of each year |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 194 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to the State Board as part of the annual budget process, |
2 | | which shall describe how each Organizational Unit will |
3 | | utilize the Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based |
4 | | Funding it receives from this State under this Section with |
5 | | specific identification of the intended utilization of |
6 | | Low-Income, English learner, and special education |
7 | | resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans of each |
8 | | Organizational Unit shall describe how the Organizational |
9 | | Unit expects to achieve student growth and how the |
10 | | Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as |
11 | | defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may, |
12 | | from time to time, identify additional requisites for |
13 | | Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual |
14 | | spending plans required under this subsection (h). The |
15 | | format and scope of annual spending plans shall be |
16 | | developed by the State Superintendent and the State Board |
17 | | of Education. School districts that serve students under |
18 | | Article 14C of this Code shall continue to submit |
19 | | information as required under Section 14C-12 of this Code. |
20 | | (10) No later than January 1, 2018, the State |
21 | | Superintendent shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for |
22 | | all Organizational Units to help in planning for adequacy |
23 | | funding under this Section. The State Superintendent shall |
24 | | submit the plan to the Governor and the General Assembly, |
25 | | as provided in Section 3.1 of the General Assembly |
26 | | Organization Act. The plan shall include recommendations |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 195 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | for: |
2 | | (A) a framework for collaborative, professional, |
3 | | innovative, and 21st century learning environments |
4 | | using the Evidence-Based Funding model; |
5 | | (B) ways to prepare and support this State's |
6 | | educators for successful instructional careers; |
7 | | (C) application and enhancement of the current |
8 | | financial accountability measures, the approved State |
9 | | plan to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds |
10 | | Act, and the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures |
11 | | in relation to student growth and elements of the |
12 | | Evidence-Based Funding model; and |
13 | | (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy |
14 | | funding system based on projected and recommended |
15 | | funding levels from the General Assembly. |
16 | | (11) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent
must |
17 | | recalibrate all of the following per pupil elements of the |
18 | | Adequacy Target and applied to the formulas, based on the |
19 | | study of average expenses and as reported in the most |
20 | | recent annual financial report: |
21 | | (A) Gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph
(2) |
22 | | of subsection (b). |
23 | | (B) Instructional materials under subparagraph
(O) |
24 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
25 | | (C) Assessment under subparagraph (P) of
paragraph |
26 | | (2) of subsection (b). |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 196 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (D) Student activities under subparagraph (R) of
|
2 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
3 | | (E) Maintenance and operations under subparagraph
|
4 | | (S) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
5 | | (F) Central office under subparagraph (T) of
|
6 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
7 | | (i) Professional Review Panel. |
8 | | (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and |
9 | | review topics related to the implementation and effect of |
10 | | Evidence-Based Funding, as assigned by a joint resolution |
11 | | or Public Act of the General Assembly or a motion passed by |
12 | | the State Board of Education. The Panel must provide |
13 | | recommendations to and serve the Governor, the General |
14 | | Assembly, and the State Board. The State Superintendent or |
15 | | his or her designee must serve as a voting member and |
16 | | chairperson of the Panel. The State Superintendent must |
17 | | appoint a vice chairperson from the membership of the |
18 | | Panel. The Panel must advance recommendations based on a |
19 | | three-fifths majority vote of Panel members present and |
20 | | voting. A minority opinion may also accompany any |
21 | | recommendation of the Panel. The Panel shall be appointed |
22 | | by the State Superintendent, except as otherwise provided |
23 | | in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i) and include the |
24 | | following members: |
25 | | (A) Two appointees that represent district |
26 | | superintendents, recommended by a statewide |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 197 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | organization that represents district superintendents. |
2 | | (B) Two appointees that represent school boards, |
3 | | recommended by a statewide organization that |
4 | | represents school boards. |
5 | | (C) Two appointees from districts that represent |
6 | | school business officials, recommended by a statewide |
7 | | organization that represents school business |
8 | | officials. |
9 | | (D) Two appointees that represent school |
10 | | principals, recommended by a statewide organization |
11 | | that represents school principals. |
12 | | (E) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
13 | | recommended by a statewide organization that |
14 | | represents teachers. |
15 | | (F) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
16 | | recommended by another statewide organization that |
17 | | represents teachers. |
18 | | (G) Two appointees that represent regional |
19 | | superintendents of schools, recommended by |
20 | | organizations that represent regional superintendents. |
21 | | (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the |
22 | | State Superintendent. |
23 | | (I) Two independent experts recommended by public |
24 | | universities in this State. |
25 | | (J) One member recommended by a statewide |
26 | | organization that represents parents. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 198 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (K) Two representatives recommended by collective |
2 | | impact organizations that represent major metropolitan |
3 | | areas or geographic areas in Illinois. |
4 | | (L) One member from a statewide organization |
5 | | focused on research-based education policy to support |
6 | | a school system that prepares all students for college, |
7 | | a career, and democratic citizenship. |
8 | | (M) One representative from a school district |
9 | | organized under Article 34 of this Code. |
10 | | The State Superintendent shall ensure that the |
11 | | membership of the Panel includes representatives from |
12 | | school districts and communities reflecting the |
13 | | geographic, socio-economic, racial, and ethnic diversity |
14 | | of this State. The State Superintendent shall additionally |
15 | | ensure that the membership of the Panel includes |
16 | | representatives with expertise in bilingual education and |
17 | | special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff |
18 | | the Panel. |
19 | | (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the |
20 | | State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly |
21 | | shall be appointed as follows: one member of the House of |
22 | | Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of |
23 | | Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the |
24 | | President of the Senate, one member of the House of |
25 | | Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the |
26 | | House of Representatives, and one member of the Senate |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 199 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | appointed by the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall |
2 | | be one additional member appointed by the Governor. All |
3 | | members appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor |
4 | | shall be non-voting, ex officio members. |
5 | | (3) The Panel must study topics at the direction of the |
6 | | General Assembly or State Board of Education, as provided |
7 | | under paragraph (1). The Panel may also study the following |
8 | | topics at the direction of the chairperson: |
9 | | (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans |
10 | | referenced in paragraph (9) of subsection (h) of this |
11 | | Section. |
12 | | (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section. |
13 | | (C) Maintenance and operations, including capital |
14 | | maintenance and construction costs. |
15 | | (D) "At-risk student" definition. |
16 | | (E) Benefits. |
17 | | (F) Technology. |
18 | | (G) Local Capacity Target. |
19 | | (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory |
20 | | Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning |
21 | | opportunities programs. |
22 | | (I) Funding for college and career acceleration |
23 | | strategies. |
24 | | (J) Special education investments. |
25 | | (K) Early childhood investments, in collaboration |
26 | | with the Illinois Early Learning Council. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 200 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (L) Anti-racism investments. |
2 | | (4) (Blank). |
3 | | (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this |
4 | | Section, and every 5 years thereafter, the Panel shall |
5 | | complete an evaluative study of the entire Evidence-Based |
6 | | Funding model, including an assessment of whether or not |
7 | | the formula is achieving State goals. The Panel shall |
8 | | report to the State Board, the General Assembly, and the |
9 | | Governor on the findings of the study. |
10 | | (6) (Blank). |
11 | | (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other |
12 | | laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section |
13 | | 18-8.05 of this Code (now repealed) shall be deemed to be |
14 | | references to evidence-based model formula funds or |
15 | | calculations under this Section.
|
16 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-578, eff. 1-31-18; |
17 | | 100-582, eff. 3-23-18; 101-10, eff. 6-5-19; 101-17, eff. |
18 | | 6-14-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20; revised 8-21-20.) |
19 | | Article 60. |
20 | | Section 5. The School Code is amended by adding Sections |
21 | | 2-3.185 and 27-23.15 and by changing Sections 10-17a, 18-8.15, |
22 | | and 27-22 as follows: |
23 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.185 new) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 201 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 2-3.185. Computer science standards and courses. On or |
2 | | before December 1, 2021, the State Board of Education shall: |
3 | | (1) develop or adopt rigorous learning standards in the |
4 | | area of computer science; and |
5 | | (2) analyze and revise, if appropriate, existing |
6 | | course titles dedicated to computer science or develop a |
7 | | short list of existing course titles that are recommended |
8 | | for computer science courses.
|
9 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-17a) (from Ch. 122, par. 10-17a)
|
10 | | Sec. 10-17a. State, school district, and school report |
11 | | cards.
|
12 | | (1) By October 31, 2013 and October 31 of each subsequent |
13 | | school year, the State Board of Education, through the State |
14 | | Superintendent of Education, shall prepare a State report card, |
15 | | school district report cards, and school report cards, and |
16 | | shall by the most economic means provide to each school
|
17 | | district in this State, including special charter districts and |
18 | | districts
subject to the provisions of Article 34, the report |
19 | | cards for the school district and each of its schools. |
20 | | (2) In addition to any information required by federal law, |
21 | | the State Superintendent shall determine the indicators and |
22 | | presentation of the school report card, which must include, at |
23 | | a minimum, the most current data collected and maintained by |
24 | | the State Board of Education related to the following: |
25 | | (A) school characteristics and student demographics, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 202 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | including average class size, average teaching experience, |
2 | | student racial/ethnic breakdown, and the percentage of |
3 | | students classified as low-income; the percentage of |
4 | | students classified as English learners; the percentage of |
5 | | students who have individualized education plans or 504 |
6 | | plans that provide for special education services; the |
7 | | number and percentage of all students who have been |
8 | | assessed for placement in a gifted education or advanced |
9 | | academic program and, of those students: (i) the racial and |
10 | | ethnic breakdown, (ii) the percentage who are classified as |
11 | | low-income, and (iii) the number and percentage of students |
12 | | who received direct instruction from a teacher who holds a |
13 | | gifted education endorsement and, of those students, the |
14 | | percentage who are classified as low-income; the |
15 | | percentage of students scoring at the "exceeds |
16 | | expectations" level on the assessments required under |
17 | | Section 2-3.64a-5 of this Code; the percentage of students |
18 | | who annually transferred in or out of the school district; |
19 | | average daily attendance; the per-pupil operating |
20 | | expenditure of the school district; and the per-pupil State |
21 | | average operating expenditure for the district type |
22 | | (elementary, high school, or unit); |
23 | | (B) curriculum information, including, where |
24 | | applicable, Advanced Placement, International |
25 | | Baccalaureate or equivalent courses, dual enrollment |
26 | | courses, foreign language classes, computer science |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 203 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | courses, school personnel resources (including Career |
2 | | Technical Education teachers), before and after school |
3 | | programs, extracurricular activities, subjects in which |
4 | | elective classes are offered, health and wellness |
5 | | initiatives (including the average number of days of |
6 | | Physical Education per week per student), approved |
7 | | programs of study, awards received, community |
8 | | partnerships, and special programs such as programming for |
9 | | the gifted and talented, students with disabilities, and |
10 | | work-study students; |
11 | | (C) student outcomes, including, where applicable, the |
12 | | percentage of students deemed proficient on assessments of |
13 | | State standards, the percentage of students in the eighth |
14 | | grade who pass Algebra, the percentage of students who |
15 | | participated in workplace learning experiences, the |
16 | | percentage of students enrolled in post-secondary |
17 | | institutions (including colleges, universities, community |
18 | | colleges, trade/vocational schools, and training programs |
19 | | leading to career certification within 2 semesters of high |
20 | | school graduation), the percentage of students graduating |
21 | | from high school who are college and career ready, and the |
22 | | percentage of graduates enrolled in community colleges, |
23 | | colleges, and universities who are in one or more courses |
24 | | that the community college, college, or university |
25 | | identifies as a developmental course; |
26 | | (D) student progress, including, where applicable, the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 204 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | percentage of students in the ninth grade who have earned 5 |
2 | | credits or more without failing more than one core class, a |
3 | | measure of students entering kindergarten ready to learn, a |
4 | | measure of growth, and the percentage of students who enter |
5 | | high school on track for college and career readiness; |
6 | | (E) the school environment, including, where |
7 | | applicable, the percentage of students with less than 10 |
8 | | absences in a school year, the percentage of teachers with |
9 | | less than 10 absences in a school year for reasons other |
10 | | than professional development, leaves taken pursuant to |
11 | | the federal Family Medical Leave Act of 1993, long-term |
12 | | disability, or parental leaves, the 3-year average of the |
13 | | percentage of teachers returning to the school from the |
14 | | previous year, the number of different principals at the |
15 | | school in the last 6 years, the number of teachers who hold |
16 | | a gifted education endorsement, the process and criteria |
17 | | used by the district to determine whether a student is |
18 | | eligible for participation in a gifted education program or |
19 | | advanced academic program and the manner in which parents |
20 | | and guardians are made aware of the process and criteria, 2 |
21 | | or more indicators from any school climate survey selected |
22 | | or approved by the State and administered pursuant to |
23 | | Section 2-3.153 of this Code, with the same or similar |
24 | | indicators included on school report cards for all surveys |
25 | | selected or approved by the State pursuant to Section |
26 | | 2-3.153 of this Code, and the combined percentage of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 205 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | teachers rated as proficient or excellent in their most |
2 | | recent evaluation; |
3 | | (F) a school district's and its individual schools' |
4 | | balanced accountability measure, in accordance with |
5 | | Section 2-3.25a of this Code; |
6 | | (G) the total and per pupil normal cost amount the |
7 | | State contributed to the Teachers' Retirement System of the |
8 | | State of Illinois in the prior fiscal year for the school's |
9 | | employees, which shall be reported to the State Board of |
10 | | Education by the Teachers' Retirement System of the State |
11 | | of Illinois; |
12 | | (H) for a school district organized under Article 34 of |
13 | | this Code only, State contributions to the Public School |
14 | | Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago and State |
15 | | contributions for health care for employees of that school |
16 | | district; |
17 | | (I) a school district's Final Percent of Adequacy, as |
18 | | defined in paragraph (4) of subsection (f) of Section |
19 | | 18-8.15 of this Code; |
20 | | (J) a school district's Local Capacity Target, as |
21 | | defined in paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of Section |
22 | | 18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount; |
23 | | (K) a school district's Real Receipts, as defined in |
24 | | paragraph (1) of subsection (d) of Section 18-8.15 of this |
25 | | Code, divided by a school district's Adequacy Target, as |
26 | | defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (b) of Section |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 206 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 18-8.15 of this Code, displayed as a percentage amount; |
2 | | (L) a school district's administrative costs; and |
3 | | (M) whether or not the school has participated in the |
4 | | Illinois Youth Survey. In this paragraph (M), "Illinois |
5 | | Youth Survey" means a self-report survey, administered in |
6 | | school settings every 2 years, designed to gather |
7 | | information about health and social indicators, including |
8 | | substance abuse patterns and the attitudes of students in |
9 | | grades 8, 10, and 12; and |
10 | | (N) whether the school offered its students career and |
11 | | technical education opportunities. |
12 | | The school report card shall also provide
information that |
13 | | allows for comparing the current outcome, progress, and |
14 | | environment data to the State average, to the school data from |
15 | | the past 5 years, and to the outcomes, progress, and |
16 | | environment of similar schools based on the type of school and |
17 | | enrollment of low-income students, special education students, |
18 | | and English learners.
|
19 | | As used in this subsection (2): |
20 | | "Administrative costs" means costs associated with |
21 | | executive, administrative, or managerial functions within the |
22 | | school district that involve planning, organizing, managing, |
23 | | or directing the school district. |
24 | | "Advanced academic program" means a course of study to |
25 | | which students are assigned based on advanced cognitive ability |
26 | | or advanced academic achievement compared to local age peers |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 207 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and in which the curriculum is substantially differentiated |
2 | | from the general curriculum to provide appropriate challenge |
3 | | and pace. |
4 | | "Computer science" means the study of computers and |
5 | | algorithms, including their principles, their hardware and |
6 | | software designs, their implementation, and their impact on |
7 | | society. "Computer science" does not include the study of |
8 | | everyday uses of computers and computer applications, such as |
9 | | keyboarding or accessing the Internet. |
10 | | "Gifted education" means educational services, including |
11 | | differentiated curricula and instructional methods, designed |
12 | | to meet the needs of gifted children as defined in Article 14A |
13 | | of this Code. |
14 | | For the purposes of paragraph (A) of this subsection (2), |
15 | | "average daily attendance" means the average of the actual |
16 | | number of attendance days during the previous school year for |
17 | | any enrolled student who is subject to compulsory attendance by |
18 | | Section 26-1 of this Code at each school and charter school. |
19 | | (3) At the discretion of the State Superintendent, the |
20 | | school district report card shall include a subset of the |
21 | | information identified in paragraphs (A) through (E) of |
22 | | subsection (2) of this Section, as well as information relating |
23 | | to the operating expense per pupil and other finances of the |
24 | | school district, and the State report card shall include a |
25 | | subset of the information identified in paragraphs (A) through |
26 | | (E) and paragraph (N) of subsection (2) of this Section. The |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 208 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | school district report card shall include the average daily |
2 | | attendance, as that term is defined in subsection (2) of this |
3 | | Section, of students who have individualized education |
4 | | programs and students who have 504 plans that provide for |
5 | | special education services within the school district. |
6 | | (4) Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this |
7 | | Section, in consultation with key education stakeholders, the |
8 | | State Superintendent shall at any time have the discretion to |
9 | | amend or update any and all metrics on the school, district, or |
10 | | State report card. |
11 | | (5) Annually, no more than 30 calendar days after receipt |
12 | | of the school district and school report cards from the State |
13 | | Superintendent of Education, each school district, including |
14 | | special charter districts and districts subject to the |
15 | | provisions of Article 34, shall present such report
cards at a |
16 | | regular school board meeting subject to
applicable notice |
17 | | requirements, post the report cards
on the
school district's |
18 | | Internet web site, if the district maintains an Internet web
|
19 | | site, make the report cards
available
to a newspaper of general |
20 | | circulation serving the district, and, upon
request, send the |
21 | | report cards
home to a parent (unless the district does not |
22 | | maintain an Internet web site,
in which case
the report card |
23 | | shall be sent home to parents without request). If the
district |
24 | | posts the report card on its Internet web
site, the district
|
25 | | shall send a
written notice home to parents stating (i) that |
26 | | the report card is available on
the web site,
(ii) the address |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 209 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of the web site, (iii) that a printed copy of the report card
|
2 | | will be sent to
parents upon request, and (iv) the telephone |
3 | | number that parents may
call to
request a printed copy of the |
4 | | report card.
|
5 | | (6) Nothing contained in Public Act 98-648 repeals, |
6 | | supersedes, invalidates, or nullifies final decisions in |
7 | | lawsuits pending on July 1, 2014 (the effective date of Public |
8 | | Act 98-648) in Illinois courts involving the interpretation of |
9 | | Public Act 97-8. |
10 | | (Source: P.A. 100-227, eff. 8-18-17; 100-364, eff. 1-1-18; |
11 | | 100-448, eff. 7-1-19; 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-807, eff. |
12 | | 8-10-18; 100-863, eff. 8-14-18; 100-1121, eff. 1-1-19; 101-68, |
13 | | eff. 1-1-20; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; revised 9-9-19.) |
14 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15) |
15 | | Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-Based Funding for student success |
16 | | for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years. |
17 | | (a) General provisions. |
18 | | (1) The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by |
19 | | June 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten |
20 | | through grade 12 public education system with the capacity |
21 | | to ensure the educational development of all persons to the |
22 | | limits of their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of |
23 | | Article X of the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To |
24 | | accomplish that objective, this Section creates a method of |
25 | | funding public education that is evidence-based; is |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 210 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | sufficient to ensure every student receives a meaningful |
2 | | opportunity to learn irrespective of race, ethnicity, |
3 | | sexual orientation, gender, or community-income level; and |
4 | | is sustainable and predictable. When fully funded under |
5 | | this Section, every school shall have the resources, based |
6 | | on what the evidence indicates is needed, to: |
7 | | (A) provide all students with a high quality |
8 | | education that offers the academic, enrichment, social |
9 | | and emotional support, technical, and career-focused |
10 | | programs that will allow them to become competitive |
11 | | workers, responsible parents, productive citizens of |
12 | | this State, and active members of our national |
13 | | democracy; |
14 | | (B) ensure all students receive the education they |
15 | | need to graduate from high school with the skills |
16 | | required to pursue post-secondary education and |
17 | | training for a rewarding career; |
18 | | (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the |
19 | | achievement gap between at-risk and non-at-risk |
20 | | students by raising the performance of at-risk |
21 | | students and not by reducing standards; and |
22 | | (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to |
23 | | assume the primary responsibility to fund public |
24 | | education and simultaneously relieve the |
25 | | disproportionate burden placed on local property taxes |
26 | | to fund schools. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 211 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) The Evidence-Based Funding formula under this |
2 | | Section shall be applied to all Organizational Units in |
3 | | this State. The Evidence-Based Funding formula outlined in |
4 | | this Act is based on the formula outlined in Senate Bill 1 |
5 | | of the 100th General Assembly, as passed by both |
6 | | legislative chambers. As further defined and described in |
7 | | this Section, there are 4 major components of the |
8 | | Evidence-Based Funding model: |
9 | | (A) First, the model calculates a unique Adequacy |
10 | | Target for each Organizational Unit in this State that |
11 | | considers the costs to implement research-based |
12 | | activities, the unit's student demographics, and |
13 | | regional wage differences. |
14 | | (B) Second, the model calculates each |
15 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity, or the amount |
16 | | each Organizational Unit is assumed to contribute |
17 | | toward its Adequacy Target from local resources. |
18 | | (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding |
19 | | the State currently contributes to the Organizational |
20 | | Unit and adds that to the unit's Local Capacity to |
21 | | determine the unit's overall current adequacy of |
22 | | funding. |
23 | | (D) Finally, the model's distribution method |
24 | | allocates new State funding to those Organizational |
25 | | Units that are least well-funded, considering both |
26 | | Local Capacity and State funding, in relation to their |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 212 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Adequacy Target. |
2 | | (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under |
3 | | this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received |
4 | | for which that Organizational Unit is authorized to make |
5 | | expenditures by law. |
6 | | (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall |
7 | | have the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4): |
8 | | "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
9 | | subsection (b) of this Section. |
10 | | "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of |
11 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
12 | | "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in |
13 | | paragraph (3) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
14 | | "Adjusted Operating Tax Rate" means a tax rate for all |
15 | | Organizational Units, for which the State Superintendent |
16 | | shall calculate and subtract for the Operating Tax Rate a |
17 | | transportation rate based on total expenses for |
18 | | transportation services under this Code, as reported on the |
19 | | most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil |
20 | | Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the |
21 | | Education and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and |
22 | | 4120 in the Transportation fund, less any corresponding |
23 | | fiscal year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding |
24 | | net adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or |
25 | | special education transportation reimbursement pursuant to |
26 | | Section 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 213 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Code divided by the Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational |
2 | | Unit's corresponding fiscal year State of Illinois |
3 | | scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for prior |
4 | | years for regular, vocational, or special education |
5 | | transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or |
6 | | subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed the |
7 | | total transportation expenses, as defined in this |
8 | | paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from |
9 | | the Operating Tax Rate. |
10 | | "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of |
11 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
12 | | "Alternative School" means a public school that is |
13 | | created and operated by a regional superintendent of |
14 | | schools and approved by the State Board. |
15 | | "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
16 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
17 | | "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress |
18 | | monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments, |
19 | | in addition to the State accountability assessment, that |
20 | | assist teachers' needs in understanding the skills and |
21 | | meeting the needs of the students they serve. |
22 | | "Assistant principal" means a school administrator |
23 | | duly endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in |
24 | | this State. |
25 | | "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not |
26 | | meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 214 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | from elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need |
2 | | for vocational support or social services beyond that |
3 | | provided by the regular school program. All students |
4 | | included in an Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as |
5 | | well as all English learner and disabled students attending |
6 | | the Organizational Unit, shall be considered at-risk |
7 | | students under this Section. |
8 | | "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" for fiscal year |
9 | | 2018 means, for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the |
10 | | average number of students (grades K through 12) reported |
11 | | to the State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit |
12 | | on October 1 in the immediately preceding school year, plus |
13 | | the pre-kindergarten students who receive special |
14 | | education services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to |
15 | | the State Board on December 1 in the immediately preceding |
16 | | school year, or the average number of students (grades K |
17 | | through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the |
18 | | Organizational Unit on October 1, plus the |
19 | | pre-kindergarten students who receive special education |
20 | | services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to the State |
21 | | Board on December 1, for each of the immediately preceding |
22 | | 3 school years. For fiscal year 2019 and each subsequent |
23 | | fiscal year, "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means, |
24 | | for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the average |
25 | | number of students (grades K through 12) reported to the |
26 | | State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit on |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 215 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding school |
2 | | year, plus the pre-kindergarten students who receive |
3 | | special education services as reported to the State Board |
4 | | on October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding |
5 | | school year, or the average number of students (grades K |
6 | | through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the |
7 | | Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the |
8 | | pre-kindergarten students who receive special education |
9 | | services as reported to the State Board on October 1 and |
10 | | March 1, for each of the immediately preceding 3 school |
11 | | years. For the purposes of this definition, "enrolled in |
12 | | the Organizational Unit" means the number of students |
13 | | reported to the State Board who are enrolled in schools |
14 | | within the Organizational Unit that the student attends or |
15 | | would attend if not placed or transferred to another school |
16 | | or program to receive needed services. For the purposes of |
17 | | calculating "ASE", all students, grades K through 12, |
18 | | excluding those attending kindergarten for a half day and |
19 | | students attending an alternative education program |
20 | | operated by a regional office of education or intermediate |
21 | | service center, shall be counted as 1.0. All students |
22 | | attending kindergarten for a half day shall be counted as |
23 | | 0.5, unless in 2017 by June 15 or by March 1 in subsequent |
24 | | years, the school district reports to the State Board of |
25 | | Education the intent to implement full-day kindergarten |
26 | | district-wide for all students, then all students |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 216 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | attending kindergarten shall be counted as 1.0. Special |
2 | | education pre-kindergarten students shall be counted as |
3 | | 0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or has not |
4 | | collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment count by |
5 | | grade or a December 1 collection of special education |
6 | | pre-kindergarten students as of August 31, 2017 (the |
7 | | effective date of Public Act 100-465), it shall establish |
8 | | such collection for all future years. For any year in which |
9 | | a count by grade level was collected only once, that count |
10 | | shall be used as the single count available for computing a |
11 | | 3-year average ASE. Funding for programs operated by a |
12 | | regional office of education or an intermediate service |
13 | | center must be calculated using the Evidence-Based Funding |
14 | | formula under this Section for the 2019-2020 school year |
15 | | and each subsequent school year until separate adequacy |
16 | | formulas are developed and adopted for each type of |
17 | | program. ASE for a program operated by a regional office of |
18 | | education or an intermediate service center must be |
19 | | determined by the March 1 enrollment for the program. For |
20 | | the 2019-2020 school year, the ASE used in the calculation |
21 | | must be the first-year ASE and, in that year only, the |
22 | | assignment of students served by a regional office of |
23 | | education or intermediate service center shall not result |
24 | | in a reduction of the March enrollment for any school |
25 | | district. For the 2020-2021 school year, the ASE must be |
26 | | the greater of the current-year ASE or the 2-year average |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 217 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ASE. Beginning with the 2021-2022 school year, the ASE must |
2 | | be the greater of the current-year ASE or the 3-year |
3 | | average ASE. School districts shall submit the data for the |
4 | | ASE calculation to the State Board within 45 days of the |
5 | | dates required in this Section for submission of enrollment |
6 | | data in order for it to be included in the ASE calculation. |
7 | | For fiscal year 2018 only, the ASE calculation shall |
8 | | include only enrollment taken on October 1. |
9 | | "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (10) |
10 | | of subsection (g) of this Section. |
11 | | "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of |
12 | | this Section. |
13 | | "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used |
14 | | to calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State |
15 | | aid. |
16 | | "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the |
17 | | equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk |
18 | | in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as |
19 | | calculated by the county clerk and defined in PTELL. |
20 | | "Bilingual Education Allocation" means the amount of |
21 | | an Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target |
22 | | attributable to bilingual education divided by the |
23 | | Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target, the product |
24 | | of which shall be multiplied by the amount of new funding |
25 | | received pursuant to this Section. An Organizational |
26 | | Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable to bilingual |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 218 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | education shall include all additional investments in |
2 | | English learner students' adequacy elements. |
3 | | "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary |
4 | | State aid is calculated and awarded under this Section. |
5 | | "Central office" means individual administrators and |
6 | | support service personnel charged with managing the |
7 | | instructional programs, business and operations, and |
8 | | security of the Organizational Unit. |
9 | | "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost |
10 | | differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional |
11 | | variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not |
12 | | educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the |
13 | | first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be |
14 | | the CWI initially developed by the National Center for |
15 | | Education Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A & |
16 | | M University. In the fourth and subsequent years of |
17 | | Evidence-Based Funding implementation, the State |
18 | | Superintendent shall re-determine the CWI using a similar |
19 | | methodology to that identified in the Texas A & M |
20 | | University study, with adjustments made no less frequently |
21 | | than once every 5 years. |
22 | | "Computer technology and equipment" means computers |
23 | | servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers, |
24 | | instructional software, security software, curriculum |
25 | | management courseware, and other similar materials and |
26 | | equipment. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 219 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Computer technology and equipment investment |
2 | | allocation" means the final Adequacy Target amount of an |
3 | | Organizational Unit assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 in the |
4 | | prior school year attributable to the additional $285.50 |
5 | | per student computer technology and equipment investment |
6 | | grant divided by the Organizational Unit's final Adequacy |
7 | | Target, the result of which shall be multiplied by the |
8 | | amount of new funding received pursuant to this Section. An |
9 | | Organizational Unit assigned to a Tier 1 or Tier 2 final |
10 | | Adequacy Target attributable to the received computer |
11 | | technology and equipment investment grant shall include |
12 | | all additional investments in computer technology and |
13 | | equipment adequacy elements. |
14 | | "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading, |
15 | | English, writing, and language arts; history and social |
16 | | studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced |
17 | | Placement in high schools. |
18 | | "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in |
19 | | elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle |
20 | | and high schools. |
21 | | "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed |
22 | | teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to |
23 | | students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects. |
24 | | "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement |
25 | | tax funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the |
26 | | calendar year one year before the calendar year in which a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 220 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | school year begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the |
2 | | abolition of ad valorem personal property tax and the |
3 | | replacement of revenues lost thereby, and amending and |
4 | | repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in connection |
5 | | therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as amended (Public |
6 | | Act 81-1st S.S.-1). |
7 | | "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in |
8 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and |
9 | | calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection |
10 | | (d) of this Section. |
11 | | "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national |
12 | | employment cost index for civilian workers in educational |
13 | | services in elementary and secondary schools on a |
14 | | cumulative basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding |
15 | | the fiscal year of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation. |
16 | | "EIS Data" means the employment information system |
17 | | data maintained by the State Board on educators within |
18 | | Organizational Units. |
19 | | "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision |
20 | | insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit, |
21 | | the costs associated with the statutorily required payment |
22 | | of the normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher |
23 | | pensions, Social Security employer contributions, and |
24 | | Illinois Municipal Retirement Fund employer contributions. |
25 | | "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the |
26 | | definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 221 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | this Code participating in a program of transitional |
2 | | bilingual education or a transitional program of |
3 | | instruction meeting the requirements and program |
4 | | application procedures of Article 14C of this Code. For the |
5 | | purposes of collecting the number of EL students enrolled, |
6 | | the same collection and calculation methodology as defined |
7 | | above for "ASE" shall apply to English learners, with the |
8 | | exception that EL student enrollment shall include |
9 | | students in grades pre-kindergarten through 12. |
10 | | "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources, |
11 | | and educational programs that have been identified through |
12 | | academic research as necessary to improve student success, |
13 | | improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and |
14 | | provide for other per student costs related to the delivery |
15 | | and leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the |
16 | | maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are |
17 | | specified in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this |
18 | | Section. |
19 | | "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided |
20 | | to an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section. |
21 | | "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs |
22 | | provided to students outside the regular school day before |
23 | | and after school or during non-instructional times during |
24 | | the school day. |
25 | | "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio |
26 | | in which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 222 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension. |
2 | | "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4) |
3 | | of subsection (f) of this Section. |
4 | | "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of |
5 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
6 | | "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time |
7 | | equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant |
8 | | position at an Organizational Unit. |
9 | | "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection |
10 | | (g). |
11 | | "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance |
12 | | counselor who provides guidance and counseling support for |
13 | | students within an Organizational Unit. |
14 | | "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit |
15 | | district created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code. |
16 | | "Instructional assistant" means a core or special |
17 | | education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in |
18 | | the classroom and provides academic support to students. |
19 | | "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher |
20 | | or licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches |
21 | | continuous improvement in classroom instruction; provides |
22 | | instructional support to teachers in the elements of |
23 | | research-based instruction or demonstrates the alignment |
24 | | of instruction with curriculum standards and assessment |
25 | | tools; develops or coordinates instructional programs or |
26 | | strategies; develops and implements training; chooses |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 223 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | standards-based instructional materials; provides teachers |
2 | | with an understanding of current research; serves as a |
3 | | mentor, site coach, curriculum specialist, or lead |
4 | | teacher; or otherwise works with fellow teachers, in |
5 | | collaboration, to use data to improve instructional |
6 | | practice or develop model lessons. |
7 | | "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional |
8 | | materials for student instruction, including, but not |
9 | | limited to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory |
10 | | equipment, library books, and other similar materials. |
11 | | "Laboratory School" means a public school that is |
12 | | created and operated by a public university and approved by |
13 | | the State Board. |
14 | | "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a |
15 | | library information specialist or another individual whose |
16 | | primary responsibility is overseeing library resources |
17 | | within an Organizational Unit. |
18 | | "Limiting rate for Hybrid Districts" means the |
19 | | combined elementary school and high school limiting rates. |
20 | | "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
21 | | subsection (c) of this Section. |
22 | | "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph |
23 | | (A) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
24 | | "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B) |
25 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
26 | | "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 224 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | subsection (c) of this Section. |
2 | | "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit |
3 | | in a fiscal year, the higher of the average number of |
4 | | students for the prior school year or the immediately |
5 | | preceding 3 school years who, as of July 1 of the |
6 | | immediately preceding fiscal year (as determined by the |
7 | | Department of Human Services), are eligible for at least |
8 | | one of the following low-income programs: Medicaid, the |
9 | | Children's Health Insurance Program, Temporary Assistance |
10 | | for Needy Families (TANF), or the Supplemental Nutrition |
11 | | Assistance Program, excluding pupils who are eligible for |
12 | | services provided by the Department of Children and Family |
13 | | Services. Until such time that grade level low-income |
14 | | populations become available, grade level low-income |
15 | | populations shall be determined by applying the low-income |
16 | | percentage to total student enrollments by grade level. The |
17 | | low-income percentage is determined by dividing the |
18 | | Low-Income Count by the Average Student Enrollment. The |
19 | | low-income percentage for programs operated by a regional |
20 | | office of education or an intermediate service center must |
21 | | be set to the weighted average of the low-income |
22 | | percentages of all of the school districts in the service |
23 | | region. The weighted low-income percentage is the result of |
24 | | multiplying the low-income percentage of each school |
25 | | district served by the regional office of education or |
26 | | intermediate service center by each school district's |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 225 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Average Student Enrollment, summarizing those products and |
2 | | dividing the total by the total Average Student Enrollment |
3 | | for the service region. |
4 | | "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services, |
5 | | facility and ground maintenance, facility operations, |
6 | | facility security, routine facility repairs, and other |
7 | | similar services and functions. |
8 | | "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (9) of |
9 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
10 | | "New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds" means, for any |
11 | | given fiscal year, all State funds appropriated under |
12 | | Section 2-3.170 of this the School Code. |
13 | | "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all |
14 | | State funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in |
15 | | excess of the amount needed to fund the Base Funding |
16 | | Minimum for all Organizational Units in that school year. |
17 | | "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given |
18 | | school year, the amount of State funds that would be |
19 | | necessary to fully meet the Adequacy Target of an |
20 | | Operational Unit minus the Preliminary Resources available |
21 | | to each unit. |
22 | | "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified |
23 | | school nurse, in accordance with the rules established for |
24 | | nursing services by the State Board, who is an employee of |
25 | | and is available to provide health care-related services |
26 | | for students of an Organizational Unit. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 226 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the |
2 | | previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes, |
3 | | except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital |
4 | | Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes. |
5 | | For Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the |
6 | | combined elementary and high school rates utilized in the |
7 | | previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes, |
8 | | except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital |
9 | | Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes. |
10 | | "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School or any |
11 | | public school district that is recognized as such by the |
12 | | State Board and that contains elementary schools typically |
13 | | serving kindergarten through 5th grades, middle schools |
14 | | typically serving 6th through 8th grades, high schools |
15 | | typically serving 9th through 12th grades, a program |
16 | | established under Section 2-3.66 or 2-3.41, or a program |
17 | | operated by a regional office of education or an |
18 | | intermediate service center under Article 13A or 13B. The |
19 | | General Assembly acknowledges that the actual grade levels |
20 | | served by a particular Organizational Unit may vary |
21 | | slightly from what is typical. |
22 | | "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating |
23 | | the CWI in the region and original county in which an |
24 | | Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is |
25 | | located as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if |
26 | | the Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 227 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | with this paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational |
2 | | Unit CWI shall be increased to 0.9. Each county's current |
3 | | CWI value shall be adjusted based on the CWI value of that |
4 | | county's neighboring Illinois counties, to create a |
5 | | "weighted adjusted index value". This shall be calculated |
6 | | by summing the CWI values of all of a county's adjacent |
7 | | Illinois counties and dividing by the number of adjacent |
8 | | Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value of the |
9 | | original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois |
10 | | county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the |
11 | | number of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the |
12 | | original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and |
13 | | the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at |
14 | | 0.75. If the number of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the |
15 | | original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.33 and |
16 | | the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at |
17 | | 0.66. The greater of the county's current CWI value and its |
18 | | weighted adjusted index value shall be used as the |
19 | | Organizational Unit CWI. |
20 | | "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year |
21 | | immediately preceding the Base Tax Year. |
22 | | "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of |
23 | | the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county |
24 | | clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating |
25 | | Tax Rate. |
26 | | "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 228 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (f) of this Section. |
2 | | "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
3 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
4 | | "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed |
5 | | to be employed as a principal in this State. |
6 | | "Professional development" means training programs for |
7 | | licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to, |
8 | | programs that assist in implementing new curriculum |
9 | | programs, provide data focused or academic assessment data |
10 | | training to help staff identify a student's weaknesses and |
11 | | strengths, target interventions, improve instruction, |
12 | | encompass instructional strategies for English learner, |
13 | | gifted, or at-risk students, address inclusivity, cultural |
14 | | sensitivity, or implicit bias, or otherwise provide |
15 | | professional support for licensed staff. |
16 | | "Prototypical" means 450 special education |
17 | | pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students |
18 | | for an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students |
19 | | for a middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students |
20 | | for a high school. |
21 | | "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation |
22 | | Law. |
23 | | "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection |
24 | | (d) of this Section. |
25 | | "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist, |
26 | | social worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 229 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | member who provides support to at-risk or struggling |
2 | | students. |
3 | | "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
4 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
5 | | "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular |
6 | | Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the |
7 | | Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI. |
8 | | "School site staff" means the primary school secretary |
9 | | and any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school. |
10 | | "Special education" means special educational |
11 | | facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of |
12 | | this Code. |
13 | | "Special Education Allocation" means the amount of an |
14 | | Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable |
15 | | to special education divided by the Organizational Unit's |
16 | | final Adequacy Target, the product of which shall be |
17 | | multiplied by the amount of new funding received pursuant |
18 | | to this Section. An Organizational Unit's final Adequacy |
19 | | Target attributable to special education shall include all |
20 | | special education investment adequacy elements. |
21 | | "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides |
22 | | instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects, |
23 | | including, but not limited to, art, music, physical |
24 | | education, health, driver education, career-technical |
25 | | education, and such other subject areas as may be mandated |
26 | | by State law or provided by an Organizational Unit. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 230 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School, |
2 | | safe school, Department of Juvenile Justice school, |
3 | | special education cooperative or entity recognized by the |
4 | | State Board as a special education cooperative, |
5 | | State-approved charter school, or alternative learning |
6 | | opportunities program that received direct funding from |
7 | | the State Board during the 2016-2017 school year through |
8 | | any of the funding sources included within the calculation |
9 | | of the Base Funding Minimum or Glenwood Academy. |
10 | | "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental |
11 | | general State aid funding received by an Organizational |
12 | | Unit during the 2016-2017 school year pursuant to |
13 | | subsection (H) of Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now |
14 | | repealed). |
15 | | "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy |
16 | | Targets of all Organizational Units. |
17 | | "State Board" means the State Board of Education. |
18 | | "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent |
19 | | of Education. |
20 | | "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by |
21 | | multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for |
22 | | that Organizational Unit creating a weighted value, |
23 | | summing all Organizational Units' weighted values, and |
24 | | dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units, |
25 | | thereby creating an average weighted index. |
26 | | "Student activities" means non-credit producing |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 231 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | after-school programs, including, but not limited to, |
2 | | clubs, bands, sports, and other activities authorized by |
3 | | the school board of the Organizational Unit. |
4 | | "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or |
5 | | teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational |
6 | | Unit and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on |
7 | | a per diem or per period-assignment basis to replace |
8 | | another staff member. |
9 | | "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs |
10 | | provided to students during the summer months outside of |
11 | | the regular school year. |
12 | | "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member |
13 | | who helps in supervising students of an Organizational |
14 | | Unit, but does so outside of the classroom, in situations |
15 | | such as, but not limited to, monitoring hallways and |
16 | | playgrounds, supervising lunchrooms, or supervising |
17 | | students when being transported in buses serving the |
18 | | Organizational Unit. |
19 | | "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of |
20 | | subsection (g). |
21 | | "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined |
22 | | in paragraph (3) of subsection (g). |
23 | | "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate |
24 | | Funding", "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate |
25 | | Funding" are defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g). |
26 | | (b) Adequacy Target calculation. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 232 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the |
2 | | sum of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing |
3 | | Essential Elements, as calculated in accordance with this |
4 | | subsection (b), with the salary amounts in the Essential |
5 | | Elements multiplied by a Regionalization Factor calculated |
6 | | pursuant to paragraph (3) of this subsection (b). |
7 | | (2) The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro |
8 | | rata basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each |
9 | | Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2), |
10 | | with investments and FTE positions pro rata funded based on |
11 | | ASE counts in excess of or less than the thresholds set |
12 | | forth in this paragraph (2). The method for calculating |
13 | | attributable pro rata costs and the defined subgroups |
14 | | thereto are as follows: |
15 | | (A) Core class size investments. Each |
16 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding required |
17 | | to support that number of FTE core teacher positions as |
18 | | is needed to keep the respective class sizes of the |
19 | | Organizational Unit to the following maximum numbers: |
20 | | (i) For grades kindergarten through 3, the |
21 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding required |
22 | | to support one FTE core teacher position for every |
23 | | 15 Low-Income Count students in those grades and |
24 | | one FTE core teacher position for every 20 |
25 | | non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. |
26 | | (ii) For grades 4 through 12, the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 233 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding required |
2 | | to support one FTE core teacher position for every |
3 | | 20 Low-Income Count students in those grades and |
4 | | one FTE core teacher position for every 25 |
5 | | non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. |
6 | | The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a |
7 | | grade shall be determined by subtracting the |
8 | | Low-Income students in that grade from the ASE of the |
9 | | Organizational Unit for that grade. |
10 | | (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each |
11 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
12 | | to cover that number of FTE specialist teacher |
13 | | positions that correspond to the following |
14 | | percentages: |
15 | | (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an |
16 | | elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the |
17 | | number of the Organizational Unit's core teachers, |
18 | | as determined under subparagraph (A) of this |
19 | | paragraph (2); and |
20 | | (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a |
21 | | high school, then 33.33% of the number of the |
22 | | Organizational Unit's core teachers. |
23 | | (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each |
24 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
25 | | to cover one FTE instructional facilitator position |
26 | | for every 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 234 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | children with disabilities and all kindergarten |
2 | | through grade 12 students of the Organizational Unit. |
3 | | (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments. |
4 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding |
5 | | needed to cover one FTE teacher position for each |
6 | | prototypical elementary, middle, and high school. |
7 | | (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each |
8 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
9 | | to cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to |
10 | | 5.70% of the minimum pupil attendance days required |
11 | | under Section 10-19 of this Code for all full-time |
12 | | equivalent core, specialist, and intervention |
13 | | teachers, school nurses, special education teachers |
14 | | and instructional assistants, instructional |
15 | | facilitators, and summer school and extended day |
16 | | teacher positions, as determined under this paragraph |
17 | | (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average salary |
18 | | for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the |
19 | | average salary of each instructional assistant |
20 | | position. |
21 | | (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each |
22 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
23 | | to cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450 |
24 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
25 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5 |
26 | | students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for each 250 |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 235 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | grades 6 through 8 ASE middle school students, plus one |
2 | | FTE guidance counselor for each 250 grades 9 through 12 |
3 | | ASE high school students. |
4 | | (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit |
5 | | shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse |
6 | | for each 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children |
7 | | with disabilities and all kindergarten through grade |
8 | | 12 students across all grade levels it serves. |
9 | | (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each |
10 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
11 | | to cover one FTE for each 225 combined ASE of |
12 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
13 | | kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE for |
14 | | each 225 ASE middle school students, plus one FTE for |
15 | | each 200 ASE high school students. |
16 | | (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational |
17 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE |
18 | | librarian for each prototypical elementary school, |
19 | | middle school, and high school and one FTE aide or |
20 | | media technician for every 300 combined ASE of |
21 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
22 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students. |
23 | | (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational |
24 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE |
25 | | principal position for each prototypical elementary |
26 | | school, plus one FTE principal position for each |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 236 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | prototypical middle school, plus one FTE principal |
2 | | position for each prototypical high school. |
3 | | (K) Assistant principal investments. Each |
4 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
5 | | to cover one FTE assistant principal position for each |
6 | | prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant |
7 | | principal position for each prototypical middle |
8 | | school, plus one FTE assistant principal position for |
9 | | each prototypical high school. |
10 | | (L) School site staff investments. Each |
11 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
12 | | for one FTE position for each 225 ASE of |
13 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
14 | | kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE |
15 | | position for each 225 ASE middle school students, plus |
16 | | one FTE position for each 200 ASE high school students. |
17 | | (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit |
18 | | shall receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12 |
19 | | ASE. |
20 | | (N) Professional development investments. Each |
21 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of |
22 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
23 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
24 | | students for trainers and other professional |
25 | | development-related expenses for supplies and |
26 | | materials. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 237 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (O) Instructional material investments. Each |
2 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of |
3 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
4 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
5 | | students to cover instructional material costs. |
6 | | (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational |
7 | | Unit shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE |
8 | | of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
9 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover |
10 | | assessment costs. |
11 | | (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments. |
12 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per |
13 | | student of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten |
14 | | children with disabilities and all kindergarten |
15 | | through grade 12 students to cover computer technology |
16 | | and equipment costs. For the 2018-2019 school year and |
17 | | subsequent school years, Organizational Units assigned |
18 | | to Tier 1 and Tier 2 in the prior school year shall |
19 | | receive an additional $285.50 per student of the |
20 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
21 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
22 | | students to cover computer technology and equipment |
23 | | costs in the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target. |
24 | | The State Board may establish additional requirements |
25 | | for Organizational Unit expenditures of funds received |
26 | | pursuant to this subparagraph (Q), including a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 238 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | requirement that funds received pursuant to this |
2 | | subparagraph (Q) may be used only for serving the |
3 | | technology needs of the district. It is the intent of |
4 | | Public Act 100-465 that all Tier 1 and Tier 2 districts |
5 | | receive the addition to their Adequacy Target in the |
6 | | following year, subject to compliance with the |
7 | | requirements of the State Board , which shall include, |
8 | | at a minimum, a requirement that each district submit |
9 | | documentation on how developmentally appropriate |
10 | | computer literacy instruction is embedded in the |
11 | | district's curriculum at each grade level . |
12 | | (R) Student activities investments. Each |
13 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the following |
14 | | funding amounts to cover student activities: $100 per |
15 | | kindergarten through grade 5 ASE student in elementary |
16 | | school, plus $200 per ASE student in middle school, |
17 | | plus $675 per ASE student in high school. |
18 | | (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each |
19 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student |
20 | | of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
21 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
22 | | students for day-to-day maintenance and operations |
23 | | expenditures, including salary, supplies, and |
24 | | materials, as well as purchased services, but |
25 | | excluding employee benefits. The proportion of salary |
26 | | for the application of a Regionalization Factor and the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 239 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | calculation of benefits is equal to $352.92. |
2 | | (T) Central office investments. Each |
3 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $742 per student of |
4 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
5 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
6 | | students to cover central office operations, including |
7 | | administrators and classified personnel charged with |
8 | | managing the instructional programs, business and |
9 | | operations of the school district, and security |
10 | | personnel. The proportion of salary for the |
11 | | application of a Regionalization Factor and the |
12 | | calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48. |
13 | | (U) Employee benefit investments. Each |
14 | | Organizational Unit shall receive 30% of the total of |
15 | | all salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target, |
16 | | excluding substitute teachers and student activities |
17 | | investments, to cover benefit costs. For central |
18 | | office and maintenance and operations investments, the |
19 | | benefit calculation shall be based upon the salary |
20 | | proportion of each investment. If at any time the |
21 | | responsibility for funding the employer normal cost of |
22 | | teacher pensions is assigned to school districts, then |
23 | | that amount certified by the Teachers' Retirement |
24 | | System of the State of Illinois to be paid by the |
25 | | Organizational Unit for the preceding school year |
26 | | shall be added to the benefit investment. For any |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 240 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | fiscal year in which a school district organized under |
2 | | Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the |
3 | | employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that |
4 | | amount of its employer normal cost plus the amount for |
5 | | retiree health insurance as certified by the Public |
6 | | School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of |
7 | | Chicago to be paid by the school district for the |
8 | | preceding school year that is statutorily required to |
9 | | cover employer normal costs and the amount for retiree |
10 | | health insurance shall be added to the 30% specified in |
11 | | this subparagraph (U). The Teachers' Retirement System |
12 | | of the State of Illinois and the Public School |
13 | | Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago shall |
14 | | submit such information as the State Superintendent |
15 | | may require for the calculations set forth in this |
16 | | subparagraph (U). |
17 | | (V) Additional investments in low-income students. |
18 | | In addition to and not in lieu of all other funding |
19 | | under this paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit |
20 | | shall receive funding based on the average teacher |
21 | | salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of: |
22 | | (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor) |
23 | | position for every 125 Low-Income Count students; |
24 | | (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for |
25 | | every 125 Low-Income Count students; |
26 | | (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 241 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | for every 120 Low-Income Count students; and |
2 | | (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position |
3 | | for every 120 Low-Income Count students. |
4 | | (W) Additional investments in English learner |
5 | | students. In addition to and not in lieu of all other |
6 | | funding under this paragraph (2), each Organizational |
7 | | Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher |
8 | | salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of: |
9 | | (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor) |
10 | | position for every 125 English learner students; |
11 | | (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for |
12 | | every 125 English learner students; |
13 | | (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position |
14 | | for every 120 English learner students; |
15 | | (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position |
16 | | for every 120 English learner students; and |
17 | | (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100 |
18 | | English learner students. |
19 | | (X) Special education investments. Each |
20 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding based on the |
21 | | average teacher salary for grades K through 12 to cover |
22 | | special education as follows: |
23 | | (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141 |
24 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
25 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
26 | | students; |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 242 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every |
2 | | 141 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
3 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
4 | | students; and |
5 | | (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every |
6 | | 1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children |
7 | | with disabilities and all kindergarten through |
8 | | grade 12 students. |
9 | | (3) For calculating the salaries included within the |
10 | | Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall |
11 | | annually calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar |
12 | | using the employment information system data maintained by |
13 | | the State Board, limited to public schools only and |
14 | | excluding special education and vocational cooperatives, |
15 | | schools operated by the Department of Juvenile Justice, and |
16 | | charter schools, for the following positions: |
17 | | (A) Teacher for grades K through 8. |
18 | | (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12. |
19 | | (C) Teacher for grades K through 12. |
20 | | (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8. |
21 | | (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12. |
22 | | (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12. |
23 | | (G) Social worker. |
24 | | (H) Psychologist. |
25 | | (I) Librarian. |
26 | | (J) Nurse. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 243 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (K) Principal. |
2 | | (L) Assistant principal. |
3 | | For the purposes of this paragraph (3), "teacher" |
4 | | includes core teachers, specialist and elective teachers, |
5 | | instructional facilitators, tutors, special education |
6 | | teachers, pupil support staff teachers, English learner |
7 | | teachers, extended day teachers, and summer school |
8 | | teachers. Where specific grade data is not required for the |
9 | | Essential Elements, the average salary for corresponding |
10 | | positions shall apply. For substitute teachers, the |
11 | | average teacher salary for grades K through 12 shall apply. |
12 | | For calculating the salaries included within the |
13 | | Essential Elements for positions not included within EIS |
14 | | Data, the following salaries shall be used in the first |
15 | | year of implementation of Evidence-Based Funding: |
16 | | (i) school site staff, $30,000; and |
17 | | (ii) non-instructional assistant, instructional |
18 | | assistant, library aide, library media tech, or |
19 | | supervisory aide: $25,000. |
20 | | In the second and subsequent years of implementation of |
21 | | Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii) |
22 | | of this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI. |
23 | | The salary amounts for the Essential Elements |
24 | | determined pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S) |
25 | | and (T), and (V) through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection |
26 | | (b) of this Section shall be multiplied by a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 244 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Regionalization Factor. |
2 | | (c) Local Capacity calculation. |
3 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity |
4 | | represents an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute |
5 | | toward its Adequacy Target for purposes of the |
6 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula calculation. "Local |
7 | | Capacity" means either (i) the Organizational Unit's Local |
8 | | Capacity Target as calculated in accordance with paragraph |
9 | | (2) of this subsection (c) if its Real Receipts are equal |
10 | | to or less than its Local Capacity Target or (ii) the |
11 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity, as |
12 | | calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of this |
13 | | subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local |
14 | | Capacity Target. |
15 | | (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an |
16 | | Organizational Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by |
17 | | multiplying its Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity |
18 | | Ratio. |
19 | | (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity |
20 | | Percentage is the conversion of the Organizational |
21 | | Unit's Local Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is |
22 | | determined in accordance with subparagraph (B) of this |
23 | | paragraph (2), into a cumulative distribution |
24 | | resulting in a percentile ranking to determine each |
25 | | Organizational Unit's relative position to all other |
26 | | Organizational Units in this State. The calculation of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 245 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Local Capacity Percentage is described in subparagraph |
2 | | (C) of this paragraph (2). |
3 | | (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio |
4 | | in a given year is the percentage obtained by dividing |
5 | | its Adjusted EAV or PTELL EAV, whichever is less, by |
6 | | its Adequacy Target, with the resulting ratio further |
7 | | adjusted as follows: |
8 | | (i) for Organizational Units serving grades |
9 | | kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no |
10 | | further adjustments shall be made; |
11 | | (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades |
12 | | kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be |
13 | | multiplied by 9/13; |
14 | | (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades |
15 | | 9 through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be |
16 | | multiplied by 4/13; and |
17 | | (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a |
18 | | different grade configuration than those specified |
19 | | in items (i) through (iii) of this subparagraph |
20 | | (B), the State Superintendent shall determine a |
21 | | comparable adjustment based on the grades served. |
22 | | (C) The Local Capacity Percentage is equal to the |
23 | | percentile ranking of the district. Local Capacity |
24 | | Percentage converts each Organizational Unit's Local |
25 | | Capacity Ratio to a cumulative distribution resulting |
26 | | in a percentile ranking to determine each |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 246 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit's relative position to all other |
2 | | Organizational Units in this State. The Local Capacity |
3 | | Percentage cumulative distribution resulting in a |
4 | | percentile ranking for each Organizational Unit shall |
5 | | be calculated using the standard normal distribution |
6 | | of the score in relation to the weighted mean and |
7 | | weighted standard deviation and Local Capacity Ratios |
8 | | of all Organizational Units. If the value assigned to |
9 | | any Organizational Unit is in excess of 90%, the value |
10 | | shall be adjusted to 90%. For Laboratory Schools, the |
11 | | Local Capacity Percentage shall be set at 10% in
|
12 | | recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from |
13 | | the public university that are allocated to
the |
14 | | Laboratory School. For programs operated by a regional |
15 | | office of education or an intermediate service center, |
16 | | the Local Capacity Percentage must be set at 10% in |
17 | | recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from |
18 | | school districts that are allocated to the regional |
19 | | office of education or intermediate service center. |
20 | | The weighted mean for the Local Capacity Percentage |
21 | | shall be determined by multiplying each Organizational |
22 | | Unit's Local Capacity Ratio times the ASE for the unit |
23 | | creating a weighted value, summing the weighted values |
24 | | of all Organizational Units, and dividing by the total |
25 | | ASE of all Organizational Units. The weighted standard |
26 | | deviation shall be determined by taking the square root |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 247 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of the weighted variance of all Organizational Units' |
2 | | Local Capacity Ratio, where the variance is calculated |
3 | | by squaring the difference between each unit's Local |
4 | | Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, then multiplying |
5 | | the variance for each unit times the ASE for the unit |
6 | | to create a weighted variance for each unit, then |
7 | | summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by |
8 | | the total ASE of all units. |
9 | | (D) For any Organizational Unit, the |
10 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity Target |
11 | | shall be reduced by either (i) the school board's |
12 | | remaining contribution pursuant to paragraph (ii) of |
13 | | subsection (b-4) of Section 16-158 of the Illinois |
14 | | Pension Code in a given year or (ii) the board of |
15 | | education's remaining contribution pursuant to |
16 | | paragraph (iv) of subsection (b) of Section 17-129 of |
17 | | the Illinois Pension Code absent the employer normal |
18 | | cost portion of the required contribution and amount |
19 | | allowed pursuant to subdivision (3) of Section |
20 | | 17-142.1 of the Illinois Pension Code in a given year. |
21 | | In the preceding sentence, item (i) shall be certified |
22 | | to the State Board of Education by the Teachers' |
23 | | Retirement System of the State of Illinois and item |
24 | | (ii) shall be certified to the State Board of Education |
25 | | by the Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement |
26 | | Fund of the City of Chicago. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 248 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more |
2 | | than its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity |
3 | | shall equal an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated |
4 | | in accordance with this paragraph (3). The Adjusted Local |
5 | | Capacity Target is calculated as the sum of the |
6 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target and its Real |
7 | | Receipts Adjustment. The Real Receipts Adjustment equals |
8 | | the Organizational Unit's Real Receipts less its Local |
9 | | Capacity Target, with the resulting figure multiplied by |
10 | | the Local Capacity Percentage. |
11 | | As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of |
12 | | Adequacy" means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real |
13 | | Receipts, CPPRT, and Base Funding Minimum, with the |
14 | | resulting figure divided by the Organizational Unit's |
15 | | Adequacy Target. |
16 | | (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for |
17 | | purposes of the Local Capacity calculation. |
18 | | (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the |
19 | | product of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV. An |
20 | | Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Adjusted |
21 | | Operating Tax Rate for property within the Organizational |
22 | | Unit. |
23 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the |
24 | | equalized assessed valuation, or EAV, of all taxable |
25 | | property of each Organizational Unit as of September 30 of |
26 | | the previous year in accordance with paragraph (3) of this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 249 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | subsection (d). The State Superintendent shall then |
2 | | determine the Adjusted EAV of each Organizational Unit in |
3 | | accordance with paragraph (4) of this subsection (d), which |
4 | | Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the purposes of |
5 | | calculating Local Capacity. |
6 | | (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department |
7 | | of Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the |
8 | | value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue |
9 | | of all taxable property of every Organizational Unit, |
10 | | together with (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending |
11 | | taxes for the funds of the Organizational Unit as of |
12 | | September 30 of the previous year and (ii) the limiting |
13 | | rate for all Organizational Units subject to property tax |
14 | | extension limitations as imposed under PTELL. |
15 | | (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the |
16 | | equalized assessed value of all taxable property of |
17 | | each Organizational Unit situated entirely or |
18 | | partially within a county that is or was subject to the |
19 | | provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property |
20 | | Tax Code (i) an amount equal to the total amount by |
21 | | which the homestead exemption allowed under Section |
22 | | 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for real |
23 | | property situated in that Organizational Unit exceeds |
24 | | the total amount that would have been allowed in that |
25 | | Organizational Unit if the maximum reduction under |
26 | | Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500 |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 250 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | in all other counties in tax year 2003 or (II) $5,000 |
2 | | in all counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and |
3 | | (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for the |
4 | | taxable year of all additional exemptions under |
5 | | Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with |
6 | | a household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk |
7 | | of any county that is or was subject to the provisions |
8 | | of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code |
9 | | shall annually calculate and certify to the Department |
10 | | of Revenue for each Organizational Unit all homestead |
11 | | exemption amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the |
12 | | Property Tax Code and all amounts of additional |
13 | | exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax |
14 | | Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or |
15 | | less. It is the intent of this subparagraph (A) that if |
16 | | the general homestead exemption for a parcel of |
17 | | property is determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177 |
18 | | of the Property Tax Code rather than Section 15-175, |
19 | | then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected by |
20 | | the difference, if any, between the amount of the |
21 | | general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of |
22 | | property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property |
23 | | Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed |
24 | | had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of |
25 | | property been determined under Section 15-175 of the |
26 | | Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 251 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | subparagraph (A) that if additional exemptions are |
2 | | allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code |
3 | | for owners with a household income of less than |
4 | | $30,000, then the calculation of EAV shall not be |
5 | | affected by the difference, if any, because of those |
6 | | additional exemptions. |
7 | | (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational |
8 | | Unit within a redevelopment project area in respect to |
9 | | which a municipality has adopted tax increment |
10 | | allocation financing pursuant to the Tax Increment |
11 | | Allocation Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of Article |
12 | | 11 of the Illinois Municipal Code, or the Industrial |
13 | | Jobs Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of Article 11 of the |
14 | | Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current EAV of |
15 | | real property located in any such project area that is |
16 | | attributable to an increase above the total initial EAV |
17 | | of such property shall be used as part of the EAV of |
18 | | the Organizational Unit, until such time as all |
19 | | redevelopment project costs have been paid, as |
20 | | provided in Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment |
21 | | Allocation Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 |
22 | | of the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of |
23 | | the EAV of the Organizational Unit, the total initial |
24 | | EAV or the current EAV, whichever is lower, shall be |
25 | | used until such time as all redevelopment project costs |
26 | | have been paid. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 252 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (B-5) The real property equalized assessed |
2 | | valuation for a school district shall be adjusted by |
3 | | subtracting from the real property value, as equalized |
4 | | or assessed by the Department of Revenue, for the |
5 | | district an amount computed by dividing the amount of |
6 | | any abatement of taxes under Section 18-170 of the |
7 | | Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a district maintaining |
8 | | grades kindergarten through 12, by 2.30% for a district |
9 | | maintaining grades kindergarten through 8, or by 1.05% |
10 | | for a district maintaining grades 9 through 12 and |
11 | | adjusted by an amount computed by dividing the amount |
12 | | of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) of |
13 | | Section 18-165 of the Property Tax Code by the same |
14 | | percentage rates for district type as specified in this |
15 | | subparagraph (B-5). |
16 | | (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid |
17 | | Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the |
18 | | lesser of the adjusted equalized assessed valuation |
19 | | for property within the partial elementary unit |
20 | | district for elementary purposes, as defined in |
21 | | Article 11E of this Code, or the adjusted equalized |
22 | | assessed valuation for property within the partial |
23 | | elementary unit district for high school purposes, as |
24 | | defined in Article 11E of this Code. |
25 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the |
26 | | average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 253 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in |
2 | | the immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more |
3 | | compared to the 3-year average. In the event of |
4 | | Organizational Unit reorganization, consolidation, or |
5 | | annexation, the Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the |
6 | | first 3 years after such change shall be as follows: the |
7 | | most current EAV shall be used in the first year, the |
8 | | average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV in the immediately |
9 | | preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or more compared |
10 | | to the 2-year average for the second year, and a 3-year |
11 | | average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if |
12 | | the Adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the |
13 | | 3-year average for the third year. For any school district |
14 | | whose EAV in the immediately preceding year is used in |
15 | | calculations, in the following year, the Adjusted EAV shall |
16 | | be the average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 2 |
17 | | years or the immediately preceding year if that year |
18 | | represents a decline of 10% or more compared to the 2-year |
19 | | average. |
20 | | "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State |
21 | | Board for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as |
22 | | described in this paragraph (4) for the purposes of |
23 | | calculating an Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio. |
24 | | Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph (4), the |
25 | | PTELL EAV of an Organizational Unit shall be equal to the |
26 | | product of the equalized assessed valuation last used in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 254 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 |
2 | | of this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under |
3 | | this Section and the Organizational Unit's Extension |
4 | | Limitation Ratio. If an Organizational Unit has approved or |
5 | | does approve an increase in its limiting rate, pursuant to |
6 | | Section 18-190 of the Property Tax Code, affecting the Base |
7 | | Tax Year, the PTELL EAV shall be equal to the product of |
8 | | the equalized assessed valuation last used in the |
9 | | calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of |
10 | | this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under |
11 | | this Section multiplied by an amount equal to one plus the |
12 | | percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price Index |
13 | | for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the |
14 | | United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar |
15 | | year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the equalized |
16 | | assessed valuation of new property, annexed property, and |
17 | | recovered tax increment value and minus the equalized |
18 | | assessed valuation of disconnected property. |
19 | | As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and |
20 | | "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set |
21 | | forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. |
22 | | (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation. |
23 | | (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding |
24 | | Minimum of an Organizational Unit or a Specially Funded |
25 | | Unit shall be the amount of State funds distributed to the |
26 | | Organizational Unit or Specially Funded Unit during the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 255 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 2016-2017 school year prior to any adjustments and |
2 | | specified appropriation amounts described in this |
3 | | paragraph (1) from the following Sections, as calculated by |
4 | | the State Superintendent: Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now |
5 | | repealed); Section 5 of Article 224 of Public Act 99-524 |
6 | | (equity grants); Section 14-7.02b of this Code (funding for |
7 | | children requiring special education services); Section |
8 | | 14-13.01 of this Code (special education facilities and |
9 | | staffing), except for reimbursement of the cost of |
10 | | transportation pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section |
11 | | 14C-12 of this Code (English learners); and Section 18-4.3 |
12 | | of this Code (summer school), based on an appropriation |
13 | | level of $13,121,600. For a school district organized under |
14 | | Article 34 of this Code, the Base Funding Minimum also |
15 | | includes (i) the funds allocated to the school district |
16 | | pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to |
17 | | funding programs authorized by the Sections of this Code |
18 | | listed in the preceding sentence and (ii) the difference |
19 | | between (I) the funds allocated to the school district |
20 | | pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to the |
21 | | funding programs authorized by Section 14-7.02 (non-public |
22 | | special education reimbursement), subsection (b) of |
23 | | Section 14-13.01 (special education transportation), |
24 | | Section 29-5 (transportation), Section 2-3.80 |
25 | | (agricultural education), Section 2-3.66 (truants' |
26 | | alternative education), Section 2-3.62 (educational |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 256 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | service centers), and Section 14-7.03 (special education - |
2 | | orphanage) of this Code and Section 15 of the Childhood |
3 | | Hunger Relief Act (free breakfast program) and (II) the |
4 | | school district's actual expenditures for its non-public |
5 | | special education, special education transportation, |
6 | | transportation programs, agricultural education, truants' |
7 | | alternative education, services that would otherwise be |
8 | | performed by a regional office of education, special |
9 | | education orphanage expenditures, and free breakfast, as |
10 | | most recently calculated and reported pursuant to |
11 | | subsection (f) of Section 1D-1 of this Code. The Base |
12 | | Funding Minimum for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. For |
13 | | programs operated by a regional office of education or an |
14 | | intermediate service center, the Base Funding Minimum must |
15 | | be the total amount of State funds allocated to those |
16 | | programs in the 2018-2019 school year and amounts provided |
17 | | pursuant to Article 34 of Public Act 100-586 and Section |
18 | | 3-16 of this Code. All programs established after June 5, |
19 | | 2019 (the effective date of Public Act 101-10) and |
20 | | administered by a regional office of education or an |
21 | | intermediate service center must have an initial Base |
22 | | Funding Minimum set to an amount equal to the first-year |
23 | | ASE multiplied by the amount of per pupil funding received |
24 | | in the previous school year by the lowest funded similar |
25 | | existing program type. If the enrollment for a program |
26 | | operated by a regional office of education or an |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 257 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | intermediate service center is zero, then it may not |
2 | | receive Base Funding Minimum funds for that program in the |
3 | | next fiscal year, and those funds must be distributed to |
4 | | Organizational Units under subsection (g). |
5 | | (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the |
6 | | Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially |
7 | | Funded Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of |
8 | | Evidence-Based Funding for the prior school year, (ii) the |
9 | | Base Funding Minimum for the prior school year, and (iii) |
10 | | any amount received by a school district pursuant to |
11 | | Section 7 of Article 97 of Public Act 100-21. |
12 | | (3) Subject to approval by the General Assembly as |
13 | | provided in this paragraph (3), an Organizational Unit that |
14 | | meets all of the following criteria, as determined by the |
15 | | State Board, shall have District Intervention Money added |
16 | | to its Base Funding Minimum at the time the Base Funding |
17 | | Minimum is calculated by the State Board: |
18 | | (A) The Organizational Unit is operating under an |
19 | | Independent Authority under Section 2-3.25f-5 of this |
20 | | Code for a minimum of 4 school years or is subject to |
21 | | the control of the State Board pursuant to a court |
22 | | order for a minimum of 4 school years. |
23 | | (B) The Organizational Unit was designated as a |
24 | | Tier 1 or Tier 2 Organizational Unit in the previous |
25 | | school year under paragraph (3) of subsection (g) of |
26 | | this Section. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 258 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (C) The Organizational Unit demonstrates |
2 | | sustainability through a 5-year financial and |
3 | | strategic plan. |
4 | | (D) The Organizational Unit has made sufficient |
5 | | progress and achieved sufficient stability in the |
6 | | areas of governance, academic growth, and finances. |
7 | | As part of its determination under this paragraph (3), |
8 | | the State Board may consider the Organizational Unit's |
9 | | summative designation, any accreditations of the |
10 | | Organizational Unit, or the Organizational Unit's |
11 | | financial profile, as calculated by the State Board. |
12 | | If the State Board determines that an Organizational |
13 | | Unit has met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3), |
14 | | it must submit a report to the General Assembly, no later |
15 | | than January 2 of the fiscal year in which the State Board |
16 | | makes it determination, on the amount of District |
17 | | Intervention Money to add to the Organizational Unit's Base |
18 | | Funding Minimum. The General Assembly must review the State |
19 | | Board's report and may approve or disapprove, by joint |
20 | | resolution, the addition of District Intervention Money. |
21 | | If the General Assembly fails to act on the report within |
22 | | 40 calendar days from the receipt of the report, the |
23 | | addition of District Intervention Money is deemed |
24 | | approved. If the General Assembly approves the amount of |
25 | | District Intervention Money to be added to the |
26 | | Organizational Unit's Base Funding Minimum, the District |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 259 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Intervention Money must be added to the Base Funding |
2 | | Minimum annually thereafter. |
3 | | For the first 4 years following the initial year that |
4 | | the State Board determines that an Organizational Unit has |
5 | | met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3) and has |
6 | | received funding under this Section, the Organizational |
7 | | Unit must annually submit to the State Board, on or before |
8 | | November 30, a progress report regarding its financial and |
9 | | strategic plan under subparagraph (C) of this paragraph |
10 | | (3). The plan shall include the financial data from the |
11 | | past 4 annual financial reports or financial audits that |
12 | | must be presented to the State Board by November 15 of each |
13 | | year and the approved budget financial data for the current |
14 | | year. The plan shall be developed according to the |
15 | | guidelines presented to the Organizational Unit by the |
16 | | State Board. The plan shall further include financial |
17 | | projections for the next 3 fiscal years and include a |
18 | | discussion and financial summary of the Organizational |
19 | | Unit's facility needs. If the Organizational Unit does not |
20 | | demonstrate sufficient progress toward its 5-year plan or |
21 | | if it has failed to file an annual financial report, an |
22 | | annual budget, a financial plan, a deficit reduction plan, |
23 | | or other financial information as required by law, the |
24 | | State Board may establish a Financial Oversight Panel under |
25 | | Article 1H of this Code. However, if the Organizational |
26 | | Unit already has a Financial Oversight Panel, the State |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 260 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Board may extend the duration of the Panel. |
2 | | (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation. |
3 | | (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a |
4 | | Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order |
5 | | to place such units into tiers for the purposes of the |
6 | | funding distribution system described in subsection (g) of |
7 | | this Section. Initially, an Organizational Unit's |
8 | | Preliminary Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy |
9 | | are calculated pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection |
10 | | (f). Then, an Organizational Unit's Final Resources and |
11 | | Final Percent of Adequacy are calculated to account for the |
12 | | Organizational Unit's poverty concentration levels |
13 | | pursuant to paragraphs (3) and (4) of this subsection (f). |
14 | | (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are |
15 | | equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and |
16 | | Base Funding Minimum. An Organizational Unit's Preliminary |
17 | | Percent of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary |
18 | | Resources divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%. |
19 | | (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an |
20 | | Organizational Unit's Final Resources are equal to the sum |
21 | | of its Local Capacity, CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding |
22 | | Minimum. The Base Funding Minimum of each Specially Funded |
23 | | Unit shall serve as its Final Resources, except that the |
24 | | Base Funding Minimum for State-approved charter schools |
25 | | shall not include any portion of general State aid |
26 | | allocated in the prior year based on the per capita tuition |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 261 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | charge times the charter school enrollment. |
2 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy |
3 | | is its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. An |
4 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is |
5 | | equal to its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental |
6 | | Grant Funding, with the resulting figure added to the |
7 | | product of its Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary |
8 | | Percent of Adequacy. |
9 | | (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system. |
10 | | (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based |
11 | | Funding formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding |
12 | | equal to the sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's |
13 | | allocation of New State Funds determined pursuant to this |
14 | | subsection (g). To allocate New State Funds, the |
15 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system first |
16 | | places all Organizational Units into one of 4 tiers in |
17 | | accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), based |
18 | | on the Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy. New |
19 | | State Funds are allocated to each of the 4 tiers as |
20 | | follows: Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 50% of all New |
21 | | State Funds, Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 49% of all New |
22 | | State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all |
23 | | New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1% |
24 | | of all New State Funds. Each Organizational Unit within |
25 | | Tier 1 or Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds |
26 | | equal to its tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 262 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | sentence, multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate |
2 | | determined pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection |
3 | | (g). For Tier 1, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap |
4 | | equals the tier's Target Ratio, as specified in paragraph |
5 | | (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the |
6 | | Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting |
7 | | amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final |
8 | | Resources. For Tier 2, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap |
9 | | equals the tier's Target Ratio, as described in paragraph |
10 | | (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the |
11 | | Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting |
12 | | amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final |
13 | | Resources and its Tier 1 funding allocation. To determine |
14 | | the Organizational Unit's Funding Gap, the resulting |
15 | | amount is then multiplied by a factor equal to one minus |
16 | | the Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target |
17 | | percentage. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or Tier |
18 | | 4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the |
19 | | product of its Adequacy Target and the tier's Allocation |
20 | | Rate, as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g). |
21 | | (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all |
22 | | Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit |
23 | | shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3 |
24 | | Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational |
25 | | Unit shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE. |
26 | | Any Tier 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 263 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | per ASE below the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall |
2 | | get a funding allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3 |
3 | | funding allocation per ASE multiplied by the |
4 | | Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 Organizational |
5 | | Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be multiplied by the |
6 | | percentage calculated by dividing the original Tier 2 |
7 | | Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 Organizational |
8 | | Units' Tier 2 funding allocation after adjusting |
9 | | districts' funding below Tier 3 levels. |
10 | | (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers |
11 | | as follows: |
12 | | (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units, |
13 | | except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of |
14 | | Adequacy less than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1 |
15 | | Target Ratio is the ratio level that allows for Tier 1 |
16 | | Aggregate Funding to be distributed, with the Tier 1 |
17 | | Allocation Rate determined pursuant to paragraph (4) |
18 | | of this subsection (g). |
19 | | (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all |
20 | | other Organizational Units, except for Specially |
21 | | Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of less than |
22 | | 0.90. |
23 | | (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units, |
24 | | except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of |
25 | | Adequacy of at least 0.90 and less than 1.0. |
26 | | (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 264 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | with a Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0. |
2 | | (4) The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 are |
3 | | determined as follows: |
4 | | (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 30%. |
5 | | (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
6 | | following equation: Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided |
7 | | by the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2 |
8 | | Organizational Units, unless the result of such |
9 | | equation is higher than 1.0. If the result of such |
10 | | equation is higher than 1.0, then the Tier 2 Allocation |
11 | | Rate is 1.0. |
12 | | (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
13 | | following equation: Tier 3
Aggregate Funding, divided |
14 | | by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3 |
15 | | Organizational
Units. |
16 | | (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
17 | | following equation: Tier 4
Aggregate Funding, divided |
18 | | by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4 |
19 | | Organizational
Units. |
20 | | (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows: |
21 | | (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that |
22 | | allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed |
23 | | with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate. |
24 | | (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90. |
25 | | (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0. |
26 | | (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 265 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | greater than 90%, then than all Tier 1 funding shall be |
2 | | allocated to Tier 2 and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's |
3 | | funding may be identified. |
4 | | (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units |
5 | | receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any |
6 | | remaining New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and |
7 | | Tier 4 Organizational Units. |
8 | | (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood |
9 | | Academy, recognized by the State Board do not qualify for |
10 | | direct funding following the implementation of Public Act |
11 | | 100-465 from any of the funding sources included within the |
12 | | definition of Base Funding Minimum, the unqualified |
13 | | portion of the Base Funding Minimum shall be transferred to |
14 | | one or more appropriate Organizational Units as determined |
15 | | by the State Superintendent based on the prior year ASE of |
16 | | the Organizational Units. |
17 | | (8.5) If a school district withdraws from a special |
18 | | education cooperative, the portion of the Base Funding |
19 | | Minimum that is attributable to the school district may be |
20 | | redistributed to the school district upon withdrawal. The |
21 | | school district and the cooperative must include the amount |
22 | | of the Base Funding Minimum that is to be reapportioned in |
23 | | their withdrawal agreement and notify the State Board of |
24 | | the change with a copy of the agreement upon withdrawal. |
25 | | (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish |
26 | | a target for State funding that will keep pace with |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 266 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | inflation and continue to advance equity through the |
2 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula. The target for State |
3 | | funding of New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds is |
4 | | $50,000,000 for State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State |
5 | | fiscal years. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to |
6 | | $350,000,000. In addition to any New State Funds, no more |
7 | | than $50,000,000 New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds may be |
8 | | counted toward the Minimum Funding Level. If the sum of New |
9 | | State Funds and applicable New Property Tax Relief Pool |
10 | | Funds are less than the Minimum Funding Level, than funding |
11 | | for tiers shall be reduced in the following manner: |
12 | | (A) First, Tier 4 funding shall be reduced by an |
13 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
14 | | Funding Level and New State Funds until such time as |
15 | | Tier 4 funding is exhausted. |
16 | | (B) Next, Tier 3 funding shall be reduced by an |
17 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
18 | | Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
19 | | Tier 4 funding until such time as Tier 3 funding is |
20 | | exhausted. |
21 | | (C) Next, Tier 2 funding shall be reduced by an |
22 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
23 | | Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
24 | | Tier 4 and Tier 3. |
25 | | (D) Finally, Tier 1 funding shall be reduced by an |
26 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 267 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Funding level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
2 | | Tier 2, 3, and 4 funding. In addition, the Allocation |
3 | | Rate for Tier 1 shall be reduced to a percentage equal |
4 | | to the Tier 1 Allocation Rate set by paragraph (4) of |
5 | | this subsection (g), multiplied by the result of New |
6 | | State Funds divided by the Minimum Funding Level. |
7 | | (9.5) For State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State |
8 | | fiscal years, if New State Funds exceed $300,000,000, then |
9 | | any amount in excess of $300,000,000 shall be dedicated for |
10 | | purposes of Section 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of |
11 | | $50,000,000. |
12 | | (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the |
13 | | appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after |
14 | | implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units |
15 | | receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under |
16 | | paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held |
17 | | harmless by establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to |
18 | | the per pupil kindergarten through grade 12 funding |
19 | | received in accordance with this Section in the prior |
20 | | fiscal year. Reductions shall be
made to the Base Funding |
21 | | Minimum of Organizational Units in Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
|
22 | | per pupil basis equivalent to the total number of the ASE |
23 | | in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded Organizational Units |
24 | | divided by the total reduction in State funding. The Base
|
25 | | Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to be applied to |
26 | | Tier 3 and Tier 4
Organizational Units and adjusted by the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 268 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | relative formula when increases in
appropriations for this |
2 | | Section resume. In no event may State funding reductions to
|
3 | | Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 exceed an amount |
4 | | that would be less than the
Base Funding Minimum |
5 | | established in the first year of implementation of this
|
6 | | Section. If additional reductions are required, all school |
7 | | districts shall receive a
reduction by a per pupil amount |
8 | | equal to the aggregate additional appropriation
reduction |
9 | | divided by the total ASE of all Organizational Units. |
10 | | (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor |
11 | | adjustments to the distribution formula set forth in this |
12 | | subsection (g) to account for the rounding of percentages |
13 | | to the nearest tenth of a percentage and dollar amounts to |
14 | | the nearest whole dollar. |
15 | | (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and |
16 | | district submission requirements. |
17 | | (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with |
18 | | appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the |
19 | | funding obligations created under this Section. |
20 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the |
21 | | Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State |
22 | | Contribution Target for each Organizational Unit under |
23 | | this Section. No Evidence-Based Funding shall be |
24 | | distributed within an Organizational Unit without the |
25 | | approval of the unit's school board. |
26 | | (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 269 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate |
2 | | financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the |
3 | | Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State |
4 | | Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for |
5 | | each Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds |
6 | | allocated for its students with disabilities. The State |
7 | | Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for |
8 | | each Organizational Unit the amount of funding and |
9 | | applicable FTE calculated for each Essential Element of the |
10 | | unit's Adequacy Target. |
11 | | (4) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate |
12 | | and report to each Organizational Unit the amount the unit |
13 | | must expend on special education and bilingual education |
14 | | and computer technology and equipment for Organizational |
15 | | Units assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 that received an |
16 | | additional $285.50 per student computer technology and |
17 | | equipment investment grant to their Adequacy Target |
18 | | pursuant to the unit's Base Funding Minimum, Special |
19 | | Education Allocation, Bilingual Education Allocation, and |
20 | | computer technology and equipment investment allocation. |
21 | | (5) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be |
22 | | calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal |
23 | | year basis, with payments beginning in August and extending |
24 | | through June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys |
25 | | appropriated for each fiscal year shall be distributed in |
26 | | 22 equal payments at least 2 times monthly to each |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 270 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit. If moneys appropriated for any fiscal |
2 | | year are distributed other than monthly, the distribution |
3 | | shall be on the same basis for each Organizational Unit. |
4 | | (6) Any school district that fails, for any given |
5 | | school year, to maintain school as required by law or to |
6 | | maintain a recognized school is not eligible to receive |
7 | | Evidence-Based Funding. In case of non-recognition of one |
8 | | or more attendance centers in a school district otherwise |
9 | | operating recognized schools, the claim of the district |
10 | | shall be reduced in the proportion that the enrollment in |
11 | | the attendance center or centers bears to the enrollment of |
12 | | the school district. "Recognized school" means any public |
13 | | school that meets the standards for recognition by the |
14 | | State Board. A school district or attendance center not |
15 | | having recognition status at the end of a school term is |
16 | | entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal |
17 | | claim that was filed while it was recognized. |
18 | | (7) School district claims filed under this Section are |
19 | | subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as |
20 | | otherwise provided in this Section. |
21 | | (8) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall |
22 | | calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its |
23 | | Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall |
24 | | be deemed attributable to the provision of special |
25 | | educational facilities and services, as defined in Section |
26 | | 14-1.08 of this Code, in a manner that ensures compliance |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 271 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | with maintenance of State financial support requirements |
2 | | under the federal Individuals with Disabilities Education |
3 | | Act. An Organizational Unit must use such funds only for |
4 | | the provision of special educational facilities and |
5 | | services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code, and |
6 | | must comply with any expenditure verification procedures |
7 | | adopted by the State Board. |
8 | | (9) All Organizational Units in this State must submit |
9 | | annual spending plans by the end of September of each year |
10 | | to the State Board as part of the annual budget process, |
11 | | which shall describe how each Organizational Unit will |
12 | | utilize the Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based |
13 | | Funding it receives from this State under this Section with |
14 | | specific identification of the intended utilization of |
15 | | Low-Income, English learner, and special education |
16 | | resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans of each |
17 | | Organizational Unit shall describe how the Organizational |
18 | | Unit expects to achieve student growth and how the |
19 | | Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as |
20 | | defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may, |
21 | | from time to time, identify additional requisites for |
22 | | Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual |
23 | | spending plans required under this subsection (h). The |
24 | | format and scope of annual spending plans shall be |
25 | | developed by the State Superintendent and the State Board |
26 | | of Education. School districts that serve students under |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 272 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Article 14C of this Code shall continue to submit |
2 | | information as required under Section 14C-12 of this Code. |
3 | | (10) No later than January 1, 2018, the State |
4 | | Superintendent shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for |
5 | | all Organizational Units to help in planning for adequacy |
6 | | funding under this Section. The State Superintendent shall |
7 | | submit the plan to the Governor and the General Assembly, |
8 | | as provided in Section 3.1 of the General Assembly |
9 | | Organization Act. The plan shall include recommendations |
10 | | for: |
11 | | (A) a framework for collaborative, professional, |
12 | | innovative, and 21st century learning environments |
13 | | using the Evidence-Based Funding model; |
14 | | (B) ways to prepare and support this State's |
15 | | educators for successful instructional careers; |
16 | | (C) application and enhancement of the current |
17 | | financial accountability measures, the approved State |
18 | | plan to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds |
19 | | Act, and the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures |
20 | | in relation to student growth and elements of the |
21 | | Evidence-Based Funding model; and |
22 | | (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy |
23 | | funding system based on projected and recommended |
24 | | funding levels from the General Assembly. |
25 | | (11) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent
must |
26 | | recalibrate all of the following per pupil elements of the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 273 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Adequacy Target and applied to the formulas, based on the |
2 | | study of average expenses and as reported in the most |
3 | | recent annual financial report: |
4 | | (A) Gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph
(2) |
5 | | of subsection (b). |
6 | | (B) Instructional materials under subparagraph
(O) |
7 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
8 | | (C) Assessment under subparagraph (P) of
paragraph |
9 | | (2) of subsection (b). |
10 | | (D) Student activities under subparagraph (R) of
|
11 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
12 | | (E) Maintenance and operations under subparagraph
|
13 | | (S) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
14 | | (F) Central office under subparagraph (T) of
|
15 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
16 | | (i) Professional Review Panel. |
17 | | (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and |
18 | | review topics related to the implementation and effect of |
19 | | Evidence-Based Funding, as assigned by a joint resolution |
20 | | or Public Act of the General Assembly or a motion passed by |
21 | | the State Board of Education. The Panel must provide |
22 | | recommendations to and serve the Governor, the General |
23 | | Assembly, and the State Board. The State Superintendent or |
24 | | his or her designee must serve as a voting member and |
25 | | chairperson of the Panel. The State Superintendent must |
26 | | appoint a vice chairperson from the membership of the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 274 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Panel. The Panel must advance recommendations based on a |
2 | | three-fifths majority vote of Panel members present and |
3 | | voting. A minority opinion may also accompany any |
4 | | recommendation of the Panel. The Panel shall be appointed |
5 | | by the State Superintendent, except as otherwise provided |
6 | | in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i) and include the |
7 | | following members: |
8 | | (A) Two appointees that represent district |
9 | | superintendents, recommended by a statewide |
10 | | organization that represents district superintendents. |
11 | | (B) Two appointees that represent school boards, |
12 | | recommended by a statewide organization that |
13 | | represents school boards. |
14 | | (C) Two appointees from districts that represent |
15 | | school business officials, recommended by a statewide |
16 | | organization that represents school business |
17 | | officials. |
18 | | (D) Two appointees that represent school |
19 | | principals, recommended by a statewide organization |
20 | | that represents school principals. |
21 | | (E) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
22 | | recommended by a statewide organization that |
23 | | represents teachers. |
24 | | (F) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
25 | | recommended by another statewide organization that |
26 | | represents teachers. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 275 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (G) Two appointees that represent regional |
2 | | superintendents of schools, recommended by |
3 | | organizations that represent regional superintendents. |
4 | | (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the |
5 | | State Superintendent. |
6 | | (I) Two independent experts recommended by public |
7 | | universities in this State. |
8 | | (J) One member recommended by a statewide |
9 | | organization that represents parents. |
10 | | (K) Two representatives recommended by collective |
11 | | impact organizations that represent major metropolitan |
12 | | areas or geographic areas in Illinois. |
13 | | (L) One member from a statewide organization |
14 | | focused on research-based education policy to support |
15 | | a school system that prepares all students for college, |
16 | | a career, and democratic citizenship. |
17 | | (M) One representative from a school district |
18 | | organized under Article 34 of this Code. |
19 | | The State Superintendent shall ensure that the |
20 | | membership of the Panel includes representatives from |
21 | | school districts and communities reflecting the |
22 | | geographic, socio-economic, racial, and ethnic diversity |
23 | | of this State. The State Superintendent shall additionally |
24 | | ensure that the membership of the Panel includes |
25 | | representatives with expertise in bilingual education and |
26 | | special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 276 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the Panel. |
2 | | (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the |
3 | | State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly |
4 | | shall be appointed as follows: one member of the House of |
5 | | Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of |
6 | | Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the |
7 | | President of the Senate, one member of the House of |
8 | | Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the |
9 | | House of Representatives, and one member of the Senate |
10 | | appointed by the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall |
11 | | be one additional member appointed by the Governor. All |
12 | | members appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor |
13 | | shall be non-voting, ex officio members. |
14 | | (3) The Panel must study topics at the direction of the |
15 | | General Assembly or State Board of Education, as provided |
16 | | under paragraph (1). The Panel may also study the following |
17 | | topics at the direction of the chairperson: |
18 | | (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans |
19 | | referenced in paragraph (9) of subsection (h) of this |
20 | | Section. |
21 | | (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section. |
22 | | (C) Maintenance and operations, including capital |
23 | | maintenance and construction costs. |
24 | | (D) "At-risk student" definition. |
25 | | (E) Benefits. |
26 | | (F) Technology. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 277 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (G) Local Capacity Target. |
2 | | (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory |
3 | | Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning |
4 | | opportunities programs. |
5 | | (I) Funding for college and career acceleration |
6 | | strategies. |
7 | | (J) Special education investments. |
8 | | (K) Early childhood investments, in collaboration |
9 | | with the Illinois Early Learning Council. |
10 | | (4) (Blank). |
11 | | (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this |
12 | | Section, and every 5 years thereafter, the Panel shall |
13 | | complete an evaluative study of the entire Evidence-Based |
14 | | Funding model, including an assessment of whether or not |
15 | | the formula is achieving State goals. The Panel shall |
16 | | report to the State Board, the General Assembly, and the |
17 | | Governor on the findings of the study. |
18 | | (6) (Blank). |
19 | | (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other |
20 | | laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section |
21 | | 18-8.05 of this Code (now repealed) shall be deemed to be |
22 | | references to evidence-based model formula funds or |
23 | | calculations under this Section.
|
24 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-578, eff. 1-31-18; |
25 | | 100-582, eff. 3-23-18; 101-10, eff. 6-5-19; 101-17, eff. |
26 | | 6-14-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20; revised 8-21-20.) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 278 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (105 ILCS 5/27-22) (from Ch. 122, par. 27-22)
|
2 | | Sec. 27-22. Required high school courses.
|
3 | | (a) (Blank).
|
4 | | (b) (Blank). |
5 | | (c) (Blank). |
6 | | (d) (Blank). |
7 | | (e) As a prerequisite to receiving a high school diploma, |
8 | | each pupil
entering the 9th grade must, in addition to other |
9 | | course requirements, successfully
complete all of the |
10 | | following courses: |
11 | | (1) Four years of language arts. |
12 | | (2) Two years of writing intensive courses, one of |
13 | | which must be English and the other of which may be English |
14 | | or any other subject. When applicable, writing-intensive |
15 | | courses may be counted towards the fulfillment of other |
16 | | graduation requirements.
|
17 | | (3) Three years of mathematics, one of which must be |
18 | | Algebra I, one of which must include geometry content, and |
19 | | one of which may be an Advanced Placement computer science |
20 | | course. A mathematics course that includes geometry |
21 | | content may be offered as an integrated, applied, |
22 | | interdisciplinary, or career and technical education |
23 | | course that prepares a student for a career readiness path. |
24 | | (3.5) For pupils entering the 9th grade in the |
25 | | 2021-2022 school year and each school year thereafter, one |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 279 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | year of a course that includes intensive instruction in |
2 | | computer literacy, which may be English, social studies, or |
3 | | any other subject and which may be counted toward the |
4 | | fulfillment of other graduation requirements. |
5 | | (4) Two years of science. |
6 | | (5) Two years of social studies, of which at least one |
7 | | year must be history of the United States or a combination |
8 | | of history of the United States and American government |
9 | | and, beginning with pupils entering the 9th grade in the |
10 | | 2016-2017 school year and each school year thereafter, at |
11 | | least one semester must be civics, which shall help young |
12 | | people acquire and learn to use the skills, knowledge, and |
13 | | attitudes that will prepare them to be competent and |
14 | | responsible citizens throughout their lives. Civics course |
15 | | content shall focus on government institutions, the |
16 | | discussion of current and controversial issues, service |
17 | | learning, and simulations of the democratic process. |
18 | | School districts may utilize private funding available for |
19 | | the purposes of offering civics education. |
20 | | (6) One year chosen from (A) music, (B) art, (C) |
21 | | foreign language, which shall be deemed to include American |
22 | | Sign Language, or (D) vocational education. |
23 | | (f) The State Board of Education shall develop and inform |
24 | | school districts of standards for writing-intensive |
25 | | coursework.
|
26 | | (f-5) If a school district offers an Advanced Placement |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 280 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | computer science course to high school students, then the |
2 | | school board must designate that course as equivalent to a high |
3 | | school mathematics course and must denote on the student's |
4 | | transcript that the Advanced Placement computer science course |
5 | | qualifies as a mathematics-based, quantitative course for |
6 | | students in accordance with subdivision (3) of subsection (e) |
7 | | of this Section. |
8 | | (g) This amendatory Act of 1983 does not apply to pupils |
9 | | entering the 9th grade
in 1983-1984 school year and prior |
10 | | school years or to students
with disabilities whose course of |
11 | | study is determined by an individualized
education program.
|
12 | | This amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly does not |
13 | | apply
to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2004-2005 school |
14 | | year or a prior
school year or to students with disabilities |
15 | | whose course of study is
determined by an individualized |
16 | | education program.
|
17 | | This amendatory Act of the 101st General Assembly does not |
18 | | apply
to pupils entering the 9th grade in the 2020-2021 school |
19 | | year or a prior
school year or to students with disabilities |
20 | | whose course of study is
determined by an individualized |
21 | | education program. |
22 | | (h) The provisions of this Section are subject to the |
23 | | provisions of
Section
27-22.05 of this Code and the |
24 | | Postsecondary and Workforce Readiness Act.
|
25 | | (i) The State Board of Education may adopt rules to modify |
26 | | the requirements of this Section for any students enrolled in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 281 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | grades 9 through 12 if the Governor has declared a disaster due |
2 | | to a public health emergency pursuant to Section 7 of the |
3 | | Illinois Emergency Management Agency Act. |
4 | | (Source: P.A. 100-443, eff. 8-25-17; 101-464, eff. 1-1-20; |
5 | | 101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
|
6 | | (105 ILCS 5/27-23.15 new) |
7 | | Sec. 27-23.15. Computer science. |
8 | | (a) In this Section, "computer science" means the study of |
9 | | computers and algorithms, including their principles, their |
10 | | hardware and software designs, their implementation, and their |
11 | | impact on society. "Computer science" does not include the |
12 | | study of everyday uses of computers and computer applications, |
13 | | such as keyboarding or accessing the Internet. |
14 | | (b) Beginning with the 2022-2023 school year, the school |
15 | | board of a school district that maintains any of grades 9 |
16 | | through 12 shall provide an opportunity for every high school |
17 | | student to take at least one computer science course aligned to |
18 | | rigorous learning standards of the State Board of Education. |
19 | | Article 65. |
20 | | Section 65-5. The School Code is amended by changing |
21 | | Sections 14A-10 and 14A-32 as follows: |
22 | | (105 ILCS 5/14A-10)
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 282 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 14A-10. Legislative findings. The General Assembly |
2 | | finds the following: |
3 | | (1) that gifted and talented children (i) exhibit high |
4 | | performance capabilities in intellectual, creative, and |
5 | | artistic areas, (ii) possess an exceptional leadership |
6 | | potential, (iii) excel in specific academic fields, and |
7 | | (iv) have the potential to be influential in business, |
8 | | government, health care, the arts, and other critical |
9 | | sectors of our economic and cultural environment; |
10 | | (2) that gifted and talented children require services |
11 | | and activities that are not ordinarily provided by schools; |
12 | | and |
13 | | (3) that outstanding talents are present in children |
14 | | and youth from all cultural groups, across all economic |
15 | | strata, and in all areas of human endeavor ; and . |
16 | | (4) that inequitable access to advanced coursework and |
17 | | enrollment in accelerated placement programs exists |
18 | | between children enrolled in different school districts |
19 | | and even within the same school district and more must be |
20 | | done to eliminate the barriers to access to advanced |
21 | | coursework and enrollment in accelerated placement |
22 | | programs for all children.
|
23 | | (Source: P.A. 94-151, eff. 7-8-05; 94-410, eff. 8-2-05.) |
24 | | (105 ILCS 5/14A-32) |
25 | | Sec. 14A-32. Accelerated placement; school district |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 283 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | responsibilities. |
2 | | (a) Each school district shall have a policy that allows |
3 | | for accelerated placement that includes or incorporates by |
4 | | reference the following components: |
5 | | (1) a provision that provides that participation in |
6 | | accelerated placement is not limited to those children who |
7 | | have been identified as gifted and talented, but rather is |
8 | | open to all children who demonstrate high ability and who |
9 | | may benefit from accelerated placement; |
10 | | (2) a fair and equitable decision-making process that |
11 | | involves multiple persons and includes a student's parents |
12 | | or guardians; |
13 | | (3) procedures for notifying parents or guardians of a |
14 | | child of a decision affecting that child's participation in |
15 | | an accelerated placement program; and |
16 | | (4) an assessment process that includes multiple |
17 | | valid, reliable indicators. |
18 | | (a-5) By no later than the beginning of the 2022-2023 |
19 | | school year, a school district's accelerated placement policy |
20 | | shall allow for the automatic enrollment, in the following |
21 | | school term, of a high school student into the next level of |
22 | | advanced coursework offered by the high school if the student |
23 | | meets or exceeds State standards in English language arts, |
24 | | mathematics, or science on a State assessment administered |
25 | | under Section 2-3.64a-5 as follows: |
26 | | (1) A student who meets or exceeds State standards in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 284 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | English language arts shall be automatically enrolled into |
2 | | the next level of advanced coursework in English, social |
3 | | studies, humanities, or related subjects. |
4 | | (2) A student who meets or exceeds State standards in |
5 | | mathematics shall be automatically enrolled into the next |
6 | | level of advanced coursework in mathematics. |
7 | | (3) A student who meets or exceeds State standards in |
8 | | science shall be automatically enrolled into the next level |
9 | | of advanced coursework in science. |
10 | | For a student entering grade 12, the next level of advanced |
11 | | coursework under this subsection (a-5) shall be a dual credit |
12 | | course, as defined in the Dual Credit Quality Act. For other |
13 | | high school grades, the next level of advanced coursework may |
14 | | include a dual credit course. |
15 | | A school district may use the student's most recent State |
16 | | assessment results to determine whether a student meets or |
17 | | exceeds State standards. For a student entering grade 9, |
18 | | results from the State assessment taken in grades 6 through 8 |
19 | | may be used. For other high school grades, the results from a |
20 | | locally selected, nationally normed assessment may be used |
21 | | instead of the State assessment if those results are the most |
22 | | recent. |
23 | | A school district must provide the parent or guardian of a |
24 | | student eligible for automatic enrollment under this |
25 | | subsection (a-5) with the option to instead have the student |
26 | | enroll in alternative coursework that better aligns with the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 285 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | student's postsecondary education or career goals. |
2 | | Nothing in this subsection (a-5) may be interpreted to |
3 | | preclude other students from enrolling in advanced coursework |
4 | | per the policy of a school district. |
5 | | (b) Further, a school district's accelerated placement |
6 | | policy may include or incorporate by reference, but need not be |
7 | | limited to, the following components: |
8 | | (1) procedures for annually informing the community |
9 | | at-large, including parents or guardians, community-based |
10 | | organizations, and providers of out-of-school programs, |
11 | | about the accelerated placement program and the methods |
12 | | used for the identification of children eligible for |
13 | | accelerated placement , including strategies to reach |
14 | | groups of students and families who have been historically |
15 | | underrepresented in accelerated placement programs and |
16 | | advanced coursework ; |
17 | | (2) a process for referral that allows for multiple |
18 | | referrers, including a child's parents or guardians; other |
19 | | referrers may include licensed education professionals, |
20 | | the child, with the written consent of a parent or |
21 | | guardian, a peer, through a licensed education |
22 | | professional who has knowledge of the referred child's |
23 | | abilities, or, in case of possible early entrance, a |
24 | | preschool educator, pediatrician, or psychologist who |
25 | | knows the child; and |
26 | | (3) a provision that provides that children |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 286 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | participating in an accelerated placement program and |
2 | | their parents or guardians will be provided a written plan |
3 | | detailing the type of acceleration the child will receive |
4 | | and strategies to support the child ; . |
5 | | (4) procedures to provide support and promote success |
6 | | for students who are newly enrolled in an accelerated |
7 | | placement program; and |
8 | | (5) a process for the school district to review and |
9 | | utilize disaggregated data on participation in an |
10 | | accelerated placement program to address gaps among |
11 | | demographic groups in accelerated placement opportunities. |
12 | | (c) The State Board of Education shall adopt rules to |
13 | | determine data to be collected and disaggregated by demographic |
14 | | group regarding accelerated placement , including the rates of |
15 | | students who participate in and successfully complete advanced |
16 | | coursework, and a method of making the information available to |
17 | | the public.
|
18 | | (d) On or before November 1, 2021, following a review of |
19 | | disaggregated data on the participation and successful |
20 | | completion rates of students enrolled in an accelerated |
21 | | placement program, each school district shall develop a plan to |
22 | | expand access to its accelerated placement program and to |
23 | | ensure the teaching capacity necessary to meet the increased |
24 | | demand. |
25 | | (Source: P.A. 100-421, eff. 7-1-18 .) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 287 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Article 70. |
2 | | Section 70-5. The School Code is amended by changing |
3 | | Section 22-45 as follows: |
4 | | (105 ILCS 5/22-45) |
5 | | Sec. 22-45. Illinois P-20 Council. |
6 | | (a) The General Assembly finds that preparing Illinoisans |
7 | | for success in school and the workplace requires a continuum of |
8 | | quality education from preschool through graduate school. This |
9 | | State needs a framework to guide education policy and integrate |
10 | | education at every level. A statewide coordinating council to |
11 | | study and make recommendations concerning education at all |
12 | | levels can avoid fragmentation of policies, promote improved |
13 | | teaching and learning, and continue to cultivate and |
14 | | demonstrate strong accountability and efficiency. Establishing |
15 | | an Illinois P-20 Council will develop a statewide agenda that |
16 | | will move the State towards the common goals of improving |
17 | | academic achievement, increasing college access and success, |
18 | | improving use of existing data and measurements, developing |
19 | | improved accountability, fostering innovative approaches to |
20 | | education, promoting lifelong learning, easing the transition |
21 | | to college, and reducing remediation. A pre-kindergarten |
22 | | through grade 20 agenda will strengthen this State's economic |
23 | | competitiveness by producing a highly-skilled workforce. In |
24 | | addition, lifelong learning plans will enhance this State's |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 288 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | ability to leverage funding. |
2 | | (b) There is created the Illinois P-20 Council. The |
3 | | Illinois P-20 Council shall include all of the following |
4 | | members: |
5 | | (1) The Governor or his or her designee, to serve as |
6 | | chairperson. |
7 | | (2) Four members of the General Assembly, one appointed |
8 | | by the Speaker of the House of Representatives, one |
9 | | appointed by the Minority Leader of the House of |
10 | | Representatives, one appointed by the President of the |
11 | | Senate, and one appointed by the Minority Leader of the |
12 | | Senate. |
13 | | (3) Six at-large members appointed by the Governor as |
14 | | follows, with 2 members being from the City of Chicago, 2
|
15 | | members being from Lake County, McHenry County, Kane
|
16 | | County, DuPage County, Will County, or that part of Cook
|
17 | | County outside of the City of Chicago, and 2 members being
|
18 | | from the remainder of the State: |
19 | | (A) one representative of civic leaders; |
20 | | (B) one representative of local government; |
21 | | (C) one representative of trade unions; |
22 | | (D) one representative of nonprofit organizations |
23 | | or foundations; |
24 | | (E) one representative of parents' organizations; |
25 | | and |
26 | | (F) one education research expert. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 289 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) Five members appointed by statewide business |
2 | | organizations and business trade associations. |
3 | | (5) Six members appointed by statewide professional |
4 | | organizations and associations representing |
5 | | pre-kindergarten through grade 20 teachers, community |
6 | | college faculty, and public university faculty. |
7 | | (6) Two members appointed by associations representing |
8 | | local school administrators and school board members. One |
9 | | of these members must be a special education administrator. |
10 | | (7) One member representing community colleges, |
11 | | appointed by the Illinois Council of Community College |
12 | | Presidents. |
13 | | (8) One member representing 4-year independent |
14 | | colleges and universities, appointed by a statewide |
15 | | organization representing private institutions of higher |
16 | | learning. |
17 | | (9) One member representing public 4-year |
18 | | universities, appointed jointly by the university |
19 | | presidents and chancellors. |
20 | | (10) Ex-officio members as follows: |
21 | | (A) The State Superintendent of Education or his or |
22 | | her designee. |
23 | | (B) The Executive Director of the Board of Higher
|
24 | | Education or his or her designee. |
25 | | (C) The Executive Director of the Illinois |
26 | | Community College Board or his or her designee. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 290 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (D) The Executive Director of the Illinois Student |
2 | | Assistance Commission or his or her designee. |
3 | | (E) The Co-chairpersons of the Illinois Workforce |
4 | | Investment Board or their designee. |
5 | | (F) The Director of Commerce and Economic |
6 | | Opportunity or his or her designee. |
7 | | (G) The Chairperson of the Illinois Early Learning |
8 | | Council or his or her designee. |
9 | | (H) The President of the Illinois Mathematics and |
10 | | Science Academy or his or her designee. |
11 | | (I) The president of an association representing |
12 | | educators of adult learners or his or her
designee. |
13 | | Ex-officio members shall have no vote on the Illinois P-20 |
14 | | Council. |
15 | | Appointed members shall serve for staggered terms expiring |
16 | | on July 1 of the first, second, or third calendar year |
17 | | following their appointments or until their successors are |
18 | | appointed and have qualified. Staggered terms shall be |
19 | | determined by lot at the organizing meeting of the Illinois |
20 | | P-20 Council. |
21 | | Vacancies shall be filled in the same manner as original |
22 | | appointments, and any member so appointed shall serve during |
23 | | the remainder of the term for which the vacancy occurred. |
24 | | (c) The Illinois P-20 Council shall be funded through State |
25 | | appropriations to support staff activities, research, |
26 | | data-collection, and dissemination. The Illinois P-20 Council |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 291 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | shall be staffed by the Office of the Governor, in coordination |
2 | | with relevant State agencies, boards, and commissions. The |
3 | | Illinois Education Research Council shall provide research and |
4 | | coordinate research collection activities for the Illinois |
5 | | P-20 Council. |
6 | | (d) The Illinois P-20 Council shall have all of the |
7 | | following duties: |
8 | | (1) To make recommendations to do all of the following: |
9 | | (A) Coordinate pre-kindergarten through grade 20 |
10 | | (graduate school) education in this State through |
11 | | working at the intersections of educational systems to |
12 | | promote collaborative infrastructure. |
13 | | (B) Coordinate and leverage strategies, actions, |
14 | | legislation, policies, and resources of all |
15 | | stakeholders to support fundamental and lasting |
16 | | improvement in this State's public schools, community |
17 | | colleges, and universities. |
18 | | (C) Better align the high school curriculum with |
19 | | postsecondary expectations. |
20 | | (D) Better align assessments across all levels of |
21 | | education. |
22 | | (E) Reduce the need for students entering |
23 | | institutions of higher education to take remedial |
24 | | courses. |
25 | | (F) Smooth the transition from high school to |
26 | | college. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 292 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (G) Improve high school and college graduation |
2 | | rates. |
3 | | (H) Improve the rigor and relevance of academic |
4 | | standards for college and workforce readiness. |
5 | | (I) Better align college and university teaching |
6 | | programs with the needs of Illinois schools. |
7 | | (2) To advise the Governor, the General Assembly, the |
8 | | State's education and higher education agencies, and the
|
9 | | State's workforce and economic development boards and
|
10 | | agencies on policies related to lifelong learning for |
11 | | Illinois students and families. |
12 | | (3) To articulate a framework for systemic educational |
13 | | improvement and innovation that will enable every student |
14 | | to meet or exceed Illinois learning standards and be |
15 | | well-prepared to succeed in the workforce and community. |
16 | | (4) To provide an estimated fiscal impact for |
17 | | implementation of all Council recommendations. |
18 | | (5) To make recommendations for short-term and |
19 | | long-term learning recovery actions for public school |
20 | | students in this State in the wake of the COVID-19 |
21 | | pandemic. The Illinois P-20 Council shall submit a report |
22 | | with its recommendations for a multi-year recovery plan by |
23 | | December 31, 2021 to the Governor, the State Board of |
24 | | Education, the Board of Higher Education, the Illinois |
25 | | Community College Board, and the General Assembly that |
26 | | addresses all of the following: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 293 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (A) Closing the digital divide for all students, |
2 | | including access to devices, Internet connectivity, |
3 | | and ensuring that educators have the necessary support |
4 | | and training to provide high quality remote and blended |
5 | | learning to students. |
6 | | (B) Evaluating the academic growth and proficiency |
7 | | of students in order to understand the impact of school |
8 | | closures and remote and blended remote learning |
9 | | conditions on student academic outcomes, including |
10 | | disaggregating data by race, income, diverse learners, |
11 | | and English learners, in ways that balance the need to |
12 | | understand that impact with the need to support student |
13 | | well-being and also take into consideration the |
14 | | logistical constraints facing schools and districts. |
15 | | (C) Establishing a system for the collection and |
16 | | review of student data at the State level, including |
17 | | data about prekindergarten through higher education |
18 | | student attendance, engagement and participation, |
19 | | discipline, and social-emotional and mental health |
20 | | inputs and outcomes, in order to better understand the |
21 | | full impact of disrupted learning. |
22 | | (D) Providing students with resources and programs |
23 | | for academic support, such as enrichment |
24 | | opportunities, tutoring corps, summer bridge programs, |
25 | | youth leadership and development programs, youth and |
26 | | community-led restorative and transformative justice |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 294 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | programs, and youth internship and apprenticeship |
2 | | programs. |
3 | | (E) Providing students with resources and support |
4 | | to ensure access to social-emotional learning, mental |
5 | | health services, and trauma responsive, restorative |
6 | | justice and anti-racist practices in order to support |
7 | | the growth of the whole child, such as investing in |
8 | | community schools and providing comprehensive |
9 | | year-round services and support for both students and |
10 | | their families. |
11 | | (F) Ensuring more time for students' academic, |
12 | | social-emotional, and mental health needs by |
13 | | considering such strategies as: (i) extending planning |
14 | | time for teachers, (ii) extending the school day and |
15 | | school year, and (iii) transitioning to year-round |
16 | | schooling. |
17 | | (G) Strengthening the transition from secondary |
18 | | education to postsecondary education in the wake of |
19 | | threats to alignment and affordability created by the |
20 | | pandemic and related conditions. |
21 | | (e) The chairperson of the Illinois P-20 Council may |
22 | | authorize the creation of working groups focusing on areas of |
23 | | interest to Illinois educational and workforce development, |
24 | | including without limitation the following areas: |
25 | | (1) Preparation, recruitment, and certification of |
26 | | highly qualified teachers. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 295 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) Mentoring and induction of highly qualified |
2 | | teachers. |
3 | | (3) The diversity of highly qualified teachers. |
4 | | (4) Funding for highly qualified teachers, including |
5 | | developing a strategic and collaborative plan to seek |
6 | | federal and private grants to support initiatives |
7 | | targeting teacher preparation and its impact on student |
8 | | achievement. |
9 | | (5) Highly effective administrators. |
10 | | (6) Illinois birth through age 3 education, |
11 | | pre-kindergarten, and early childhood education. |
12 | | (7) The assessment, alignment, outreach, and network |
13 | | of college and workforce readiness efforts. |
14 | | (8) Alternative routes to college access. |
15 | | (9) Research data and accountability. |
16 | | (10) Community schools, community participation, and |
17 | | other innovative approaches to education that foster |
18 | | community partnerships. |
19 | | (11) Tuition, financial aid, and other issues related |
20 | | to keeping postsecondary education affordable for Illinois |
21 | | residents. |
22 | | (12) Learning recovery in the wake of the COVID-19 |
23 | | pandemic. |
24 | | The chairperson of the Illinois P-20 Council may designate |
25 | | Council members to serve as working group chairpersons. Working |
26 | | groups may invite organizations and individuals representing |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 296 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | pre-kindergarten through grade 20 interests to participate in |
2 | | discussions, data collection, and dissemination.
|
3 | | (Source: P.A. 98-463, eff. 8-16-13; 98-719, eff. 1-1-15; |
4 | | 99-643, eff. 1-1-17 .) |
5 | | Article 75. |
6 | | Section 75-5. The State Finance Act is amended by adding |
7 | | Section 5.935 as follows: |
8 | | (30 ILCS 105/5.935 new) |
9 | | Sec. 5.935. The Freedom Schools Fund. |
10 | | Section 75-10. The School Code is amended by adding Section |
11 | | 2-3.186 as follows: |
12 | | (105 ILCS 5/2-3.186 new) |
13 | | Sec. 2-3.186. Freedom Schools; grant program. |
14 | | (a) The General Assembly recognizes and values the |
15 | | contributions that Freedom Schools make to enhance the lives of |
16 | | Black students. The General Assembly makes all of the following |
17 | | findings: |
18 | | (1) The fundamental goal of the Freedom Schools of the |
19 | | 1960s was to create Black political power to defend the |
20 | | interests of the disempowered. The curriculum of Freedom |
21 | | Schools allowed students of all ages to experience a new |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 297 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and liberating form of education that directly related to |
2 | | the imperatives of their lives, their communities, and the |
3 | | Freedom Movement. |
4 | | (2) Freedom Schools continue to demonstrate the proven |
5 | | benefits of race modeling and intergenerational effects by |
6 | | providing Black students with quality instruction that |
7 | | fosters student confidence, resiliency, and social and |
8 | | emotional development. |
9 | | (3) Freedom Schools offer culturally relevant learning |
10 | | opportunities with the academic and social supports that |
11 | | Black children need by utilizing quality teaching, |
12 | | challenging and engaging curricula, wrap-around supports, |
13 | | a positive school climate, and strong ties to family and |
14 | | community. Freedom Schools have a clear focus on results. |
15 | | (4) Public schools serve a foundational role in the |
16 | | education of over 2,000,000 students in this State. |
17 | | (b) The State Board of Education shall establish Freedom |
18 | | Schools to supplement the learning taking place in public |
19 | | schools by expanding the teaching of Black history, developing |
20 | | leadership skills, and providing an understanding of the tenets |
21 | | of the civil rights movement. The teachers in Freedom Schools |
22 | | must be college students or recent high school graduates from |
23 | | the local community, with an emphasis on Black youth, so that |
24 | | (i) these individuals have access to summer jobs and teaching |
25 | | experiences that serve as a long-term pipeline to educational |
26 | | careers and the hiring of Black educators in public schools, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 298 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (ii) these individuals are elevated as content experts and |
2 | | community leaders, and (iii) Freedom School students have |
3 | | access to both role models and education. |
4 | | (c) A Freedom School shall intentionally and imaginatively |
5 | | implement strategies that focus on all of the following: |
6 | | (1) Racial justice and equity. |
7 | | (2) Transparency and building trusting relationships. |
8 | | (3) Self-determination and governance. |
9 | | (4) Building on community strengths and community |
10 | | wisdom. |
11 | | (5) Utilizing current data, best practices, and |
12 | | evidence. |
13 | | (6) Shared leadership and collaboration. |
14 | | (7) A reflective learning culture. |
15 | | (8) A whole-child approach to education. |
16 | | (9) Literacy. |
17 | | (d) The State Board of Education, in the establishment of |
18 | | Freedom Schools, shall strive for authentic parent and |
19 | | community engagement during the development of Freedom Schools |
20 | | and their curriculum. Authentic parent and community |
21 | | engagement includes all of the following: |
22 | | (1) A shared responsibility that values equal |
23 | | partnerships between families and professionals. |
24 | | (2) Ensuring that students and families who are |
25 | | directly impacted by Freedom School policies and practices |
26 | | are the decision-makers in the creation, design, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 299 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | implementation, and assessment of those policies and |
2 | | practices. |
3 | | (3) Genuine respect for the culture and diversity of |
4 | | families. |
5 | | (4) Relationships that center around the goal of |
6 | | supporting family well-being and children's development |
7 | | and learning. |
8 | | (e) Subject to appropriation, the State Board of Education |
9 | | shall establish and implement a grant program to provide grants |
10 | | to public schools, public community colleges, and |
11 | | not-for-profit, community-based organizations to facilitate |
12 | | improved educational outcomes for Black students in grades |
13 | | pre-kindergarten through 12. Grant recipients under the |
14 | | program may include, but are not limited to, entities that |
15 | | offer established programs with proven results and outcomes. |
16 | | The State Board of Education shall award grants to eligible |
17 | | entities that demonstrate a likelihood of reasonable success in |
18 | | achieving the goals identified in the grant application, |
19 | | including, but not limited to, all of the following: |
20 | | (1) Engaging, culturally relevant, and challenging |
21 | | curricula. |
22 | | (2) High-quality teaching. |
23 | | (3) Wrap-around supports and opportunities. |
24 | | (4) Positive discipline practices, such as restorative |
25 | | justice. |
26 | | (5) Inclusive leadership. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 300 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (f) The Freedom Schools Fund is created as a special fund |
2 | | in the State treasury. the Fund shall consist of appropriations |
3 | | from the General Revenue Fund, grant funds from the
federal |
4 | | government, and donations from educational and private |
5 | | foundations. All money in the Fund shall be used, subject to |
6 | | appropriation, by the State Board of Education for the purposes |
7 | | of this Section and to support related activities. |
8 | | (g) The State Board of Education may adopt any rules |
9 | | necessary to implement this Section. |
10 | | Article 80. |
11 | | Section 80-5. The School Code is amended by changing |
12 | | Section 10-19 as follows:
|
13 | | (105 ILCS 5/10-19) (from Ch. 122, par. 10-19)
|
14 | | Sec. 10-19. Length of school term ; - experimental programs. |
15 | | Each school
board shall annually prepare a calendar for the |
16 | | school term, specifying
the opening and closing dates and |
17 | | providing a minimum term of at least 185
days to ensure insure |
18 | | 176 days of actual pupil attendance, computable under Section |
19 | | 10-19.05, except that for each of the 2021-2022, 2022-2023, and |
20 | | 2023-2024 school years, each school board, including a school |
21 | | board operating one or more schools on a full year school plan |
22 | | pursuant to Section 10-19.1, shall include in its calendar a |
23 | | minimum of an additional 15 days of actual pupil attendance and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 301 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 5 days of in-service training for teachers. A school board may |
2 | | choose how to reach the minimum of 15 additional days of actual |
3 | | pupil attendance for each of the 2021-2022, 2022-2023, and |
4 | | 2023-2024 school years by either extending the length of the |
5 | | school day or extending the length of the school term. During |
6 | | the 2021-2022 school year, if a school is closed for more than |
7 | | 5 days of actual pupil attendance because the Governor has |
8 | | declared a disaster due to a public health emergency pursuant |
9 | | to Section 7 of the Illinois Emergency Management Agency Act, |
10 | | the school board shall extend the length of the school day or |
11 | | extend the length of the school term during any of the |
12 | | 2021-2022, 2022-2023, and 2023-2024 school years by one |
13 | | additional day of actual pupil attendance for every 5 days of |
14 | | actual pupil attendance that are missed during the 2021-2022 |
15 | | school year because of the public health emergency, unless the |
16 | | school board has decided at the beginning of the 2021-2022 |
17 | | school year to implement a plan to use remote learning or |
18 | | blended remote learning under Section 10-30 or 34-18.66 for the |
19 | | 1980-1981 school year only 175 days
of actual
pupil attendance |
20 | | shall be required because of the closing of schools pursuant
to |
21 | | Section 24-2 on January 29, 1981 upon the appointment by the |
22 | | President
of that day as a day of thanksgiving for the freedom |
23 | | of the Americans who
had been held hostage in Iran . Any days |
24 | | allowed by law for teachers' institutes
but not used as such or |
25 | | used as parental institutes as provided
in Section 10-22.18d |
26 | | shall increase the minimum term by the school days not
so used. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 302 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Except as provided in Section 10-19.1, the board may not extend
|
2 | | the school term beyond the such closing date unless that |
3 | | extension of term is
necessary to provide the minimum number of |
4 | | computable days. In case of
such necessary extension , other |
5 | | than for the additional days of actual pupil attendance and |
6 | | in-service training for teachers required by this amendatory |
7 | | Act of the 101st General Assembly, school employees
shall be |
8 | | paid for such additional time on the basis of their regular
|
9 | | contracts. A school board may specify a closing date earlier |
10 | | than that
set on the annual calendar when the schools of the |
11 | | district have
provided the minimum number of computable days |
12 | | under this Section.
Nothing in this Section prevents the board |
13 | | from employing
superintendents of schools, principals and |
14 | | other nonteaching personnel
for a period of 12 months, or in |
15 | | the case of superintendents for a
period in accordance with |
16 | | Section 10-23.8, or prevents the board from
employing other |
17 | | personnel before or after the regular school term with
payment |
18 | | of salary proportionate to that received for comparable work
|
19 | | during the school term. Remote learning days, blended remote |
20 | | learning days, and up to 5 remote and blended remote learning |
21 | | planning days established under Section 10-30 or 34-18.66 shall |
22 | | be deemed pupil attendance days for calculation of the length |
23 | | of a school term under this Section.
|
24 | | A school board may make such changes in its calendar for |
25 | | the school term
as may be required by any changes in the legal |
26 | | school holidays prescribed
in Section 24-2. A school board may |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 303 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | make changes in its calendar for the
school term as may be |
2 | | necessary to reflect the utilization of teachers'
institute |
3 | | days as parental institute days as provided in Section |
4 | | 10-22.18d.
|
5 | | The calendar for the school term and any changes must be |
6 | | submitted to and approved by the regional superintendent of |
7 | | schools before the calendar or changes may take effect.
|
8 | | With the prior approval of the State Board of Education and |
9 | | subject
to review by the State Board of Education every 3 |
10 | | years, any school
board may, by resolution of its board and in |
11 | | agreement with affected
exclusive collective bargaining |
12 | | agents, establish experimental
educational programs, including |
13 | | but not limited to programs for e-learning days as authorized |
14 | | under Section 10-20.56 of this Code,
self-directed learning, or |
15 | | outside of formal class periods, which programs
when so |
16 | | approved shall be considered to comply with the requirements of
|
17 | | this Section as respects numbers of days of actual pupil |
18 | | attendance and
with the other requirements of this Code Act as |
19 | | respects courses of instruction.
|
20 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 101-12, eff. 7-1-19; |
21 | | 101-643, eff. 6-18-20.)
|
22 | | Article 85. |
23 | | Section 85-5. The School Code is amended by changing |
24 | | Section 18-8.15 as follows: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 304 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (105 ILCS 5/18-8.15) |
2 | | Sec. 18-8.15. Evidence-Based Funding for student success |
3 | | for the 2017-2018 and subsequent school years. |
4 | | (a) General provisions. |
5 | | (1) The purpose of this Section is to ensure that, by |
6 | | June 30, 2027 and beyond, this State has a kindergarten |
7 | | through grade 12 public education system with the capacity |
8 | | to ensure the educational development of all persons to the |
9 | | limits of their capacities in accordance with Section 1 of |
10 | | Article X of the Constitution of the State of Illinois. To |
11 | | accomplish that objective, this Section creates a method of |
12 | | funding public education that is evidence-based; is |
13 | | sufficient to ensure every student receives a meaningful |
14 | | opportunity to learn irrespective of race, ethnicity, |
15 | | sexual orientation, gender, or community-income level; and |
16 | | is sustainable and predictable. When fully funded under |
17 | | this Section, every school shall have the resources, based |
18 | | on what the evidence indicates is needed, to: |
19 | | (A) provide all students with a high quality |
20 | | education that offers the academic, enrichment, social |
21 | | and emotional support, technical, and career-focused |
22 | | programs that will allow them to become competitive |
23 | | workers, responsible parents, productive citizens of |
24 | | this State, and active members of our national |
25 | | democracy; |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 305 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (B) ensure all students receive the education they |
2 | | need to graduate from high school with the skills |
3 | | required to pursue post-secondary education and |
4 | | training for a rewarding career; |
5 | | (C) reduce, with a goal of eliminating, the |
6 | | achievement gap between at-risk and non-at-risk |
7 | | students by raising the performance of at-risk |
8 | | students and not by reducing standards; and |
9 | | (D) ensure this State satisfies its obligation to |
10 | | assume the primary responsibility to fund public |
11 | | education and simultaneously relieve the |
12 | | disproportionate burden placed on local property taxes |
13 | | to fund schools. |
14 | | (2) The Evidence-Based Funding formula under this |
15 | | Section shall be applied to all Organizational Units in |
16 | | this State. The Evidence-Based Funding formula outlined in |
17 | | this Act is based on the formula outlined in Senate Bill 1 |
18 | | of the 100th General Assembly, as passed by both |
19 | | legislative chambers. As further defined and described in |
20 | | this Section, there are 4 major components of the |
21 | | Evidence-Based Funding model: |
22 | | (A) First, the model calculates a unique Adequacy |
23 | | Target for each Organizational Unit in this State that |
24 | | considers the costs to implement research-based |
25 | | activities, the unit's student demographics, and |
26 | | regional wage differences. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 306 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (B) Second, the model calculates each |
2 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity, or the amount |
3 | | each Organizational Unit is assumed to contribute |
4 | | toward its Adequacy Target from local resources. |
5 | | (C) Third, the model calculates how much funding |
6 | | the State currently contributes to the Organizational |
7 | | Unit and adds that to the unit's Local Capacity to |
8 | | determine the unit's overall current adequacy of |
9 | | funding. |
10 | | (D) Finally, the model's distribution method |
11 | | allocates new State funding to those Organizational |
12 | | Units that are least well-funded, considering both |
13 | | Local Capacity and State funding, in relation to their |
14 | | Adequacy Target. |
15 | | (3) An Organizational Unit receiving any funding under |
16 | | this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received |
17 | | for which that Organizational Unit is authorized to make |
18 | | expenditures by law. |
19 | | (4) As used in this Section, the following terms shall |
20 | | have the meanings ascribed in this paragraph (4): |
21 | | "Adequacy Target" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
22 | | subsection (b) of this Section. |
23 | | "Adjusted EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of |
24 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
25 | | "Adjusted Local Capacity Target" is defined in |
26 | | paragraph (3) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 307 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Adjusted Operating Tax Rate" means a tax rate for all |
2 | | Organizational Units, for which the State Superintendent |
3 | | shall calculate and subtract for the Operating Tax Rate a |
4 | | transportation rate based on total expenses for |
5 | | transportation services under this Code, as reported on the |
6 | | most recent Annual Financial Report in Pupil |
7 | | Transportation Services, function 2550 in both the |
8 | | Education and Transportation funds and functions 4110 and |
9 | | 4120 in the Transportation fund, less any corresponding |
10 | | fiscal year State of Illinois scheduled payments excluding |
11 | | net adjustments for prior years for regular, vocational, or |
12 | | special education transportation reimbursement pursuant to |
13 | | Section 29-5 or subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this |
14 | | Code divided by the Adjusted EAV. If an Organizational |
15 | | Unit's corresponding fiscal year State of Illinois |
16 | | scheduled payments excluding net adjustments for prior |
17 | | years for regular, vocational, or special education |
18 | | transportation reimbursement pursuant to Section 29-5 or |
19 | | subsection (b) of Section 14-13.01 of this Code exceed the |
20 | | total transportation expenses, as defined in this |
21 | | paragraph, no transportation rate shall be subtracted from |
22 | | the Operating Tax Rate. |
23 | | "Allocation Rate" is defined in paragraph (3) of |
24 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
25 | | "Alternative School" means a public school that is |
26 | | created and operated by a regional superintendent of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 308 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | schools and approved by the State Board. |
2 | | "Applicable Tax Rate" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
3 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
4 | | "Assessment" means any of those benchmark, progress |
5 | | monitoring, formative, diagnostic, and other assessments, |
6 | | in addition to the State accountability assessment, that |
7 | | assist teachers' needs in understanding the skills and |
8 | | meeting the needs of the students they serve. |
9 | | "Assistant principal" means a school administrator |
10 | | duly endorsed to be employed as an assistant principal in |
11 | | this State. |
12 | | "At-risk student" means a student who is at risk of not |
13 | | meeting the Illinois Learning Standards or not graduating |
14 | | from elementary or high school and who demonstrates a need |
15 | | for vocational support or social services beyond that |
16 | | provided by the regular school program. All students |
17 | | included in an Organizational Unit's Low-Income Count, as |
18 | | well as all English learner and disabled students attending |
19 | | the Organizational Unit, shall be considered at-risk |
20 | | students under this Section. |
21 | | "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" for fiscal year |
22 | | 2018 means, for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the |
23 | | average number of students (grades K through 12) reported |
24 | | to the State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit |
25 | | on October 1 in the immediately preceding school year, plus |
26 | | the pre-kindergarten students who receive special |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 309 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | education services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to |
2 | | the State Board on December 1 in the immediately preceding |
3 | | school year, or the average number of students (grades K |
4 | | through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the |
5 | | Organizational Unit on October 1, plus the |
6 | | pre-kindergarten students who receive special education |
7 | | services of 2 or more hours a day as reported to the State |
8 | | Board on December 1, for each of the immediately preceding |
9 | | 3 school years. For fiscal year 2019 and each subsequent |
10 | | fiscal year, "Average Student Enrollment" or "ASE" means, |
11 | | for an Organizational Unit, the greater of the average |
12 | | number of students (grades K through 12) reported to the |
13 | | State Board as enrolled in the Organizational Unit on |
14 | | October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding school |
15 | | year, plus the pre-kindergarten students who receive |
16 | | special education services as reported to the State Board |
17 | | on October 1 and March 1 in the immediately preceding |
18 | | school year, or the average number of students (grades K |
19 | | through 12) reported to the State Board as enrolled in the |
20 | | Organizational Unit on October 1 and March 1, plus the |
21 | | pre-kindergarten students who receive special education |
22 | | services as reported to the State Board on October 1 and |
23 | | March 1, for each of the immediately preceding 3 school |
24 | | years. For the purposes of this definition, "enrolled in |
25 | | the Organizational Unit" means the number of students |
26 | | reported to the State Board who are enrolled in schools |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 310 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | within the Organizational Unit that the student attends or |
2 | | would attend if not placed or transferred to another school |
3 | | or program to receive needed services. For the purposes of |
4 | | calculating "ASE", all students, grades K through 12, |
5 | | excluding those attending kindergarten for a half day and |
6 | | students attending an alternative education program |
7 | | operated by a regional office of education or intermediate |
8 | | service center, shall be counted as 1.0. All students |
9 | | attending kindergarten for a half day shall be counted as |
10 | | 0.5, unless in 2017 by June 15 or by March 1 in subsequent |
11 | | years, the school district reports to the State Board of |
12 | | Education the intent to implement full-day kindergarten |
13 | | district-wide for all students, then all students |
14 | | attending kindergarten shall be counted as 1.0. Special |
15 | | education pre-kindergarten students shall be counted as |
16 | | 0.5 each. If the State Board does not collect or has not |
17 | | collected both an October 1 and March 1 enrollment count by |
18 | | grade or a December 1 collection of special education |
19 | | pre-kindergarten students as of August 31, 2017 (the |
20 | | effective date of Public Act 100-465), it shall establish |
21 | | such collection for all future years. For any year in which |
22 | | a count by grade level was collected only once, that count |
23 | | shall be used as the single count available for computing a |
24 | | 3-year average ASE. Funding for programs operated by a |
25 | | regional office of education or an intermediate service |
26 | | center must be calculated using the Evidence-Based Funding |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 311 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | formula under this Section for the 2019-2020 school year |
2 | | and each subsequent school year until separate adequacy |
3 | | formulas are developed and adopted for each type of |
4 | | program. ASE for a program operated by a regional office of |
5 | | education or an intermediate service center must be |
6 | | determined by the March 1 enrollment for the program. For |
7 | | the 2019-2020 school year, the ASE used in the calculation |
8 | | must be the first-year ASE and, in that year only, the |
9 | | assignment of students served by a regional office of |
10 | | education or intermediate service center shall not result |
11 | | in a reduction of the March enrollment for any school |
12 | | district. For the 2020-2021 school year, the ASE must be |
13 | | the greater of the current-year ASE or the 2-year average |
14 | | ASE. Beginning with the 2021-2022 school year, the ASE must |
15 | | be the greater of the current-year ASE or the 3-year |
16 | | average ASE. School districts shall submit the data for the |
17 | | ASE calculation to the State Board within 45 days of the |
18 | | dates required in this Section for submission of enrollment |
19 | | data in order for it to be included in the ASE calculation. |
20 | | For fiscal year 2018 only, the ASE calculation shall |
21 | | include only enrollment taken on October 1. |
22 | | "Base Funding Guarantee" is defined in paragraph (10) |
23 | | of subsection (g) of this Section. |
24 | | "Base Funding Minimum" is defined in subsection (e) of |
25 | | this Section. |
26 | | "Base Tax Year" means the property tax levy year used |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 312 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to calculate the Budget Year allocation of primary State |
2 | | aid. |
3 | | "Base Tax Year's Extension" means the product of the |
4 | | equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county clerk |
5 | | in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as |
6 | | calculated by the county clerk and defined in PTELL. |
7 | | "Bilingual Education Allocation" means the amount of |
8 | | an Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target |
9 | | attributable to bilingual education divided by the |
10 | | Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target, the product |
11 | | of which shall be multiplied by the amount of new funding |
12 | | received pursuant to this Section. An Organizational |
13 | | Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable to bilingual |
14 | | education shall include all additional investments in |
15 | | English learner students' adequacy elements. |
16 | | "Budget Year" means the school year for which primary |
17 | | State aid is calculated and awarded under this Section. |
18 | | "Central office" means individual administrators and |
19 | | support service personnel charged with managing the |
20 | | instructional programs, business and operations, and |
21 | | security of the Organizational Unit. |
22 | | "Comparable Wage Index" or "CWI" means a regional cost |
23 | | differentiation metric that measures systemic, regional |
24 | | variations in the salaries of college graduates who are not |
25 | | educators. The CWI utilized for this Section shall, for the |
26 | | first 3 years of Evidence-Based Funding implementation, be |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 313 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the CWI initially developed by the National Center for |
2 | | Education Statistics, as most recently updated by Texas A & |
3 | | M University. In the fourth and subsequent years of |
4 | | Evidence-Based Funding implementation, the State |
5 | | Superintendent shall re-determine the CWI using a similar |
6 | | methodology to that identified in the Texas A & M |
7 | | University study, with adjustments made no less frequently |
8 | | than once every 5 years. |
9 | | "Computer technology and equipment" means computers |
10 | | servers, notebooks, network equipment, copiers, printers, |
11 | | instructional software, security software, curriculum |
12 | | management courseware, and other similar materials and |
13 | | equipment. |
14 | | "Computer technology and equipment investment |
15 | | allocation" means the final Adequacy Target amount of an |
16 | | Organizational Unit assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 in the |
17 | | prior school year attributable to the additional $285.50 |
18 | | per student computer technology and equipment investment |
19 | | grant divided by the Organizational Unit's final Adequacy |
20 | | Target, the result of which shall be multiplied by the |
21 | | amount of new funding received pursuant to this Section. An |
22 | | Organizational Unit assigned to a Tier 1 or Tier 2 final |
23 | | Adequacy Target attributable to the received computer |
24 | | technology and equipment investment grant shall include |
25 | | all additional investments in computer technology and |
26 | | equipment adequacy elements. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 314 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Core subject" means mathematics; science; reading, |
2 | | English, writing, and language arts; history and social |
3 | | studies; world languages; and subjects taught as Advanced |
4 | | Placement in high schools. |
5 | | "Core teacher" means a regular classroom teacher in |
6 | | elementary schools and teachers of a core subject in middle |
7 | | and high schools. |
8 | | "Core Intervention teacher (tutor)" means a licensed |
9 | | teacher providing one-on-one or small group tutoring to |
10 | | students struggling to meet proficiency in core subjects. |
11 | | "CPPRT" means corporate personal property replacement |
12 | | tax funds paid to an Organizational Unit during the |
13 | | calendar year one year before the calendar year in which a |
14 | | school year begins, pursuant to "An Act in relation to the |
15 | | abolition of ad valorem personal property tax and the |
16 | | replacement of revenues lost thereby, and amending and |
17 | | repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in connection |
18 | | therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as amended (Public |
19 | | Act 81-1st S.S.-1). |
20 | | "EAV" means equalized assessed valuation as defined in |
21 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (d) of this Section and |
22 | | calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of subsection |
23 | | (d) of this Section. |
24 | | "ECI" means the Bureau of Labor Statistics' national |
25 | | employment cost index for civilian workers in educational |
26 | | services in elementary and secondary schools on a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 315 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | cumulative basis for the 12-month calendar year preceding |
2 | | the fiscal year of the Evidence-Based Funding calculation. |
3 | | "EIS Data" means the employment information system |
4 | | data maintained by the State Board on educators within |
5 | | Organizational Units. |
6 | | "Employee benefits" means health, dental, and vision |
7 | | insurance offered to employees of an Organizational Unit, |
8 | | the costs associated with the statutorily required payment |
9 | | of the normal cost of the Organizational Unit's teacher |
10 | | pensions, Social Security employer contributions, and |
11 | | Illinois Municipal Retirement Fund employer contributions. |
12 | | "English learner" or "EL" means a child included in the |
13 | | definition of "English learners" under Section 14C-2 of |
14 | | this Code participating in a program of transitional |
15 | | bilingual education or a transitional program of |
16 | | instruction meeting the requirements and program |
17 | | application procedures of Article 14C of this Code. For the |
18 | | purposes of collecting the number of EL students enrolled, |
19 | | the same collection and calculation methodology as defined |
20 | | above for "ASE" shall apply to English learners, with the |
21 | | exception that EL student enrollment shall include |
22 | | students in grades pre-kindergarten through 12. |
23 | | "Essential Elements" means those elements, resources, |
24 | | and educational programs that have been identified through |
25 | | academic research as necessary to improve student success, |
26 | | improve academic performance, close achievement gaps, and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 316 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | provide for other per student costs related to the delivery |
2 | | and leadership of the Organizational Unit, as well as the |
3 | | maintenance and operations of the unit, and which are |
4 | | specified in paragraph (2) of subsection (b) of this |
5 | | Section. |
6 | | "Evidence-Based Funding" means State funding provided |
7 | | to an Organizational Unit pursuant to this Section. |
8 | | "Extended day" means academic and enrichment programs |
9 | | provided to students outside the regular school day before |
10 | | and after school or during non-instructional times during |
11 | | the school day. |
12 | | "Extension Limitation Ratio" means a numerical ratio |
13 | | in which the numerator is the Base Tax Year's Extension and |
14 | | the denominator is the Preceding Tax Year's Extension. |
15 | | "Final Percent of Adequacy" is defined in paragraph (4) |
16 | | of subsection (f) of this Section. |
17 | | "Final Resources" is defined in paragraph (3) of |
18 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
19 | | "Full-time equivalent" or "FTE" means the full-time |
20 | | equivalency compensation for staffing the relevant |
21 | | position at an Organizational Unit. |
22 | | "Funding Gap" is defined in paragraph (1) of subsection |
23 | | (g). |
24 | | "Guidance counselor" means a licensed guidance |
25 | | counselor who provides guidance and counseling support for |
26 | | students within an Organizational Unit. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 317 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Hybrid District" means a partial elementary unit |
2 | | district created pursuant to Article 11E of this Code. |
3 | | "Instructional assistant" means a core or special |
4 | | education, non-licensed employee who assists a teacher in |
5 | | the classroom and provides academic support to students. |
6 | | "Instructional facilitator" means a qualified teacher |
7 | | or licensed teacher leader who facilitates and coaches |
8 | | continuous improvement in classroom instruction; provides |
9 | | instructional support to teachers in the elements of |
10 | | research-based instruction or demonstrates the alignment |
11 | | of instruction with curriculum standards and assessment |
12 | | tools; develops or coordinates instructional programs or |
13 | | strategies; develops and implements training; chooses |
14 | | standards-based instructional materials; provides teachers |
15 | | with an understanding of current research; serves as a |
16 | | mentor, site coach, curriculum specialist, or lead |
17 | | teacher; or otherwise works with fellow teachers, in |
18 | | collaboration, to use data to improve instructional |
19 | | practice or develop model lessons. |
20 | | "Instructional materials" means relevant instructional |
21 | | materials for student instruction, including, but not |
22 | | limited to, textbooks, consumable workbooks, laboratory |
23 | | equipment, library books, and other similar materials. |
24 | | "Laboratory School" means a public school that is |
25 | | created and operated by a public university and approved by |
26 | | the State Board. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 318 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | "Librarian" means a teacher with an endorsement as a |
2 | | library information specialist or another individual whose |
3 | | primary responsibility is overseeing library resources |
4 | | within an Organizational Unit. |
5 | | "Limiting rate for Hybrid Districts" means the |
6 | | combined elementary school and high school limiting rates. |
7 | | "Local Capacity" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
8 | | subsection (c) of this Section. |
9 | | "Local Capacity Percentage" is defined in subparagraph |
10 | | (A) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
11 | | "Local Capacity Ratio" is defined in subparagraph (B) |
12 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) of this Section. |
13 | | "Local Capacity Target" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
14 | | subsection (c) of this Section. |
15 | | "Low-Income Count" means, for an Organizational Unit |
16 | | in a fiscal year, the higher of the average number of |
17 | | students for the prior school year or the immediately |
18 | | preceding 3 school years who, as of July 1 of the |
19 | | immediately preceding fiscal year (as determined by the |
20 | | Department of Human Services), are eligible for at least |
21 | | one of the following low-income programs: Medicaid, the |
22 | | Children's Health Insurance Program, Temporary Assistance |
23 | | for Needy Families (TANF), or the Supplemental Nutrition |
24 | | Assistance Program, excluding pupils who are eligible for |
25 | | services provided by the Department of Children and Family |
26 | | Services. Until such time that grade level low-income |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 319 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | populations become available, grade level low-income |
2 | | populations shall be determined by applying the low-income |
3 | | percentage to total student enrollments by grade level. The |
4 | | low-income percentage is determined by dividing the |
5 | | Low-Income Count by the Average Student Enrollment. The |
6 | | low-income percentage for programs operated by a regional |
7 | | office of education or an intermediate service center must |
8 | | be set to the weighted average of the low-income |
9 | | percentages of all of the school districts in the service |
10 | | region. The weighted low-income percentage is the result of |
11 | | multiplying the low-income percentage of each school |
12 | | district served by the regional office of education or |
13 | | intermediate service center by each school district's |
14 | | Average Student Enrollment, summarizing those products and |
15 | | dividing the total by the total Average Student Enrollment |
16 | | for the service region. |
17 | | "Maintenance and operations" means custodial services, |
18 | | facility and ground maintenance, facility operations, |
19 | | facility security, routine facility repairs, and other |
20 | | similar services and functions. |
21 | | "Minimum Funding Level" is defined in paragraph (9) of |
22 | | subsection (g) of this Section. |
23 | | "New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds" means, for any |
24 | | given fiscal year, all State funds appropriated under |
25 | | Section 2-3.170 of this the School Code. |
26 | | "New State Funds" means, for a given school year, all |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 320 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | State funds appropriated for Evidence-Based Funding in |
2 | | excess of the amount needed to fund the Base Funding |
3 | | Minimum for all Organizational Units in that school year. |
4 | | "Net State Contribution Target" means, for a given |
5 | | school year, the amount of State funds that would be |
6 | | necessary to fully meet the Adequacy Target of an |
7 | | Operational Unit minus the Preliminary Resources available |
8 | | to each unit. |
9 | | "Nurse" means an individual licensed as a certified |
10 | | school nurse, in accordance with the rules established for |
11 | | nursing services by the State Board, who is an employee of |
12 | | and is available to provide health care-related services |
13 | | for students of an Organizational Unit. |
14 | | "Operating Tax Rate" means the rate utilized in the |
15 | | previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes, |
16 | | except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital |
17 | | Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes. |
18 | | For Hybrid Districts, the Operating Tax Rate shall be the |
19 | | combined elementary and high school rates utilized in the |
20 | | previous year to extend property taxes for all purposes, |
21 | | except Bond and Interest, Summer School, Rent, Capital |
22 | | Improvement, and Vocational Education Building purposes. |
23 | | "Organizational Unit" means a Laboratory School or any |
24 | | public school district that is recognized as such by the |
25 | | State Board and that contains elementary schools typically |
26 | | serving kindergarten through 5th grades, middle schools |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 321 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | typically serving 6th through 8th grades, high schools |
2 | | typically serving 9th through 12th grades, a program |
3 | | established under Section 2-3.66 or 2-3.41, or a program |
4 | | operated by a regional office of education or an |
5 | | intermediate service center under Article 13A or 13B. The |
6 | | General Assembly acknowledges that the actual grade levels |
7 | | served by a particular Organizational Unit may vary |
8 | | slightly from what is typical. |
9 | | "Organizational Unit CWI" is determined by calculating |
10 | | the CWI in the region and original county in which an |
11 | | Organizational Unit's primary administrative office is |
12 | | located as set forth in this paragraph, provided that if |
13 | | the Organizational Unit CWI as calculated in accordance |
14 | | with this paragraph is less than 0.9, the Organizational |
15 | | Unit CWI shall be increased to 0.9. Each county's current |
16 | | CWI value shall be adjusted based on the CWI value of that |
17 | | county's neighboring Illinois counties, to create a |
18 | | "weighted adjusted index value". This shall be calculated |
19 | | by summing the CWI values of all of a county's adjacent |
20 | | Illinois counties and dividing by the number of adjacent |
21 | | Illinois counties, then taking the weighted value of the |
22 | | original county's CWI value and the adjacent Illinois |
23 | | county average. To calculate this weighted value, if the |
24 | | number of adjacent Illinois counties is greater than 2, the |
25 | | original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.25 and |
26 | | the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 322 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 0.75. If the number of adjacent Illinois counties is 2, the |
2 | | original county's CWI value will be weighted at 0.33 and |
3 | | the adjacent Illinois county average will be weighted at |
4 | | 0.66. The greater of the county's current CWI value and its |
5 | | weighted adjusted index value shall be used as the |
6 | | Organizational Unit CWI. |
7 | | "Preceding Tax Year" means the property tax levy year |
8 | | immediately preceding the Base Tax Year. |
9 | | "Preceding Tax Year's Extension" means the product of |
10 | | the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the county |
11 | | clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating |
12 | | Tax Rate. |
13 | | "Preliminary Percent of Adequacy" is defined in |
14 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (f) of this Section. |
15 | | "Preliminary Resources" is defined in paragraph (2) of |
16 | | subsection (f) of this Section. |
17 | | "Principal" means a school administrator duly endorsed |
18 | | to be employed as a principal in this State. |
19 | | "Professional development" means training programs for |
20 | | licensed staff in schools, including, but not limited to, |
21 | | programs that assist in implementing new curriculum |
22 | | programs, provide data focused or academic assessment data |
23 | | training to help staff identify a student's weaknesses and |
24 | | strengths, target interventions, improve instruction, |
25 | | encompass instructional strategies for English learner, |
26 | | gifted, or at-risk students, address inclusivity, cultural |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 323 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | sensitivity, or implicit bias, or otherwise provide |
2 | | professional support for licensed staff. |
3 | | "Prototypical" means 450 special education |
4 | | pre-kindergarten and kindergarten through grade 5 students |
5 | | for an elementary school, 450 grade 6 through 8 students |
6 | | for a middle school, and 600 grade 9 through 12 students |
7 | | for a high school. |
8 | | "PTELL" means the Property Tax Extension Limitation |
9 | | Law. |
10 | | "PTELL EAV" is defined in paragraph (4) of subsection |
11 | | (d) of this Section. |
12 | | "Pupil support staff" means a nurse, psychologist, |
13 | | social worker, family liaison personnel, or other staff |
14 | | member who provides support to at-risk or struggling |
15 | | students. |
16 | | "Real Receipts" is defined in paragraph (1) of |
17 | | subsection (d) of this Section. |
18 | | "Regionalization Factor" means, for a particular |
19 | | Organizational Unit, the figure derived by dividing the |
20 | | Organizational Unit CWI by the Statewide Weighted CWI. |
21 | | "School site staff" means the primary school secretary |
22 | | and any additional clerical personnel assigned to a school. |
23 | | "Special education" means special educational |
24 | | facilities and services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of |
25 | | this Code. |
26 | | "Special Education Allocation" means the amount of an |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 324 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Organizational Unit's final Adequacy Target attributable |
2 | | to special education divided by the Organizational Unit's |
3 | | final Adequacy Target, the product of which shall be |
4 | | multiplied by the amount of new funding received pursuant |
5 | | to this Section. An Organizational Unit's final Adequacy |
6 | | Target attributable to special education shall include all |
7 | | special education investment adequacy elements. |
8 | | "Specialist teacher" means a teacher who provides |
9 | | instruction in subject areas not included in core subjects, |
10 | | including, but not limited to, art, music, physical |
11 | | education, health, driver education, career-technical |
12 | | education, and such other subject areas as may be mandated |
13 | | by State law or provided by an Organizational Unit. |
14 | | "Specially Funded Unit" means an Alternative School, |
15 | | safe school, Department of Juvenile Justice school, |
16 | | special education cooperative or entity recognized by the |
17 | | State Board as a special education cooperative, |
18 | | State-approved charter school, or alternative learning |
19 | | opportunities program that received direct funding from |
20 | | the State Board during the 2016-2017 school year through |
21 | | any of the funding sources included within the calculation |
22 | | of the Base Funding Minimum or Glenwood Academy. |
23 | | "Supplemental Grant Funding" means supplemental |
24 | | general State aid funding received by an Organizational |
25 | | Unit during the 2016-2017 school year pursuant to |
26 | | subsection (H) of Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 325 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | repealed). |
2 | | "State Adequacy Level" is the sum of the Adequacy |
3 | | Targets of all Organizational Units. |
4 | | "State Board" means the State Board of Education. |
5 | | "State Superintendent" means the State Superintendent |
6 | | of Education. |
7 | | "Statewide Weighted CWI" means a figure determined by |
8 | | multiplying each Organizational Unit CWI times the ASE for |
9 | | that Organizational Unit creating a weighted value, |
10 | | summing all Organizational Units' weighted values, and |
11 | | dividing by the total ASE of all Organizational Units, |
12 | | thereby creating an average weighted index. |
13 | | "Student activities" means non-credit producing |
14 | | after-school programs, including, but not limited to, |
15 | | clubs, bands, sports, and other activities authorized by |
16 | | the school board of the Organizational Unit. |
17 | | "Substitute teacher" means an individual teacher or |
18 | | teaching assistant who is employed by an Organizational |
19 | | Unit and is temporarily serving the Organizational Unit on |
20 | | a per diem or per period-assignment basis to replace |
21 | | another staff member. |
22 | | "Summer school" means academic and enrichment programs |
23 | | provided to students during the summer months outside of |
24 | | the regular school year. |
25 | | "Supervisory aide" means a non-licensed staff member |
26 | | who helps in supervising students of an Organizational |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 326 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Unit, but does so outside of the classroom, in situations |
2 | | such as, but not limited to, monitoring hallways and |
3 | | playgrounds, supervising lunchrooms, or supervising |
4 | | students when being transported in buses serving the |
5 | | Organizational Unit. |
6 | | "Target Ratio" is defined in paragraph (4) of |
7 | | subsection (g). |
8 | | "Tier 1", "Tier 2", "Tier 3", and "Tier 4" are defined |
9 | | in paragraph (3) of subsection (g). |
10 | | "Tier 1 Aggregate Funding", "Tier 2 Aggregate |
11 | | Funding", "Tier 3 Aggregate Funding", and "Tier 4 Aggregate |
12 | | Funding" are defined in paragraph (1) of subsection (g). |
13 | | (b) Adequacy Target calculation. |
14 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target is the |
15 | | sum of the Organizational Unit's cost of providing |
16 | | Essential Elements, as calculated in accordance with this |
17 | | subsection (b), with the salary amounts in the Essential |
18 | | Elements multiplied by a Regionalization Factor calculated |
19 | | pursuant to paragraph (3) of this subsection (b). |
20 | | (2) The Essential Elements are attributable on a pro |
21 | | rata basis related to defined subgroups of the ASE of each |
22 | | Organizational Unit as specified in this paragraph (2), |
23 | | with investments and FTE positions pro rata funded based on |
24 | | ASE counts in excess of or less than the thresholds set |
25 | | forth in this paragraph (2). The method for calculating |
26 | | attributable pro rata costs and the defined subgroups |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 327 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | thereto are as follows: |
2 | | (A) Core class size investments. Each |
3 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding required |
4 | | to support that number of FTE core teacher positions as |
5 | | is needed to keep the respective class sizes of the |
6 | | Organizational Unit to the following maximum numbers: |
7 | | (i) For grades kindergarten through 3, the |
8 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding required |
9 | | to support one FTE core teacher position for every |
10 | | 15 Low-Income Count students in those grades and |
11 | | one FTE core teacher position for every 20 |
12 | | non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. |
13 | | (ii) For grades 4 through 12, the |
14 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding required |
15 | | to support one FTE core teacher position for every |
16 | | 20 Low-Income Count students in those grades and |
17 | | one FTE core teacher position for every 25 |
18 | | non-Low-Income Count students in those grades. |
19 | | The number of non-Low-Income Count students in a |
20 | | grade shall be determined by subtracting the |
21 | | Low-Income students in that grade from the ASE of the |
22 | | Organizational Unit for that grade. |
23 | | (B) Specialist teacher investments. Each |
24 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
25 | | to cover that number of FTE specialist teacher |
26 | | positions that correspond to the following |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 328 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | percentages: |
2 | | (i) if the Organizational Unit operates an |
3 | | elementary or middle school, then 20.00% of the |
4 | | number of the Organizational Unit's core teachers, |
5 | | as determined under subparagraph (A) of this |
6 | | paragraph (2); and |
7 | | (ii) if such Organizational Unit operates a |
8 | | high school, then 33.33% of the number of the |
9 | | Organizational Unit's core teachers. |
10 | | (C) Instructional facilitator investments. Each |
11 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
12 | | to cover one FTE instructional facilitator position |
13 | | for every 200 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten |
14 | | children with disabilities and all kindergarten |
15 | | through grade 12 students of the Organizational Unit. |
16 | | (D) Core intervention teacher (tutor) investments. |
17 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive the funding |
18 | | needed to cover one FTE teacher position for each |
19 | | prototypical elementary, middle, and high school. |
20 | | (E) Substitute teacher investments. Each |
21 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
22 | | to cover substitute teacher costs that is equal to |
23 | | 5.70% of the minimum pupil attendance days required |
24 | | under Section 10-19 of this Code for all full-time |
25 | | equivalent core, specialist, and intervention |
26 | | teachers, school nurses, special education teachers |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 329 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and instructional assistants, instructional |
2 | | facilitators, and summer school and extended day |
3 | | teacher positions, as determined under this paragraph |
4 | | (2), at a salary rate of 33.33% of the average salary |
5 | | for grade K through 12 teachers and 33.33% of the |
6 | | average salary of each instructional assistant |
7 | | position. |
8 | | (F) Core guidance counselor investments. Each |
9 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
10 | | to cover one FTE guidance counselor for each 450 |
11 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
12 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 5 |
13 | | students, plus one FTE guidance counselor for each 250 |
14 | | grades 6 through 8 ASE middle school students, plus one |
15 | | FTE guidance counselor for each 250 grades 9 through 12 |
16 | | ASE high school students. |
17 | | (G) Nurse investments. Each Organizational Unit |
18 | | shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE nurse |
19 | | for each 750 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children |
20 | | with disabilities and all kindergarten through grade |
21 | | 12 students across all grade levels it serves. |
22 | | (H) Supervisory aide investments. Each |
23 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
24 | | to cover one FTE for each 225 combined ASE of |
25 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
26 | | kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE for |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 330 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | each 225 ASE middle school students, plus one FTE for |
2 | | each 200 ASE high school students. |
3 | | (I) Librarian investments. Each Organizational |
4 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE |
5 | | librarian for each prototypical elementary school, |
6 | | middle school, and high school and one FTE aide or |
7 | | media technician for every 300 combined ASE of |
8 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
9 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students. |
10 | | (J) Principal investments. Each Organizational |
11 | | Unit shall receive the funding needed to cover one FTE |
12 | | principal position for each prototypical elementary |
13 | | school, plus one FTE principal position for each |
14 | | prototypical middle school, plus one FTE principal |
15 | | position for each prototypical high school. |
16 | | (K) Assistant principal investments. Each |
17 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
18 | | to cover one FTE assistant principal position for each |
19 | | prototypical elementary school, plus one FTE assistant |
20 | | principal position for each prototypical middle |
21 | | school, plus one FTE assistant principal position for |
22 | | each prototypical high school. |
23 | | (L) School site staff investments. Each |
24 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the funding needed |
25 | | for one FTE position for each 225 ASE of |
26 | | pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 331 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | kindergarten through grade 5 students, plus one FTE |
2 | | position for each 225 ASE middle school students, plus |
3 | | one FTE position for each 200 ASE high school students. |
4 | | (M) Gifted investments. Each Organizational Unit |
5 | | shall receive $40 per kindergarten through grade 12 |
6 | | ASE. |
7 | | (N) Professional development investments. Each |
8 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $125 per student of |
9 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
10 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
11 | | students for trainers and other professional |
12 | | development-related expenses for supplies and |
13 | | materials. |
14 | | (O) Instructional material investments. Each |
15 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $190 per student of |
16 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
17 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
18 | | students to cover instructional material costs. |
19 | | (P) Assessment investments. Each Organizational |
20 | | Unit shall receive $25 per student of the combined ASE |
21 | | of pre-kindergarten children with disabilities and all |
22 | | kindergarten through grade 12 students to cover |
23 | | assessment costs. |
24 | | (Q) Computer technology and equipment investments. |
25 | | Each Organizational Unit shall receive $285.50 per |
26 | | student of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 332 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | children with disabilities and all kindergarten |
2 | | through grade 12 students to cover computer technology |
3 | | and equipment costs. For the 2018-2019 school year and |
4 | | subsequent school years, Organizational Units assigned |
5 | | to Tier 1 and Tier 2 in the prior school year shall |
6 | | receive an additional $285.50 per student of the |
7 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
8 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
9 | | students to cover computer technology and equipment |
10 | | costs in the Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target. |
11 | | The State Board may establish additional requirements |
12 | | for Organizational Unit expenditures of funds received |
13 | | pursuant to this subparagraph (Q), including a |
14 | | requirement that funds received pursuant to this |
15 | | subparagraph (Q) may be used only for serving the |
16 | | technology needs of the district. It is the intent of |
17 | | Public Act 100-465 that all Tier 1 and Tier 2 districts |
18 | | receive the addition to their Adequacy Target in the |
19 | | following year, subject to compliance with the |
20 | | requirements of the State Board. |
21 | | (R) Student activities investments. Each |
22 | | Organizational Unit shall receive the following |
23 | | funding amounts to cover student activities: $100 per |
24 | | kindergarten through grade 5 ASE student in elementary |
25 | | school, plus $200 per ASE student in middle school, |
26 | | plus $675 per ASE student in high school. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 333 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (S) Maintenance and operations investments. Each |
2 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $1,038 per student |
3 | | of the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
4 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
5 | | students for day-to-day maintenance and operations |
6 | | expenditures, including salary, supplies, and |
7 | | materials, as well as purchased services, but |
8 | | excluding employee benefits. The proportion of salary |
9 | | for the application of a Regionalization Factor and the |
10 | | calculation of benefits is equal to $352.92. |
11 | | (T) Central office investments. Each |
12 | | Organizational Unit shall receive $742 per student of |
13 | | the combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
14 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
15 | | students to cover central office operations, including |
16 | | administrators and classified personnel charged with |
17 | | managing the instructional programs, business and |
18 | | operations of the school district, and security |
19 | | personnel. The proportion of salary for the |
20 | | application of a Regionalization Factor and the |
21 | | calculation of benefits is equal to $368.48. |
22 | | (U) Employee benefit investments. Each |
23 | | Organizational Unit shall receive 30% of the total of |
24 | | all salary-calculated elements of the Adequacy Target, |
25 | | excluding substitute teachers and student activities |
26 | | investments, to cover benefit costs. For central |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 334 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | office and maintenance and operations investments, the |
2 | | benefit calculation shall be based upon the salary |
3 | | proportion of each investment. If at any time the |
4 | | responsibility for funding the employer normal cost of |
5 | | teacher pensions is assigned to school districts, then |
6 | | that amount certified by the Teachers' Retirement |
7 | | System of the State of Illinois to be paid by the |
8 | | Organizational Unit for the preceding school year |
9 | | shall be added to the benefit investment. For any |
10 | | fiscal year in which a school district organized under |
11 | | Article 34 of this Code is responsible for paying the |
12 | | employer normal cost of teacher pensions, then that |
13 | | amount of its employer normal cost plus the amount for |
14 | | retiree health insurance as certified by the Public |
15 | | School Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of |
16 | | Chicago to be paid by the school district for the |
17 | | preceding school year that is statutorily required to |
18 | | cover employer normal costs and the amount for retiree |
19 | | health insurance shall be added to the 30% specified in |
20 | | this subparagraph (U). The Teachers' Retirement System |
21 | | of the State of Illinois and the Public School |
22 | | Teachers' Pension and Retirement Fund of Chicago shall |
23 | | submit such information as the State Superintendent |
24 | | may require for the calculations set forth in this |
25 | | subparagraph (U). |
26 | | (V) Additional investments in low-income students. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 335 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | In addition to and not in lieu of all other funding |
2 | | under this paragraph (2), each Organizational Unit |
3 | | shall receive funding based on the average teacher |
4 | | salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of: |
5 | | (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor) |
6 | | position for every 125 Low-Income Count students; |
7 | | (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for |
8 | | every 125 Low-Income Count students; |
9 | | (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position |
10 | | for every 120 Low-Income Count students; and |
11 | | (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position |
12 | | for every 120 Low-Income Count students. |
13 | | (W) Additional investments in English learner |
14 | | students. In addition to and not in lieu of all other |
15 | | funding under this paragraph (2), each Organizational |
16 | | Unit shall receive funding based on the average teacher |
17 | | salary for grades K through 12 to cover the costs of: |
18 | | (i) one FTE intervention teacher (tutor) |
19 | | position for every 125 English learner students; |
20 | | (ii) one FTE pupil support staff position for |
21 | | every 125 English learner students; |
22 | | (iii) one FTE extended day teacher position |
23 | | for every 120 English learner students; |
24 | | (iv) one FTE summer school teacher position |
25 | | for every 120 English learner students; and |
26 | | (v) one FTE core teacher position for every 100 |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 336 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | English learner students. |
2 | | (X) Special education investments. Each |
3 | | Organizational Unit shall receive funding based on the |
4 | | average teacher salary for grades K through 12 to cover |
5 | | special education as follows: |
6 | | (i) one FTE teacher position for every 141 |
7 | | combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
8 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
9 | | students; |
10 | | (ii) one FTE instructional assistant for every |
11 | | 141 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children with |
12 | | disabilities and all kindergarten through grade 12 |
13 | | students; and |
14 | | (iii) one FTE psychologist position for every |
15 | | 1,000 combined ASE of pre-kindergarten children |
16 | | with disabilities and all kindergarten through |
17 | | grade 12 students. |
18 | | (3) For calculating the salaries included within the |
19 | | Essential Elements, the State Superintendent shall |
20 | | annually calculate average salaries to the nearest dollar |
21 | | using the employment information system data maintained by |
22 | | the State Board, limited to public schools only and |
23 | | excluding special education and vocational cooperatives, |
24 | | schools operated by the Department of Juvenile Justice, and |
25 | | charter schools, for the following positions: |
26 | | (A) Teacher for grades K through 8. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 337 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (B) Teacher for grades 9 through 12. |
2 | | (C) Teacher for grades K through 12. |
3 | | (D) Guidance counselor for grades K through 8. |
4 | | (E) Guidance counselor for grades 9 through 12. |
5 | | (F) Guidance counselor for grades K through 12. |
6 | | (G) Social worker. |
7 | | (H) Psychologist. |
8 | | (I) Librarian. |
9 | | (J) Nurse. |
10 | | (K) Principal. |
11 | | (L) Assistant principal. |
12 | | For the purposes of this paragraph (3), "teacher" |
13 | | includes core teachers, specialist and elective teachers, |
14 | | instructional facilitators, tutors, special education |
15 | | teachers, pupil support staff teachers, English learner |
16 | | teachers, extended day teachers, and summer school |
17 | | teachers. Where specific grade data is not required for the |
18 | | Essential Elements, the average salary for corresponding |
19 | | positions shall apply. For substitute teachers, the |
20 | | average teacher salary for grades K through 12 shall apply. |
21 | | For calculating the salaries included within the |
22 | | Essential Elements for positions not included within EIS |
23 | | Data, the following salaries shall be used in the first |
24 | | year of implementation of Evidence-Based Funding: |
25 | | (i) school site staff, $30,000; and |
26 | | (ii) non-instructional assistant, instructional |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 338 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | assistant, library aide, library media tech, or |
2 | | supervisory aide: $25,000. |
3 | | In the second and subsequent years of implementation of |
4 | | Evidence-Based Funding, the amounts in items (i) and (ii) |
5 | | of this paragraph (3) shall annually increase by the ECI. |
6 | | The salary amounts for the Essential Elements |
7 | | determined pursuant to subparagraphs (A) through (L), (S) |
8 | | and (T), and (V) through (X) of paragraph (2) of subsection |
9 | | (b) of this Section shall be multiplied by a |
10 | | Regionalization Factor. |
11 | | (c) Local Capacity calculation. |
12 | | (1) Each Organizational Unit's Local Capacity |
13 | | represents an amount of funding it is assumed to contribute |
14 | | toward its Adequacy Target for purposes of the |
15 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula calculation. "Local |
16 | | Capacity" means either (i) the Organizational Unit's Local |
17 | | Capacity Target as calculated in accordance with paragraph |
18 | | (2) of this subsection (c) if its Real Receipts are equal |
19 | | to or less than its Local Capacity Target or (ii) the |
20 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity, as |
21 | | calculated in accordance with paragraph (3) of this |
22 | | subsection (c) if Real Receipts are more than its Local |
23 | | Capacity Target. |
24 | | (2) "Local Capacity Target" means, for an |
25 | | Organizational Unit, that dollar amount that is obtained by |
26 | | multiplying its Adequacy Target by its Local Capacity |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 339 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Ratio. |
2 | | (A) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity |
3 | | Percentage is the conversion of the Organizational |
4 | | Unit's Local Capacity Ratio, as such ratio is |
5 | | determined in accordance with subparagraph (B) of this |
6 | | paragraph (2), into a cumulative distribution |
7 | | resulting in a percentile ranking to determine each |
8 | | Organizational Unit's relative position to all other |
9 | | Organizational Units in this State. The calculation of |
10 | | Local Capacity Percentage is described in subparagraph |
11 | | (C) of this paragraph (2). |
12 | | (B) An Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio |
13 | | in a given year is the percentage obtained by dividing |
14 | | its Adjusted EAV or PTELL EAV, whichever is less, by |
15 | | its Adequacy Target, with the resulting ratio further |
16 | | adjusted as follows: |
17 | | (i) for Organizational Units serving grades |
18 | | kindergarten through 12 and Hybrid Districts, no |
19 | | further adjustments shall be made; |
20 | | (ii) for Organizational Units serving grades |
21 | | kindergarten through 8, the ratio shall be |
22 | | multiplied by 9/13; |
23 | | (iii) for Organizational Units serving grades |
24 | | 9 through 12, the Local Capacity Ratio shall be |
25 | | multiplied by 4/13; and |
26 | | (iv) for an Organizational Unit with a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 340 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | different grade configuration than those specified |
2 | | in items (i) through (iii) of this subparagraph |
3 | | (B), the State Superintendent shall determine a |
4 | | comparable adjustment based on the grades served. |
5 | | (C) The Local Capacity Percentage is equal to the |
6 | | percentile ranking of the district. Local Capacity |
7 | | Percentage converts each Organizational Unit's Local |
8 | | Capacity Ratio to a cumulative distribution resulting |
9 | | in a percentile ranking to determine each |
10 | | Organizational Unit's relative position to all other |
11 | | Organizational Units in this State. The Local Capacity |
12 | | Percentage cumulative distribution resulting in a |
13 | | percentile ranking for each Organizational Unit shall |
14 | | be calculated using the standard normal distribution |
15 | | of the score in relation to the weighted mean and |
16 | | weighted standard deviation and Local Capacity Ratios |
17 | | of all Organizational Units. If the value assigned to |
18 | | any Organizational Unit is in excess of 90%, the value |
19 | | shall be adjusted to 90%. For Laboratory Schools, the |
20 | | Local Capacity Percentage shall be set at 10% in
|
21 | | recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from |
22 | | the public university that are allocated to
the |
23 | | Laboratory School. For programs operated by a regional |
24 | | office of education or an intermediate service center, |
25 | | the Local Capacity Percentage must be set at 10% in |
26 | | recognition of the absence of EAV and resources from |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 341 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | school districts that are allocated to the regional |
2 | | office of education or intermediate service center. |
3 | | The weighted mean for the Local Capacity Percentage |
4 | | shall be determined by multiplying each Organizational |
5 | | Unit's Local Capacity Ratio times the ASE for the unit |
6 | | creating a weighted value, summing the weighted values |
7 | | of all Organizational Units, and dividing by the total |
8 | | ASE of all Organizational Units. The weighted standard |
9 | | deviation shall be determined by taking the square root |
10 | | of the weighted variance of all Organizational Units' |
11 | | Local Capacity Ratio, where the variance is calculated |
12 | | by squaring the difference between each unit's Local |
13 | | Capacity Ratio and the weighted mean, then multiplying |
14 | | the variance for each unit times the ASE for the unit |
15 | | to create a weighted variance for each unit, then |
16 | | summing all units' weighted variance and dividing by |
17 | | the total ASE of all units. |
18 | | (D) For any Organizational Unit, the |
19 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Local Capacity Target |
20 | | shall be reduced by either (i) the school board's |
21 | | remaining contribution pursuant to paragraph (ii) of |
22 | | subsection (b-4) of Section 16-158 of the Illinois |
23 | | Pension Code in a given year or (ii) the board of |
24 | | education's remaining contribution pursuant to |
25 | | paragraph (iv) of subsection (b) of Section 17-129 of |
26 | | the Illinois Pension Code absent the employer normal |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 342 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | cost portion of the required contribution and amount |
2 | | allowed pursuant to subdivision (3) of Section |
3 | | 17-142.1 of the Illinois Pension Code in a given year. |
4 | | In the preceding sentence, item (i) shall be certified |
5 | | to the State Board of Education by the Teachers' |
6 | | Retirement System of the State of Illinois and item |
7 | | (ii) shall be certified to the State Board of Education |
8 | | by the Public School Teachers' Pension and Retirement |
9 | | Fund of the City of Chicago. |
10 | | (3) If an Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are more |
11 | | than its Local Capacity Target, then its Local Capacity |
12 | | shall equal an Adjusted Local Capacity Target as calculated |
13 | | in accordance with this paragraph (3). The Adjusted Local |
14 | | Capacity Target is calculated as the sum of the |
15 | | Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target and its Real |
16 | | Receipts Adjustment. The Real Receipts Adjustment equals |
17 | | the Organizational Unit's Real Receipts less its Local |
18 | | Capacity Target, with the resulting figure multiplied by |
19 | | the Local Capacity Percentage. |
20 | | As used in this paragraph (3), "Real Percent of |
21 | | Adequacy" means the sum of an Organizational Unit's Real |
22 | | Receipts, CPPRT, and Base Funding Minimum, with the |
23 | | resulting figure divided by the Organizational Unit's |
24 | | Adequacy Target. |
25 | | (d) Calculation of Real Receipts, EAV, and Adjusted EAV for |
26 | | purposes of the Local Capacity calculation. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 343 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) An Organizational Unit's Real Receipts are the |
2 | | product of its Applicable Tax Rate and its Adjusted EAV. An |
3 | | Organizational Unit's Applicable Tax Rate is its Adjusted |
4 | | Operating Tax Rate for property within the Organizational |
5 | | Unit. |
6 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the |
7 | | equalized assessed valuation, or EAV, of all taxable |
8 | | property of each Organizational Unit as of September 30 of |
9 | | the previous year in accordance with paragraph (3) of this |
10 | | subsection (d). The State Superintendent shall then |
11 | | determine the Adjusted EAV of each Organizational Unit in |
12 | | accordance with paragraph (4) of this subsection (d), which |
13 | | Adjusted EAV figure shall be used for the purposes of |
14 | | calculating Local Capacity. |
15 | | (3) To calculate Real Receipts and EAV, the Department |
16 | | of Revenue shall supply to the State Superintendent the |
17 | | value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue |
18 | | of all taxable property of every Organizational Unit, |
19 | | together with (i) the applicable tax rate used in extending |
20 | | taxes for the funds of the Organizational Unit as of |
21 | | September 30 of the previous year and (ii) the limiting |
22 | | rate for all Organizational Units subject to property tax |
23 | | extension limitations as imposed under PTELL. |
24 | | (A) The Department of Revenue shall add to the |
25 | | equalized assessed value of all taxable property of |
26 | | each Organizational Unit situated entirely or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 344 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | partially within a county that is or was subject to the |
2 | | provisions of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property |
3 | | Tax Code (i) an amount equal to the total amount by |
4 | | which the homestead exemption allowed under Section |
5 | | 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code for real |
6 | | property situated in that Organizational Unit exceeds |
7 | | the total amount that would have been allowed in that |
8 | | Organizational Unit if the maximum reduction under |
9 | | Section 15-176 was (I) $4,500 in Cook County or $3,500 |
10 | | in all other counties in tax year 2003 or (II) $5,000 |
11 | | in all counties in tax year 2004 and thereafter and |
12 | | (ii) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for the |
13 | | taxable year of all additional exemptions under |
14 | | Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with |
15 | | a household income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk |
16 | | of any county that is or was subject to the provisions |
17 | | of Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property Tax Code |
18 | | shall annually calculate and certify to the Department |
19 | | of Revenue for each Organizational Unit all homestead |
20 | | exemption amounts under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the |
21 | | Property Tax Code and all amounts of additional |
22 | | exemptions under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax |
23 | | Code for owners with a household income of $30,000 or |
24 | | less. It is the intent of this subparagraph (A) that if |
25 | | the general homestead exemption for a parcel of |
26 | | property is determined under Section 15-176 or 15-177 |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 345 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of the Property Tax Code rather than Section 15-175, |
2 | | then the calculation of EAV shall not be affected by |
3 | | the difference, if any, between the amount of the |
4 | | general homestead exemption allowed for that parcel of |
5 | | property under Section 15-176 or 15-177 of the Property |
6 | | Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed |
7 | | had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of |
8 | | property been determined under Section 15-175 of the |
9 | | Property Tax Code. It is further the intent of this |
10 | | subparagraph (A) that if additional exemptions are |
11 | | allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code |
12 | | for owners with a household income of less than |
13 | | $30,000, then the calculation of EAV shall not be |
14 | | affected by the difference, if any, because of those |
15 | | additional exemptions. |
16 | | (B) With respect to any part of an Organizational |
17 | | Unit within a redevelopment project area in respect to |
18 | | which a municipality has adopted tax increment |
19 | | allocation financing pursuant to the Tax Increment |
20 | | Allocation Redevelopment Act, Division 74.4 of Article |
21 | | 11 of the Illinois Municipal Code, or the Industrial |
22 | | Jobs Recovery Law, Division 74.6 of Article 11 of the |
23 | | Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current EAV of |
24 | | real property located in any such project area that is |
25 | | attributable to an increase above the total initial EAV |
26 | | of such property shall be used as part of the EAV of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 346 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the Organizational Unit, until such time as all |
2 | | redevelopment project costs have been paid, as |
3 | | provided in Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment |
4 | | Allocation Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 |
5 | | of the Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of |
6 | | the EAV of the Organizational Unit, the total initial |
7 | | EAV or the current EAV, whichever is lower, shall be |
8 | | used until such time as all redevelopment project costs |
9 | | have been paid. |
10 | | (B-5) The real property equalized assessed |
11 | | valuation for a school district shall be adjusted by |
12 | | subtracting from the real property value, as equalized |
13 | | or assessed by the Department of Revenue, for the |
14 | | district an amount computed by dividing the amount of |
15 | | any abatement of taxes under Section 18-170 of the |
16 | | Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a district maintaining |
17 | | grades kindergarten through 12, by 2.30% for a district |
18 | | maintaining grades kindergarten through 8, or by 1.05% |
19 | | for a district maintaining grades 9 through 12 and |
20 | | adjusted by an amount computed by dividing the amount |
21 | | of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a) of |
22 | | Section 18-165 of the Property Tax Code by the same |
23 | | percentage rates for district type as specified in this |
24 | | subparagraph (B-5). |
25 | | (C) For Organizational Units that are Hybrid |
26 | | Districts, the State Superintendent shall use the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 347 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | lesser of the adjusted equalized assessed valuation |
2 | | for property within the partial elementary unit |
3 | | district for elementary purposes, as defined in |
4 | | Article 11E of this Code, or the adjusted equalized |
5 | | assessed valuation for property within the partial |
6 | | elementary unit district for high school purposes, as |
7 | | defined in Article 11E of this Code. |
8 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV shall be the |
9 | | average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 3 years |
10 | | or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if the EAV in |
11 | | the immediately preceding year has declined by 10% or more |
12 | | compared to the 3-year average. In the event of |
13 | | Organizational Unit reorganization, consolidation, or |
14 | | annexation, the Organizational Unit's Adjusted EAV for the |
15 | | first 3 years after such change shall be as follows: the |
16 | | most current EAV shall be used in the first year, the |
17 | | average of a 2-year EAV or its EAV in the immediately |
18 | | preceding year if the EAV declines by 10% or more compared |
19 | | to the 2-year average for the second year, and a 3-year |
20 | | average EAV or its EAV in the immediately preceding year if |
21 | | the Adjusted EAV declines by 10% or more compared to the |
22 | | 3-year average for the third year. For any school district |
23 | | whose EAV in the immediately preceding year is used in |
24 | | calculations, in the following year, the Adjusted EAV shall |
25 | | be the average of its EAV over the immediately preceding 2 |
26 | | years or the immediately preceding year if that year |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 348 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | represents a decline of 10% or more compared to the 2-year |
2 | | average. |
3 | | "PTELL EAV" means a figure calculated by the State |
4 | | Board for Organizational Units subject to PTELL as |
5 | | described in this paragraph (4) for the purposes of |
6 | | calculating an Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Ratio. |
7 | | Except as otherwise provided in this paragraph (4), the |
8 | | PTELL EAV of an Organizational Unit shall be equal to the |
9 | | product of the equalized assessed valuation last used in |
10 | | the calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 |
11 | | of this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under |
12 | | this Section and the Organizational Unit's Extension |
13 | | Limitation Ratio. If an Organizational Unit has approved or |
14 | | does approve an increase in its limiting rate, pursuant to |
15 | | Section 18-190 of the Property Tax Code, affecting the Base |
16 | | Tax Year, the PTELL EAV shall be equal to the product of |
17 | | the equalized assessed valuation last used in the |
18 | | calculation of general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of |
19 | | this Code (now repealed) or Evidence-Based Funding under |
20 | | this Section multiplied by an amount equal to one plus the |
21 | | percentage increase, if any, in the Consumer Price Index |
22 | | for All Urban Consumers for all items published by the |
23 | | United States Department of Labor for the 12-month calendar |
24 | | year preceding the Base Tax Year, plus the equalized |
25 | | assessed valuation of new property, annexed property, and |
26 | | recovered tax increment value and minus the equalized |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 349 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | assessed valuation of disconnected property. |
2 | | As used in this paragraph (4), "new property" and |
3 | | "recovered tax increment value" shall have the meanings set |
4 | | forth in the Property Tax Extension Limitation Law. |
5 | | (e) Base Funding Minimum calculation. |
6 | | (1) For the 2017-2018 school year, the Base Funding |
7 | | Minimum of an Organizational Unit or a Specially Funded |
8 | | Unit shall be the amount of State funds distributed to the |
9 | | Organizational Unit or Specially Funded Unit during the |
10 | | 2016-2017 school year prior to any adjustments and |
11 | | specified appropriation amounts described in this |
12 | | paragraph (1) from the following Sections, as calculated by |
13 | | the State Superintendent: Section 18-8.05 of this Code (now |
14 | | repealed); Section 5 of Article 224 of Public Act 99-524 |
15 | | (equity grants); Section 14-7.02b of this Code (funding for |
16 | | children requiring special education services); Section |
17 | | 14-13.01 of this Code (special education facilities and |
18 | | staffing), except for reimbursement of the cost of |
19 | | transportation pursuant to Section 14-13.01; Section |
20 | | 14C-12 of this Code (English learners); and Section 18-4.3 |
21 | | of this Code (summer school), based on an appropriation |
22 | | level of $13,121,600. For a school district organized under |
23 | | Article 34 of this Code, the Base Funding Minimum also |
24 | | includes (i) the funds allocated to the school district |
25 | | pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to |
26 | | funding programs authorized by the Sections of this Code |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 350 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | listed in the preceding sentence and (ii) the difference |
2 | | between (I) the funds allocated to the school district |
3 | | pursuant to Section 1D-1 of this Code attributable to the |
4 | | funding programs authorized by Section 14-7.02 (non-public |
5 | | special education reimbursement), subsection (b) of |
6 | | Section 14-13.01 (special education transportation), |
7 | | Section 29-5 (transportation), Section 2-3.80 |
8 | | (agricultural education), Section 2-3.66 (truants' |
9 | | alternative education), Section 2-3.62 (educational |
10 | | service centers), and Section 14-7.03 (special education - |
11 | | orphanage) of this Code and Section 15 of the Childhood |
12 | | Hunger Relief Act (free breakfast program) and (II) the |
13 | | school district's actual expenditures for its non-public |
14 | | special education, special education transportation, |
15 | | transportation programs, agricultural education, truants' |
16 | | alternative education, services that would otherwise be |
17 | | performed by a regional office of education, special |
18 | | education orphanage expenditures, and free breakfast, as |
19 | | most recently calculated and reported pursuant to |
20 | | subsection (f) of Section 1D-1 of this Code. The Base |
21 | | Funding Minimum for Glenwood Academy shall be $625,500. For |
22 | | programs operated by a regional office of education or an |
23 | | intermediate service center, the Base Funding Minimum must |
24 | | be the total amount of State funds allocated to those |
25 | | programs in the 2018-2019 school year and amounts provided |
26 | | pursuant to Article 34 of Public Act 100-586 and Section |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 351 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 3-16 of this Code. All programs established after June 5, |
2 | | 2019 (the effective date of Public Act 101-10) and |
3 | | administered by a regional office of education or an |
4 | | intermediate service center must have an initial Base |
5 | | Funding Minimum set to an amount equal to the first-year |
6 | | ASE multiplied by the amount of per pupil funding received |
7 | | in the previous school year by the lowest funded similar |
8 | | existing program type. If the enrollment for a program |
9 | | operated by a regional office of education or an |
10 | | intermediate service center is zero, then it may not |
11 | | receive Base Funding Minimum funds for that program in the |
12 | | next fiscal year, and those funds must be distributed to |
13 | | Organizational Units under subsection (g). |
14 | | (2) For the 2018-2019 and subsequent school years, the |
15 | | Base Funding Minimum of Organizational Units and Specially |
16 | | Funded Units shall be the sum of (i) the amount of |
17 | | Evidence-Based Funding for the prior school year, (ii) the |
18 | | Base Funding Minimum for the prior school year, and (iii) |
19 | | any amount received by a school district pursuant to |
20 | | Section 7 of Article 97 of Public Act 100-21. |
21 | | (3) Subject to approval by the General Assembly as |
22 | | provided in this paragraph (3), an Organizational Unit that |
23 | | meets all of the following criteria, as determined by the |
24 | | State Board, shall have District Intervention Money added |
25 | | to its Base Funding Minimum at the time the Base Funding |
26 | | Minimum is calculated by the State Board: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 352 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (A) The Organizational Unit is operating under an |
2 | | Independent Authority under Section 2-3.25f-5 of this |
3 | | Code for a minimum of 4 school years or is subject to |
4 | | the control of the State Board pursuant to a court |
5 | | order for a minimum of 4 school years. |
6 | | (B) The Organizational Unit was designated as a |
7 | | Tier 1 or Tier 2 Organizational Unit in the previous |
8 | | school year under paragraph (3) of subsection (g) of |
9 | | this Section. |
10 | | (C) The Organizational Unit demonstrates |
11 | | sustainability through a 5-year financial and |
12 | | strategic plan. |
13 | | (D) The Organizational Unit has made sufficient |
14 | | progress and achieved sufficient stability in the |
15 | | areas of governance, academic growth, and finances. |
16 | | As part of its determination under this paragraph (3), |
17 | | the State Board may consider the Organizational Unit's |
18 | | summative designation, any accreditations of the |
19 | | Organizational Unit, or the Organizational Unit's |
20 | | financial profile, as calculated by the State Board. |
21 | | If the State Board determines that an Organizational |
22 | | Unit has met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3), |
23 | | it must submit a report to the General Assembly, no later |
24 | | than January 2 of the fiscal year in which the State Board |
25 | | makes it determination, on the amount of District |
26 | | Intervention Money to add to the Organizational Unit's Base |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 353 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Funding Minimum. The General Assembly must review the State |
2 | | Board's report and may approve or disapprove, by joint |
3 | | resolution, the addition of District Intervention Money. |
4 | | If the General Assembly fails to act on the report within |
5 | | 40 calendar days from the receipt of the report, the |
6 | | addition of District Intervention Money is deemed |
7 | | approved. If the General Assembly approves the amount of |
8 | | District Intervention Money to be added to the |
9 | | Organizational Unit's Base Funding Minimum, the District |
10 | | Intervention Money must be added to the Base Funding |
11 | | Minimum annually thereafter. |
12 | | For the first 4 years following the initial year that |
13 | | the State Board determines that an Organizational Unit has |
14 | | met the criteria set forth in this paragraph (3) and has |
15 | | received funding under this Section, the Organizational |
16 | | Unit must annually submit to the State Board, on or before |
17 | | November 30, a progress report regarding its financial and |
18 | | strategic plan under subparagraph (C) of this paragraph |
19 | | (3). The plan shall include the financial data from the |
20 | | past 4 annual financial reports or financial audits that |
21 | | must be presented to the State Board by November 15 of each |
22 | | year and the approved budget financial data for the current |
23 | | year. The plan shall be developed according to the |
24 | | guidelines presented to the Organizational Unit by the |
25 | | State Board. The plan shall further include financial |
26 | | projections for the next 3 fiscal years and include a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 354 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | discussion and financial summary of the Organizational |
2 | | Unit's facility needs. If the Organizational Unit does not |
3 | | demonstrate sufficient progress toward its 5-year plan or |
4 | | if it has failed to file an annual financial report, an |
5 | | annual budget, a financial plan, a deficit reduction plan, |
6 | | or other financial information as required by law, the |
7 | | State Board may establish a Financial Oversight Panel under |
8 | | Article 1H of this Code. However, if the Organizational |
9 | | Unit already has a Financial Oversight Panel, the State |
10 | | Board may extend the duration of the Panel. |
11 | | (f) Percent of Adequacy and Final Resources calculation. |
12 | | (1) The Evidence-Based Funding formula establishes a |
13 | | Percent of Adequacy for each Organizational Unit in order |
14 | | to place such units into tiers for the purposes of the |
15 | | funding distribution system described in subsection (g) of |
16 | | this Section. Initially, an Organizational Unit's |
17 | | Preliminary Resources and Preliminary Percent of Adequacy |
18 | | are calculated pursuant to paragraph (2) of this subsection |
19 | | (f). Then, an Organizational Unit's Final Resources and |
20 | | Final Percent of Adequacy are calculated to account for the |
21 | | Organizational Unit's poverty concentration levels |
22 | | pursuant to paragraphs (3) and (4) of this subsection (f). |
23 | | (2) An Organizational Unit's Preliminary Resources are |
24 | | equal to the sum of its Local Capacity Target, CPPRT, and |
25 | | Base Funding Minimum. An Organizational Unit's Preliminary |
26 | | Percent of Adequacy is the lesser of (i) its Preliminary |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 355 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Resources divided by its Adequacy Target or (ii) 100%. |
2 | | (3) Except for Specially Funded Units, an |
3 | | Organizational Unit's Final Resources are equal to the sum |
4 | | of its Local Capacity, CPPRT, and Adjusted Base Funding |
5 | | Minimum. The Base Funding Minimum of each Specially Funded |
6 | | Unit shall serve as its Final Resources, except that the |
7 | | Base Funding Minimum for State-approved charter schools |
8 | | shall not include any portion of general State aid |
9 | | allocated in the prior year based on the per capita tuition |
10 | | charge times the charter school enrollment. |
11 | | (4) An Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy |
12 | | is its Final Resources divided by its Adequacy Target. An |
13 | | Organizational Unit's Adjusted Base Funding Minimum is |
14 | | equal to its Base Funding Minimum less its Supplemental |
15 | | Grant Funding, with the resulting figure added to the |
16 | | product of its Supplemental Grant Funding and Preliminary |
17 | | Percent of Adequacy. |
18 | | (g) Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system. |
19 | | (1) In each school year under the Evidence-Based |
20 | | Funding formula, each Organizational Unit receives funding |
21 | | equal to the sum of its Base Funding Minimum and the unit's |
22 | | allocation of New State Funds determined pursuant to this |
23 | | subsection (g). To allocate New State Funds, the |
24 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula distribution system first |
25 | | places all Organizational Units into one of 4 tiers in |
26 | | accordance with paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), based |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 356 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | on the Organizational Unit's Final Percent of Adequacy. New |
2 | | State Funds are allocated to each of the 4 tiers as |
3 | | follows: Tier 1 Aggregate Funding equals 50% of all New |
4 | | State Funds, Tier 2 Aggregate Funding equals 49% of all New |
5 | | State Funds, Tier 3 Aggregate Funding equals 0.9% of all |
6 | | New State Funds, and Tier 4 Aggregate Funding equals 0.1% |
7 | | of all New State Funds. Each Organizational Unit within |
8 | | Tier 1 or Tier 2 receives an allocation of New State Funds |
9 | | equal to its tier Funding Gap, as defined in the following |
10 | | sentence, multiplied by the tier's Allocation Rate |
11 | | determined pursuant to paragraph (4) of this subsection |
12 | | (g). For Tier 1, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap |
13 | | equals the tier's Target Ratio, as specified in paragraph |
14 | | (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the |
15 | | Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting |
16 | | amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final |
17 | | Resources. For Tier 2, an Organizational Unit's Funding Gap |
18 | | equals the tier's Target Ratio, as described in paragraph |
19 | | (5) of this subsection (g), multiplied by the |
20 | | Organizational Unit's Adequacy Target, with the resulting |
21 | | amount reduced by the Organizational Unit's Final |
22 | | Resources and its Tier 1 funding allocation. To determine |
23 | | the Organizational Unit's Funding Gap, the resulting |
24 | | amount is then multiplied by a factor equal to one minus |
25 | | the Organizational Unit's Local Capacity Target |
26 | | percentage. Each Organizational Unit within Tier 3 or Tier |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 357 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 4 receives an allocation of New State Funds equal to the |
2 | | product of its Adequacy Target and the tier's Allocation |
3 | | Rate, as specified in paragraph (4) of this subsection (g). |
4 | | (2) To ensure equitable distribution of dollars for all |
5 | | Tier 2 Organizational Units, no Tier 2 Organizational Unit |
6 | | shall receive fewer dollars per ASE than any Tier 3 |
7 | | Organizational Unit. Each Tier 2 and Tier 3 Organizational |
8 | | Unit shall have its funding allocation divided by its ASE. |
9 | | Any Tier 2 Organizational Unit with a funding allocation |
10 | | per ASE below the greatest Tier 3 allocation per ASE shall |
11 | | get a funding allocation equal to the greatest Tier 3 |
12 | | funding allocation per ASE multiplied by the |
13 | | Organizational Unit's ASE. Each Tier 2 Organizational |
14 | | Unit's Tier 2 funding allocation shall be multiplied by the |
15 | | percentage calculated by dividing the original Tier 2 |
16 | | Aggregate Funding by the sum of all Tier 2 Organizational |
17 | | Units' Tier 2 funding allocation after adjusting |
18 | | districts' funding below Tier 3 levels. |
19 | | (3) Organizational Units are placed into one of 4 tiers |
20 | | as follows: |
21 | | (A) Tier 1 consists of all Organizational Units, |
22 | | except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of |
23 | | Adequacy less than the Tier 1 Target Ratio. The Tier 1 |
24 | | Target Ratio is the ratio level that allows for Tier 1 |
25 | | Aggregate Funding to be distributed, with the Tier 1 |
26 | | Allocation Rate determined pursuant to paragraph (4) |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 358 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | of this subsection (g). |
2 | | (B) Tier 2 consists of all Tier 1 Units and all |
3 | | other Organizational Units, except for Specially |
4 | | Funded Units, with a Percent of Adequacy of less than |
5 | | 0.90. |
6 | | (C) Tier 3 consists of all Organizational Units, |
7 | | except for Specially Funded Units, with a Percent of |
8 | | Adequacy of at least 0.90 and less than 1.0. |
9 | | (D) Tier 4 consists of all Organizational Units |
10 | | with a Percent of Adequacy of at least 1.0. |
11 | | (4) The Allocation Rates for Tiers 1 through 4 are |
12 | | determined as follows: |
13 | | (A) The Tier 1 Allocation Rate is 30%. |
14 | | (B) The Tier 2 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
15 | | following equation: Tier 2 Aggregate Funding, divided |
16 | | by the sum of the Funding Gaps for all Tier 2 |
17 | | Organizational Units, unless the result of such |
18 | | equation is higher than 1.0. If the result of such |
19 | | equation is higher than 1.0, then the Tier 2 Allocation |
20 | | Rate is 1.0. |
21 | | (C) The Tier 3 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
22 | | following equation: Tier 3
Aggregate Funding, divided |
23 | | by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 3 |
24 | | Organizational
Units. |
25 | | (D) The Tier 4 Allocation Rate is the result of the |
26 | | following equation: Tier 4
Aggregate Funding, divided |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 359 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | by the sum of the Adequacy Targets of all Tier 4 |
2 | | Organizational
Units. |
3 | | (5) A tier's Target Ratio is determined as follows: |
4 | | (A) The Tier 1 Target Ratio is the ratio level that |
5 | | allows for Tier 1 Aggregate Funding to be distributed |
6 | | with the Tier 1 Allocation Rate. |
7 | | (B) The Tier 2 Target Ratio is 0.90. |
8 | | (C) The Tier 3 Target Ratio is 1.0. |
9 | | (6) If, at any point, the Tier 1 Target Ratio is |
10 | | greater than 90%, then than all Tier 1 funding shall be |
11 | | allocated to Tier 2 and no Tier 1 Organizational Unit's |
12 | | funding may be identified. |
13 | | (7) In the event that all Tier 2 Organizational Units |
14 | | receive funding at the Tier 2 Target Ratio level, any |
15 | | remaining New State Funds shall be allocated to Tier 3 and |
16 | | Tier 4 Organizational Units. |
17 | | (8) If any Specially Funded Units, excluding Glenwood |
18 | | Academy, recognized by the State Board do not qualify for |
19 | | direct funding following the implementation of Public Act |
20 | | 100-465 from any of the funding sources included within the |
21 | | definition of Base Funding Minimum, the unqualified |
22 | | portion of the Base Funding Minimum shall be transferred to |
23 | | one or more appropriate Organizational Units as determined |
24 | | by the State Superintendent based on the prior year ASE of |
25 | | the Organizational Units. |
26 | | (8.5) If a school district withdraws from a special |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 360 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | education cooperative, the portion of the Base Funding |
2 | | Minimum that is attributable to the school district may be |
3 | | redistributed to the school district upon withdrawal. The |
4 | | school district and the cooperative must include the amount |
5 | | of the Base Funding Minimum that is to be reapportioned in |
6 | | their withdrawal agreement and notify the State Board of |
7 | | the change with a copy of the agreement upon withdrawal. |
8 | | (9) The Minimum Funding Level is intended to establish |
9 | | a target for State funding that will keep pace with |
10 | | inflation and continue to advance equity through the |
11 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula. The target for State |
12 | | funding of New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds is |
13 | | $50,000,000 for State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State |
14 | | fiscal years. The Minimum Funding Level is equal to |
15 | | $350,000,000. In addition to any New State Funds, no more |
16 | | than $50,000,000 New Property Tax Relief Pool Funds may be |
17 | | counted toward the Minimum Funding Level. If the sum of New |
18 | | State Funds and applicable New Property Tax Relief Pool |
19 | | Funds are less than the Minimum Funding Level, than funding |
20 | | for tiers shall be reduced in the following manner: |
21 | | (A) First, Tier 4 funding shall be reduced by an |
22 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
23 | | Funding Level and New State Funds until such time as |
24 | | Tier 4 funding is exhausted. |
25 | | (B) Next, Tier 3 funding shall be reduced by an |
26 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 361 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
2 | | Tier 4 funding until such time as Tier 3 funding is |
3 | | exhausted. |
4 | | (C) Next, Tier 2 funding shall be reduced by an |
5 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
6 | | Funding Level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
7 | | Tier 4 and Tier 3. |
8 | | (D) Finally, Tier 1 funding shall be reduced by an |
9 | | amount equal to the difference between the Minimum |
10 | | Funding level and New State Funds and the reduction in |
11 | | Tier 2, 3, and 4 funding. In addition, the Allocation |
12 | | Rate for Tier 1 shall be reduced to a percentage equal |
13 | | to the Tier 1 Allocation Rate set by paragraph (4) of |
14 | | this subsection (g), multiplied by the result of New |
15 | | State Funds divided by the Minimum Funding Level. |
16 | | (9.5) For State fiscal year 2019 and subsequent State |
17 | | fiscal years, if New State Funds exceed $300,000,000, then |
18 | | any amount in excess of $300,000,000 shall be dedicated for |
19 | | purposes of Section 2-3.170 of this Code up to a maximum of |
20 | | $50,000,000. |
21 | | (10) In the event of a decrease in the amount of the |
22 | | appropriation for this Section in any fiscal year after |
23 | | implementation of this Section, the Organizational Units |
24 | | receiving Tier 1 and Tier 2 funding, as determined under |
25 | | paragraph (3) of this subsection (g), shall be held |
26 | | harmless by establishing a Base Funding Guarantee equal to |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 362 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the per pupil kindergarten through grade 12 funding |
2 | | received in accordance with this Section in the prior |
3 | | fiscal year. Reductions shall be
made to the Base Funding |
4 | | Minimum of Organizational Units in Tier 3 and Tier 4 on a
|
5 | | per pupil basis equivalent to the total number of the ASE |
6 | | in Tier 3-funded and Tier 4-funded Organizational Units |
7 | | divided by the total reduction in State funding. The Base
|
8 | | Funding Minimum as reduced shall continue to be applied to |
9 | | Tier 3 and Tier 4
Organizational Units and adjusted by the |
10 | | relative formula when increases in
appropriations for this |
11 | | Section resume. In no event may State funding reductions to
|
12 | | Organizational Units in Tier 3 or Tier 4 exceed an amount |
13 | | that would be less than the
Base Funding Minimum |
14 | | established in the first year of implementation of this
|
15 | | Section. If additional reductions are required, all school |
16 | | districts shall receive a
reduction by a per pupil amount |
17 | | equal to the aggregate additional appropriation
reduction |
18 | | divided by the total ASE of all Organizational Units. |
19 | | (11) The State Superintendent shall make minor |
20 | | adjustments to the distribution formula set forth in this |
21 | | subsection (g) to account for the rounding of percentages |
22 | | to the nearest tenth of a percentage and dollar amounts to |
23 | | the nearest whole dollar. |
24 | | (h) State Superintendent administration of funding and |
25 | | district submission requirements. |
26 | | (1) The State Superintendent shall, in accordance with |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 363 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | appropriations made by the General Assembly, meet the |
2 | | funding obligations created under this Section. |
3 | | (2) The State Superintendent shall calculate the |
4 | | Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit and Net State |
5 | | Contribution Target for each Organizational Unit under |
6 | | this Section. No Evidence-Based Funding shall be |
7 | | distributed within an Organizational Unit without the |
8 | | approval of the unit's school board. |
9 | | (3) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate |
10 | | and report to each Organizational Unit the unit's aggregate |
11 | | financial adequacy amount, which shall be the sum of the |
12 | | Adequacy Target for each Organizational Unit. The State |
13 | | Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for |
14 | | each Organizational Unit the unit's total State funds |
15 | | allocated for its students with disabilities. The State |
16 | | Superintendent shall calculate and report separately for |
17 | | each Organizational Unit the amount of funding and |
18 | | applicable FTE calculated for each Essential Element of the |
19 | | unit's Adequacy Target. |
20 | | (4) Annually, the State Superintendent shall calculate |
21 | | and report to each Organizational Unit the amount the unit |
22 | | must expend on special education and bilingual education |
23 | | and computer technology and equipment for Organizational |
24 | | Units assigned to Tier 1 or Tier 2 that received an |
25 | | additional $285.50 per student computer technology and |
26 | | equipment investment grant to their Adequacy Target |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 364 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | pursuant to the unit's Base Funding Minimum, Special |
2 | | Education Allocation, Bilingual Education Allocation, and |
3 | | computer technology and equipment investment allocation. |
4 | | (5) Moneys distributed under this Section shall be |
5 | | calculated on a school year basis, but paid on a fiscal |
6 | | year basis, with payments beginning in August and extending |
7 | | through June. Unless otherwise provided, the moneys |
8 | | appropriated for each fiscal year shall be distributed in |
9 | | 22 equal payments at least 2 times monthly to each |
10 | | Organizational Unit. If moneys appropriated for any fiscal |
11 | | year are distributed other than monthly, the distribution |
12 | | shall be on the same basis for each Organizational Unit. |
13 | | (6) Any school district that fails, for any given |
14 | | school year, to maintain school as required by law or to |
15 | | maintain a recognized school is not eligible to receive |
16 | | Evidence-Based Funding. In case of non-recognition of one |
17 | | or more attendance centers in a school district otherwise |
18 | | operating recognized schools, the claim of the district |
19 | | shall be reduced in the proportion that the enrollment in |
20 | | the attendance center or centers bears to the enrollment of |
21 | | the school district. "Recognized school" means any public |
22 | | school that meets the standards for recognition by the |
23 | | State Board. A school district or attendance center not |
24 | | having recognition status at the end of a school term is |
25 | | entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal |
26 | | claim that was filed while it was recognized. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 365 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (7) School district claims filed under this Section are |
2 | | subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12 of this Code, except as |
3 | | otherwise provided in this Section. |
4 | | (8) Each fiscal year, the State Superintendent shall |
5 | | calculate for each Organizational Unit an amount of its |
6 | | Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based Funding that shall |
7 | | be deemed attributable to the provision of special |
8 | | educational facilities and services, as defined in Section |
9 | | 14-1.08 of this Code, in a manner that ensures compliance |
10 | | with maintenance of State financial support requirements |
11 | | under the federal Individuals with Disabilities Education |
12 | | Act. An Organizational Unit must use such funds only for |
13 | | the provision of special educational facilities and |
14 | | services, as defined in Section 14-1.08 of this Code, and |
15 | | must comply with any expenditure verification procedures |
16 | | adopted by the State Board. |
17 | | (9) All Organizational Units in this State must submit |
18 | | annual spending plans by the end of September of each year |
19 | | to the State Board as part of the annual budget process, |
20 | | which shall describe how each Organizational Unit will |
21 | | utilize the Base Funding Minimum and Evidence-Based |
22 | | Funding it receives from this State under this Section with |
23 | | specific identification of the intended utilization of |
24 | | Low-Income, English learner, and special education |
25 | | resources. Additionally, the annual spending plans of each |
26 | | Organizational Unit shall describe how the Organizational |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 366 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Unit expects to achieve student growth and how the |
2 | | Organizational Unit will achieve State education goals, as |
3 | | defined by the State Board. The State Superintendent may, |
4 | | from time to time, identify additional requisites for |
5 | | Organizational Units to satisfy when compiling the annual |
6 | | spending plans required under this subsection (h). The |
7 | | format and scope of annual spending plans shall be |
8 | | developed by the State Superintendent and the State Board |
9 | | of Education. School districts that serve students under |
10 | | Article 14C of this Code shall continue to submit |
11 | | information as required under Section 14C-12 of this Code. |
12 | | (10) No later than January 1, 2018, the State |
13 | | Superintendent shall develop a 5-year strategic plan for |
14 | | all Organizational Units to help in planning for adequacy |
15 | | funding under this Section. The State Superintendent shall |
16 | | submit the plan to the Governor and the General Assembly, |
17 | | as provided in Section 3.1 of the General Assembly |
18 | | Organization Act. The plan shall include recommendations |
19 | | for: |
20 | | (A) a framework for collaborative, professional, |
21 | | innovative, and 21st century learning environments |
22 | | using the Evidence-Based Funding model; |
23 | | (B) ways to prepare and support this State's |
24 | | educators for successful instructional careers; |
25 | | (C) application and enhancement of the current |
26 | | financial accountability measures, the approved State |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 367 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | plan to comply with the federal Every Student Succeeds |
2 | | Act, and the Illinois Balanced Accountability Measures |
3 | | in relation to student growth and elements of the |
4 | | Evidence-Based Funding model; and |
5 | | (D) implementation of an effective school adequacy |
6 | | funding system based on projected and recommended |
7 | | funding levels from the General Assembly. |
8 | | (11) On an annual basis, the State Superintendent
must |
9 | | recalibrate all of the following per pupil elements of the |
10 | | Adequacy Target and applied to the formulas, based on the |
11 | | study of average expenses and as reported in the most |
12 | | recent annual financial report: |
13 | | (A) Gifted under subparagraph (M) of paragraph
(2) |
14 | | of subsection (b). |
15 | | (B) Instructional materials under subparagraph
(O) |
16 | | of paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
17 | | (C) Assessment under subparagraph (P) of
paragraph |
18 | | (2) of subsection (b). |
19 | | (D) Student activities under subparagraph (R) of
|
20 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
21 | | (E) Maintenance and operations under subparagraph
|
22 | | (S) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
23 | | (F) Central office under subparagraph (T) of
|
24 | | paragraph (2) of subsection (b). |
25 | | (i) Professional Review Panel. |
26 | | (1) A Professional Review Panel is created to study and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 368 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | review topics related to the implementation and effect of |
2 | | Evidence-Based Funding, as assigned by a joint resolution |
3 | | or Public Act of the General Assembly or a motion passed by |
4 | | the State Board of Education. The Panel must provide |
5 | | recommendations to and serve the Governor, the General |
6 | | Assembly, and the State Board. The State Superintendent or |
7 | | his or her designee must serve as a voting member and |
8 | | chairperson of the Panel. The State Superintendent must |
9 | | appoint a vice chairperson from the membership of the |
10 | | Panel. The Panel must advance recommendations based on a |
11 | | three-fifths majority vote of Panel members present and |
12 | | voting. A minority opinion may also accompany any |
13 | | recommendation of the Panel. The Panel shall be appointed |
14 | | by the State Superintendent, except as otherwise provided |
15 | | in paragraph (2) of this subsection (i) and include the |
16 | | following members: |
17 | | (A) Two appointees that represent district |
18 | | superintendents, recommended by a statewide |
19 | | organization that represents district superintendents. |
20 | | (B) Two appointees that represent school boards, |
21 | | recommended by a statewide organization that |
22 | | represents school boards. |
23 | | (C) Two appointees from districts that represent |
24 | | school business officials, recommended by a statewide |
25 | | organization that represents school business |
26 | | officials. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 369 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (D) Two appointees that represent school |
2 | | principals, recommended by a statewide organization |
3 | | that represents school principals. |
4 | | (E) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
5 | | recommended by a statewide organization that |
6 | | represents teachers. |
7 | | (F) Two appointees that represent teachers, |
8 | | recommended by another statewide organization that |
9 | | represents teachers. |
10 | | (G) Two appointees that represent regional |
11 | | superintendents of schools, recommended by |
12 | | organizations that represent regional superintendents. |
13 | | (H) Two independent experts selected solely by the |
14 | | State Superintendent. |
15 | | (I) Two independent experts recommended by public |
16 | | universities in this State. |
17 | | (J) One member recommended by a statewide |
18 | | organization that represents parents. |
19 | | (K) Two representatives recommended by collective |
20 | | impact organizations that represent major metropolitan |
21 | | areas or geographic areas in Illinois. |
22 | | (L) One member from a statewide organization |
23 | | focused on research-based education policy to support |
24 | | a school system that prepares all students for college, |
25 | | a career, and democratic citizenship. |
26 | | (M) One representative from a school district |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 370 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | organized under Article 34 of this Code. |
2 | | The State Superintendent shall ensure that the |
3 | | membership of the Panel includes representatives from |
4 | | school districts and communities reflecting the |
5 | | geographic, socio-economic, racial, and ethnic diversity |
6 | | of this State. The State Superintendent shall additionally |
7 | | ensure that the membership of the Panel includes |
8 | | representatives with expertise in bilingual education and |
9 | | special education. Staff from the State Board shall staff |
10 | | the Panel. |
11 | | (2) In addition to those Panel members appointed by the |
12 | | State Superintendent, 4 members of the General Assembly |
13 | | shall be appointed as follows: one member of the House of |
14 | | Representatives appointed by the Speaker of the House of |
15 | | Representatives, one member of the Senate appointed by the |
16 | | President of the Senate, one member of the House of |
17 | | Representatives appointed by the Minority Leader of the |
18 | | House of Representatives, and one member of the Senate |
19 | | appointed by the Minority Leader of the Senate. There shall |
20 | | be one additional member appointed by the Governor. All |
21 | | members appointed by legislative leaders or the Governor |
22 | | shall be non-voting, ex officio members. |
23 | | (3) The Panel must study topics at the direction of the |
24 | | General Assembly or State Board of Education, as provided |
25 | | under paragraph (1). The Panel may also study the following |
26 | | topics at the direction of the chairperson: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 371 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (A) The format and scope of annual spending plans |
2 | | referenced in paragraph (9) of subsection (h) of this |
3 | | Section. |
4 | | (B) The Comparable Wage Index under this Section. |
5 | | (C) Maintenance and operations, including capital |
6 | | maintenance and construction costs. |
7 | | (D) "At-risk student" definition. |
8 | | (E) Benefits. |
9 | | (F) Technology. |
10 | | (G) Local Capacity Target. |
11 | | (H) Funding for Alternative Schools, Laboratory |
12 | | Schools, safe schools, and alternative learning |
13 | | opportunities programs. |
14 | | (I) Funding for college and career acceleration |
15 | | strategies. |
16 | | (J) Special education investments. |
17 | | (K) Early childhood investments, in collaboration |
18 | | with the Illinois Early Learning Council. |
19 | | (4) (Blank). |
20 | | (5) Within 5 years after the implementation of this |
21 | | Section, and every 5 years thereafter, the Panel shall |
22 | | complete an evaluative study of the entire Evidence-Based |
23 | | Funding model, including an assessment of whether or not |
24 | | the formula is achieving State goals. The Panel shall |
25 | | report to the State Board, the General Assembly, and the |
26 | | Governor on the findings of the study. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 372 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (6) (Blank). |
2 | | (7) To ensure that (i) the Adequacy Target calculation |
3 | | under subsection (b) accurately reflects the needs of |
4 | | students living in poverty or attending schools located in |
5 | | areas of high poverty, (ii) racial equity within the |
6 | | Evidence-Based Funding formula is explicitly explored and |
7 | | advanced, and (iii) the funding goals of the formula |
8 | | distribution system established under this Section are |
9 | | sufficient to provide adequate funding for every student |
10 | | and to fully fund every school in this State, the Panel |
11 | | shall review the Essential Elements under paragraph (2) of |
12 | | subsection (b). The Panel shall consider all of the |
13 | | following in its review: |
14 | | (A) The financial ability of school districts to |
15 | | provide instruction in a foreign language to every |
16 | | student and whether an additional Essential Element |
17 | | should be added to the formula to ensure that every |
18 | | student has access to instruction in a foreign |
19 | | language. |
20 | | (B) The adult-to-student ratio for each Essential |
21 | | Element in which a ratio is identified. The Panel shall |
22 | | consider whether the ratio accurately reflects the |
23 | | staffing needed to support students living in poverty |
24 | | or who have traumatic backgrounds. |
25 | | (C) Changes to the Essential Elements that may be |
26 | | required to better promote racial equity and eliminate |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 373 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | structural racism within schools. |
2 | | (D) The impact of investing $350,000,000 in |
3 | | additional funds each year under this Section and an |
4 | | estimate of when the school system will become fully |
5 | | funded under this level of appropriation. |
6 | | (E) Provide an overview of alternative funding |
7 | | structures that would enable the State to become fully |
8 | | funded at an earlier date. |
9 | | (F) The potential to increase efficiency and to |
10 | | find cost savings within the school system to expedite |
11 | | the journey to a fully funded system. |
12 | | On or before April 1, 2021, the Panel shall report to |
13 | | the State Board, the General Assembly, and the Governor on |
14 | | the findings of its review. This paragraph (7) is |
15 | | inoperative on and after April 1, 2022. |
16 | | (j) References. Beginning July 1, 2017, references in other |
17 | | laws to general State aid funds or calculations under Section |
18 | | 18-8.05 of this Code (now repealed) shall be deemed to be |
19 | | references to evidence-based model formula funds or |
20 | | calculations under this Section.
|
21 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17; 100-578, eff. 1-31-18; |
22 | | 100-582, eff. 3-23-18; 101-10, eff. 6-5-19; 101-17, eff. |
23 | | 6-14-19; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20; revised 8-21-20.) |
24 | | Article 90. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 374 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 90-5. The Department of Human Services Act is |
2 | | amended by adding Section 10-75 as follows: |
3 | | (20 ILCS 1305/10-75 new) |
4 | | Sec. 10-75. Findings; compensation; barriers. |
5 | | (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following |
6 | | findings: |
7 | | (1) Research demonstrates that the effectiveness of an |
8 | | early childhood teacher is a predictor for the positive |
9 | | developmental and academic outcomes for children. |
10 | | (2) The work of early childhood educators is |
11 | | sophisticated and central to the healthy learning and |
12 | | development of young children and takes place in diverse |
13 | | settings, including schools, community-based centers, and |
14 | | homes. |
15 | | (3) It is critically important for children's outcome |
16 | | to have educators that reflect the diversity of the |
17 | | families and communities they serve. |
18 | | (4) The early childhood workforce is more racially |
19 | | diverse than the K-12 workforce and its members hold |
20 | | degrees, have earned credentials, and have years of |
21 | | experience in the field of early childhood education. |
22 | | (5) The early childhood workforce, particularly those |
23 | | members who work in community-based settings and those who |
24 | | work with infants and toddlers, are often not paid wages |
25 | | that are aligned with the sophistication of their work and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 375 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | their level of education. |
2 | | (6) All regions and settings have difficulty in finding |
3 | | qualified teachers. |
4 | | (7) A disproportionate number of Black and Latinx women |
5 | | serve in essential, frontline positions, but are |
6 | | underrepresented as lead teachers and in program |
7 | | leadership where credentials and degrees are required. |
8 | | (8) Members of the early childhood workforce face |
9 | | multiple barriers that prevent them from attaining the |
10 | | additional credentials and degrees required for career |
11 | | advancement and higher levels of compensation. |
12 | | (b) The Department of Human Services shall conduct an |
13 | | analysis of the data relating to teachers that is available in |
14 | | the Gateways to Opportunity Registry under the Gateways to |
15 | | Opportunity program established in Section 10-70 of this Act to |
16 | | ascertain those individuals who are participating in the |
17 | | Gateways to Opportunity program and who are close to attaining |
18 | | a higher credential lever or degree. If the following |
19 | | information is available in the Gateways to Opportunity |
20 | | Registry, the analysis of data about an identified individual |
21 | | shall include the individual's geographic location, |
22 | | demographic information, work setting, and the age groups of |
23 | | the children for which the individual is responsible. |
24 | | (c) The Department of Human Services shall conduct outreach |
25 | | and provide targeted coaching and access to financial support |
26 | | that shall include, but is not limited to, scholarships and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 376 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | debt relief, to members of the early childhood workforce in a |
2 | | manner that must prioritize (i) increasing the diversity of the |
3 | | teacher pipeline, (ii) the regions in the State that have the |
4 | | greatest need, and (iii) those children in age groups who are |
5 | | experiencing the greatest shortage of teachers. |
6 | | (d) The State Board of Education, in cooperation with the |
7 | | Department of Human Services, shall provide additional |
8 | | financial support to members of the early childhood workforce |
9 | | regardless of the setting in which they work and the |
10 | | credentials they seek. The State Board of Education shall |
11 | | prioritize potential candidates for assistance under this |
12 | | Section by those individuals who have the greatest need in the |
13 | | field of early childhood education. |
14 | | (e) The Department of Human Services shall prepare and |
15 | | submit reports annually to the General Assembly disclosing the |
16 | | individuals who received financial assistance, scholarships, |
17 | | or other types of financial support provided through or |
18 | | administered by the Department of Human Services or by the |
19 | | State Board of Education. If the following information is |
20 | | available in the Gateways to Opportunity Registry, the analysis |
21 | | of data about the recipients of financial assistance shall |
22 | | include the geographic location, demographic information, work |
23 | | setting, the age groups of the children for which a recipient |
24 | | is responsible, and the degrees or credentials a recipient has |
25 | | attained. |
26 | | (f) In cooperation with the Department of Human Services, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 377 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the Board of Higher Education in the course of their strategic |
2 | | planning process shall review the barriers to higher education |
3 | | and career advancement experienced by the early childhood |
4 | | workforce and by teachers of color. The Board of Higher |
5 | | Education shall place particular focus on the barriers |
6 | | experienced by the early childhood workforce and by teachers of |
7 | | color in accessing and completing the required coursework |
8 | | needed to attain additional credentials and degrees. The Board |
9 | | of Higher Education shall make policy recommendations and |
10 | | recommendations for the changes in practices to better meet the |
11 | | needs of the early childhood workforce that is largely |
12 | | comprised of non-traditional students and women of color. |
13 | | (g) Subject to appropriation, the Department of Human |
14 | | Services and the State Board of Education shall prioritize |
15 | | reducing the compensation disparities that exist between |
16 | | members of the early childhood workforce and their K-12 |
17 | | workforce counterparts and the disparities that exist within |
18 | | the early childhood workforce between the settings and the age |
19 | | groups of children in which they work. |
20 | | Article 95. |
21 | | Section 95-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the |
22 | | Equity in Higher Education Act. References in this Article to |
23 | | "this Act" mean this Article. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 378 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 95-5. Findings; policies. |
2 | | (a) The General Assembly finds the following: |
3 | | (1) Historic and continuous systemic racism has |
4 | | created significant disparities in college access, |
5 | | affordability, and completion for Black, Latinx, |
6 | | low-income, and other underrepresented and historically |
7 | | underserved students. |
8 | | (2) Higher education is examining its role as a |
9 | | contributor to systemic racism, while recognizing its |
10 | | place in providing opportunity and upward mobility, and its |
11 | | role as a powerful actor in dismantling systemic racism. |
12 | | (3) Chicago State University has created the Equity |
13 | | Working Group, which includes statewide representation of |
14 | | private, community, and public sector stakeholders, to |
15 | | create an action plan for employers, the secondary and |
16 | | postsecondary education systems, philanthropic |
17 | | organizations, community-based organizations, and our |
18 | | executive and legislative bodies to improve college |
19 | | access, completion, and post-graduation outcomes for Black |
20 | | college students in Illinois. |
21 | | (4) Despite similar numbers of Black high school |
22 | | graduates, Illinois saw about 25,000 fewer Black enrollees |
23 | | in Illinois higher education in 2018 compared to 2008. |
24 | | (5) Illinois must address wide disparities in degree |
25 | | completion at Illinois community colleges, which currently |
26 | | graduate Black and Latinx students at a rate of 14% and 26% |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 379 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | respectively compared to the rate of 38% for White |
2 | | students, as well as at public universities, which |
3 | | currently graduate Black and Latinx students at a rate of |
4 | | 34% and 49% respectively compared to 66% of White students, |
5 | | within 6 years. |
6 | | (6) The State of Illinois benefits from a diverse |
7 | | public higher education system that includes universities |
8 | | and community colleges with different missions and scopes |
9 | | that maximize college enrollment, persistence, and |
10 | | completion of underrepresented and historically |
11 | | underserved students, including Black and Latinx students |
12 | | and students from low-income families. |
13 | | (7) Illinois has a moral obligation and an economic |
14 | | interest in dismantling and reforming structures that |
15 | | create or exacerbate racial and socioeconomic inequities |
16 | | in K-12 and higher education. |
17 | | (8) The Board of Higher Education has a statutory |
18 | | obligation to create a strategic plan for higher education |
19 | | and has adopted core principles to guide this plan. |
20 | | (9) The Board of Higher Education has included among |
21 | | its core principles designed to guide the strategic plan |
22 | | the assumption that excellence coupled with equity should |
23 | | drive the higher education system and that the higher |
24 | | education system will make equity-driven decisions, |
25 | | elevating the voices of those who have been underserved, |
26 | | and actively identify and remove systemic barriers that |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 380 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | have prevented students of color, first generation college |
2 | | students, low-income students, adult learners, and rural |
3 | | students from accessing and succeeding in higher |
4 | | education; access and affordability as well as high quality |
5 | | are embedded in the definition of equity. |
6 | | (b) The General Assembly supports all of the following work |
7 | | and goals of the Board of Higher Education: |
8 | | (1) Its work on the strategic plan for higher education |
9 | | and the vision it has set forth that over the next 10 years |
10 | | Illinois will have an equitable, accessible, innovative, |
11 | | nimble, and aligned higher education ecosystem that |
12 | | ensures individuals, families, and communities across the |
13 | | state thrive. |
14 | | (2) Its goal to close equity gaps in higher education |
15 | | in Illinois and that the strategic plan will identify |
16 | | multiple strategies to achieve this goal. |
17 | | (3) Its goal to increase postsecondary |
18 | | credential/degree attainment and develop talent to drive |
19 | | the economy of Illinois and that the strategic plan will |
20 | | identify strategies to achieve this goal, including |
21 | | embedding equity in the State's attainment goal. |
22 | | (4) Its goal to improve higher education |
23 | | affordability, increase access, and manage costs and the |
24 | | expectation that the strategic plan will identify |
25 | | strategies for stakeholders to achieve these goals, |
26 | | including opportunities to improve efficiency and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 381 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | principles for equitable and adequate ways to fund higher |
2 | | education.
|
3 | | (c) The General Assembly encourages the Board of Higher |
4 | | Education to prepare an array of policy, practice, and proposed |
5 | | legislative changes required to implement the strategic plan, |
6 | | along with an implementation process and timeline by May 1, |
7 | | 2021 and to regularly evaluate the impact of the implementation |
8 | | of the strategic plan and publicly report the evaluation to |
9 | | ensure that the goals are achieved as intended and lead to a |
10 | | high-quality, equitable, and diverse higher education system |
11 | | in Illinois. |
12 | | Article 100. |
13 | | Section 100-1. Short title. This Act may be cited as the |
14 | | Developmental Education Reform Act. References in this Article |
15 | | to "this Act" mean this Article. |
16 | | Section 100-5. Findings. The General Assembly makes all of |
17 | | the following findings: |
18 | | (1) Nearly 50% of this State's high school graduates |
19 | | who enroll full-time in a community college are placed in |
20 | | developmental education coursework in at least one |
21 | | subject. Community colleges place nearly 71% of Black |
22 | | students in developmental education courses compared to |
23 | | 42% of white students. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 382 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) Traditional developmental education courses cost |
2 | | students' time and money and expend their financial aid |
3 | | because a student does not receive college credit for the |
4 | | successful completion of a traditional developmental |
5 | | education course. This can be a barrier to enrollment, |
6 | | persistence, and certificate or degree completion. |
7 | | (3) Developmental education courses can exacerbate |
8 | | inequities in higher education. Community colleges |
9 | | graduate Black students who are placed in developmental |
10 | | education courses at a rate of approximately 8% compared to |
11 | | a graduation rate of 26% for white students who are placed |
12 | | in developmental education courses. |
13 | | (4) A history of inconsistent and inadequate |
14 | | approaches to student placement in community college |
15 | | coursework, such as the reliance on standardized test |
16 | | scores, has resulted in too many students being placed in |
17 | | developmental education coursework who could otherwise |
18 | | succeed in introductory college-level coursework or |
19 | | introductory college-level coursework with concurrent |
20 | | support. |
21 | | (5) Public institutions of higher education and State |
22 | | agencies have undertaken voluntary efforts and committed |
23 | | resources to improve placement and to address disparities |
24 | | in the successful completion of introductory college-level |
25 | | coursework. |
26 | | (6) The Illinois Council of Community College |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 383 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Presidents, the Illinois Community College Chief Academic |
2 | | Officers Commission, the Illinois Community College Chief |
3 | | Student Services Officers Commission, and the Illinois |
4 | | Mathematics Association of Community Colleges have already |
5 | | developed and approved a more equitable, multiple measures |
6 | | framework for placement in coursework that is currently |
7 | | implemented at many but not all community colleges. |
8 | | (7) In 2019, members of the General Assembly, faculty |
9 | | and administrators from public institutions of higher |
10 | | education, board trustees from community college |
11 | | districts, representatives from the Board of Higher |
12 | | Education, the Illinois Community College Board, and other |
13 | | appointed stakeholders convened a task force to inventory |
14 | | and study developmental education models employed by |
15 | | public community colleges and universities in this State |
16 | | and to submit a detailed plan for scaling developmental |
17 | | education reforms in which all students who are placed in |
18 | | developmental education coursework are enrolled in an |
19 | | evidence-based developmental education model that |
20 | | maximizes a student's likelihood of completing an |
21 | | introductory college-level course within his or her first 2 |
22 | | semesters at an institution of higher education. The data |
23 | | released by the task force indicates all of the following: |
24 | | (A) Despite more effective developmental education |
25 | | models, community colleges and universities use the |
26 | | traditional developmental education model for 77% of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 384 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | students who place in a developmental education |
2 | | mathematics course and for 67% of students who place in |
3 | | a developmental English language course. |
4 | | (B) In a 2017 cohort study, only 25% of the |
5 | | students who were placed in traditional developmental |
6 | | education mathematics courses and only 42% of students |
7 | | who were placed in traditional developmental English |
8 | | language courses completed the developmental education |
9 | | courses and introductory college-level courses with a |
10 | | grade of "C" or better within 2 years compared to the |
11 | | completion rate of 65% of students who were placed |
12 | | directly in introductory college-level mathematics |
13 | | courses with concurrent support and 75% of students who |
14 | | were placed directly in introductory college-level |
15 | | English language courses with concurrent support. |
16 | | (C) Improved policies, programs, and practices are |
17 | | essential to address the systemic inequities that |
18 | | exist in postsecondary education in this State, such as |
19 | | the disproportionate enrollment of Black students in |
20 | | developmental education courses. |
21 | | Section 100-10. Definitions. In this Act: |
22 | | "College-level English language or mathematics course" or |
23 | | "college-level English language or mathematics coursework" |
24 | | means a course that bears credit and fulfills English language |
25 | | or mathematics credit requirements for a baccalaureate degree, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 385 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | a certificate, or an associate degree from a postsecondary |
2 | | educational institution. |
3 | | "Community college" means a public community college in |
4 | | this State.
|
5 | | "Developmental education" means instruction through which |
6 | | a high school graduate who applies to a college credit program |
7 | | may attain the communication and computation skills necessary |
8 | | to successfully complete college-level coursework.
|
9 | | "Developmental education course" or "developmental |
10 | | education coursework" means a course or a category of courses |
11 | | in which students are placed based on an institution's finding |
12 | | that a student does not have the proficiency necessary to |
13 | | succeed in an introductory college-level English language or |
14 | | mathematics course. |
15 | | "Institution of higher education" or "institution" means a |
16 | | public community college or university in this State. |
17 | | "University" means a public university in this State. |
18 | | Section 100-15. Placement measures. |
19 | | (a) On or before May 1, 2022, a community college shall use |
20 | | each of the following measures, as appropriate, to determine |
21 | | the placement of a student in introductory college-level |
22 | | English language or mathematics coursework and shall use the |
23 | | scores set forth in recommendations approved by the Illinois |
24 | | Council of Community College Presidents on June 1, 2018: |
25 | | (1) A student's cumulative high school grade point |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 386 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | average. |
2 | | (2) A student's successful completion of an |
3 | | appropriate high school transition course in mathematics |
4 | | or English. |
5 | | (3) A student's successful completion of an |
6 | | appropriate developmental education or introductory |
7 | | college-level English language or mathematics course at |
8 | | another regionally accredited postsecondary educational |
9 | | institution. |
10 | | (b) In determining the placement of a student in |
11 | | introductory college-level English language or mathematics |
12 | | coursework, a community college shall consider the |
13 | | standardized test scores provided by the student for placement |
14 | | in an introductory college-level English language or |
15 | | mathematics course. |
16 | | In addition, a community college is encouraged to use the |
17 | | scores set forth in recommendations approved by the Illinois |
18 | | Council of Community College Presidents on June 1, 2018 and |
19 | | should also consider other individual measures for placement in |
20 | | an introductory college-level English language or mathematics |
21 | | course, as set forth in recommendations approved by the |
22 | | Illinois Council of Community College Presidents on June 1, |
23 | | 2018, and the scores set forth in those recommendations. |
24 | | In its discretion, a community college may accept a lower |
25 | | score on individual placement measures or accept lower scores |
26 | | in combination with other placement measures than those set |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 387 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | forth in the recommendations. |
2 | | (c) If a student qualifies for placement in an introductory |
3 | | college-level English language or mathematics course using a |
4 | | single measure under subsection (a) or (b), no additional |
5 | | measures need to be considered for placement of the student in |
6 | | the introductory college-level English language or mathematics |
7 | | course. |
8 | | Section 100-20. Recommendations of Illinois Council of |
9 | | Community College Presidents; revisions. If the Illinois |
10 | | Council of Community College Presidents approves any revised |
11 | | recommendations for determining the placement of students in |
12 | | introductory college-level English language or mathematics |
13 | | courses in response to changes in scoring systems, the |
14 | | introduction and use of additional measures, or evidence that |
15 | | demonstrates the inaccuracy in the use of scores in previous |
16 | | recommendations, then, within one year after the date of the |
17 | | adoption of those revised recommendations, references in this |
18 | | Act to recommendations approved by the Illinois Council of |
19 | | Community College Presidents on June 1, 2018 shall mean the |
20 | | revised recommendations. The General Assembly may request that |
21 | | the Illinois Council of Community College Presidents provide to |
22 | | the General Assembly the rationale and supporting evidence for |
23 | | any revision to the Council's recommendations. |
24 | | Section 100-25. Placement policy; report. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 388 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (a) Each institution of higher education shall publicly |
2 | | post its placement policy in a manner that is easily accessible |
3 | | to both students and prospective students. |
4 | | (b) On or before July 1, 2023, the Illinois Community |
5 | | College Board shall issue a report, which shall be made |
6 | | available to the public on its Internet website, concerning |
7 | | each community college's developmental education and |
8 | | college-level coursework placement policy and the policy's |
9 | | outcomes. The data disclosed in the report must be consistent |
10 | | with the Illinois Community College Board's requirements for |
11 | | data collection and must be disaggregated by developmental |
12 | | education course model, as defined by the Illinois Community |
13 | | College Board, and by gender, race and ethnicity, and federal |
14 | | Pell Grant status. |
15 | | Section 100-30. Institutional plans; report. |
16 | | (a) On or before January 1, 2022, each university shall |
17 | | submit to the Board of Higher Education and each community |
18 | | college shall submit to the Illinois Community College Board |
19 | | its institutional plan for scaling evidence-based |
20 | | developmental education reforms to maximize the probability |
21 | | that a student will be placed in and successfully complete |
22 | | introductory college-level English language or mathematics |
23 | | coursework within 2 semesters at the institution. At a minimum, |
24 | | a plan submitted by an institution shall include all of the |
25 | | following: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 389 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) A description of the current developmental |
2 | | education models offered by the institution. If the |
3 | | institution does not currently offer developmental |
4 | | education coursework, it must provide details regarding |
5 | | its decision not to offer developmental education |
6 | | coursework and the pathways that are available to students |
7 | | deemed to be insufficiently prepared for introductory |
8 | | college-level English language or mathematics coursework. |
9 | | (2) A description of the developmental education |
10 | | models that will be implemented and scaled and the basis of |
11 | | the evidence and associated data that the institution |
12 | | considered in making the decision to scale each model. |
13 | | (3) Baseline data and benchmarks for progress, |
14 | | including, but not limited to, (i) enrollment in |
15 | | credit-bearing English language or mathematics courses, |
16 | | (ii) rates of successful completion of introductory |
17 | | college-level English language or mathematics courses, and |
18 | | (iii) college-credit accumulation. |
19 | | (4) Detailed plans for scaling reforms and improving |
20 | | outcomes for all students placed in traditional |
21 | | developmental education models or models with comparable |
22 | | introductory college-level course completion rates. The |
23 | | plan shall provide details about the expected improvements |
24 | | in educational outcomes for Black students as result of the |
25 | | proposed reforms. |
26 | | (b) On or before January 1, 2023 and each year thereafter, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 390 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the Board of Higher Education and Illinois Community College |
2 | | Board shall collect data and report to the General Assembly and |
3 | | the public the status of developmental education reforms at |
4 | | institutions. The report must include data on the progress of |
5 | | the developmental education reforms, including, but not |
6 | | limited to, (i) enrollment in credit-bearing English language |
7 | | or mathematics courses, (ii) rates of successful completion of |
8 | | introductory college-level English language or mathematics |
9 | | courses, and (iii) college-credit accumulation. The data must |
10 | | be disaggregated by gender, race and ethnicity, federal Pell |
11 | | Grant status, and other variables of interest to the Board of |
12 | | Higher Education and the Illinois Community College Board. |
13 | | (c) On or before January 1, 2024 and each year thereafter, |
14 | | the Board of Higher Education and Illinois Community College |
15 | | Board, in consultation with institutions of higher education |
16 | | and other stakeholders, shall consider additional data |
17 | | reporting requirements to facilitate the rigorous and |
18 | | continuous evaluation of each institution's implementation |
19 | | plan and its impact on improving outcomes for students in |
20 | | developmental education, particularly for Black students.
|
21 | | Section 100-90. Family Educational Rights and Privacy Act |
22 | | of 1974. Nothing in this Act supersedes the federal Family |
23 | | Educational Rights and Privacy Act of 1974 or rules adopted |
24 | | pursuant to the federal Family Educational Rights and Privacy |
25 | | Act of 1974. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 391 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Article 105. |
2 | | Section 105-5. The Illinois Administrative Procedure Act |
3 | | is amended by adding Section 5-45.8 as follows: |
4 | | (5 ILCS 100/5-45.8 new) |
5 | | Sec. 5-45.8. Emergency rulemaking. To provide for the |
6 | | expeditious and timely implementation of this amendatory Act of |
7 | | the 101st General Assembly, emergency rules implementing this |
8 | | amendatory Act of the 101st General Assembly may be adopted in |
9 | | accordance with Section 5-45 to implement this amendatory Act |
10 | | of the 101st General Assembly. The adoption of emergency rules |
11 | | authorized by Section 5-45 and this Section is deemed to be |
12 | | necessary for the public interest, safety, and welfare. |
13 | | This Section is repealed on January 1, 2026. |
14 | | Section 105-10. The Invest in Kids Act is amended by |
15 | | changing Sections 5, 10, 40, and 45 and by adding Section 7.5 |
16 | | as follows: |
17 | | (35 ILCS 40/5) |
18 | | (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
|
19 | | Sec. 5. Definitions. As used in this Act: |
20 | | "Authorized contribution" means the contribution amount |
21 | | that is listed on the contribution authorization certificate |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 392 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | issued to the taxpayer.
|
2 | | "Board" means the State Board of Education.
|
3 | | "Contribution" means a donation made by the taxpayer during |
4 | | the taxable year for providing scholarships as provided in this |
5 | | Act. |
6 | | "Custodian" means, with respect to eligible students, an |
7 | | Illinois resident who is a parent or legal guardian of the |
8 | | eligible student or students.
|
9 | | "Department" means the Department of Revenue. |
10 | | "Eligible student" means a child who:
|
11 | | (1) is a member of a household whose federal adjusted |
12 | | gross income the year before he or she
initially receives a |
13 | | scholarship under this program, as determined by the |
14 | | Department, does not exceed 300% of the federal poverty
|
15 | | level and, once the child receives a scholarship, does not |
16 | | exceed 400% of the federal poverty
level;
|
17 | | (2) is eligible to attend a public elementary school or |
18 | | high school in Illinois in the semester immediately |
19 | | preceding the semester for which he or she first receives a |
20 | | scholarship or is
starting school in Illinois for the first |
21 | | time when he or she first receives a scholarship; and
|
22 | | (3) resides in Illinois while receiving a scholarship. |
23 | | "Family member" means a parent, child, or sibling, whether |
24 | | by whole blood, half blood, or adoption; spouse; or stepchild. |
25 | | "Focus district" means a school district which has a school |
26 | | that is either (i) a school that has one or more subgroups in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 393 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | which the average student performance is at or below the State |
2 | | average for the lowest 10% of student performance in that |
3 | | subgroup or (ii) a school with an average graduation rate of |
4 | | less than 60% and not identified for priority.
|
5 | | "Jointly-administered CTE program" means a program or set |
6 | | of programs within a non-public school located in Illinois, as |
7 | | determined by the Department of Labor pursuant to Section 7.5 |
8 | | of this Act. |
9 | | "Necessary costs and fees" includes the customary charge |
10 | | for instruction and use of facilities in general
and the |
11 | | additional fixed fees charged for specified purposes that are |
12 | | required generally of non-scholarship recipients for each |
13 | | academic period for which the scholarship applicant actually |
14 | | enrolls, including costs associated with student assessments, |
15 | | but does not
include fees payable only once and other |
16 | | contingent deposits that are refundable in whole or in part. |
17 | | The Board may prescribe, by rules consistent with this Act, |
18 | | detailed provisions concerning the computation of necessary |
19 | | costs and fees.
|
20 | | "Scholarship granting organization" means an entity that:
|
21 | | (1) is exempt from taxation under Section 501(c)(3) of |
22 | | the Internal Revenue Code;
|
23 | | (2) uses at least 95% of the qualified contributions |
24 | | received during a taxable year for scholarships;
|
25 | | (3) provides scholarships to students according to the |
26 | | guidelines of this Act;
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 394 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) deposits and holds qualified contributions and any |
2 | | income derived from qualified contributions
in an account |
3 | | that is separate from the organization's operating fund or |
4 | | other funds until such qualified contributions or income |
5 | | are withdrawn for use; and
|
6 | | (5) is approved to issue certificates of receipt.
|
7 | | "Qualified contribution" means the authorized contribution |
8 | | made by a taxpayer to a scholarship granting organization for |
9 | | which the taxpayer has received a certificate of receipt from |
10 | | such organization.
|
11 | | "Qualified school" means a non-public school located in |
12 | | Illinois and recognized by the Board pursuant to Section |
13 | | 2-3.25o of the School Code.
|
14 | | "Scholarship" means an educational scholarship awarded to |
15 | | an eligible student to attend a qualified school
of their |
16 | | custodians' choice in an amount not exceeding the necessary |
17 | | costs and fees to attend that school.
|
18 | | "Taxpayer" means any individual, corporation, partnership, |
19 | | trust, or other entity subject to the Illinois income tax. For |
20 | | the purposes of this Act, 2 individuals filing a joint return |
21 | | shall be considered one taxpayer.
|
22 | | "Technical academy" means a non-public school located in |
23 | | Illinois that (i) registers with the Board pursuant to Section |
24 | | 2-3.25o of the School Code and (ii) operates or will operate a |
25 | | jointly-administered CTE program as the primary focus of the |
26 | | school. To maintain its status as a technical academy, the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 395 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | non-public school must obtain recognition from the Board |
2 | | pursuant to Section 2-3.25o of the School Code within 2 |
3 | | calendar years of its registration with the Board. |
4 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.) |
5 | | (35 ILCS 40/7.5 new) |
6 | | Sec. 7.5. Determination of jointly-administered CTE |
7 | | programs. |
8 | | (a) Upon its own motion, or petition from a qualified |
9 | | school or technical academy, the Department of Labor shall |
10 | | determine whether a program or set of programs offered or |
11 | | proposed by a qualified school or technical academy provides |
12 | | coursework and training in career and technical education |
13 | | pathways aligned to industry-recognized certifications and |
14 | | credentials. The Department of Labor shall make that |
15 | | determination based upon whether the industry-recognized |
16 | | certifications or credentials that are the focus of a qualified |
17 | | school or technical academy's coursework and training program |
18 | | or set of programs (i) are associated with an occupation |
19 | | determined to fall under the LEADING or EMERGING priority |
20 | | sectors as determined through Illinois' Workforce Innovation |
21 | | and Opportunity Act Unified State Plan, and (ii) provide wages |
22 | | that are at least 70% of the average annual wage in the State |
23 | | as determined by the United States Bureau of Labor Statistics. |
24 | | The Department of Labor shall publish a list of approved |
25 | | jointly-administered programs on its website and otherwise |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 396 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | make such list available to the public. |
2 | | (b) A qualified school or technical academy may petition |
3 | | the Department of Labor to obtain a determination that a |
4 | | proposed program or set of programs that it seeks to offer |
5 | | qualifies as a jointly-administered CTE program under |
6 | | subsection (a) of this Section. A petitioner shall file one |
7 | | original petition in the format provided by the Department of |
8 | | Labor and in the manner specified by the Department of Labor. |
9 | | The petitioner may withdraw his or her petition by submitting a |
10 | | written statement to the Department indicating withdrawal. The |
11 | | Department shall approve or deny a petition within 180 days of |
12 | | its submission, and, upon approval, shall proceed to add the |
13 | | program or set of programs to the list of approved |
14 | | jointly-administered CTE programs. The approval or denial of |
15 | | any petition is a final decision of the Department, subject to |
16 | | judicial review under the Administrative Review Law. |
17 | | Jurisdiction and venue are vested in the circuit court. |
18 | | (c) The Department of Labor shall evaluate the approved |
19 | | jointly-administered CTE programs under this Section once |
20 | | every 5 years. At this time, the Department shall determine |
21 | | whether these programs continue to meet the requirements set |
22 | | forth in subsection (a) of this Section. |
23 | | (35 ILCS 40/10) |
24 | | (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
|
25 | | Sec. 10. Credit awards. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 397 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (a) The Department shall award credits against the tax |
2 | | imposed under subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of the |
3 | | Illinois Income Tax Act to taxpayers who make qualified |
4 | | contributions. For contributions made under this Act, the |
5 | | credit shall be equal to % 75% of the total amount of
qualified |
6 | | contributions made by the taxpayer during a taxable year, not |
7 | | to exceed a credit of $1,333,333 $1,000,000 per taxpayer.
|
8 | | (b) The aggregate amount of all credits the Department may |
9 | | award under this Act in any calendar year may not exceed |
10 | | $,000,000 $75,000,000 . The aggregate credit cap under this |
11 | | subsection (b) shall be increased by 20% beginning on the first |
12 | | day of a calendar year if, in at least 2 of the previous 3 |
13 | | calendar years, the applicable aggregate credit cap was |
14 | | reached. |
15 | | (c) Contributions made by corporations (including |
16 | | Subchapter S corporations), partnerships, and trusts under |
17 | | this Act may not be directed to a particular subset of schools |
18 | | or , a particular school, but may not be directed to a |
19 | | particular group of students , or a particular student.
|
20 | | Contributions made by individuals under this Act may be |
21 | | directed to a particular subset of schools or a particular |
22 | | school but may not be directed to a particular group of |
23 | | students or a particular student. |
24 | | (d) No credit shall be taken under this Act for any |
25 | | qualified contribution for which the taxpayer claims a federal |
26 | | income tax deduction. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 398 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (e) Credits shall be awarded in a manner, as determined by |
2 | | the Department, that is geographically proportionate to |
3 | | enrollment in recognized non-public schools in Illinois. If the |
4 | | cap on the aggregate credits that may be awarded by the |
5 | | Department is not reached by April 1 June 1 of a given year, |
6 | | the Department shall award remaining credits on a first-come, |
7 | | first-served basis, without regard to the limitation of this |
8 | | subsection.
|
9 | | (f) Credits awarded for donations made to a technical |
10 | | academy shall be awarded without regard to subsection (e), but |
11 | | shall not exceed 15% of the annual statewide program cap. For |
12 | | the purposes of this subsection, "technical academy" means a |
13 | | technical academy that is registered with the Board within 30 |
14 | | days after the effective date of this amendatory Act of the |
15 | | 101st General Assembly. |
16 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.) |
17 | | (35 ILCS 40/40) |
18 | | (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
|
19 | | Sec. 40. Scholarship granting organization |
20 | | responsibilities. |
21 | | (a) Before granting a scholarship for an academic year, all |
22 | | scholarship granting organizations shall assess and document |
23 | | each student's eligibility for the academic year.
|
24 | | (b) A scholarship granting organization shall grant |
25 | | scholarships only to eligible students.
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 399 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (c) A scholarship granting organization shall allow an |
2 | | eligible student to attend any qualified school of the |
3 | | student's choosing, subject to the availability of funds.
|
4 | | (d) In granting scholarships, beginning in the 2022-2023 |
5 | | school year and each school year thereafter, a scholarship |
6 | | granting organization shall give first priority to eligible |
7 | | students who received a scholarship from a scholarship granting |
8 | | organization during the previous school year. Second priority |
9 | | shall be given to the following priority groups: |
10 | | (1) (blank); eligible students who received a |
11 | | scholarship from a scholarship granting organization |
12 | | during the previous school year;
|
13 | | (2) eligible students who are members of a household |
14 | | whose previous year's total annual income does not exceed |
15 | | 185% of the federal poverty level;
|
16 | | (3) eligible students who reside within a focus |
17 | | district; and
|
18 | | (4) eligible students who are siblings of students |
19 | | currently receiving a scholarship.
|
20 | | (d-5) A scholarship granting organization shall begin |
21 | | granting scholarships no later than February 1 preceding the |
22 | | school year for which the scholarship is sought. Each The |
23 | | priority group groups identified in subsection (d) of this |
24 | | Section shall be eligible to receive scholarships on a |
25 | | first-come, first-served basis until the April 1 immediately |
26 | | preceding the school year for which the scholarship is sought |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 400 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | starting with the first priority group identified in subsection |
2 | | (d) of this Section . Applications for scholarships for eligible |
3 | | students meeting the qualifications of one or more priority |
4 | | groups that are received before April 1 must be either approved |
5 | | or denied within 10 business days after receipt. Beginning |
6 | | April 1, all eligible students shall be eligible to receive |
7 | | scholarships without regard to the priority groups identified |
8 | | in subsection (d) of this Section. |
9 | | (e) Except as provided in subsection (e-5) of this Section, |
10 | | scholarships shall not exceed the lesser of (i) the statewide |
11 | | average operational expense per
student among public schools or |
12 | | (ii) the necessary costs and fees for attendance at the |
13 | | qualified school.
Scholarships shall be prorated as follows: |
14 | | (1) for eligible students whose household income is |
15 | | less than 185% of the federal poverty level, the |
16 | | scholarship shall be 100% of the amount determined pursuant |
17 | | to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this |
18 | | Section; |
19 | | (2) for eligible students whose household income is |
20 | | 185% or more of the federal poverty level but less than |
21 | | 250% of the federal poverty level, the average of |
22 | | scholarships shall be 75% of the amount determined pursuant |
23 | | to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this |
24 | | Section; and |
25 | | (3) for eligible students whose household income is |
26 | | 250% or more of the federal poverty level, the average of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 401 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | scholarships shall be 50% of the amount determined pursuant |
2 | | to this subsection (e) and subsection (e-5) of this |
3 | | Section. |
4 | | (e-5) The statewide average operational expense per |
5 | | student among public schools shall be multiplied by the |
6 | | following factors: |
7 | | (1) for students determined eligible to receive |
8 | | services under the federal Individuals with Disabilities |
9 | | Education Act, 2; |
10 | | (2) for students who are English learners, as defined |
11 | | in subsection (d) of Section 14C-2 of the School Code, 1.2; |
12 | | and |
13 | | (3) for students who are gifted and talented children, |
14 | | as defined in Section 14A-20 of the School Code, 1.1 ; and . |
15 | | (4) for students enrolled in a jointly-administered |
16 | | CTE program, 1.5. |
17 | | (f) A scholarship granting organization shall distribute |
18 | | scholarship payments to the participating school where the |
19 | | student is enrolled.
|
20 | | (g) Beginning in For the 2018-2019 school year through the |
21 | | 2021-2022 school year , each scholarship granting organization |
22 | | shall expend no less than 75% of the qualified contributions |
23 | | received during the calendar year in which the qualified |
24 | | contributions were received. No more than 25% of the
qualified |
25 | | contributions may be carried forward to the following calendar |
26 | | year.
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 402 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (h) In determining compliance with subsection (g), a |
2 | | scholarship granting organization may exempt a portion of |
3 | | donations directed to a technical academy operating in the |
4 | | first two calendar years in which the school is eligible to |
5 | | receive donations. For purposes of determining compliance with |
6 | | subsection (g) the sum of exempted donations per technical |
7 | | academy shall not exceed $3,000,000 over the 2-calendar year |
8 | | period. Not more than one scholarship granting organization |
9 | | shall exempt a portion of directed donations per technical |
10 | | academy. For the 2022-2023 school year, each scholarship |
11 | | granting organization shall expend all qualified contributions |
12 | | received during the calendar year in which the qualified |
13 | | contributions were
received. No qualified contributions may be |
14 | | carried forward to the following calendar year.
|
15 | | (i) A scholarship granting organization shall allow an |
16 | | eligible student to transfer a scholarship during a school year |
17 | | to any other participating school of the custodian's choice. |
18 | | Such scholarships shall be prorated.
|
19 | | (j) With the prior approval of the Department, a |
20 | | scholarship granting organization may transfer funds to |
21 | | another scholarship granting organization if additional funds |
22 | | are required to meet scholarship demands at the receiving |
23 | | scholarship granting organization. All transferred funds must |
24 | | be
deposited by the receiving scholarship granting |
25 | | organization into its scholarship accounts. All transferred |
26 | | amounts received by any scholarship granting organization must |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 403 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | be separately
disclosed to the Department.
|
2 | | (k) If the approval of a scholarship granting organization |
3 | | is revoked as provided in Section 20 of this Act or the |
4 | | scholarship granting organization is dissolved, all remaining |
5 | | qualified contributions of the scholarship granting |
6 | | organization shall be transferred to another scholarship |
7 | | granting organization. All transferred funds must be deposited |
8 | | by the receiving scholarship granting organization into its |
9 | | scholarship accounts. |
10 | | (l) Scholarship granting organizations shall make |
11 | | reasonable efforts to advertise the availability of |
12 | | scholarships to eligible students.
|
13 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.) |
14 | | (35 ILCS 40/45) |
15 | | (Section scheduled to be repealed on January 1, 2024)
|
16 | | Sec. 45. State Board responsibilities. |
17 | | (a) Beginning in the 2019-2020 school year, students who |
18 | | have been granted a scholarship under this Act shall be |
19 | | annually assessed at the qualified school where the student |
20 | | attends school in the same manner in which students that attend |
21 | | public schools are annually assessed pursuant to Section |
22 | | 2-3.64a-5 of the School Code. Such qualified school shall pay |
23 | | costs associated with this requirement. |
24 | | (b) The Board shall select an independent research |
25 | | organization, which may be a public or private entity or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 404 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | university, to which participating qualified schools must |
2 | | report the scores of students who are receiving scholarships |
3 | | and are assessed pursuant to subsection (a) of this Section. |
4 | | Costs associated with the independent research organization |
5 | | shall be paid by the scholarship granting organizations on a |
6 | | per-pupil basis or by gifts, grants, or donations received by |
7 | | the Board under subsection (d) of this Section, as determined |
8 | | by the Board. The independent research organization must |
9 | | annually report to the Board on the year-to-year learning gains |
10 | | of students receiving scholarships on a statewide basis. The |
11 | | report shall also include, to the extent possible, a comparison |
12 | | of these learning gains to the statewide learning gains of |
13 | | public school students with socioeconomic backgrounds similar |
14 | | to those of students receiving scholarships. The annual report |
15 | | shall be delivered to the Board and published on its website. |
16 | | (c) Beginning within 120 days after the Board first |
17 | | receives the annual report by the independent research |
18 | | organization as provided in subsection (b) of this Section and |
19 | | on an annual basis thereafter, the Board shall submit a written |
20 | | report to the Governor, the President of the Senate, the |
21 | | Speaker of the House of Representatives, the Minority Leader of |
22 | | the Senate, and the Minority Leader of the House of |
23 | | Representatives regarding this Act. Such report shall include |
24 | | an evaluation of the academic performance of students receiving |
25 | | scholarships and recommendations for improving student |
26 | | performance. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 405 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (d) Subject to the State Officials and Employees Ethics |
2 | | Act, the Board may receive and expend gifts, grants, and |
3 | | donations of any kind from any public or private entity to |
4 | | carry out the purposes of this Section, subject to the terms |
5 | | and conditions under which the gifts are given, provided that |
6 | | all such terms and conditions are permissible under law. |
7 | | (e) The sharing and reporting of student assessment |
8 | | learning gain data under this Section must be in accordance |
9 | | with requirements of the Family Educational Rights and Privacy |
10 | | Act and the Illinois School Student Records Act. All parties |
11 | | must preserve the confidentiality of such information as |
12 | | required by law. The annual report must not disaggregate data |
13 | | to a level that will disclose the academic level of individual |
14 | | students.
|
15 | | (Source: P.A. 100-465, eff. 8-31-17.) |
16 | | (35 ILCS 40/65 rep.) |
17 | | (35 ILCS 40/995 rep.) |
18 | | Section 105-15. The Invest in Kids Act is amended by |
19 | | repealing Sections 65 and 995. |
20 | | Article 110. |
21 | | Section 110-5. The Illinois Vehicle Code is amended by |
22 | | changing Sections 6-209.1, 11-208.3, 11-208.6, 11-208.8, |
23 | | 11-208.9, and 11-1201.1 as follows: |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 406 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (625 ILCS 5/6-209.1) |
2 | | Sec. 6-209.1. Restoration of driving privileges; |
3 | | revocation; suspension; cancellation. |
4 | | (a) The Secretary shall rescind the suspension or |
5 | | cancellation of a person's driver's license that has been |
6 | | suspended or canceled before July 1, 2020 ( the effective date |
7 | | of Public Act 101-623) this amendatory Act of the 101st General |
8 | | Assembly due to: |
9 | | (1) the person being convicted of theft of motor fuel |
10 | | under Section Sections 16-25 or 16K-15 of the Criminal Code |
11 | | of 1961 or the Criminal Code of 2012; |
12 | | (2) the person, since the issuance of the driver's |
13 | | license, being adjudged to be afflicted with or suffering |
14 | | from any mental disability or disease; |
15 | | (3) a violation of Section 6-16 of the Liquor Control |
16 | | Act of 1934 or a similar provision of a local ordinance; |
17 | | (4) the person being convicted of a violation of |
18 | | Section 6-20 of the Liquor Control Act of 1934 or a similar |
19 | | provision of a local ordinance, if the person presents a |
20 | | certified copy of a court order that includes a finding |
21 | | that the person was not an occupant of a motor vehicle at |
22 | | the time of the violation; |
23 | | (5) the person receiving a disposition of court |
24 | | supervision for a violation of subsection subsections (a), |
25 | | (d), or (e) of Section 6-20 of the Liquor Control Act of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 407 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 1934 or a similar provision of a local ordinance, if the |
2 | | person presents a certified copy of a court order that |
3 | | includes a finding that the person was not an occupant of a |
4 | | motor vehicle at the time of the violation; |
5 | | (6) the person failing to pay any fine or penalty due |
6 | | or owing as a result of 10 or more violations of a |
7 | | municipality's or county's vehicular standing, parking, or |
8 | | compliance regulations established by ordinance under |
9 | | Section 11-208.3 of this Code; |
10 | | (7) the person failing to satisfy any fine or penalty |
11 | | resulting from a final order issued by the Illinois State |
12 | | Toll Highway Authority relating directly or indirectly to 5 |
13 | | or more toll violations, toll evasions, or both; |
14 | | (8) the person being convicted of a violation of |
15 | | Section 4-102 of this Code, if the person presents a |
16 | | certified copy of a court order that includes a finding |
17 | | that the person did not exercise actual physical control of |
18 | | the vehicle at the time of the violation; or |
19 | | (9) the person being convicted of criminal trespass to |
20 | | vehicles under Section 21-2 of the Criminal Code of 2012, |
21 | | if the person presents a certified copy of a court order |
22 | | that includes a finding that the person did not exercise |
23 | | actual physical control of the vehicle at the time of the |
24 | | violation.
|
25 | | (b) As soon as practicable and no later than July 1, 2021, |
26 | | the Secretary shall rescind the suspension, cancellation, or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 408 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | prohibition of renewal of a person's driver's license that has |
2 | | been suspended, canceled, or whose renewal has been prohibited |
3 | | before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 101st |
4 | | General Assembly due to the person having failed to pay any |
5 | | fine or penalty as a result of 5 offenses for automated traffic |
6 | | law enforcement system violations under Sections 11-208.6, |
7 | | 11-208.8, 11-208.9, and 11-1201.1. |
8 | | (Source: P.A. 101-623, eff. 7-1-20; revised 8-18-20.)
|
9 | | (625 ILCS 5/11-208.3) (from Ch. 95 1/2, par. 11-208.3)
|
10 | | Sec. 11-208.3. Administrative adjudication of violations |
11 | | of traffic
regulations concerning the standing, parking, or |
12 | | condition of
vehicles, automated traffic law violations, and |
13 | | automated speed enforcement system violations.
|
14 | | (a) Any municipality or county may provide by ordinance for |
15 | | a system of
administrative adjudication of vehicular standing |
16 | | and parking violations and
vehicle compliance violations as |
17 | | described in this subsection, automated traffic law violations |
18 | | as defined in Section 11-208.6, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1, and |
19 | | automated speed enforcement system violations as defined in |
20 | | Section 11-208.8.
The administrative system shall have as its |
21 | | purpose the fair and
efficient enforcement of municipal or |
22 | | county regulations through the
administrative adjudication of |
23 | | automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic law |
24 | | violations and violations of municipal or county ordinances
|
25 | | regulating the standing and parking of vehicles, the condition |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 409 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and use of
vehicle equipment, and the display of municipal or |
2 | | county wheel tax licenses within the
municipality's
or county's |
3 | | borders. The administrative system shall only have authority to |
4 | | adjudicate
civil offenses carrying fines not in excess of $500 |
5 | | or requiring the completion of a traffic education program, or |
6 | | both, that occur after the
effective date of the ordinance |
7 | | adopting such a system under this Section.
For purposes of this |
8 | | Section, "compliance violation" means a violation of a
|
9 | | municipal or county regulation governing the condition or use |
10 | | of equipment on a vehicle
or governing the display of a |
11 | | municipal or county wheel tax license.
|
12 | | (b) Any ordinance establishing a system of administrative |
13 | | adjudication
under this Section shall provide for:
|
14 | | (1) A traffic compliance administrator authorized to
|
15 | | adopt, distribute , and
process parking, compliance, and |
16 | | automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic |
17 | | law violation notices and other notices required
by this
|
18 | | Section, collect money paid as fines and penalties for |
19 | | violation of parking
and compliance
ordinances and |
20 | | automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic |
21 | | law violations, and operate an administrative adjudication |
22 | | system. The traffic
compliance
administrator also may make |
23 | | a certified report to the Secretary of State
under Section |
24 | | 6-306.5.
|
25 | | (2) A parking, standing, compliance, automated speed |
26 | | enforcement system, or automated traffic law violation |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 410 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | notice
that
shall specify or include the date,
time, and |
2 | | place of violation of a parking, standing,
compliance, |
3 | | automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic |
4 | | law
regulation; the particular regulation
violated; any |
5 | | requirement to complete a traffic education program; the |
6 | | fine and any penalty that may be assessed for late payment |
7 | | or failure to complete a required traffic education |
8 | | program, or both,
when so provided by ordinance; the |
9 | | vehicle make or a photograph of the vehicle; the state |
10 | | registration
number of the vehicle; and the identification |
11 | | number of the
person issuing the notice.
With regard to |
12 | | automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic |
13 | | law violations, vehicle make shall be specified on the |
14 | | automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic |
15 | | law violation notice if the notice does not include a |
16 | | photograph of the vehicle and the make is available and |
17 | | readily discernible. With regard to municipalities or |
18 | | counties with a population of 1 million or more, it
shall |
19 | | be grounds for
dismissal of a parking
violation if the |
20 | | state registration number or vehicle make specified is
|
21 | | incorrect. The violation notice shall state that the |
22 | | completion of any required traffic education program, the |
23 | | payment of any indicated
fine, and the payment of any |
24 | | applicable penalty for late payment or failure to complete |
25 | | a required traffic education program, or both, shall |
26 | | operate as a
final disposition of the violation. The notice |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 411 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | also shall contain
information as to the availability of a |
2 | | hearing in which the violation may
be contested on its |
3 | | merits. The violation notice shall specify the
time and |
4 | | manner in which a hearing may be had.
|
5 | | (3) Service of a parking, standing, or compliance
|
6 | | violation notice by: (i) affixing the
original or a |
7 | | facsimile of the notice to an unlawfully parked or standing |
8 | | vehicle; (ii)
handing the notice to the operator of a |
9 | | vehicle if he or she is
present; or (iii) mailing the |
10 | | notice to the address of the registered owner or lessee of |
11 | | the cited vehicle as recorded with the Secretary of State |
12 | | or the lessor of the motor vehicle within 30 days after the |
13 | | Secretary of State or the lessor of the motor vehicle |
14 | | notifies the municipality or county of the identity of the |
15 | | owner or lessee of the vehicle, but not later than 90 days |
16 | | after the date of the violation, except that in the case of |
17 | | a lessee of a motor vehicle, service of a parking, |
18 | | standing, or compliance violation notice may occur no later |
19 | | than 210 days after the violation; and service of an |
20 | | automated speed enforcement system or automated traffic |
21 | | law violation notice by mail to the
address
of the |
22 | | registered owner or lessee of the cited vehicle as recorded |
23 | | with the Secretary of
State or the lessor of the motor |
24 | | vehicle within 30 days after the Secretary of State or the |
25 | | lessor of the motor vehicle notifies the municipality or |
26 | | county of the identity of the owner or lessee of the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 412 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | vehicle, but not later than 90 days after the violation, |
2 | | except that in the case of a lessee of a motor vehicle, |
3 | | service of an automated traffic law violation notice may |
4 | | occur no later than 210 days after the violation. A person |
5 | | authorized by ordinance to issue and serve parking,
|
6 | | standing, and compliance
violation notices shall certify |
7 | | as to the correctness of the facts entered
on the violation |
8 | | notice by signing his or her name to the notice at
the time |
9 | | of service or , in the case of a notice produced by a |
10 | | computerized
device, by signing a single certificate to be |
11 | | kept by the traffic
compliance
administrator attesting to |
12 | | the correctness of all notices produced by the
device while |
13 | | it was under his or her control. In the case of an |
14 | | automated traffic law violation, the ordinance shall
|
15 | | require
a
determination by a technician employed or |
16 | | contracted by the municipality or county that,
based on |
17 | | inspection of recorded images, the motor vehicle was being |
18 | | operated in
violation of Section 11-208.6, 11-208.9, or |
19 | | 11-1201.1 or a local ordinance.
If the technician |
20 | | determines that the
vehicle entered the intersection as |
21 | | part of a funeral procession or in order to
yield the |
22 | | right-of-way to an emergency vehicle, a citation shall not |
23 | | be issued. In municipalities with a population of less than |
24 | | 1,000,000 inhabitants and counties with a population of |
25 | | less than 3,000,000 inhabitants, the automated traffic law |
26 | | ordinance shall require that all determinations by a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 413 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | technician that a motor vehicle was being operated in
|
2 | | violation of Section 11-208.6, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1 or a |
3 | | local ordinance must be reviewed and approved by a law |
4 | | enforcement officer or retired law enforcement officer of |
5 | | the municipality or county issuing the violation. In |
6 | | municipalities with a population of 1,000,000 or more |
7 | | inhabitants and counties with a population of 3,000,000 or |
8 | | more inhabitants, the automated traffic law ordinance |
9 | | shall require that all determinations by a technician that |
10 | | a motor vehicle was being operated in
violation of Section |
11 | | 11-208.6, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1 or a local ordinance must |
12 | | be reviewed and approved by a law enforcement officer or |
13 | | retired law enforcement officer of the municipality or |
14 | | county issuing the violation or by an additional fully |
15 | | trained fully-trained reviewing technician who is not |
16 | | employed by the contractor who employs the technician who |
17 | | made the initial determination. In the case of an automated |
18 | | speed enforcement system violation, the ordinance shall |
19 | | require a determination by a technician employed by the |
20 | | municipality, based upon an inspection of recorded images, |
21 | | video or other documentation, including documentation of |
22 | | the speed limit and automated speed enforcement signage, |
23 | | and documentation of the inspection, calibration, and |
24 | | certification of the speed equipment, that the vehicle was |
25 | | being operated in violation of Article VI of Chapter 11 of |
26 | | this Code or a similar local ordinance. If the technician |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 414 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | determines that the vehicle speed was not determined by a |
2 | | calibrated, certified speed equipment device based upon |
3 | | the speed equipment documentation, or if the vehicle was an |
4 | | emergency vehicle, a citation may not be issued. The |
5 | | automated speed enforcement ordinance shall require that |
6 | | all determinations by a technician that a violation |
7 | | occurred be reviewed and approved by a law enforcement |
8 | | officer or retired law enforcement officer of the |
9 | | municipality issuing the violation or by an additional |
10 | | fully trained reviewing technician who is not employed by |
11 | | the contractor who employs the technician who made the |
12 | | initial determination. Routine and independent calibration |
13 | | of the speeds produced by automated speed enforcement |
14 | | systems and equipment shall be conducted annually by a |
15 | | qualified technician. Speeds produced by an automated |
16 | | speed enforcement system shall be compared with speeds |
17 | | produced by lidar or other independent equipment. Radar or |
18 | | lidar equipment shall undergo an internal validation test |
19 | | no less frequently than once each week. Qualified |
20 | | technicians shall test loop-based loop based equipment no |
21 | | less frequently than once a year. Radar equipment shall be |
22 | | checked for accuracy by a qualified technician when the |
23 | | unit is serviced, when unusual or suspect readings persist, |
24 | | or when deemed necessary by a reviewing technician. Radar |
25 | | equipment shall be checked with the internal frequency |
26 | | generator and the internal circuit test whenever the radar |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 415 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | is turned on. Technicians must be alert for any unusual or |
2 | | suspect readings, and if unusual or suspect readings of a |
3 | | radar unit persist, that unit shall immediately be removed |
4 | | from service and not returned to service until it has been |
5 | | checked by a qualified technician and determined to be |
6 | | functioning properly. Documentation of the annual |
7 | | calibration results, including the equipment tested, test |
8 | | date, technician performing the test, and test results, |
9 | | shall be maintained and available for use in the |
10 | | determination of an automated speed enforcement system |
11 | | violation and issuance of a citation. The technician |
12 | | performing the calibration and testing of the automated |
13 | | speed enforcement equipment shall be trained and certified |
14 | | in the use of equipment for speed enforcement purposes. |
15 | | Training on the speed enforcement equipment may be |
16 | | conducted by law enforcement, civilian, or manufacturer's |
17 | | personnel and if applicable may be equivalent to the |
18 | | equipment use and operations training included in the Speed |
19 | | Measuring Device Operator Program developed by the |
20 | | National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA). |
21 | | The vendor or technician who performs the work shall keep |
22 | | accurate records on each piece of equipment the technician |
23 | | calibrates and tests. As used in this paragraph, " fully |
24 | | trained fully-trained reviewing technician" means a person |
25 | | who has received at least 40 hours of supervised training |
26 | | in subjects which shall include image inspection and |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 416 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | interpretation, the elements necessary to prove a |
2 | | violation, license plate identification, and traffic |
3 | | safety and management. In all municipalities and counties, |
4 | | the automated speed enforcement system or automated |
5 | | traffic law ordinance shall require that no additional fee |
6 | | shall be charged to the alleged violator for exercising his |
7 | | or her right to an administrative hearing, and persons |
8 | | shall be given at least 25 days following an administrative |
9 | | hearing to pay any civil penalty imposed by a finding that |
10 | | Section 11-208.6, 11-208.8, 11-208.9, or 11-1201.1 or a |
11 | | similar local ordinance has been violated. The original or |
12 | | a
facsimile of the violation notice or, in the case of a |
13 | | notice produced by a
computerized device, a printed record |
14 | | generated by the device showing the facts
entered on the |
15 | | notice, shall be retained by the
traffic compliance
|
16 | | administrator, and shall be a record kept in the ordinary |
17 | | course of
business. A parking, standing, compliance, |
18 | | automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic |
19 | | law violation notice issued,
signed , and served in
|
20 | | accordance with this Section, a copy of the notice, or the |
21 | | computer-generated computer
generated record shall be |
22 | | prima facie
correct and shall be prima facie evidence of |
23 | | the correctness of the facts
shown on the notice. The |
24 | | notice, copy, or computer-generated computer generated
|
25 | | record shall be admissible in any
subsequent |
26 | | administrative or legal proceedings.
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 417 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (4) An opportunity for a hearing for the registered |
2 | | owner of the
vehicle cited in the parking, standing, |
3 | | compliance, automated speed enforcement system, or |
4 | | automated traffic law violation notice in
which the owner |
5 | | may
contest the merits of the alleged violation, and during |
6 | | which formal or
technical rules of evidence shall not |
7 | | apply; provided, however, that under
Section 11-1306 of |
8 | | this Code the lessee of a vehicle cited in the
violation |
9 | | notice likewise shall be provided an opportunity for a |
10 | | hearing of
the same kind afforded the registered owner. The |
11 | | hearings shall be
recorded, and the person conducting the |
12 | | hearing on behalf of the traffic
compliance
administrator |
13 | | shall be empowered to administer oaths and to secure by
|
14 | | subpoena both the attendance and testimony of witnesses and |
15 | | the production
of relevant books and papers. Persons |
16 | | appearing at a hearing under this
Section may be |
17 | | represented by counsel at their expense. The ordinance may
|
18 | | also provide for internal administrative review following |
19 | | the decision of
the hearing officer.
|
20 | | (5) Service of additional notices, sent by first class |
21 | | United States
mail, postage prepaid, to the address of the |
22 | | registered owner of the cited
vehicle as recorded with the |
23 | | Secretary of State or, if any notice to that address is |
24 | | returned as undeliverable, to the last known address |
25 | | recorded in a United States Post Office approved database,
|
26 | | or, under Section 11-1306
or subsection (p) of Section |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 418 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 11-208.6 or 11-208.9, or subsection (p) of Section 11-208.8 |
2 | | of this Code, to the lessee of the cited vehicle at the |
3 | | last address known
to the lessor of the cited vehicle at |
4 | | the time of lease or, if any notice to that address is |
5 | | returned as undeliverable, to the last known address |
6 | | recorded in a United States Post Office approved database.
|
7 | | The service shall
be deemed complete as of the date of |
8 | | deposit in the United States mail.
The notices shall be in |
9 | | the following sequence and shall include , but not be
|
10 | | limited to , the information specified herein:
|
11 | | (i) A second notice of parking, standing, or |
12 | | compliance violation if the first notice of the |
13 | | violation was issued by affixing the original or a |
14 | | facsimile of the notice to the unlawfully parked |
15 | | vehicle or by handing the notice to the operator. This |
16 | | notice shall specify or include the
date and location |
17 | | of the violation cited in the parking,
standing,
or |
18 | | compliance violation
notice, the particular regulation |
19 | | violated, the vehicle
make or a photograph of the |
20 | | vehicle, the state registration number of the vehicle, |
21 | | any requirement to complete a traffic education |
22 | | program, the fine and any penalty that may be
assessed |
23 | | for late payment or failure to complete a traffic |
24 | | education program, or both, when so provided by |
25 | | ordinance, the availability
of a hearing in which the |
26 | | violation may be contested on its merits, and the
time |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 419 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | and manner in which the hearing may be had. The notice |
2 | | of violation
shall also state that failure to complete |
3 | | a required traffic education program, to pay the |
4 | | indicated fine and any
applicable penalty, or to appear |
5 | | at a hearing on the merits in the time and
manner |
6 | | specified, will result in a final determination of |
7 | | violation
liability for the cited violation in the |
8 | | amount of the fine or penalty
indicated, and that, upon |
9 | | the occurrence of a final determination of violation |
10 | | liability for the failure, and the exhaustion of, or
|
11 | | failure to exhaust, available administrative or |
12 | | judicial procedures for
review, any incomplete traffic |
13 | | education program or any unpaid fine or penalty, or |
14 | | both, will constitute a debt due and owing
the |
15 | | municipality or county.
|
16 | | (ii) A notice of final determination of parking, |
17 | | standing,
compliance, automated speed enforcement |
18 | | system, or automated traffic law violation liability.
|
19 | | This notice shall be sent following a final |
20 | | determination of parking,
standing, compliance, |
21 | | automated speed enforcement system, or automated |
22 | | traffic law
violation liability and the conclusion of |
23 | | judicial review procedures taken
under this Section. |
24 | | The notice shall state that the incomplete traffic |
25 | | education program or the unpaid fine or
penalty, or |
26 | | both, is a debt due and owing the municipality or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 420 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | county. The notice shall contain
warnings that failure |
2 | | to complete any required traffic education program or |
3 | | to pay any fine or penalty due and owing the
|
4 | | municipality or county, or both, within the time |
5 | | specified may result in the municipality's
or county's |
6 | | filing of a petition in the Circuit Court to have the |
7 | | incomplete traffic education program or unpaid
fine or |
8 | | penalty, or both, rendered a judgment as provided by |
9 | | this Section, or, where applicable, may
result in |
10 | | suspension of the person's driver's drivers license |
11 | | for failure to complete a traffic education program or |
12 | | to pay
fines or penalties, or both, for 5 or more |
13 | | automated traffic law violations under Section |
14 | | 11-208.6 or 11-208.9 or automated speed enforcement |
15 | | system violations under Section 11-208.8 .
|
16 | | (6) A notice of impending driver's drivers license |
17 | | suspension. This
notice shall be sent to the person liable |
18 | | for failure to complete a required traffic education |
19 | | program or to pay any fine or penalty that
remains due and |
20 | | owing, or both, on 5 or more unpaid automated speed |
21 | | enforcement system or automated traffic law violations . |
22 | | The notice
shall state that failure to complete a required |
23 | | traffic education program or to pay the fine or penalty |
24 | | owing, or both, within 45 days of
the notice's date will |
25 | | result in the municipality or county notifying the |
26 | | Secretary
of State that the person is eligible for |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 421 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | initiation of suspension
proceedings under Section 6-306.5 |
2 | | of this Code. The notice shall also state
that the person |
3 | | may obtain a photostatic copy of an original ticket |
4 | | imposing a
fine or penalty by sending a self-addressed self |
5 | | addressed , stamped envelope to the
municipality or county |
6 | | along with a request for the photostatic copy.
The notice |
7 | | of impending driver's
drivers license suspension shall be |
8 | | sent by first class United States mail,
postage prepaid, to |
9 | | the address recorded with the Secretary of State or, if any |
10 | | notice to that address is returned as undeliverable, to the |
11 | | last known address recorded in a United States Post Office |
12 | | approved database.
|
13 | | (7) Final determinations of violation liability. A |
14 | | final
determination of violation liability shall occur |
15 | | following failure to complete the required traffic |
16 | | education program or
to pay the fine or penalty, or both, |
17 | | after a hearing officer's determination of violation |
18 | | liability and the exhaustion of or failure to exhaust any
|
19 | | administrative review procedures provided by ordinance. |
20 | | Where a person
fails to appear at a hearing to contest the |
21 | | alleged violation in the time
and manner specified in a |
22 | | prior mailed notice, the hearing officer's
determination |
23 | | of violation liability shall become final: (A) upon
denial |
24 | | of a timely petition to set aside that determination, or |
25 | | (B) upon
expiration of the period for filing the petition |
26 | | without a
filing having been made.
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 422 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (8) A petition to set aside a determination of parking, |
2 | | standing,
compliance, automated speed enforcement system, |
3 | | or automated traffic law violation
liability that may be |
4 | | filed by a person owing an unpaid fine or penalty. A |
5 | | petition to set aside a determination of liability may also |
6 | | be filed by a person required to complete a traffic |
7 | | education program.
The petition shall be filed with and |
8 | | ruled upon by the traffic compliance
administrator in the |
9 | | manner and within the time specified by ordinance.
The |
10 | | grounds for the petition may be limited to: (A) the person |
11 | | not having
been the owner or lessee of the cited vehicle on |
12 | | the date the
violation notice was issued, (B) the person |
13 | | having already completed the required traffic education |
14 | | program or paid the fine or
penalty, or both, for the |
15 | | violation in question, and (C) excusable failure to
appear |
16 | | at or
request a new date for a hearing.
With regard to |
17 | | municipalities or counties with a population of 1 million |
18 | | or more, it
shall be grounds for
dismissal of a
parking |
19 | | violation if the state registration number or vehicle make, |
20 | | only if specified in the violation notice, is
incorrect. |
21 | | After the determination of
parking, standing, compliance, |
22 | | automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic |
23 | | law violation liability has been set aside
upon a showing |
24 | | of just
cause, the registered owner shall be provided with |
25 | | a hearing on the merits
for that violation.
|
26 | | (9) Procedures for non-residents. Procedures by which |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 423 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | persons who are
not residents of the municipality or county |
2 | | may contest the merits of the alleged
violation without |
3 | | attending a hearing.
|
4 | | (10) A schedule of civil fines for violations of |
5 | | vehicular standing,
parking, compliance, automated speed |
6 | | enforcement system, or automated traffic law regulations |
7 | | enacted by ordinance pursuant to this
Section, and a
|
8 | | schedule of penalties for late payment of the fines or |
9 | | failure to complete required traffic education programs, |
10 | | provided, however,
that the total amount of the fine and |
11 | | penalty for any one violation shall
not exceed $250, except |
12 | | as provided in subsection (c) of Section 11-1301.3 of this |
13 | | Code.
|
14 | | (11) Other provisions as are necessary and proper to |
15 | | carry into
effect the powers granted and purposes stated in |
16 | | this Section.
|
17 | | (c) Any municipality or county establishing vehicular |
18 | | standing, parking,
compliance, automated speed enforcement |
19 | | system, or automated traffic law
regulations under this Section |
20 | | may also provide by ordinance for a
program of vehicle |
21 | | immobilization for the purpose of facilitating
enforcement of |
22 | | those regulations. The program of vehicle
immobilization shall |
23 | | provide for immobilizing any eligible vehicle upon the
public |
24 | | way by presence of a restraint in a manner to prevent operation |
25 | | of
the vehicle. Any ordinance establishing a program of vehicle
|
26 | | immobilization under this Section shall provide:
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 424 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (1) Criteria for the designation of vehicles eligible |
2 | | for
immobilization. A vehicle shall be eligible for |
3 | | immobilization when the
registered owner of the vehicle has |
4 | | accumulated the number of incomplete traffic education |
5 | | programs or unpaid final
determinations of parking, |
6 | | standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement system, |
7 | | or automated traffic law violation liability, or both, as
|
8 | | determined by ordinance.
|
9 | | (2) A notice of impending vehicle immobilization and a |
10 | | right to a
hearing to challenge the validity of the notice |
11 | | by disproving liability
for the incomplete traffic |
12 | | education programs or unpaid final determinations of |
13 | | parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement |
14 | | system, or automated traffic law
violation liability, or |
15 | | both, listed
on the notice.
|
16 | | (3) The right to a prompt hearing after a vehicle has |
17 | | been immobilized
or subsequently towed without the |
18 | | completion of the required traffic education program or |
19 | | payment of the outstanding fines and
penalties on parking, |
20 | | standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement system, |
21 | | or automated traffic law violations, or both, for which |
22 | | final
determinations have been
issued. An order issued |
23 | | after the hearing is a final administrative
decision within |
24 | | the meaning of Section 3-101 of the Code of Civil |
25 | | Procedure.
|
26 | | (4) A post immobilization and post-towing notice |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 425 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | advising the registered
owner of the vehicle of the right |
2 | | to a hearing to challenge the validity
of the impoundment.
|
3 | | (d) Judicial review of final determinations of parking, |
4 | | standing,
compliance, automated speed enforcement system, or |
5 | | automated traffic law
violations and final administrative |
6 | | decisions issued after hearings
regarding vehicle |
7 | | immobilization and impoundment made
under this Section shall be |
8 | | subject to the provisions of
the Administrative Review Law.
|
9 | | (e) Any fine, penalty, incomplete traffic education |
10 | | program, or part of any fine or any penalty remaining
unpaid |
11 | | after the exhaustion of, or the failure to exhaust, |
12 | | administrative
remedies created under this Section and the |
13 | | conclusion of any judicial
review procedures shall be a debt |
14 | | due and owing the municipality or county and, as
such, may be |
15 | | collected in accordance with applicable law. Completion of any |
16 | | required traffic education program and payment in full
of any |
17 | | fine or penalty resulting from a standing, parking,
compliance, |
18 | | automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic law |
19 | | violation shall
constitute a final disposition of that |
20 | | violation.
|
21 | | (f) After the expiration of the period within which |
22 | | judicial review may
be sought for a final determination of |
23 | | parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement |
24 | | system, or automated traffic law
violation, the municipality
or |
25 | | county may commence a proceeding in the Circuit Court for |
26 | | purposes of obtaining a
judgment on the final determination of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 426 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | violation. Nothing in this
Section shall prevent a municipality |
2 | | or county from consolidating multiple final
determinations of |
3 | | parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement |
4 | | system, or automated traffic law violations against a
person in |
5 | | a proceeding.
Upon commencement of the action, the municipality |
6 | | or county shall file a certified
copy or record of the final |
7 | | determination of parking, standing, compliance, automated |
8 | | speed enforcement system, or automated traffic law
violation, |
9 | | which shall be
accompanied by a certification that recites |
10 | | facts sufficient to show that
the final determination of |
11 | | violation was
issued in accordance with this Section and the |
12 | | applicable municipal
or county ordinance. Service of the |
13 | | summons and a copy of the petition may be by
any method |
14 | | provided by Section 2-203 of the Code of Civil Procedure or by
|
15 | | certified mail, return receipt requested, provided that the |
16 | | total amount of
fines and penalties for final determinations of |
17 | | parking, standing,
compliance, automated speed enforcement |
18 | | system, or automated traffic law violations does not
exceed |
19 | | $2500. If the court is satisfied that the final determination |
20 | | of
parking, standing, compliance, automated speed enforcement |
21 | | system, or automated traffic law violation was entered in |
22 | | accordance with
the requirements of
this Section and the |
23 | | applicable municipal or county ordinance, and that the |
24 | | registered
owner or the lessee, as the case may be, had an |
25 | | opportunity for an
administrative hearing and for judicial |
26 | | review as provided in this Section,
the court shall render |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 427 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | judgment in favor of the municipality or county and against
the |
2 | | registered owner or the lessee for the amount indicated in the |
3 | | final
determination of parking, standing, compliance, |
4 | | automated speed enforcement system, or automated traffic law |
5 | | violation, plus costs.
The judgment shall have
the same effect |
6 | | and may be enforced in the same manner as other judgments
for |
7 | | the recovery of money.
|
8 | | (g) The fee for participating in a traffic education |
9 | | program under this Section shall not exceed $25. |
10 | | A low-income individual required to complete a traffic |
11 | | education program under this Section who provides proof of |
12 | | eligibility for the federal earned income tax credit under |
13 | | Section 32 of the Internal Revenue Code or the Illinois earned |
14 | | income tax credit under Section 212 of the Illinois Income Tax |
15 | | Act shall not be required to pay any fee for participating in a |
16 | | required traffic education program. |
17 | | (Source: P.A. 101-32, eff. 6-28-19; 101-623, eff. 7-1-20; |
18 | | revised 12-21-20.)
|
19 | | (625 ILCS 5/11-208.6)
|
20 | | Sec. 11-208.6. Automated traffic law enforcement system.
|
21 | | (a) As used in this Section, "automated traffic law |
22 | | enforcement
system" means a device with one or more motor |
23 | | vehicle sensors working
in conjunction with a red light signal |
24 | | to produce recorded images of
motor vehicles entering an |
25 | | intersection against a red signal
indication in violation of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 428 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 11-306 of this Code or a similar provision
of a local |
2 | | ordinance.
|
3 | | An
automated traffic law enforcement system is a system, in |
4 | | a municipality or
county operated by a
governmental agency, |
5 | | that
produces a recorded image of a motor vehicle's
violation |
6 | | of a provision of this Code or a local ordinance
and is |
7 | | designed to obtain a clear recorded image of the
vehicle and |
8 | | the vehicle's license plate. The recorded image must also
|
9 | | display the time, date, and location of the violation.
|
10 | | (b) As used in this Section, "recorded images" means images
|
11 | | recorded by an automated traffic law enforcement system on:
|
12 | | (1) 2 or more photographs;
|
13 | | (2) 2 or more microphotographs;
|
14 | | (3) 2 or more electronic images; or
|
15 | | (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on |
16 | | at
least one image or portion of the recording, clearly |
17 | | identifying the
registration plate or digital registration |
18 | | plate number of the motor vehicle.
|
19 | | (b-5) A municipality or
county that
produces a recorded |
20 | | image of a motor vehicle's
violation of a provision of this |
21 | | Code or a local ordinance must make the recorded images of a |
22 | | violation accessible to the alleged violator by providing the |
23 | | alleged violator with a website address, accessible through the |
24 | | Internet. |
25 | | (c) Except as provided under Section 11-208.8 of this Code, |
26 | | a county or municipality, including a home rule county or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 429 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | municipality, may not use an automated traffic law enforcement |
2 | | system to provide recorded images of a motor vehicle for the |
3 | | purpose of recording its speed. Except as provided under |
4 | | Section 11-208.8 of this Code, the regulation of the use of |
5 | | automated traffic law enforcement systems to record vehicle |
6 | | speeds is an exclusive power and function of the State. This |
7 | | subsection (c) is a denial and limitation of home rule powers |
8 | | and functions under subsection (h) of Section 6 of Article VII |
9 | | of the Illinois Constitution.
|
10 | | (c-5) A county or municipality, including a home rule |
11 | | county or municipality, may not use an automated traffic law |
12 | | enforcement system to issue violations in instances where the |
13 | | motor vehicle comes to a complete stop and does not enter the |
14 | | intersection, as defined by Section 1-132 of this Code, during |
15 | | the cycle of the red signal indication unless one or more |
16 | | pedestrians or bicyclists are present, even if the motor |
17 | | vehicle stops at a point past a stop line or crosswalk where a |
18 | | driver is required to stop, as specified in subsection (c) of |
19 | | Section 11-306 of this Code or a similar provision of a local |
20 | | ordinance. |
21 | | (c-6) A county, or a municipality with less than 2,000,000 |
22 | | inhabitants, including a home rule county or municipality, may |
23 | | not use an automated traffic law enforcement system to issue |
24 | | violations in instances where a motorcyclist enters an |
25 | | intersection against a red signal
indication when the red |
26 | | signal fails to change to a green signal within a reasonable |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 430 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | period of time not less than 120 seconds because of a signal |
2 | | malfunction or because the signal has failed to detect the |
3 | | arrival of the motorcycle due to the motorcycle's size or |
4 | | weight. |
5 | | (d) For each violation of a provision of this Code or a |
6 | | local ordinance
recorded by an automatic
traffic law |
7 | | enforcement system, the county or municipality having
|
8 | | jurisdiction shall issue a written notice of the
violation to |
9 | | the registered owner of the vehicle as the alleged
violator. |
10 | | The notice shall be delivered to the registered
owner of the |
11 | | vehicle, by mail, within 30 days after the Secretary of State |
12 | | notifies the municipality or county of the identity of the |
13 | | owner of the vehicle, but in no event later than 90 days after |
14 | | the violation.
|
15 | | The notice shall include:
|
16 | | (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the
|
17 | | vehicle;
|
18 | | (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle
|
19 | | involved in the violation;
|
20 | | (3) the violation charged;
|
21 | | (4) the location where the violation occurred;
|
22 | | (5) the date and time of the violation;
|
23 | | (6) a copy of the recorded images;
|
24 | | (7) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the |
25 | | requirements of any traffic education program imposed and |
26 | | the date
by which the civil penalty should be paid and the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 431 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | traffic education program should be completed;
|
2 | | (8) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a
|
3 | | violation of a red light signal;
|
4 | | (9) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty, to |
5 | | complete a required traffic education program, or to
|
6 | | contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of
|
7 | | liability and may result in a suspension of the driving
|
8 | | privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle ;
|
9 | | (10) a statement that the person may elect to proceed |
10 | | by:
|
11 | | (A) paying the fine, completing a required traffic |
12 | | education program, or both; or
|
13 | | (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by |
14 | | administrative hearing; and
|
15 | | (11) a website address, accessible through the |
16 | | Internet, where the person may view the recorded images of |
17 | | the violation. |
18 | | (e) (Blank). If a person
charged with a traffic violation, |
19 | | as a result of an automated traffic law
enforcement system, |
20 | | does not pay the fine or complete a required traffic education |
21 | | program, or both, or successfully contest the civil
penalty |
22 | | resulting from that violation, the Secretary of State shall |
23 | | suspend the
driving privileges of the
registered owner of the |
24 | | vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this Code for failing
to |
25 | | complete a required traffic education program or to pay any |
26 | | fine or penalty
due and owing, or both, as a result of a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 432 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | combination of 5 violations of the automated traffic law
|
2 | | enforcement system or the automated speed enforcement system |
3 | | under Section 11-208.8 of this Code.
|
4 | | (f) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an
|
5 | | automated traffic law enforcement system, a notice alleging |
6 | | that the violation occurred shall be evidence of the facts |
7 | | contained
in the notice and admissible in any proceeding |
8 | | alleging a
violation under this Section.
|
9 | | (g) Recorded images made by an automatic traffic law
|
10 | | enforcement system are confidential and shall be made
available |
11 | | only to the alleged violator and governmental and
law |
12 | | enforcement agencies for purposes of adjudicating a
violation |
13 | | of this Section, for statistical purposes, or for other |
14 | | governmental purposes. Any recorded image evidencing a
|
15 | | violation of this Section, however, may be admissible in
any |
16 | | proceeding resulting from the issuance of the citation.
|
17 | | (h) The court or hearing officer may consider in defense of |
18 | | a violation:
|
19 | | (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or |
20 | | digital registration plates of the motor
vehicle were |
21 | | stolen before the violation occurred and not
under the |
22 | | control of or in the possession of the owner at
the time of |
23 | | the violation;
|
24 | | (2) that the driver of the vehicle passed through the
|
25 | | intersection when the light was red either (i) in order to
|
26 | | yield the right-of-way to an emergency vehicle or (ii) as
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 433 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | part of a funeral procession; and
|
2 | | (3) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal |
3 | | or county ordinance.
|
4 | | (i) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the |
5 | | registration
plates or digital registration plates were stolen |
6 | | before the violation occurred and were not under the
control or |
7 | | possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the
owner |
8 | | must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen
motor |
9 | | vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement |
10 | | agency in a timely manner.
|
11 | | (j) Unless the driver of the motor vehicle received a |
12 | | Uniform
Traffic Citation from a police officer at the time of |
13 | | the violation,
the motor vehicle owner is subject to a civil |
14 | | penalty not exceeding
$100 or the completion of a traffic |
15 | | education program, or both, plus an additional penalty of not |
16 | | more than $100 for failure to pay the original penalty or to |
17 | | complete a required traffic education program, or both, in a |
18 | | timely manner, if the motor vehicle is recorded by an automated |
19 | | traffic law
enforcement system. A violation for which a civil |
20 | | penalty is imposed
under this Section is not a violation of a |
21 | | traffic regulation governing
the movement of vehicles and may |
22 | | not be recorded on the driving record
of the owner of the |
23 | | vehicle.
|
24 | | (j-3) A registered owner who is a holder of a valid |
25 | | commercial driver's license is not required to complete a |
26 | | traffic education program. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 434 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (j-5) For purposes of the required traffic education |
2 | | program only, a registered owner may submit an affidavit to the |
3 | | court or hearing officer swearing that at the time of the |
4 | | alleged violation, the vehicle was in the custody and control |
5 | | of another person. The affidavit must identify the person in |
6 | | custody and control of the vehicle, including the person's name |
7 | | and current address. The person in custody and control of the |
8 | | vehicle at the time of the violation is required to complete |
9 | | the required traffic education program. If the person in |
10 | | custody and control of the vehicle at the time of the violation |
11 | | completes the required traffic education program, the |
12 | | registered owner of the vehicle is not required to complete a |
13 | | traffic education program. |
14 | | (k) An intersection equipped with an automated traffic law
|
15 | | enforcement system must be posted with a sign visible to |
16 | | approaching traffic
indicating that the intersection is being |
17 | | monitored by an automated
traffic law enforcement system. |
18 | | (k-3) A municipality or
county that has one or more |
19 | | intersections equipped with an automated traffic law
|
20 | | enforcement system must provide notice to drivers by posting |
21 | | the locations of automated traffic law systems on the |
22 | | municipality or county website.
|
23 | | (k-5) An intersection equipped with an automated traffic |
24 | | law
enforcement system must have a yellow change interval that |
25 | | conforms with the Illinois Manual on Uniform Traffic Control |
26 | | Devices (IMUTCD) published by the Illinois Department of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 435 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Transportation. |
2 | | (k-7) A municipality or county operating an automated |
3 | | traffic law enforcement system shall conduct a statistical |
4 | | analysis to assess the safety impact of each automated traffic |
5 | | law enforcement system at an intersection following |
6 | | installation of the system. The statistical analysis shall be |
7 | | based upon the best available crash, traffic, and other data, |
8 | | and shall cover a period of time before and after installation |
9 | | of the system sufficient to provide a statistically valid |
10 | | comparison of safety impact. The statistical analysis shall be |
11 | | consistent with professional judgment and acceptable industry |
12 | | practice. The statistical analysis also shall be consistent |
13 | | with the data required for valid comparisons of before and |
14 | | after conditions and shall be conducted within a reasonable |
15 | | period following the installation of the automated traffic law |
16 | | enforcement system. The statistical analysis required by this |
17 | | subsection (k-7) shall be made available to the public and |
18 | | shall be published on the website of the municipality or |
19 | | county. If the statistical analysis for the 36 month period |
20 | | following installation of the system indicates that there has |
21 | | been an increase in the rate of accidents at the approach to |
22 | | the intersection monitored by the system, the municipality or |
23 | | county shall undertake additional studies to determine the |
24 | | cause and severity of the accidents, and may take any action |
25 | | that it determines is necessary or appropriate to reduce the |
26 | | number or severity of the accidents at that intersection. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 436 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (l) The compensation paid for an automated traffic law |
2 | | enforcement system
must be based on the value of the equipment |
3 | | or the services provided and may
not be based on the number of |
4 | | traffic citations issued or the revenue generated
by the |
5 | | system.
|
6 | | (m) This Section applies only to the counties of Cook, |
7 | | DuPage, Kane, Lake, Madison, McHenry, St. Clair, and Will and |
8 | | to municipalities located within those counties.
|
9 | | (n) The fee for participating in a traffic education |
10 | | program under this Section shall not exceed $25. |
11 | | A low-income individual required to complete a traffic |
12 | | education program under this Section who provides proof of |
13 | | eligibility for the federal earned income tax credit under |
14 | | Section 32 of the Internal Revenue Code or the Illinois earned |
15 | | income tax credit under Section 212 of the Illinois Income Tax |
16 | | Act shall not be required to pay any fee for participating in a |
17 | | required traffic education program. |
18 | | (o) (Blank). A municipality or county shall make a |
19 | | certified report to the Secretary of State pursuant to Section |
20 | | 6-306.5 of this Code whenever a registered owner of a vehicle |
21 | | has failed to pay any
fine or penalty due and owing as a result |
22 | | of a combination of 5 offenses for automated traffic
law or |
23 | | speed enforcement system violations. |
24 | | (p) No person who is the lessor of a motor vehicle pursuant |
25 | | to a written lease agreement shall be liable for an automated |
26 | | speed or traffic law enforcement system violation involving |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 437 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | such motor vehicle during the period of the lease; provided |
2 | | that upon the request of the appropriate authority received |
3 | | within 120 days after the violation occurred, the lessor |
4 | | provides within 60 days after such receipt the name and address |
5 | | of the lessee. The drivers license number of a lessee may be |
6 | | subsequently individually requested by the appropriate |
7 | | authority if needed for enforcement of this Section. |
8 | | Upon the provision of information by the lessor pursuant to |
9 | | this subsection, the county or municipality may issue the |
10 | | violation to the lessee of the vehicle in the same manner as it |
11 | | would issue a violation to a registered owner of a vehicle |
12 | | pursuant to this Section, and the lessee may be held liable for |
13 | | the violation. |
14 | | (Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.) |
15 | | (625 ILCS 5/11-208.8) |
16 | | Sec. 11-208.8. Automated speed enforcement systems in |
17 | | safety zones. |
18 | | (a) As used in this Section: |
19 | | "Automated speed enforcement
system" means a photographic |
20 | | device, radar device, laser device, or other electrical or |
21 | | mechanical device or devices installed or utilized in a safety |
22 | | zone and designed to record the speed of a vehicle and obtain a |
23 | | clear photograph or other recorded image of the vehicle and the |
24 | | vehicle's registration plate or digital registration plate |
25 | | while the driver is violating Article VI of Chapter 11 of this |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 438 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Code or a similar provision of a local ordinance. |
2 | | An automated speed enforcement system is a system, located |
3 | | in a safety zone which is under the jurisdiction of a |
4 | | municipality, that produces a recorded image of a motor |
5 | | vehicle's violation of a provision of this Code or a local |
6 | | ordinance and is designed to obtain a clear recorded image of |
7 | | the vehicle and the vehicle's license plate. The recorded image |
8 | | must also display the time, date, and location of the |
9 | | violation. |
10 | | "Owner" means the person or entity to whom the vehicle is |
11 | | registered. |
12 | | "Recorded image" means images
recorded by an automated |
13 | | speed enforcement system on: |
14 | | (1) 2 or more photographs; |
15 | | (2) 2 or more microphotographs; |
16 | | (3) 2 or more electronic images; or |
17 | | (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on |
18 | | at
least one image or portion of the recording, clearly |
19 | | identifying the
registration plate or digital registration |
20 | | plate number of the motor vehicle. |
21 | | "Safety zone" means an area that is within one-eighth of a |
22 | | mile from the nearest property line of any public or private |
23 | | elementary or secondary school, or from the nearest property |
24 | | line of any facility, area, or land owned by a school district |
25 | | that is used for educational purposes approved by the Illinois |
26 | | State Board of Education, not including school district |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 439 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | headquarters or administrative buildings. A safety zone also |
2 | | includes an area that is within one-eighth of a mile from the |
3 | | nearest property line of any facility, area, or land owned by a |
4 | | park district used for recreational purposes. However, if any |
5 | | portion of a roadway is within either one-eighth mile radius, |
6 | | the safety zone also shall include the roadway extended to the |
7 | | furthest portion of the next furthest intersection. The term |
8 | | "safety zone" does not include any portion of the roadway known |
9 | | as Lake Shore Drive or any controlled access highway with 8 or |
10 | | more lanes of traffic. |
11 | | (a-5) The automated speed enforcement system shall be |
12 | | operational and violations shall be recorded only at the |
13 | | following times: |
14 | | (i) if the safety zone is based upon the property line |
15 | | of any facility, area, or land owned by a school district, |
16 | | only on school days and no earlier than 6 a.m. and no later |
17 | | than 8:30 p.m. if the school day is during the period of |
18 | | Monday through Thursday, or 9 p.m. if the school day is a |
19 | | Friday; and |
20 | | (ii) if the safety zone is based upon the property line |
21 | | of any facility, area, or land owned by a park district, no |
22 | | earlier than one hour prior to the time that the facility, |
23 | | area, or land is open to the public or other patrons, and |
24 | | no later than one hour after the facility, area, or land is |
25 | | closed to the public or other patrons. |
26 | | (b) A municipality that
produces a recorded image of a |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 440 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | motor vehicle's
violation of a provision of this Code or a |
2 | | local ordinance must make the recorded images of a violation |
3 | | accessible to the alleged violator by providing the alleged |
4 | | violator with a website address, accessible through the |
5 | | Internet. |
6 | | (c) Notwithstanding any penalties for any other violations |
7 | | of this Code, the owner of a motor vehicle used in a traffic |
8 | | violation recorded by an automated speed enforcement system |
9 | | shall be subject to the following penalties: |
10 | | (1) if the recorded speed is no less than 6 miles per |
11 | | hour and no more than 10 miles per hour over the legal |
12 | | speed limit, a civil penalty not exceeding $50, plus an |
13 | | additional penalty of not more than $50 for failure to pay |
14 | | the original penalty in a timely manner; or |
15 | | (2) if the recorded speed is more than 10 miles per |
16 | | hour over the legal speed limit, a civil penalty not |
17 | | exceeding $100, plus an additional penalty of not more than |
18 | | $100 for failure to pay the original penalty in a timely |
19 | | manner. |
20 | | A penalty may not be imposed under this Section if the |
21 | | driver of the motor vehicle received a Uniform Traffic Citation |
22 | | from a police officer for a speeding violation occurring within |
23 | | one-eighth of a mile and 15 minutes of the violation that was |
24 | | recorded by the system. A violation for which a civil penalty |
25 | | is imposed
under this Section is not a violation of a traffic |
26 | | regulation governing
the movement of vehicles and may not be |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 441 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | recorded on the driving record
of the owner of the vehicle. A |
2 | | law enforcement officer is not required to be present or to |
3 | | witness the violation. No penalty may be imposed under this |
4 | | Section if the recorded speed of a vehicle is 5 miles per hour |
5 | | or less over the legal speed limit. The municipality may send, |
6 | | in the same manner that notices are sent under this Section, a |
7 | | speed violation warning notice where the violation involves a |
8 | | speed of 5 miles per hour or less above the legal speed limit. |
9 | | (d) The net proceeds that a municipality receives from |
10 | | civil penalties imposed under an automated speed enforcement |
11 | | system, after deducting all non-personnel and personnel costs |
12 | | associated with the operation and maintenance of such system, |
13 | | shall be expended or obligated by the municipality for the |
14 | | following purposes: |
15 | | (i) public safety initiatives to ensure safe passage |
16 | | around schools, and to provide police protection and |
17 | | surveillance around schools and parks, including but not |
18 | | limited to:
(1) personnel costs; and
(2) non-personnel |
19 | | costs such as construction and maintenance of public safety |
20 | | infrastructure and equipment; |
21 | | (ii) initiatives to improve pedestrian and traffic |
22 | | safety; |
23 | | (iii) construction and maintenance of infrastructure |
24 | | within the municipality, including but not limited to roads |
25 | | and bridges; and |
26 | | (iv) after school programs. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 442 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (e) For each violation of a provision of this Code or a |
2 | | local ordinance
recorded by an automated speed enforcement |
3 | | system, the municipality having
jurisdiction shall issue a |
4 | | written notice of the
violation to the registered owner of the |
5 | | vehicle as the alleged
violator. The notice shall be delivered |
6 | | to the registered
owner of the vehicle, by mail, within 30 days |
7 | | after the Secretary of State notifies the municipality of the |
8 | | identity of the owner of the vehicle, but in no event later |
9 | | than 90 days after the violation. |
10 | | (f) The notice required under subsection (e) of this |
11 | | Section shall include: |
12 | | (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the
|
13 | | vehicle; |
14 | | (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle
|
15 | | involved in the violation; |
16 | | (3) the violation charged; |
17 | | (4) the date, time, and location where the violation |
18 | | occurred; |
19 | | (5) a copy of the recorded image or images; |
20 | | (6) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the |
21 | | date
by which the civil penalty should be paid; |
22 | | (7) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a
|
23 | | violation of a speed restriction; |
24 | | (8) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty or |
25 | | to
contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of
|
26 | | liability and may result in a suspension of the driving
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 443 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle ; |
2 | | (9) a statement that the person may elect to proceed |
3 | | by: |
4 | | (A) paying the fine; or |
5 | | (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by |
6 | | administrative hearing; and |
7 | | (10) a website address, accessible through the
|
8 | | Internet, where the person may view the recorded images of |
9 | | the violation. |
10 | | (g) (Blank). If a person
charged with a traffic violation, |
11 | | as a result of an automated speed enforcement system, does not |
12 | | pay the fine or successfully contest the civil
penalty |
13 | | resulting from that violation, the Secretary of State shall |
14 | | suspend the
driving privileges of the
registered owner of the |
15 | | vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this Code for failing
to pay |
16 | | any fine or penalty
due and owing, or both, as a result of a |
17 | | combination of 5 violations of the automated speed enforcement |
18 | | system or the automated traffic law under Section 11-208.6 of |
19 | | this Code. |
20 | | (h) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an
|
21 | | automated speed enforcement system, a notice alleging that the |
22 | | violation occurred shall be evidence of the facts contained
in |
23 | | the notice and admissible in any proceeding alleging a
|
24 | | violation under this Section. |
25 | | (i) Recorded images made by an automated speed
enforcement |
26 | | system are confidential and shall be made
available only to the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 444 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | alleged violator and governmental and
law enforcement agencies |
2 | | for purposes of adjudicating a
violation of this Section, for |
3 | | statistical purposes, or for other governmental purposes. Any |
4 | | recorded image evidencing a
violation of this Section, however, |
5 | | may be admissible in
any proceeding resulting from the issuance |
6 | | of the citation. |
7 | | (j) The court or hearing officer may consider in defense of |
8 | | a violation: |
9 | | (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or |
10 | | digital registration plates of the motor
vehicle were |
11 | | stolen before the violation occurred and not
under the |
12 | | control or in the possession of the owner at
the time of |
13 | | the violation; |
14 | | (2) that the driver of the motor vehicle received a |
15 | | Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer for a |
16 | | speeding violation occurring within one-eighth of a mile |
17 | | and 15 minutes of the violation that was recorded by the |
18 | | system; and |
19 | | (3) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal |
20 | | ordinance. |
21 | | (k) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the |
22 | | registration
plates or digital registration plates were stolen |
23 | | before the violation occurred and were not under the
control or |
24 | | possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the
owner |
25 | | must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen
motor |
26 | | vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 445 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | agency in a timely manner. |
2 | | (l) A roadway equipped with an automated speed enforcement |
3 | | system shall be posted with a sign conforming to the national |
4 | | Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices that is visible to |
5 | | approaching traffic stating that vehicle speeds are being |
6 | | photo-enforced and indicating the speed limit. The |
7 | | municipality shall install such additional signage as it |
8 | | determines is necessary to give reasonable notice to drivers as |
9 | | to where automated speed enforcement systems are installed. |
10 | | (m) A roadway where a new automated speed enforcement |
11 | | system is installed shall be posted with signs providing 30 |
12 | | days notice of the use of a new automated speed enforcement |
13 | | system prior to the issuance of any citations through the |
14 | | automated speed enforcement system. |
15 | | (n) The compensation paid for an automated speed |
16 | | enforcement system
must be based on the value of the equipment |
17 | | or the services provided and may
not be based on the number of |
18 | | traffic citations issued or the revenue generated
by the |
19 | | system. |
20 | | (o) (Blank). A municipality shall make a certified report |
21 | | to the Secretary of State pursuant to Section 6-306.5 of this |
22 | | Code whenever a registered owner of a vehicle has failed to pay |
23 | | any
fine or penalty due and owing as a result of a combination |
24 | | of 5 offenses for automated speed or traffic law enforcement |
25 | | system violations. |
26 | | (p) No person who is the lessor of a motor vehicle pursuant |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 446 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | to a written lease agreement shall be liable for an automated |
2 | | speed or traffic law enforcement system violation involving |
3 | | such motor vehicle during the period of the lease; provided |
4 | | that upon the request of the appropriate authority received |
5 | | within 120 days after the violation occurred, the lessor |
6 | | provides within 60 days after such receipt the name and address |
7 | | of the lessee. The drivers license number of a lessee may be |
8 | | subsequently individually requested by the appropriate |
9 | | authority if needed for enforcement of this Section. |
10 | | Upon the provision of information by the lessor pursuant to |
11 | | this subsection, the municipality may issue the violation to |
12 | | the lessee of the vehicle in the same manner as it would issue |
13 | | a violation to a registered owner of a vehicle pursuant to this |
14 | | Section, and the lessee may be held liable for the violation. |
15 | | (q) A municipality using an automated speed enforcement |
16 | | system must provide notice to drivers by publishing the |
17 | | locations of all safety zones where system equipment is |
18 | | installed on the website of the municipality. |
19 | | (r) A municipality operating an automated speed |
20 | | enforcement system shall conduct a statistical analysis to |
21 | | assess the safety impact of the system. The statistical |
22 | | analysis shall be based upon the best available crash, traffic, |
23 | | and other data, and shall cover a period of time before and |
24 | | after installation of the system sufficient to provide a |
25 | | statistically valid comparison of safety impact. The |
26 | | statistical analysis shall be consistent with professional |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 447 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | judgment and acceptable industry practice. The statistical |
2 | | analysis also shall be consistent with the data required for |
3 | | valid comparisons of before and after conditions and shall be |
4 | | conducted within a reasonable period following the |
5 | | installation of the automated traffic law enforcement system. |
6 | | The statistical analysis required by this subsection shall be |
7 | | made available to the public and shall be published on the |
8 | | website of the municipality. |
9 | | (s) This Section applies only to municipalities with a |
10 | | population of 1,000,000 or more inhabitants.
|
11 | | (Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.) |
12 | | (625 ILCS 5/11-208.9) |
13 | | Sec. 11-208.9. Automated traffic law enforcement system; |
14 | | approaching, overtaking, and passing a school bus. |
15 | | (a) As used in this Section, "automated traffic law |
16 | | enforcement
system" means a device with one or more motor |
17 | | vehicle sensors working
in conjunction with the visual signals |
18 | | on a school bus, as specified in Sections 12-803 and 12-805 of |
19 | | this Code, to produce recorded images of
motor vehicles that |
20 | | fail to stop before meeting or overtaking, from either |
21 | | direction, any school bus stopped at any location for the |
22 | | purpose of receiving or discharging pupils in violation of |
23 | | Section 11-1414 of this Code or a similar provision
of a local |
24 | | ordinance. |
25 | | An
automated traffic law enforcement system is a system, in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 448 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | a municipality or
county operated by a
governmental agency, |
2 | | that
produces a recorded image of a motor vehicle's
violation |
3 | | of a provision of this Code or a local ordinance
and is |
4 | | designed to obtain a clear recorded image of the
vehicle and |
5 | | the vehicle's license plate. The recorded image must also
|
6 | | display the time, date, and location of the violation. |
7 | | (b) As used in this Section, "recorded images" means images
|
8 | | recorded by an automated traffic law enforcement system on: |
9 | | (1) 2 or more photographs; |
10 | | (2) 2 or more microphotographs; |
11 | | (3) 2 or more electronic images; or |
12 | | (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on |
13 | | at
least one image or portion of the recording, clearly |
14 | | identifying the
registration plate or digital registration |
15 | | plate number of the motor vehicle. |
16 | | (c) A municipality or
county that
produces a recorded image |
17 | | of a motor vehicle's
violation of a provision of this Code or a |
18 | | local ordinance must make the recorded images of a violation |
19 | | accessible to the alleged violator by providing the alleged |
20 | | violator with a website address, accessible through the |
21 | | Internet. |
22 | | (d) For each violation of a provision of this Code or a |
23 | | local ordinance
recorded by an automated
traffic law |
24 | | enforcement system, the county or municipality having
|
25 | | jurisdiction shall issue a written notice of the
violation to |
26 | | the registered owner of the vehicle as the alleged
violator. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 449 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | The notice shall be delivered to the registered
owner of the |
2 | | vehicle, by mail, within 30 days after the Secretary of State |
3 | | notifies the municipality or county of the identity of the |
4 | | owner of the vehicle, but in no event later than 90 days after |
5 | | the violation. |
6 | | (e) The notice required under subsection (d) shall include: |
7 | | (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the
|
8 | | vehicle; |
9 | | (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle
|
10 | | involved in the violation; |
11 | | (3) the violation charged; |
12 | | (4) the location where the violation occurred; |
13 | | (5) the date and time of the violation; |
14 | | (6) a copy of the recorded images; |
15 | | (7) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the |
16 | | date
by which the civil penalty should be paid; |
17 | | (8) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a
|
18 | | violation of overtaking or passing a school bus stopped for |
19 | | the purpose of receiving or discharging pupils; |
20 | | (9) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty or |
21 | | to
contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of
|
22 | | liability and may result in a suspension of the driving
|
23 | | privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle ; |
24 | | (10) a statement that the person may elect to proceed |
25 | | by: |
26 | | (A) paying the fine; or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 450 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by |
2 | | administrative hearing; and |
3 | | (11) a website address, accessible through the |
4 | | Internet, where the person may view the recorded images of |
5 | | the violation. |
6 | | (f) (Blank). If a person
charged with a traffic violation, |
7 | | as a result of an automated traffic law
enforcement system |
8 | | under this Section, does not pay the fine or successfully |
9 | | contest the civil
penalty resulting from that violation, the |
10 | | Secretary of State shall suspend the
driving privileges of the
|
11 | | registered owner of the vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this |
12 | | Code for failing
to pay any fine or penalty
due and owing as a |
13 | | result of a combination of 5 violations of the automated |
14 | | traffic law
enforcement system or the automated speed |
15 | | enforcement system under Section 11-208.8 of this Code. |
16 | | (g) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an
|
17 | | automated traffic law enforcement system, a notice alleging |
18 | | that the violation occurred shall be evidence of the facts |
19 | | contained
in the notice and admissible in any proceeding |
20 | | alleging a
violation under this Section. |
21 | | (h) Recorded images made by an automated traffic law
|
22 | | enforcement system are confidential and shall be made
available |
23 | | only to the alleged violator and governmental and
law |
24 | | enforcement agencies for purposes of adjudicating a
violation |
25 | | of this Section, for statistical purposes, or for other |
26 | | governmental purposes. Any recorded image evidencing a
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 451 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | violation of this Section, however, may be admissible in
any |
2 | | proceeding resulting from the issuance of the citation. |
3 | | (i) The court or hearing officer may consider in defense of |
4 | | a violation: |
5 | | (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or |
6 | | digital registration plates of the motor
vehicle were |
7 | | stolen before the violation occurred and not
under the |
8 | | control of or in the possession of the owner at
the time of |
9 | | the violation; |
10 | | (2) that the driver of the motor vehicle received a |
11 | | Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer for a |
12 | | violation of Section 11-1414 of this Code within one-eighth |
13 | | of a mile and 15 minutes of the violation that was recorded |
14 | | by the system; |
15 | | (3) that the visual signals required by Sections 12-803 |
16 | | and 12-805 of this Code were damaged, not activated, not |
17 | | present in violation of Sections 12-803 and 12-805, or |
18 | | inoperable; and |
19 | | (4) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal |
20 | | or county ordinance. |
21 | | (j) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the |
22 | | registration
plates or digital registration plates were stolen |
23 | | before the violation occurred and were not under the
control or |
24 | | possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the
owner |
25 | | must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen
motor |
26 | | vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 452 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | agency in a timely manner. |
2 | | (k) Unless the driver of the motor vehicle received a |
3 | | Uniform
Traffic Citation from a police officer at the time of |
4 | | the violation,
the motor vehicle owner is subject to a civil |
5 | | penalty not exceeding
$150 for a first time violation or $500 |
6 | | for a second or subsequent violation, plus an additional |
7 | | penalty of not more than $100 for failure to pay the original |
8 | | penalty in a timely manner, if the motor vehicle is recorded by |
9 | | an automated traffic law
enforcement system. A violation for |
10 | | which a civil penalty is imposed
under this Section is not a |
11 | | violation of a traffic regulation governing
the movement of |
12 | | vehicles and may not be recorded on the driving record
of the |
13 | | owner of the vehicle, but may be recorded by the municipality |
14 | | or county for the purpose of determining if a person is subject |
15 | | to the higher fine for a second or subsequent offense. |
16 | | (l) A school bus equipped with an automated traffic law
|
17 | | enforcement system must be posted with a sign indicating that |
18 | | the school bus is being monitored by an automated
traffic law |
19 | | enforcement system. |
20 | | (m) A municipality or
county that has one or more school |
21 | | buses equipped with an automated traffic law
enforcement system |
22 | | must provide notice to drivers by posting a list of school |
23 | | districts using school buses equipped with an automated traffic |
24 | | law enforcement system on the municipality or county website. |
25 | | School districts that have one or more school buses equipped |
26 | | with an automated traffic law enforcement system must provide |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 453 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | notice to drivers by posting that information on their |
2 | | websites. |
3 | | (n) A municipality or county operating an automated traffic |
4 | | law enforcement system shall conduct a statistical analysis to |
5 | | assess the safety impact in each school district using school |
6 | | buses equipped with an automated traffic law enforcement system |
7 | | following installation of the system. The statistical analysis |
8 | | shall be based upon the best available crash, traffic, and |
9 | | other data, and shall cover a period of time before and after |
10 | | installation of the system sufficient to provide a |
11 | | statistically valid comparison of safety impact. The |
12 | | statistical analysis shall be consistent with professional |
13 | | judgment and acceptable industry practice. The statistical |
14 | | analysis also shall be consistent with the data required for |
15 | | valid comparisons of before and after conditions and shall be |
16 | | conducted within a reasonable period following the |
17 | | installation of the automated traffic law enforcement system. |
18 | | The statistical analysis required by this subsection shall be |
19 | | made available to the public and shall be published on the |
20 | | website of the municipality or county. If the statistical |
21 | | analysis for the 36-month period following installation of the |
22 | | system indicates that there has been an increase in the rate of |
23 | | accidents at the approach to school buses monitored by the |
24 | | system, the municipality or county shall undertake additional |
25 | | studies to determine the cause and severity of the accidents, |
26 | | and may take any action that it determines is necessary or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 454 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | appropriate to reduce the number or severity of the accidents |
2 | | involving school buses equipped with an automated traffic law |
3 | | enforcement system. |
4 | | (o) The compensation paid for an automated traffic law |
5 | | enforcement system
must be based on the value of the equipment |
6 | | or the services provided and may
not be based on the number of |
7 | | traffic citations issued or the revenue generated
by the |
8 | | system. |
9 | | (p) No person who is the lessor of a motor vehicle pursuant |
10 | | to a written lease agreement shall be liable for an automated |
11 | | speed or traffic law enforcement system violation involving |
12 | | such motor vehicle during the period of the lease; provided |
13 | | that upon the request of the appropriate authority received |
14 | | within 120 days after the violation occurred, the lessor |
15 | | provides within 60 days after such receipt the name and address |
16 | | of the lessee. The drivers license number of a lessee may be |
17 | | subsequently individually requested by the appropriate |
18 | | authority if needed for enforcement of this Section. |
19 | | Upon the provision of information by the lessor pursuant to |
20 | | this subsection, the county or municipality may issue the |
21 | | violation to the lessee of the vehicle in the same manner as it |
22 | | would issue a violation to a registered owner of a vehicle |
23 | | pursuant to this Section, and the lessee may be held liable for |
24 | | the violation. |
25 | | (q) (Blank). A municipality or county shall make a |
26 | | certified report to the Secretary of State pursuant to Section |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 455 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | 6-306.5 of this Code whenever a registered owner of a vehicle |
2 | | has failed to pay any
fine or penalty due and owing as a result |
3 | | of a combination of 5 offenses for automated traffic
law or |
4 | | speed enforcement system violations. |
5 | | (r) After a municipality or county enacts an ordinance |
6 | | providing for automated traffic law enforcement systems under |
7 | | this Section, each school district within that municipality or |
8 | | county's jurisdiction may implement an automated traffic law |
9 | | enforcement system under this Section. The elected school board |
10 | | for that district must approve the implementation of an |
11 | | automated traffic law enforcement system. The school district |
12 | | shall be responsible for entering into a contract, approved by |
13 | | the elected school board of that district, with vendors for the |
14 | | installation, maintenance, and operation of the automated |
15 | | traffic law enforcement system. The school district must enter |
16 | | into an intergovernmental agreement, approved by the elected |
17 | | school board of that district, with the municipality or county |
18 | | with jurisdiction over that school district for the |
19 | | administration of the automated traffic law enforcement |
20 | | system. The proceeds from a school district's automated traffic |
21 | | law enforcement system's fines shall be divided equally between |
22 | | the school district and the municipality or county |
23 | | administering the automated traffic law enforcement system.
|
24 | | (Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.)
|
25 | | (625 ILCS 5/11-1201.1)
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 456 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Sec. 11-1201.1. Automated Railroad Crossing Enforcement |
2 | | System.
|
3 | | (a) For the purposes of this Section, an automated railroad |
4 | | grade crossing
enforcement system is a system in a municipality |
5 | | or county operated by a governmental agency that produces a |
6 | | recorded image of a motor vehicle's violation of a provision of |
7 | | this Code or local ordinance and is designed to obtain a clear |
8 | | recorded image of the vehicle and vehicle's license plate. The |
9 | | recorded image must also display the time, date, and location |
10 | | of the violation. |
11 | | As used in this Section, "recorded images" means images |
12 | | recorded by an automated railroad grade crossing enforcement |
13 | | system on: |
14 | | (1) 2 or more photographs; |
15 | | (2) 2 or more microphotographs; |
16 | | (3) 2 or more electronic images; or |
17 | | (4) a video recording showing the motor vehicle and, on |
18 | | at least one image or portion of the recording, clearly |
19 | | identifying the registration plate or digital registration |
20 | | plate number of the motor vehicle.
|
21 | | (b) The Illinois
Commerce Commission may, in cooperation |
22 | | with a
local law enforcement agency, establish in any county or |
23 | | municipality an automated
railroad grade crossing enforcement |
24 | | system at any railroad grade crossing equipped with a crossing |
25 | | gate designated by local authorities. Local authorities |
26 | | desiring the establishment of an automated railroad crossing |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 457 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | enforcement system must initiate the process by enacting a |
2 | | local ordinance requesting the creation of such a system. After |
3 | | the ordinance has been enacted, and before any additional steps |
4 | | toward the establishment of the system are undertaken, the |
5 | | local authorities and the Commission must agree to a plan for |
6 | | obtaining, from any combination of federal, State, and local |
7 | | funding sources, the moneys required for the purchase and |
8 | | installation of any necessary equipment.
|
9 | | (b-1) (Blank.)
|
10 | | (c) For each violation of Section 11-1201 of this Code or a |
11 | | local ordinance recorded by an automated railroad grade |
12 | | crossing enforcement system, the county or municipality having |
13 | | jurisdiction shall issue a written notice of the violation to |
14 | | the registered owner of the vehicle as the alleged violator. |
15 | | The notice shall be delivered to the registered owner of the |
16 | | vehicle, by mail, no later than 90 days after the violation. |
17 | | The notice shall include: |
18 | | (1) the name and address of the registered owner of the |
19 | | vehicle; |
20 | | (2) the registration number of the motor vehicle |
21 | | involved in the violation; |
22 | | (3) the violation charged; |
23 | | (4) the location where the violation occurred; |
24 | | (5) the date and time of the violation; |
25 | | (6) a copy of the recorded images; |
26 | | (7) the amount of the civil penalty imposed and the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 458 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | date by which the civil penalty should be paid; |
2 | | (8) a statement that recorded images are evidence of a |
3 | | violation of a railroad grade crossing; |
4 | | (9) a warning that failure to pay the civil penalty or |
5 | | to contest liability in a timely manner is an admission of |
6 | | liability and may result in a suspension of the driving |
7 | | privileges of the registered owner of the vehicle ; and |
8 | | (10) a statement that the person may elect to proceed |
9 | | by: |
10 | | (A) paying the fine; or |
11 | | (B) challenging the charge in court, by mail, or by |
12 | | administrative hearing.
|
13 | | (d) (Blank). If a person charged with a traffic violation, |
14 | | as a result of an automated railroad grade crossing enforcement |
15 | | system, does not pay or successfully contest the civil penalty |
16 | | resulting from that violation, the Secretary of State shall |
17 | | suspend the driving privileges of the registered owner of the |
18 | | vehicle under Section 6-306.5 of this Code for failing to pay |
19 | | any fine or penalty due and owing as a result of 5 violations |
20 | | of the automated railroad grade crossing enforcement system.
|
21 | | (d-1) (Blank.)
|
22 | | (d-2) (Blank.)
|
23 | | (e) Based on inspection of recorded images produced by an |
24 | | automated railroad grade crossing enforcement system, a notice |
25 | | alleging that the violation occurred shall be evidence of the |
26 | | facts contained in the notice and admissible in any proceeding |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 459 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | alleging a violation under this Section.
|
2 | | (e-1) Recorded images made by an automated railroad grade |
3 | | crossing enforcement system are confidential and shall be made |
4 | | available only to the alleged violator and governmental and law |
5 | | enforcement agencies for purposes of adjudicating a violation |
6 | | of this Section, for statistical purposes, or for other |
7 | | governmental purposes. Any recorded image evidencing a |
8 | | violation of this Section, however, may be admissible in any |
9 | | proceeding resulting from the issuance of the citation.
|
10 | | (e-2) The court or hearing officer may consider the |
11 | | following in the defense of a violation:
|
12 | | (1) that the motor vehicle or registration plates or |
13 | | digital registration plates of the motor vehicle were |
14 | | stolen before the violation occurred and not under the |
15 | | control of or in the possession of the owner at the time of |
16 | | the violation;
|
17 | | (2) that the driver of the motor vehicle received a |
18 | | Uniform Traffic Citation from a police officer at the time |
19 | | of the violation for the same offense; |
20 | | (3) any other evidence or issues provided by municipal |
21 | | or county ordinance. |
22 | | (e-3) To demonstrate that the motor vehicle or the |
23 | | registration plates or digital registration plates were stolen |
24 | | before the violation occurred and were not under the control or |
25 | | possession of the owner at the time of the violation, the owner |
26 | | must submit proof that a report concerning the stolen motor |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 460 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | vehicle or registration plates was filed with a law enforcement |
2 | | agency in a timely manner.
|
3 | | (f) Rail crossings equipped with an automatic railroad |
4 | | grade crossing
enforcement system shall be posted with a sign |
5 | | visible to approaching traffic
stating that the railroad grade |
6 | | crossing is being monitored, that citations
will be issued, and |
7 | | the amount of the fine for violation.
|
8 | | (g) The compensation paid for an automated railroad grade |
9 | | crossing enforcement system must be based on the value of the |
10 | | equipment or the services provided and may not be based on the |
11 | | number of citations issued or the revenue generated by the |
12 | | system.
|
13 | | (h) (Blank.)
|
14 | | (i) If any part or parts of this Section are held by a |
15 | | court of competent
jurisdiction to be unconstitutional, the |
16 | | unconstitutionality shall not affect
the validity of the |
17 | | remaining parts of this Section. The General Assembly
hereby |
18 | | declares that it would have passed the remaining parts of this |
19 | | Section
if it had known that the other part or parts of this |
20 | | Section would be declared
unconstitutional.
|
21 | | (j) Penalty. A civil fine of
$250 shall be imposed for a |
22 | | first violation of this Section, and a civil fine of $500 shall |
23 | | be
imposed for a second or subsequent violation of this |
24 | | Section.
|
25 | | (Source: P.A. 101-395, eff. 8-16-19.)
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 461 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Article 115. |
2 | | Section 115-5. The School Code is amended by changing |
3 | | Section 21B-50 as follows: |
4 | | (105 ILCS 5/21B-50) |
5 | | Sec. 21B-50. Alternative Educator Licensure Program. |
6 | | (a) There is established an alternative educator licensure |
7 | | program, to be known as the Alternative Educator Licensure |
8 | | Program for Teachers. |
9 | | (b) The Alternative Educator Licensure Program for |
10 | | Teachers may be offered by a recognized institution approved to |
11 | | offer educator preparation programs by the State Board of |
12 | | Education, in consultation with the State Educator Preparation |
13 | | and Licensure Board. |
14 | | The program shall be comprised of 4 phases: |
15 | | (1) A course of study that at a minimum includes |
16 | | instructional planning; instructional strategies, |
17 | | including special education, reading, and English language |
18 | | learning; classroom management; and the assessment of |
19 | | students and use of data to drive instruction. |
20 | | (2) A year of residency, which is a candidate's |
21 | | assignment to a full-time teaching position or as a |
22 | | co-teacher for one full school year. An individual must |
23 | | hold an Educator License with Stipulations with an |
24 | | alternative provisional educator endorsement in order to |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 462 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | enter the residency and must complete additional program |
2 | | requirements that address required State and national |
3 | | standards, pass the State Board's teacher performance |
4 | | assessment no later than the end of the first semester of |
5 | | the second year of residency, as required under phase (3) |
6 | | of this subsection (b), and be recommended by the principal |
7 | | or qualified equivalent of a principal, as required under |
8 | | subsection (d) of this Section, and the program coordinator |
9 | | to continue with the second year of the residency. |
10 | | (3) A second year of residency, which shall include the |
11 | | candidate's assignment to a full-time teaching position |
12 | | for one school year. The candidate must be assigned an |
13 | | experienced teacher to act as a mentor and coach the |
14 | | candidate through the second year of residency. |
15 | | (4) A comprehensive assessment of the candidate's |
16 | | teaching effectiveness, as evaluated by the principal or |
17 | | qualified equivalent of a principal, as required under |
18 | | subsection (d) of this Section, and the program |
19 | | coordinator, at the end of the second year of residency. If |
20 | | there is disagreement between the 2 evaluators about the |
21 | | candidate's teaching effectiveness, the candidate may |
22 | | complete one additional year of residency teaching under a |
23 | | professional development plan developed by the principal |
24 | | or qualified equivalent and the preparation program. At the |
25 | | completion of the third year, a candidate must have |
26 | | positive evaluations and a recommendation for full |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 463 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | licensure from both the principal or qualified equivalent |
2 | | and the program coordinator or no Professional Educator |
3 | | License shall be issued. |
4 | | Successful completion of the program shall be deemed to |
5 | | satisfy any other practice or student teaching and content |
6 | | matter requirements established by law. |
7 | | (c) An alternative provisional educator endorsement on an |
8 | | Educator License with Stipulations is valid for 2 years of |
9 | | teaching in the public schools, including without limitation a |
10 | | preschool educational program under Section 2-3.71 of this Code |
11 | | or charter school, or in a State-recognized nonpublic school in |
12 | | which the chief administrator is required to have the licensure |
13 | | necessary to be a principal in a public school in this State |
14 | | and in which a majority of the teachers are required to have |
15 | | the licensure necessary to be instructors in a public school in |
16 | | this State, but may be renewed for a third year if needed to |
17 | | complete the Alternative Educator Licensure Program for |
18 | | Teachers. The endorsement shall be issued only once to an |
19 | | individual who meets all of the following requirements: |
20 | | (1) Has graduated from a regionally accredited college |
21 | | or university with a bachelor's degree or higher. |
22 | | (2) (Blank). Has a cumulative grade point average of |
23 | | 3.0 or greater on a 4.0 scale or its equivalent on another |
24 | | scale. |
25 | | (3) Has completed a major in the content area if |
26 | | seeking a middle or secondary level endorsement or, if |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 464 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | seeking an early childhood, elementary, or special |
2 | | education endorsement, has completed a major in the content |
3 | | area of reading, English/language arts, mathematics, or |
4 | | one of the sciences. If the individual does not have a |
5 | | major in a content area for any level of teaching, he or |
6 | | she must submit transcripts to the State Board of Education |
7 | | to be reviewed for equivalency. |
8 | | (4) Has successfully completed phase (1) of subsection |
9 | | (b) of this Section. |
10 | | (5) Has passed a content area test required for the |
11 | | specific endorsement for admission into the program, as |
12 | | required under Section 21B-30 of this Code. |
13 | | A candidate possessing the alternative provisional |
14 | | educator endorsement may receive a salary, benefits, and any |
15 | | other terms of employment offered to teachers in the school who |
16 | | are members of an exclusive bargaining representative, if any, |
17 | | but a school is not required to provide these benefits during |
18 | | the years of residency if the candidate is serving only as a |
19 | | co-teacher. If the candidate is serving as the teacher of |
20 | | record, the candidate must receive a salary, benefits, and any |
21 | | other terms of employment. Residency experiences must not be |
22 | | counted towards tenure. |
23 | | (d) The recognized institution offering the Alternative |
24 | | Educator Licensure Program for Teachers must partner with a |
25 | | school district, including without limitation a preschool |
26 | | educational program under Section 2-3.71 of this Code or |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 465 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | charter school, or a State-recognized, nonpublic school in this |
2 | | State in which the chief administrator is required to have the |
3 | | licensure necessary to be a principal in a public school in |
4 | | this State and in which a majority of the teachers are required |
5 | | to have the licensure necessary to be instructors in a public |
6 | | school in this State. A recognized institution that partners |
7 | | with a public school district administering a preschool |
8 | | educational program under Section 2-3.71 of this Code must |
9 | | require a principal to recommend or evaluate candidates in the |
10 | | program. A recognized institution that partners with an |
11 | | eligible entity administering a preschool educational program |
12 | | under Section 2-3.71 of this Code and that is not a public |
13 | | school district must require a principal or qualified |
14 | | equivalent of a principal to recommend or evaluate candidates |
15 | | in the program. The program presented for approval by the State |
16 | | Board of Education must demonstrate the supports that are to be |
17 | | provided to assist the provisional teacher during the 2-year |
18 | | residency period. These supports must provide additional |
19 | | contact hours with mentors during the first year of residency. |
20 | | (e) Upon completion of the 4 phases outlined in subsection |
21 | | (b) of this Section and all assessments required under Section |
22 | | 21B-30 of this Code, an individual shall receive a Professional |
23 | | Educator License. |
24 | | (f) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the |
25 | | State Educator Preparation and Licensure Board, may adopt such |
26 | | rules as may be necessary to establish and implement the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 466 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Alternative Educator Licensure Program for Teachers.
|
2 | | (Source: P.A. 100-596, eff. 7-1-18; 100-822, eff. 1-1-19; |
3 | | 101-220, eff. 8-7-19; 101-570, eff. 8-23-19; 101-643, eff. |
4 | | 6-18-20.) |
5 | | Article 120. |
6 | | Section 120-5. The Higher Education Student Assistance Act |
7 | | is amended by changing Section 50 as follows: |
8 | | (110 ILCS 947/50)
|
9 | | Sec. 50. Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship |
10 | | program.
|
11 | | (a) As used in this Section:
|
12 | | "Eligible applicant" means a minority student who has |
13 | | graduated
from high school or has received a high school |
14 | | equivalency certificate
and has
maintained a cumulative |
15 | | grade point average of
no
less than 2.5 on a 4.0 scale, and |
16 | | who by reason thereof is entitled to
apply for scholarships |
17 | | to be awarded under this Section.
|
18 | | "Minority student" means a student who is any of the |
19 | | following: |
20 | | (1) American Indian or Alaska Native (a person |
21 | | having origins in any of the original peoples of North |
22 | | and South America, including Central America, and who |
23 | | maintains tribal affiliation or community attachment). |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 467 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (2) Asian (a person having origins in any of the |
2 | | original peoples of the Far East, Southeast Asia, or |
3 | | the Indian subcontinent, including, but not limited |
4 | | to, Cambodia, China, India, Japan, Korea, Malaysia, |
5 | | Pakistan, the Philippine Islands, Thailand, and |
6 | | Vietnam). |
7 | | (3) Black or African American (a person having |
8 | | origins in any of the black racial groups of Africa). |
9 | | Terms such as "Haitian" or "Negro" can be used in |
10 | | addition to "Black or African American". |
11 | | (4) Hispanic or Latino (a person of Cuban, Mexican, |
12 | | Puerto Rican, South or Central American, or other |
13 | | Spanish culture or origin, regardless of race). |
14 | | (5) Native Hawaiian or Other Pacific Islander (a |
15 | | person having origins in any of the original peoples of |
16 | | Hawaii, Guam, Samoa, or other Pacific Islands).
|
17 | | "Qualified bilingual minority applicant" means a |
18 | | minority student who demonstrates proficiency in a |
19 | | language other than English by (i) receiving a State Seal |
20 | | of Biliteracy from the State Board of Education or (ii) |
21 | | receiving a passing score on an educator licensure target |
22 | | language proficiency test. |
23 | | "Qualified student" means a person (i) who is a |
24 | | resident of this State
and eligible for State financial aid |
25 | | under Section 15 of the Retention of Illinois Students and |
26 | | Equity Act a citizen or permanent resident of the United |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 468 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | States ; (ii) who is a
minority student, as defined in this |
2 | | Section; (iii) who, as an eligible
applicant, has made a |
3 | | timely application for a minority teaching
scholarship |
4 | | under this Section; (iv) who is enrolled on at least a
|
5 | | half-time basis at a
qualified Illinois institution of
|
6 | | higher learning; (v) who is enrolled in a course of study |
7 | | leading to
teacher licensure, including alternative |
8 | | teacher licensure, or, if the student is already licensed |
9 | | to teach, in a course of study leading to an additional |
10 | | teaching endorsement or a master's degree in an academic |
11 | | field in which he or she is teaching or plans to teach or |
12 | | who has received one or more College and Career Pathway |
13 | | Endorsements pursuant to Section 80 of the Postsecondary |
14 | | and Workforce Readiness Act and commits to enrolling in a |
15 | | course of study leading to teacher licensure, including |
16 | | alternative teacher licensure ; (vi)
who maintains a grade |
17 | | point average of no
less than 2.5 on a 4.0 scale;
and (vii) |
18 | | who continues to advance satisfactorily toward the |
19 | | attainment
of a degree.
|
20 | | (b) In order to encourage academically talented Illinois |
21 | | minority
students to pursue teaching careers at the preschool |
22 | | or elementary or
secondary
school
level, each qualified student |
23 | | shall be awarded a minority teacher
scholarship to any |
24 | | qualified Illinois institution of higher learning.
However, |
25 | | preference may be given to qualified applicants enrolled at or |
26 | | above
the
junior level.
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 469 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | (c) Each minority teacher scholarship awarded under this |
2 | | Section shall
be in an amount sufficient to pay the tuition and |
3 | | fees and room and board
costs of the qualified Illinois |
4 | | institution of higher learning at which the
recipient is |
5 | | enrolled, up to an annual maximum of $5,000;
except that
in
the |
6 | | case of a recipient who does not reside on-campus at the |
7 | | institution at
which he or she is enrolled, the amount of the |
8 | | scholarship shall be
sufficient to pay tuition and fee expenses |
9 | | and a commuter allowance, up to
an annual maximum of $5,000.
|
10 | | However, if at least $2,850,000 is appropriated in a given |
11 | | fiscal year for the Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship |
12 | | program, then, in each fiscal year thereafter, each scholarship |
13 | | awarded under this Section shall
be in an amount sufficient to |
14 | | pay the tuition and fees and room and board
costs of the |
15 | | qualified Illinois institution of higher learning at which the
|
16 | | recipient is enrolled, up to an annual maximum of $7,500;
|
17 | | except that
in
the case of a recipient who does not reside |
18 | | on-campus at the institution at
which he or she is enrolled, |
19 | | the amount of the scholarship shall be
sufficient to pay |
20 | | tuition and fee expenses and a commuter allowance, up to
an |
21 | | annual maximum of $7,500.
|
22 | | (d) The total amount of minority teacher scholarship |
23 | | assistance awarded by
the Commission under this Section to an |
24 | | individual in any given fiscal
year, when added to other |
25 | | financial assistance awarded to that individual
for that year, |
26 | | shall not exceed the cost of attendance at the institution
at |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 470 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | which the student is enrolled. If the amount of minority |
2 | | teacher
scholarship to be awarded to a qualified student as |
3 | | provided in
subsection (c) of this Section exceeds the cost of |
4 | | attendance at the
institution at which the student is enrolled, |
5 | | the minority teacher
scholarship shall be reduced by an amount |
6 | | equal to the amount by which the
combined financial assistance |
7 | | available to the student exceeds the cost
of attendance.
|
8 | | (e) The maximum number of academic terms for which a |
9 | | qualified
student
can receive minority teacher scholarship |
10 | | assistance shall be 8 semesters or
12 quarters.
|
11 | | (f) In any academic year for which an eligible applicant |
12 | | under this
Section accepts financial assistance through the |
13 | | Paul Douglas Teacher
Scholarship Program, as authorized by |
14 | | Section 551 et seq. of the Higher
Education Act of 1965, the |
15 | | applicant shall not be eligible for scholarship
assistance |
16 | | awarded under this Section.
|
17 | | (g) All applications for minority teacher scholarships to |
18 | | be awarded
under this Section shall be made to the Commission |
19 | | on forms which the
Commission shall provide for eligible |
20 | | applicants. The form of applications
and the information |
21 | | required to be set forth therein shall be determined by
the |
22 | | Commission, and the Commission shall require eligible |
23 | | applicants to
submit with their applications such supporting |
24 | | documents or recommendations
as the Commission deems |
25 | | necessary.
|
26 | | (h) Subject to a separate appropriation for such purposes, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 471 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | payment of
any minority teacher scholarship awarded under this |
2 | | Section shall be
determined by the Commission. All scholarship |
3 | | funds distributed in
accordance with this subsection shall be |
4 | | paid to the institution and used
only for payment of the |
5 | | tuition and fee and room and board expenses
incurred by the |
6 | | student in connection with his or her attendance at a qualified |
7 | | Illinois institution of higher
learning. Any minority teacher |
8 | | scholarship awarded under this Section
shall be applicable to 2 |
9 | | semesters or 3 quarters of enrollment. If a
qualified student |
10 | | withdraws from enrollment prior to completion of the
first |
11 | | semester or quarter for which the minority teacher scholarship |
12 | | is
applicable, the school shall refund to the Commission the |
13 | | full amount of the
minority teacher scholarship.
|
14 | | (i) The Commission shall administer the minority teacher |
15 | | scholarship aid
program established by this Section and shall |
16 | | make all necessary and proper
rules not inconsistent with this |
17 | | Section for its effective implementation.
|
18 | | (j) When an appropriation to the Commission for a given |
19 | | fiscal year is
insufficient to provide scholarships to all |
20 | | qualified students, the
Commission shall allocate the |
21 | | appropriation in accordance with this
subsection. If funds are |
22 | | insufficient to provide all qualified students
with a |
23 | | scholarship as authorized by this Section, the Commission shall
|
24 | | allocate the available scholarship funds for that fiscal year |
25 | | to qualified students who submit a complete application form on |
26 | | or before a date specified by the Commission based on the |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 472 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | following order of priority: |
2 | | (1) To students who received a scholarship under this |
3 | | Section in the prior academic year and who remain eligible |
4 | | for a minority teacher scholarship under this Section. |
5 | | (2) Except as otherwise provided in subsection (k), to |
6 | | students who demonstrate financial need, as determined by |
7 | | the Commission. on the basis
of the date the Commission |
8 | | receives a complete application form.
|
9 | | (k) Notwithstanding paragraph (2) of the provisions of |
10 | | subsection (j) or any other
provision of this Section , at least |
11 | | 35% 30% of the funds appropriated for
scholarships awarded |
12 | | under this Section in each fiscal year shall be reserved
for |
13 | | qualified male minority applicants , with priority being given |
14 | | to qualified Black male applicants beginning with fiscal year |
15 | | 2023 .
If the Commission does not receive enough applications |
16 | | from qualified male
minorities on or before
January 1 of each |
17 | | fiscal year to award 35% 30% of the funds appropriated for |
18 | | these
scholarships to qualified
male minority applicants, then |
19 | | the Commission may award a portion of the
reserved funds to |
20 | | qualified
female minority applicants in accordance with |
21 | | subsection (j) .
|
22 | | Beginning with fiscal year 2023, if at least $2,850,000 but |
23 | | less than $4,200,000 is appropriated in a given fiscal year for |
24 | | scholarships awarded under this Section, then at least 10% of |
25 | | the funds appropriated shall be reserved for qualified |
26 | | bilingual minority applicants, with priority being given to |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 473 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | qualified bilingual minority applicants who are enrolled in an |
2 | | educator preparation program with a concentration in |
3 | | bilingual, bicultural education. Beginning with fiscal year |
4 | | 2023, if at least $4,200,000 is appropriated in a given fiscal |
5 | | year for the Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship program, |
6 | | then at least 30% of the funds appropriated shall be reserved |
7 | | for qualified bilingual minority applicants, with priority |
8 | | being given to qualified bilingual minority applicants who are |
9 | | enrolled in an educator preparation program with a |
10 | | concentration in bilingual, bicultural education. Beginning |
11 | | with fiscal year 2023, if at least $2,850,000 is appropriated |
12 | | in a given fiscal year for scholarships awarded under this |
13 | | Section but the Commission does not receive enough applications |
14 | | from qualified bilingual minority applicants on or before |
15 | | January 1 of that fiscal year to award at least 10% of the |
16 | | funds appropriated to qualified bilingual minority applicants, |
17 | | then the Commission may, in its discretion, award a portion of |
18 | | the reserved funds to other qualified students in accordance |
19 | | with subsection (j).
|
20 | | (l) Prior to receiving scholarship assistance for any |
21 | | academic year,
each recipient of a minority teacher scholarship |
22 | | awarded under this Section
shall be required by the Commission |
23 | | to sign an agreement under which the
recipient pledges that, |
24 | | within the one-year period following the
termination
of the |
25 | | program for which the recipient was awarded a minority
teacher |
26 | | scholarship, the recipient (i) shall begin teaching for a
|
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 474 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | period of not less
than one year for each year of scholarship |
2 | | assistance he or she was awarded
under this Section; and (ii) |
3 | | shall fulfill this teaching obligation at a
nonprofit Illinois |
4 | | public, private, or parochial preschool, elementary school,
or |
5 | | secondary school at which no less than 30% of the enrolled |
6 | | students are
minority students in the year during which the |
7 | | recipient begins teaching at the
school or may instead, if the |
8 | | recipient received a scholarship as a qualified bilingual |
9 | | minority applicant, fulfill this teaching obligation in a |
10 | | program in transitional bilingual education pursuant to |
11 | | Article 14C of the School Code or in a school in which 20 or |
12 | | more English learner students in the same language |
13 | | classification are enrolled ; and (iii) shall, upon request by |
14 | | the Commission, provide the Commission
with evidence that he or |
15 | | she is fulfilling or has fulfilled the terms of the
teaching |
16 | | agreement provided for in this subsection.
|
17 | | (m) If a recipient of a minority teacher scholarship |
18 | | awarded under this
Section fails to fulfill the teaching |
19 | | obligation set forth in subsection
(l) of this Section, the |
20 | | Commission shall require the recipient to repay
the amount of |
21 | | the scholarships received, prorated according to the fraction
|
22 | | of the teaching obligation not completed, at a rate of interest |
23 | | equal to
5%, and, if applicable, reasonable collection fees.
|
24 | | The Commission is authorized to establish rules relating to its |
25 | | collection
activities for repayment of scholarships under this |
26 | | Section. All repayments
collected under this Section shall be |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 475 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | forwarded to the State Comptroller for
deposit into the State's |
2 | | General Revenue Fund.
|
3 | | (n) A recipient of minority teacher scholarship shall not |
4 | | be considered
in violation of the agreement entered into |
5 | | pursuant to subsection (l) if
the recipient (i) enrolls on a |
6 | | full time basis as a graduate student in a
course of study |
7 | | related to the field of teaching at a qualified Illinois
|
8 | | institution of higher learning; (ii) is serving, not in excess |
9 | | of 3 years,
as a member of the armed services of the United |
10 | | States; (iii) is
a person with a temporary total disability for |
11 | | a period of time not to exceed 3 years as
established by sworn |
12 | | affidavit of a qualified physician; (iv) is seeking
and unable |
13 | | to find full time employment as a teacher at an Illinois |
14 | | public,
private, or parochial preschool or elementary or |
15 | | secondary school that
satisfies the
criteria set forth in |
16 | | subsection (l) of this Section and is able to provide
evidence |
17 | | of that fact; (v) becomes a person with a permanent total |
18 | | disability as
established by sworn affidavit of a qualified |
19 | | physician; (vi) is taking additional courses, on at least a |
20 | | half-time basis, needed to obtain licensure as a teacher in |
21 | | Illinois; or (vii) is fulfilling teaching requirements |
22 | | associated with other programs administered by the Commission |
23 | | and cannot concurrently fulfill them under this Section in a |
24 | | period of time equal to the length of the teaching obligation.
|
25 | | (o) Scholarship recipients under this Section who withdraw |
26 | | from
a program of teacher education but remain enrolled in |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 476 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | school
to continue their postsecondary studies in another |
2 | | academic discipline shall
not be required to commence repayment |
3 | | of their Minority Teachers of Illinois
scholarship so long as |
4 | | they remain enrolled in school on a full-time basis or
if they |
5 | | can document for the Commission special circumstances that |
6 | | warrant
extension of repayment.
|
7 | | (p) If the Minority Teachers of Illinois scholarship |
8 | | program does not expend at least 90% of the amount appropriated |
9 | | for the program in a given fiscal year for 3 consecutive fiscal |
10 | | years and the Commission does not receive enough applications |
11 | | from the groups identified in subsection (k) on or before |
12 | | January 1 in each of those fiscal years to meet the percentage |
13 | | reserved for those groups under subsection (k), then up to 3% |
14 | | of amount appropriated for the program for each of next 3 |
15 | | fiscal years shall be allocated to increasing awareness of the |
16 | | program and for the recruitment of Black male applicants. The |
17 | | Commission shall make a recommendation to the General Assembly |
18 | | by January 1 of the year immediately following the end of that |
19 | | third fiscal year regarding whether the amount allocated to |
20 | | increasing awareness and recruitment should continue. |
21 | | (q) Each qualified Illinois institution of higher learning |
22 | | that receives funds from the Minority Teachers of Illinois |
23 | | scholarship program shall host an annual information session at |
24 | | the institution about the program for teacher candidates of |
25 | | color in accordance with rules adopted by the Commission. |
26 | | Additionally, the institution shall ensure that each |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 477 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | scholarship recipient enrolled at the institution meets with an |
2 | | academic advisor at least once per academic year to facilitate |
3 | | on-time completion of the recipient's educator preparation |
4 | | program. |
5 | | (Source: P.A. 99-143, eff. 7-27-15; 100-235, eff. 6-1-18 .)
|
6 | | Article 125. |
7 | | Section 125-5. The Higher Education Student Assistance Act |
8 | | is amended by changing Section 65.100 as follows: |
9 | | (110 ILCS 947/65.100) |
10 | | (Section scheduled to be repealed on October 1, 2024) |
11 | | Sec. 65.100. AIM HIGH Grant Pilot Program. |
12 | | (a) The General Assembly makes all of the following |
13 | | findings: |
14 | | (1) Both access and affordability are important |
15 | | aspects of the Illinois Public Agenda for College and |
16 | | Career Success report. |
17 | | (2) This State is in the top quartile with respect to |
18 | | the percentage of family income needed to pay for college. |
19 | | (3) Research suggests that as loan amounts increase, |
20 | | rather than an increase in grant amounts, the probability |
21 | | of college attendance decreases. |
22 | | (4) There is further research indicating that |
23 | | socioeconomic status may affect the willingness of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 478 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | students to use loans to attend college. |
2 | | (5) Strategic use of tuition discounting can decrease |
3 | | the amount of loans that students must use to pay for |
4 | | tuition. |
5 | | (6) A modest, individually tailored tuition discount |
6 | | can make the difference in a student choosing to attend |
7 | | college and enhance college access for low-income and |
8 | | middle-income families. |
9 | | (7) Even if the federally calculated financial need for |
10 | | college attendance is met, the federally determined |
11 | | Expected Family Contribution can still be a daunting |
12 | | amount. |
13 | | (8) This State is the second largest exporter of |
14 | | students in the country. |
15 | | (9) When talented Illinois students attend |
16 | | universities in this State, the State and those |
17 | | universities benefit. |
18 | | (10) State universities in other states have adopted |
19 | | pricing and incentives that allow many Illinois residents |
20 | | to pay less to attend an out-of-state university than to |
21 | | remain in this State for college. |
22 | | (11) Supporting Illinois student attendance at |
23 | | Illinois public universities can assist in State efforts to |
24 | | maintain and educate a highly trained workforce. |
25 | | (12) Modest tuition discounts that are individually |
26 | | targeted and tailored can result in enhanced revenue for |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 479 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | public universities. |
2 | | (13) By increasing a public university's capacity to |
3 | | strategically use tuition discounting, the public |
4 | | university will be capable of creating enhanced tuition |
5 | | revenue by increasing enrollment yields. |
6 | | (b) In this Section: |
7 | | "Eligible applicant" means a student from any high school |
8 | | in this State, whether or not recognized by the State Board of |
9 | | Education, who is engaged in a program of study that in due |
10 | | course will be completed by the end of the school year and who |
11 | | meets all of the qualifications and requirements under this |
12 | | Section. |
13 | | "Tuition and other necessary fees" includes the customary |
14 | | charge for instruction and use of facilities in general and the |
15 | | additional fixed fees charged for specified purposes that are |
16 | | required generally of non-grant recipients for each academic |
17 | | period for which the grant applicant actually enrolls, but does |
18 | | not include fees payable only once or breakage fees and other |
19 | | contingent deposits that are refundable in whole or in part. |
20 | | The Commission may adopt, by rule not inconsistent with this |
21 | | Section, detailed provisions concerning the computation of |
22 | | tuition and other necessary fees. |
23 | | (c) Beginning with the 2019-2020 academic year, each public |
24 | | university may establish a merit-based scholarship pilot |
25 | | program known as the AIM HIGH Grant Pilot Program. Each year, |
26 | | the Commission shall receive and consider applications from |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 480 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | public universities under this Section. Subject to |
2 | | appropriation and any tuition waiver limitation established by |
3 | | the Board of Higher Education, a public university campus may |
4 | | award a grant to a student under this Section if it finds that |
5 | | the applicant meets all of the following criteria: |
6 | | (1) He or she is a resident of this State and a citizen |
7 | | or eligible noncitizen of the United States. |
8 | | (2) He or she files a Free Application for Federal |
9 | | Student Aid and demonstrates financial need with a |
10 | | household income no greater than 6 times the poverty |
11 | | guidelines updated periodically in the Federal Register by |
12 | | the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services under the |
13 | | authority of 42 U.S.C. 9902(2). The household income of the |
14 | | applicant at the time of initial application shall be |
15 | | deemed to be the household income of the applicant for the |
16 | | duration of the pilot program. |
17 | | (3) He or she meets the minimum cumulative grade point |
18 | | average or ACT or SAT college admissions test score, as |
19 | | determined by the public university campus. |
20 | | (4) He or she is enrolled in a public university as an |
21 | | undergraduate student on a full-time basis. |
22 | | (5) He or she has not yet received a baccalaureate |
23 | | degree or the equivalent of 135 semester credit hours. |
24 | | (6) He or she is not incarcerated. |
25 | | (7) He or she is not in default on any student loan or |
26 | | does not owe a refund or repayment on any State or federal |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 481 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | grant or scholarship. |
2 | | (8) Any other reasonable criteria, as determined by the |
3 | | public university campus. |
4 | | (d) Each public university campus shall determine grant |
5 | | renewal criteria consistent with the requirements under this |
6 | | Section. |
7 | | (e) Each participating public university campus shall post |
8 | | on its Internet website criteria and eligibility requirements |
9 | | for receiving awards that use funds under this Section that |
10 | | include a range in the sizes of these individual awards. The |
11 | | criteria and amounts must also be reported to the Commission |
12 | | and the Board of Higher Education, who shall post the |
13 | | information on their respective Internet websites. |
14 | | (f) After enactment of an appropriation for this Program, |
15 | | the Commission shall determine an allocation of funds to each |
16 | | public university in an amount proportionate to the number of |
17 | | undergraduate students who are residents of this State and |
18 | | citizens or eligible noncitizens of the United States and who |
19 | | were enrolled at each public university campus in the previous |
20 | | academic year. All applications must be made to the Commission |
21 | | on or before a date determined by the Commission and on forms |
22 | | that the Commission shall provide to each public university |
23 | | campus. The form of the application and the information |
24 | | required shall be determined by the Commission and shall |
25 | | include, without limitation, the total public university |
26 | | campus funds used to match funds received from the Commission |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 482 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | in the previous academic year under this Section, if any, the |
2 | | total enrollment of undergraduate students who are residents of |
3 | | this State from the previous academic year, and any supporting |
4 | | documents as the Commission deems necessary. Each public |
5 | | university campus shall match the amount of funds received by |
6 | | the Commission with financial aid for eligible students. |
7 | | A public university that has reported to the Commission |
8 | | that at least 49% of its student body received financial aid |
9 | | under the federal Pell Grant program for the previous academic |
10 | | year shall match 20% of the amount of funds received from the |
11 | | Commission for financial aid for eligible students. |
12 | | A public university that has reported to the Commission |
13 | | that less than 49% of its student body received financial aid |
14 | | under the federal Pell Grant program for the previous academic |
15 | | year shall match 60% of the amount of funds received from the |
16 | | Commission for financial aid for eligible students. |
17 | | A public university campus is not required to claim its |
18 | | entire allocation. The Commission shall make available to all |
19 | | public universities, on a date determined by the Commission, |
20 | | any unclaimed funds and the funds must be made available to |
21 | | those public university campuses in the proportion determined |
22 | | under this subsection (f), excluding from the calculation those |
23 | | public university campuses not claiming their full |
24 | | allocations. |
25 | | Each public university campus may determine the award |
26 | | amounts for eligible students on an individual or broad basis, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 483 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | but, subject to renewal eligibility, each renewed award may not |
2 | | be less than the amount awarded to the eligible student in his |
3 | | or her first year attending the public university campus. |
4 | | Notwithstanding this limitation, a renewal grant may be reduced |
5 | | due to changes in the student's cost of attendance, including, |
6 | | but not limited to, if a student reduces the number of credit |
7 | | hours in which he or she is enrolled, but remains a full-time |
8 | | student, or switches to a course of study with a lower tuition |
9 | | rate. |
10 | | An eligible applicant awarded grant assistance under this |
11 | | Section is eligible to receive other financial aid. Total grant |
12 | | aid to the student from all sources may not exceed the total |
13 | | cost of attendance at the public university campus. |
14 | | (g) All money allocated to a public university campus under |
15 | | this Section may be used only for financial aid purposes for |
16 | | students attending the public university campus during the |
17 | | academic year, not including summer terms. Notwithstanding any |
18 | | other provision of law to the contrary, any funds received by a |
19 | | public university campus under this Section that are not |
20 | | granted to students in the academic year for which the funds |
21 | | are received may be retained by the public university campus |
22 | | for expenditure on students participating in the Program or |
23 | | students eligible to participate in the Program. |
24 | | (h) Each public university campus that establishes a |
25 | | Program under this Section must annually report to the |
26 | | Commission, on or before a date determined by the Commission, |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 484 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the number of undergraduate students enrolled at that campus |
2 | | who are residents of this State. |
3 | | (i) Each public university campus must report to the |
4 | | Commission the total non-loan financial aid amount given by the |
5 | | public university campus to undergraduate students in the |
6 | | 2017-2018 academic year, not including the summer term. To be |
7 | | eligible to receive funds under the Program, a public |
8 | | university campus may not decrease the total amount of non-loan |
9 | | financial aid it gives to undergraduate students, not including |
10 | | any funds received from the Commission under this Section or |
11 | | any funds used to match grant awards under this Section, to an |
12 | | amount lower than the reported amount for the 2017-2018 |
13 | | academic year, not including the summer term. |
14 | | (j) On or before a date determined by the Commission, each |
15 | | public university campus that participates in the Program under |
16 | | this Section shall annually submit a report to the Commission |
17 | | with all of the following information: |
18 | | (1) The Program's impact on tuition revenue and |
19 | | enrollment goals and increase in access and affordability |
20 | | at the public university campus. |
21 | | (2) Total funds received by the public university |
22 | | campus under the Program. |
23 | | (3) Total non-loan financial aid awarded to |
24 | | undergraduate students attending the public university |
25 | | campus. |
26 | | (4) Total amount of funds matched by the public |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 485 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | university campus. |
2 | | (5) Total amount of claimed and unexpended funds |
3 | | retained by the public university campus. |
4 | | (6) The percentage of total financial aid distributed |
5 | | under the Program by the public university campus. |
6 | | (7) The total number of students receiving grants from |
7 | | the public university campus under the Program and those |
8 | | students' grade level, race, gender, income level, family |
9 | | size, Monetary Award Program eligibility, Pell Grant |
10 | | eligibility, and zip code of residence and the amount of |
11 | | each grant award. This information shall include unit |
12 | | record data on those students regarding variables |
13 | | associated with the parameters of the public university's |
14 | | Program, including, but not limited to, a student's ACT or |
15 | | SAT college admissions test score, high school or |
16 | | university cumulative grade point average, or program of |
17 | | study. |
18 | | On or before October 1, 2020 and annually on or before |
19 | | October 1 thereafter, the Commission shall submit a report with |
20 | | the findings under this subsection (j) and any other |
21 | | information regarding the AIM HIGH Grant Pilot Program to (i) |
22 | | the Governor, (ii) the Speaker of the House of Representatives, |
23 | | (iii) the Minority Leader of the House of Representatives, (iv) |
24 | | the President of the Senate, and (v) the Minority Leader of the |
25 | | Senate. The reports to the General Assembly shall be filed with |
26 | | the Clerk of the House of Representatives and the Secretary of |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 486 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | the Senate in electronic form only, in the manner that the |
2 | | Clerk and the Secretary shall direct. The Commission's report |
3 | | may not disaggregate data to a level that may disclose |
4 | | personally identifying information of individual students. |
5 | | The sharing and reporting of student data under this |
6 | | subsection (j) must be in accordance with the requirements |
7 | | under the federal Family Educational Rights and Privacy Act of |
8 | | 1974 and the Illinois School Student Records Act. All parties |
9 | | must preserve the confidentiality of the information as |
10 | | required by law. The names of the grant recipients under this |
11 | | Section are not subject to disclosure under the Freedom of |
12 | | Information Act. |
13 | | Public university campuses that fail to submit a report |
14 | | under this subsection (j) or that fail to adhere to any other |
15 | | requirements under this Section may not be eligible for |
16 | | distribution of funds under the Program for the next academic |
17 | | year, but may be eligible for distribution of funds for each |
18 | | academic year thereafter. |
19 | | (k) The Commission shall adopt rules to implement this |
20 | | Section. |
21 | | (l) This Section is repealed on October 1, 2024.
|
22 | | (Source: P.A. 100-587, eff. 6-4-18; 100-1015, eff. 8-21-18; |
23 | | 100-1183, eff. 4-4-19; 101-81, eff. 7-12-19; 101-613, eff. |
24 | | 6-1-20; 101-643, eff. 6-18-20.) |
25 | | Article 130. |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 487 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Section 130-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as |
2 | | the Transitions in Education Act. References in this Article to |
3 | | "this Act" mean this Article. |
4 | | Section 130-5. Findings; policies. |
5 | | (a) The General Assembly finds the following: |
6 | | (1) Teachers are the single most important in-school |
7 | | factor in supporting student outcomes and success; yet, |
8 | | Illinois is suffering from a profound teacher shortage |
9 | | across the State. |
10 | | (2) To reverse this shortage, Illinois needs to develop |
11 | | and invest in a robust and diverse educator pipeline, |
12 | | addressing any barriers or gaps that limit high quality |
13 | | candidates, particularly candidates of color, from |
14 | | becoming teachers. |
15 | | (3) Illinois loses many high quality, diverse educator |
16 | | candidates in postsecondary programs due to confusion or |
17 | | lack of course transfer credits and course articulation |
18 | | from Illinois's 2-year to 4-year institutions. |
19 | | (4) Lack of alignment and transferability of course |
20 | | credits may often force candidates to spend additional time |
21 | | and money to earn a degree or lead to an inability to |
22 | | complete a degree. |
23 | | (5) In 1993, the Board of Higher Education, the |
24 | | Illinois Community College Board, and the Transfer |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 488 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | Coordinators of Illinois Colleges and Universities brought |
2 | | together faculty from public and independent, associate, |
3 | | and baccalaureate degree-granting institutions across the |
4 | | State to develop the Illinois Articulation Initiative |
5 | | (IAI). |
6 | | (6) The goal of IAI is to facilitate the transfer of |
7 | | courses from one participating college or university to |
8 | | another in order to complete a baccalaureate degree. |
9 | | (7) The Student Transfer Achievement Reform (STAR) |
10 | | Act, as mandated by subsection (b) of Section 25 of the |
11 | | Act, is designed to facilitate transfer among Illinois |
12 | | public institutions, particularly for students with a |
13 | | completed Associate of Arts or an Associate of Science |
14 | | degree. |
15 | | (8) While Illinois is a leading state for college |
16 | | completion rates for adult learners and transfer students |
17 | | from community colleges, it needs to increase the number of |
18 | | high-quality postsecondary teaching credentials to meet |
19 | | the demands of our schools and education workforce. |
20 | | (9) With the rising costs of higher education for |
21 | | Illinois students and families, the State needs to ensure |
22 | | to the maximize extent possible that community college |
23 | | courses will transfer with full credit for the student and |
24 | | be accepted at an Illinois public or private institution as |
25 | | they pursue a baccalaureate degree in education. |
26 | | (10) Illinois can do this by improving transitions all |
|
| | 10100HB2170sam001 | - 489 - | LRB101 07409 CMG 74497 a |
|
|
1 | | along the education pipeline; for postsecondary education, |
2 | | this means strengthening articulation through stable |
3 | | funding and the expansion of transfer tools, such as |
4 | | Transferology and the IAI through development of an |
5 | | objective measure of transfer and acceptance of credits in |
6 | | education degrees. |
7 | | (11) The IAI Education Pathway can be modeled off of |
8 | | existing IAI major pathways like Early Childhood Education |
9 | | and Criminal Justice.
|
10 | | (b) The General Assembly encourages the Board of Higher |
11 | | Education, the State Board of Education, and the Illinois |
12 | | Community College Board, as part of the IAI, to do all of the |
13 | | following: |
14 | | (1) To jointly establish a task force for a Major Panel |
15 | | in Education and identify respective recommended major |
16 | | courses that would be accepted as credit toward the |
17 | | education major at the receiving institutions. |
18 | | (2) As part of the report on the status of the Illinois |
19 | | Articulation Initiative pursuant to Section 25 of the |
20 | | Illinois Articulation Initiative Act, the Board of Higher |
21 | | Education and the Illinois Community College Board are |
22 | | encourage to include in the annual report to the General |
23 | | Assembly, the Governor, and the Illinois P-20 Council the |
24 | | progress made on the task force on the Education Major |
25 | | Panel. |